20090811-1.c: Skip for incompatible options, do not override other options.
[official-gcc.git] / gcc / dwarf2out.c
blob776066b275c905596a1b791e7841c73b0b69146e
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2 Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011
4 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
6 Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
7 Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
9 This file is part of GCC.
11 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
12 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
13 Software Foundation; either version 3, or (at your option) any later
14 version.
16 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
17 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
18 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
19 for more details.
21 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
22 along with GCC; see the file COPYING3. If not see
23 <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 the file numbers are used by .debug_info. Alternately, leave
27 out locations for types and decls.
28 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs. */
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32 information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33 mechanism. The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34 DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35 information. */
37 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
39 CFA = Canonical Frame Address
40 a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
41 We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
42 The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
43 of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
45 CFI = Call Frame Instruction
46 an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
48 CIE = Common Information Entry
49 information describing information common to one or more FDEs
51 DIE = Debugging Information Entry
53 FDE = Frame Description Entry
54 information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
55 how to restore registers
57 DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
58 DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
60 #include "config.h"
61 #include "system.h"
62 #include "coretypes.h"
63 #include "tm.h"
64 #include "tree.h"
65 #include "version.h"
66 #include "flags.h"
67 #include "rtl.h"
68 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
69 #include "regs.h"
70 #include "insn-config.h"
71 #include "reload.h"
72 #include "function.h"
73 #include "output.h"
74 #include "expr.h"
75 #include "libfuncs.h"
76 #include "except.h"
77 #include "dwarf2.h"
78 #include "dwarf2out.h"
79 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
80 #include "toplev.h"
81 #include "ggc.h"
82 #include "md5.h"
83 #include "tm_p.h"
84 #include "diagnostic.h"
85 #include "tree-pretty-print.h"
86 #include "debug.h"
87 #include "target.h"
88 #include "langhooks.h"
89 #include "hashtab.h"
90 #include "cgraph.h"
91 #include "input.h"
92 #include "gimple.h"
93 #include "tree-pass.h"
94 #include "tree-flow.h"
95 #include "cfglayout.h"
97 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *, int, bool);
98 static rtx last_var_location_insn;
100 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
101 int vms_file_stats_name (const char *, long long *, long *, char *, int *);
103 /* Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the directory specifications
104 which are output in the debug info should end with a separator. */
105 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 1
106 /* Define this macro to evaluate to a nonzero value if GCC should refrain
107 from generating indirect strings in DWARF2 debug information, for instance
108 if your target is stuck with an old version of GDB that is unable to
109 process them properly or uses VMS Debug. */
110 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 1
111 #else
112 #define DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR 0
113 #define DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET 0
114 #endif
116 /* ??? Poison these here until it can be done generically. They've been
117 totally replaced in this file; make sure it stays that way. */
118 #undef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
119 #undef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
120 #if (GCC_VERSION >= 3000)
121 #pragma GCC poison DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
122 #endif
124 #ifndef INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
125 #define INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX (gcc_unreachable (), NULL_RTX)
126 #endif
128 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
129 collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
130 .debug_frame and .eh_frame. */
131 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
132 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
133 #endif
135 /* Save the result of dwarf2out_do_frame across PCH. */
136 static GTY(()) bool saved_do_cfi_asm = 0;
138 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
139 translation unit. */
142 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
144 /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
145 have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
146 we're not going to output frame or unwind info. */
147 if (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
148 return true;
150 if (saved_do_cfi_asm)
151 return true;
153 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
154 return true;
156 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
157 && targetm.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
158 return true;
160 return false;
163 /* Decide whether to emit frame unwind via assembler directives. */
166 dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm (void)
168 int enc;
170 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
171 return false;
172 #endif
173 if (saved_do_cfi_asm)
174 return true;
175 if (!flag_dwarf2_cfi_asm || !dwarf2out_do_frame ())
176 return false;
177 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_PERSONALITY_DIRECTIVE)
178 return false;
180 /* Make sure the personality encoding is one the assembler can support.
181 In particular, aligned addresses can't be handled. */
182 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,/*global=*/1);
183 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
184 return false;
185 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,/*global=*/0);
186 if ((enc & 0x70) != 0 && (enc & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_pcrel)
187 return false;
189 /* If we can't get the assembler to emit only .debug_frame, and we don't need
190 dwarf2 unwind info for exceptions, then emit .debug_frame by hand. */
191 if (!HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
192 && !flag_unwind_tables && !flag_exceptions
193 && targetm.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2)
194 return false;
196 saved_do_cfi_asm = true;
197 return true;
200 /* The size of the target's pointer type. */
201 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
202 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
203 #endif
205 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
206 must be kept around forever. */
207 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
209 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
210 completed at some later time. incomplete_types_list needs to be a
211 VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
212 it. */
213 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
215 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
216 scopes. This table is a display which tracks the nesting
217 of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
218 scopes. This table is used to find the proper place to
219 define type declaration DIE's. */
220 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
222 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections. */
223 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
224 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
225 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
226 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
227 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
228 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
229 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
230 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
231 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
232 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
233 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
235 /* Personality decl of current unit. Used only when assembler does not support
236 personality CFI. */
237 static GTY(()) rtx current_unit_personality;
239 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
240 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
241 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
242 #endif
244 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
245 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
246 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
248 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
249 Information instructions. The register number, offset
250 and address fields are provided as possible operands;
251 their use is selected by the opcode field. */
253 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
254 dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
255 dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
256 dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
257 dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
258 dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
261 typedef union GTY(()) dw_cfi_oprnd_struct {
262 unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
263 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
264 const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
265 struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
267 dw_cfi_oprnd;
269 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_cfi_struct {
270 enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
271 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
272 dw_cfi_oprnd1;
273 dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
274 dw_cfi_oprnd2;
276 dw_cfi_node;
278 DEF_VEC_P (dw_cfi_ref);
279 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (dw_cfi_ref, heap);
280 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P (dw_cfi_ref, gc);
282 typedef VEC(dw_cfi_ref, gc) *cfi_vec;
284 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
285 as REG + OFFSET all the time, but now it can be more complex.
286 It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
287 Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
288 of this structure. */
289 typedef struct cfa_loc {
290 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
291 HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
292 unsigned int reg;
293 BOOL_BITFIELD indirect : 1; /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference. */
294 BOOL_BITFIELD in_use : 1; /* 1 if a saved cfa is stored here. */
295 } dw_cfa_location;
297 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
298 refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
299 the beginning of the .debug_frame section. This use of a single
300 CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
301 in the DWARF generation routines below. */
303 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_fde_struct {
304 tree decl;
305 const char *dw_fde_begin;
306 const char *dw_fde_current_label;
307 const char *dw_fde_end;
308 const char *dw_fde_vms_end_prologue;
309 const char *dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue;
310 const char *dw_fde_second_begin;
311 const char *dw_fde_second_end;
312 cfi_vec dw_fde_cfi;
313 int dw_fde_switch_cfi_index; /* Last CFI before switching sections. */
314 HOST_WIDE_INT stack_realignment;
315 unsigned funcdef_number;
316 /* Dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
317 unsigned int drap_reg;
318 /* Virtual dynamic realign argument pointer register. */
319 unsigned int vdrap_reg;
320 /* These 3 flags are copied from rtl_data in function.h. */
321 unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
322 unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
323 unsigned nothrow : 1;
324 /* Whether we did stack realign in this call frame. */
325 unsigned stack_realign : 1;
326 /* Whether dynamic realign argument pointer register has been saved. */
327 unsigned drap_reg_saved: 1;
328 /* True iff dw_fde_begin label is in text_section or cold_text_section. */
329 unsigned in_std_section : 1;
330 /* True iff dw_fde_second_begin label is in text_section or
331 cold_text_section. */
332 unsigned second_in_std_section : 1;
334 dw_fde_node;
336 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label. */
337 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES 30
339 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
340 Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
341 but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses. On such machines,
342 Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
343 pointers. */
344 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
345 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
346 #endif
348 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
349 relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
350 DWARF-2 specification. The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
351 as PTR_SIZE. */
353 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
354 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
355 #endif
357 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF 4 type signature. */
359 #ifndef DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE
360 #define DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE 8
361 #endif
363 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
364 should either be 4 or 12 bytes. When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
365 bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
366 bytes.
368 However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
369 DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE. It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly. */
371 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
372 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
373 #endif
375 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY. */
376 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
377 ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
379 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor. */
380 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
381 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
382 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
383 #else
384 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
385 #endif
386 #endif
388 /* CIE identifier. */
389 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
390 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
391 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
392 #else
393 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
394 #endif
396 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
397 information for each routine. */
398 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
400 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table. */
401 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
403 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use. */
404 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
406 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
407 fde_table. */
408 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
410 /* Get the current fde_table entry we should use. */
412 static inline dw_fde_ref
413 current_fde (void)
415 return fde_table_in_use ? &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1] : NULL;
418 /* A vector of call frame insns for the CIE. */
419 static GTY(()) cfi_vec cie_cfi_vec;
421 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
422 attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
423 with the subprogram. This variable holds the table index of the FDE
424 associated with the current function (body) definition. */
425 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
427 struct GTY(()) indirect_string_node {
428 const char *str;
429 unsigned int refcount;
430 enum dwarf_form form;
431 char *label;
434 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
436 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
437 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
439 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section. */
440 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
442 /* Whether the default text and cold text sections have been used at all. */
444 static GTY(()) bool text_section_used = false;
445 static GTY(()) bool cold_text_section_used = false;
447 /* The default cold text section. */
448 static GTY(()) section *cold_text_section;
450 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
452 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
453 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
454 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
455 static void add_cfi (cfi_vec *, dw_cfi_ref);
456 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
457 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *, dw_cfa_location *);
458 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
459 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
460 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
461 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
462 HOST_WIDE_INT);
463 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
464 static void output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref);
465 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
466 static void dwarf2out_note_section_used (void);
467 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx);
468 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
470 /* Support for complex CFA locations. */
471 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref, int);
472 static void output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref);
473 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
474 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
475 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
476 (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
477 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_aligned_loc
478 (HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT);
479 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
480 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *mem_loc_descriptor
481 (rtx, enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode mem_mode,
482 enum var_init_status);
484 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
485 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
486 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
487 #endif
489 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data. */
490 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
491 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
493 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
494 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION ".debug_frame"
495 #endif
497 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
498 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL "LFB"
499 #endif
501 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
502 #define FUNC_END_LABEL "LFE"
503 #endif
505 #ifndef PROLOGUE_END_LABEL
506 #define PROLOGUE_END_LABEL "LPE"
507 #endif
509 #ifndef EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL
510 #define EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL "LEB"
511 #endif
513 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
514 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL "Lframe"
515 #endif
516 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LSCIE"
517 #define CIE_END_LABEL "LECIE"
518 #define FDE_LABEL "LSFDE"
519 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL "LASFDE"
520 #define FDE_END_LABEL "LEFDE"
521 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL "LSLT"
522 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL "LELT"
523 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL "LASLTP"
524 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL "LELTP"
525 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX "DW"
527 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address. Normally this
528 is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
529 registers. */
530 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
531 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
532 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
533 #else
534 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
535 #endif
536 #endif
538 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number. By
539 default, we just provide columns for all registers. */
540 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
541 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
542 #endif
544 /* Match the base name of a file to the base name of a compilation unit. */
546 static int
547 matches_main_base (const char *path)
549 /* Cache the last query. */
550 static const char *last_path = NULL;
551 static int last_match = 0;
552 if (path != last_path)
554 const char *base;
555 int length = base_of_path (path, &base);
556 last_path = path;
557 last_match = (length == main_input_baselength
558 && memcmp (base, main_input_basename, length) == 0);
560 return last_match;
563 #ifdef DEBUG_DEBUG_STRUCT
565 static int
566 dump_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage,
567 enum debug_struct_file criterion, int generic,
568 int matches, int result)
570 /* Find the type name. */
571 tree type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (type);
572 tree t = type_decl;
573 const char *name = 0;
574 if (TREE_CODE (t) == TYPE_DECL)
575 t = DECL_NAME (t);
576 if (t)
577 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
579 fprintf (stderr, " struct %d %s %s %s %s %d %p %s\n",
580 criterion,
581 DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl) ? "sys" : "usr",
582 matches ? "bas" : "hdr",
583 generic ? "gen" : "ord",
584 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DFN ? ";" :
585 usage == DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE ? "." : "*",
586 result,
587 (void*) type_decl, name);
588 return result;
590 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
591 dump_struct_debug (type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result)
593 #else
595 #define DUMP_GSTRUCT(type, usage, criterion, generic, matches, result) \
596 (result)
598 #endif
600 static bool
601 should_emit_struct_debug (tree type, enum debug_info_usage usage)
603 enum debug_struct_file criterion;
604 tree type_decl;
605 bool generic = lang_hooks.types.generic_p (type);
607 if (generic)
608 criterion = debug_struct_generic[usage];
609 else
610 criterion = debug_struct_ordinary[usage];
612 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_NONE)
613 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
614 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_ANY)
615 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
617 type_decl = TYPE_STUB_DECL (TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type));
619 if (criterion == DINFO_STRUCT_FILE_SYS && DECL_IN_SYSTEM_HEADER (type_decl))
620 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, true);
622 if (matches_main_base (DECL_SOURCE_FILE (type_decl)))
623 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, true, true);
624 return DUMP_GSTRUCT (type, usage, criterion, generic, false, false);
627 /* Hook used by __throw. */
630 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
632 unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
633 return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
636 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
637 attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name). */
639 static inline char *
640 stripattributes (const char *s)
642 char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
643 char *p = stripped;
645 *p++ = '*';
647 while (*s && *s != ',')
648 *p++ = *s++;
650 *p = '\0';
651 return stripped;
654 /* MEM is a memory reference for the register size table, each element of
655 which has mode MODE. Initialize column C as a return address column. */
657 static void
658 init_return_column_size (enum machine_mode mode, rtx mem, unsigned int c)
660 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = c * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
661 HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (Pmode);
662 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
665 /* Divide OFF by DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, asserting no remainder. */
667 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
668 div_data_align (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
670 HOST_WIDE_INT r = off / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
671 gcc_assert (r * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == off);
672 return r;
675 /* Return true if we need a signed version of a given opcode
676 (e.g. DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf vs DW_CFA_offset_extended). */
678 static inline bool
679 need_data_align_sf_opcode (HOST_WIDE_INT off)
681 return DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT < 0 ? off > 0 : off < 0;
684 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table. */
686 void
687 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
689 unsigned int i;
690 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
691 rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
692 rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
693 bool wrote_return_column = false;
695 for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
697 int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
699 if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
701 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
702 enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
703 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
705 if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
706 save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
707 if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
709 if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
710 continue;
711 wrote_return_column = true;
713 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
714 if (offset < 0)
715 continue;
717 emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
718 gen_int_mode (size, mode));
722 if (!wrote_return_column)
723 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
725 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
726 init_return_column_size (mode, mem, DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN);
727 #endif
729 targetm.init_dwarf_reg_sizes_extra (address);
732 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
734 static const char *
735 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
737 switch (cfi_opc)
739 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
740 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
741 case DW_CFA_offset:
742 return "DW_CFA_offset";
743 case DW_CFA_restore:
744 return "DW_CFA_restore";
745 case DW_CFA_nop:
746 return "DW_CFA_nop";
747 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
748 return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
749 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
750 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
751 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
752 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
753 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
754 return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
755 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
756 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
757 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
758 return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
759 case DW_CFA_undefined:
760 return "DW_CFA_undefined";
761 case DW_CFA_same_value:
762 return "DW_CFA_same_value";
763 case DW_CFA_register:
764 return "DW_CFA_register";
765 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
766 return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
767 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
768 return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
769 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
770 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
771 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
772 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
773 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
774 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
776 /* DWARF 3 */
777 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
778 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
779 case DW_CFA_expression:
780 return "DW_CFA_expression";
781 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
782 return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
783 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
784 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
785 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
786 return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
788 /* SGI/MIPS specific */
789 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
790 return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
792 /* GNU extensions */
793 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
794 return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
795 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
796 return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
797 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
798 return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
800 default:
801 return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
805 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction. */
807 static inline dw_cfi_ref
808 new_cfi (void)
810 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc_dw_cfi_node ();
812 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
813 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
815 return cfi;
818 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions. */
820 static inline void
821 add_cfi (cfi_vec *vec, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
823 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
825 /* When DRAP is used, CFA is defined with an expression. Redefine
826 CFA may lead to a different CFA value. */
827 /* ??? Of course, this heuristic fails when we're annotating epilogues,
828 because of course we'll always want to redefine the CFA back to the
829 stack pointer on the way out. Where should we move this check? */
830 if (0 && fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
831 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
833 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
834 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
835 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
836 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
837 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
838 gcc_unreachable ();
840 default:
841 break;
844 VEC_safe_push (dw_cfi_ref, gc, *vec, cfi);
847 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to. FORCE is true
848 if a label needs to be output even when using .cfi_* directives. */
850 char *
851 dwarf2out_cfi_label (bool force)
853 static char label[20];
855 if (!force && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
857 /* In this case, we will be emitting the asm directive instead of
858 the label, so just return a placeholder to keep the rest of the
859 interfaces happy. */
860 strcpy (label, "<do not output>");
862 else
864 int num = dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++;
865 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", num);
866 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LCFI", num);
869 return label;
872 /* True if remember_state should be emitted before following CFI directive. */
873 static bool emit_cfa_remember;
875 /* True if any CFI directives were emitted at the current insn. */
876 static bool any_cfis_emitted;
878 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
879 or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL. */
881 static void
882 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
884 cfi_vec *vec;
886 if (cie_cfi_vec == NULL)
887 cie_cfi_vec = VEC_alloc (dw_cfi_ref, gc, 20);
889 vec = &cie_cfi_vec;
891 if (emit_cfa_remember)
893 dw_cfi_ref cfi_remember;
895 /* Emit the state save. */
896 emit_cfa_remember = false;
897 cfi_remember = new_cfi ();
898 cfi_remember->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_remember_state;
899 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi_remember);
902 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
904 if (label)
906 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
908 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
910 /* We still have to add the cfi to the list so that lookup_cfa
911 works later on. When -g2 and above we even need to force
912 emitting of CFI labels and add to list a DW_CFA_set_loc for
913 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list purposes. If we're generating
914 DWARF3 output we use DW_OP_call_frame_cfa and so don't use
915 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
916 if (dwarf_version == 2
917 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
918 && (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
919 || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG))
921 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
923 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
924 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
925 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
926 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
927 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
928 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
929 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
930 if (*label == 0 || strcmp (label, "<do not output>") == 0)
931 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (true);
933 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
934 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
936 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
938 label = xstrdup (label);
940 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
941 xcfi = new_cfi ();
942 /* It doesn't metter whether DW_CFA_set_loc
943 or DW_CFA_advance_loc4 is added here, those aren't
944 emitted into assembly, only looked up by
945 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list. */
946 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_set_loc;
947 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
948 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
949 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
951 break;
952 default:
953 break;
957 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
959 vec = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
960 any_cfis_emitted = true;
962 /* ??? If this is a CFI for the CIE, we don't emit. This
963 assumes that the standard CIE contents that the assembler
964 uses matches the standard CIE contents that the compiler
965 uses. This is probably a bad assumption. I'm not quite
966 sure how to address this for now. */
968 else if (label)
970 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
972 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
974 if (*label == 0)
975 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
977 if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
978 || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
980 dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
982 label = xstrdup (label);
984 /* Set the location counter to the new label. */
985 xcfi = new_cfi ();
986 /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
987 set the location directly using set_loc. */
988 xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
989 ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
990 : DW_CFA_set_loc;
991 xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
992 add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
994 fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
997 vec = &fde->dw_fde_cfi;
998 any_cfis_emitted = true;
1001 add_cfi (vec, cfi);
1004 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa. */
1006 static void
1007 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc, dw_cfa_location *remember)
1009 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
1011 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1012 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1013 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
1014 break;
1015 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1016 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
1017 break;
1018 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1019 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1020 loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
1021 loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
1022 break;
1023 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1024 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
1025 break;
1027 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
1028 gcc_assert (!remember->in_use);
1029 *remember = *loc;
1030 remember->in_use = 1;
1031 break;
1032 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
1033 gcc_assert (remember->in_use);
1034 *loc = *remember;
1035 remember->in_use = 0;
1036 break;
1038 default:
1039 break;
1043 /* Find the previous value for the CFA. */
1045 static void
1046 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
1048 int ix;
1049 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1050 dw_fde_ref fde;
1051 dw_cfa_location remember;
1053 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
1054 loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1055 remember = *loc;
1057 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
1058 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
1060 fde = current_fde ();
1061 if (fde)
1062 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
1063 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc, &remember);
1066 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address. */
1067 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
1069 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
1070 from the CFA. */
1071 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
1073 /* The current save location around an epilogue. */
1074 static dw_cfa_location cfa_remember;
1076 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack. */
1077 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
1079 /* The last args_size we actually output. */
1080 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
1082 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
1083 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi. The value of CFA is now to be
1084 calculated from REG+OFFSET. */
1086 void
1087 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1089 dw_cfa_location loc;
1090 loc.indirect = 0;
1091 loc.base_offset = 0;
1092 loc.reg = reg;
1093 loc.offset = offset;
1094 def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
1097 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data. */
1099 static bool
1100 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
1102 return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
1103 && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
1104 && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
1105 && (loc1->indirect == 0
1106 || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
1109 /* This routine does the actual work. The CFA is now calculated from
1110 the dw_cfa_location structure. */
1112 static void
1113 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
1115 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1116 dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
1118 cfa = *loc_p;
1119 loc = *loc_p;
1121 if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
1122 cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
1124 loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
1125 lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
1127 /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions. */
1128 if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
1129 return;
1131 cfi = new_cfi ();
1133 if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect && !old_cfa.indirect)
1135 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
1136 the CFA register did not change but the offset did. The data
1137 factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf happens in output_cfi, or
1138 in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa_offset directive. */
1139 if (loc.offset < 0)
1140 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
1141 else
1142 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
1143 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1146 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset. */
1147 else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
1148 && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
1149 && !loc.indirect
1150 && !old_cfa.indirect)
1152 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
1153 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
1154 offset has not changed. */
1155 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
1156 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1158 #endif
1160 else if (loc.indirect == 0)
1162 /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
1163 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
1164 the specified offset. The data factoring for DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf
1165 happens in output_cfi, or in the assembler via the .cfi_def_cfa
1166 directive. */
1167 if (loc.offset < 0)
1168 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
1169 else
1170 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
1171 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
1172 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
1174 else
1176 /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
1177 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
1178 register-offset pair is available. */
1179 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
1181 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
1182 loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
1183 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
1186 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1189 /* Add the CFI for saving a register. REG is the CFA column number.
1190 LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
1191 If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
1192 otherwise it is saved in SREG. */
1194 static void
1195 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1197 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1198 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
1200 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1202 /* When stack is aligned, store REG using DW_CFA_expression with
1203 FP. */
1204 if (fde
1205 && fde->stack_realign
1206 && sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1208 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_expression;
1209 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
1210 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc
1211 = build_cfa_aligned_loc (offset, fde->stack_realignment);
1213 else if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
1215 if (need_data_align_sf_opcode (offset))
1216 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
1217 else if (reg & ~0x3f)
1218 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
1219 else
1220 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
1221 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
1223 else if (sreg == reg)
1224 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
1225 else
1227 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
1228 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
1231 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1234 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window. LABEL is passed to reg_save.
1235 This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
1236 from the previous frame's window save area.
1238 ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
1239 assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window. */
1241 void
1242 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
1244 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
1246 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
1247 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1250 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack. REG is the GCC register
1251 number. LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1253 void
1254 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1256 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1259 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
1260 LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save. */
1262 void
1263 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1265 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
1268 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
1269 LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save. */
1271 void
1272 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
1274 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
1277 /* Record the initial position of the return address. RTL is
1278 INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX. */
1280 static void
1281 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
1283 unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1284 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1286 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1288 case REG:
1289 /* RA is in a register. */
1290 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
1291 break;
1293 case MEM:
1294 /* RA is on the stack. */
1295 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
1296 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
1298 case REG:
1299 gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1300 offset = 0;
1301 break;
1303 case PLUS:
1304 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1305 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1306 break;
1308 case MINUS:
1309 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1310 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
1311 break;
1313 default:
1314 gcc_unreachable ();
1317 break;
1319 case PLUS:
1320 /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
1321 actually load. For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
1322 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames. */
1323 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
1324 initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1325 return;
1327 default:
1328 gcc_unreachable ();
1331 if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1332 reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1335 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1336 contains. */
1338 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1339 stack_adjust_offset (const_rtx pattern, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1340 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_offset)
1342 const_rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1343 const_rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1344 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1345 enum rtx_code code;
1347 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1349 code = GET_CODE (src);
1351 /* Assume (set (reg sp) (reg whatever)) sets args_size
1352 level to 0. */
1353 if (code == REG && src != stack_pointer_rtx)
1355 offset = -cur_args_size;
1356 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1357 offset = -offset;
1358 #endif
1359 return offset - cur_offset;
1362 if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1363 || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1364 || !CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
1365 return 0;
1367 /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1368 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1369 if (code == PLUS)
1370 offset = -offset;
1371 return offset;
1374 if (MEM_P (src) && !MEM_P (dest))
1375 dest = src;
1376 if (MEM_P (dest))
1378 /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1379 src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1380 code = GET_CODE (src);
1382 switch (code)
1384 case PRE_MODIFY:
1385 case POST_MODIFY:
1386 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1388 rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1389 /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount. */
1390 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1391 && CONST_INT_P (val));
1392 offset = -INTVAL (val);
1393 break;
1395 return 0;
1397 case PRE_DEC:
1398 case POST_DEC:
1399 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1401 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1402 break;
1404 return 0;
1406 case PRE_INC:
1407 case POST_INC:
1408 if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1410 offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1411 break;
1413 return 0;
1415 default:
1416 return 0;
1419 else
1420 return 0;
1422 return offset;
1425 /* Precomputed args_size for CODE_LABELs and BARRIERs preceeding them,
1426 indexed by INSN_UID. */
1428 static HOST_WIDE_INT *barrier_args_size;
1430 /* Helper function for compute_barrier_args_size. Handle one insn. */
1432 static HOST_WIDE_INT
1433 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (rtx insn, HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size,
1434 VEC (rtx, heap) **next)
1436 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1437 int i;
1439 if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1441 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1442 /* Nothing */;
1443 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1444 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), cur_args_size, 0);
1445 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1446 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1448 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1449 for them. */
1450 for (i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1451 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1452 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1453 cur_args_size, offset);
1456 else
1458 rtx expr = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1460 if (expr)
1462 expr = XEXP (expr, 0);
1463 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL
1464 || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1465 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (expr, 0); i++)
1467 rtx elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, i);
1469 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
1470 offset += stack_adjust_offset (elem, cur_args_size, offset);
1475 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1476 offset = -offset;
1477 #endif
1479 cur_args_size += offset;
1480 if (cur_args_size < 0)
1481 cur_args_size = 0;
1483 if (JUMP_P (insn))
1485 rtx dest = JUMP_LABEL (insn);
1487 if (dest)
1489 if (barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] < 0)
1491 barrier_args_size [INSN_UID (dest)] = cur_args_size;
1492 VEC_safe_push (rtx, heap, *next, dest);
1497 return cur_args_size;
1500 /* Walk the whole function and compute args_size on BARRIERs. */
1502 static void
1503 compute_barrier_args_size (void)
1505 int max_uid = get_max_uid (), i;
1506 rtx insn;
1507 VEC (rtx, heap) *worklist, *next, *tmp;
1509 barrier_args_size = XNEWVEC (HOST_WIDE_INT, max_uid);
1510 for (i = 0; i < max_uid; i++)
1511 barrier_args_size[i] = -1;
1513 worklist = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1514 next = VEC_alloc (rtx, heap, 20);
1515 insn = get_insns ();
1516 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = 0;
1517 VEC_quick_push (rtx, worklist, insn);
1518 for (;;)
1520 while (!VEC_empty (rtx, worklist))
1522 rtx prev, body, first_insn;
1523 HOST_WIDE_INT cur_args_size;
1525 first_insn = insn = VEC_pop (rtx, worklist);
1526 cur_args_size = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1527 prev = prev_nonnote_insn (insn);
1528 if (prev && BARRIER_P (prev))
1529 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (prev)] = cur_args_size;
1531 for (; insn; insn = NEXT_INSN (insn))
1533 if (INSN_DELETED_P (insn) || NOTE_P (insn))
1534 continue;
1535 if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1536 break;
1538 if (LABEL_P (insn))
1540 if (insn == first_insn)
1541 continue;
1542 else if (barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] < 0)
1544 barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)] = cur_args_size;
1545 continue;
1547 else
1549 /* The insns starting with this label have been
1550 already scanned or are in the worklist. */
1551 break;
1555 body = PATTERN (insn);
1556 if (GET_CODE (body) == SEQUENCE)
1558 HOST_WIDE_INT dest_args_size = cur_args_size;
1559 for (i = 1; i < XVECLEN (body, 0); i++)
1560 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0))
1561 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, i)))
1562 dest_args_size
1563 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1564 dest_args_size, &next);
1565 else
1566 cur_args_size
1567 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, i),
1568 cur_args_size, &next);
1570 if (INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0)))
1571 compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1572 dest_args_size, &next);
1573 else
1574 cur_args_size
1575 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (XVECEXP (body, 0, 0),
1576 cur_args_size, &next);
1578 else
1579 cur_args_size
1580 = compute_barrier_args_size_1 (insn, cur_args_size, &next);
1584 if (VEC_empty (rtx, next))
1585 break;
1587 /* Swap WORKLIST with NEXT and truncate NEXT for next iteration. */
1588 tmp = next;
1589 next = worklist;
1590 worklist = tmp;
1591 VEC_truncate (rtx, next, 0);
1594 VEC_free (rtx, heap, worklist);
1595 VEC_free (rtx, heap, next);
1598 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
1599 pushed onto the stack. */
1601 static void
1602 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
1604 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
1606 if (size == old_args_size)
1607 return;
1609 old_args_size = size;
1611 cfi = new_cfi ();
1612 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
1613 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
1614 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
1617 /* Record a stack adjustment of OFFSET bytes. */
1619 static void
1620 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, const char *label)
1622 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1623 cfa.offset += offset;
1625 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1626 cfa_store.offset += offset;
1628 if (ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1629 return;
1631 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1632 offset = -offset;
1633 #endif
1635 args_size += offset;
1636 if (args_size < 0)
1637 args_size = 0;
1639 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1640 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1641 dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1644 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1645 make a note of it if it does. EH uses this information to find out
1646 how much extra space it needs to pop off the stack. */
1648 static void
1649 dwarf2out_notice_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1651 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1652 const char *label;
1653 int i;
1655 /* Don't handle epilogues at all. Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1656 with this function. Proper support would require all frame-related
1657 insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1658 epilogues textually in the middle of the function. */
1659 if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn))
1660 return;
1662 /* If INSN is an instruction from target of an annulled branch, the
1663 effects are for the target only and so current argument size
1664 shouldn't change at all. */
1665 if (final_sequence
1666 && INSN_ANNULLED_BRANCH_P (XVECEXP (final_sequence, 0, 0))
1667 && INSN_FROM_TARGET_P (insn))
1668 return;
1670 /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1671 save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN. */
1672 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1674 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1676 /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself. */
1677 insn = PATTERN (insn);
1678 if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1679 insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1680 if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1681 insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1682 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1683 dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1685 return;
1688 if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1690 if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1691 dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1692 return;
1694 else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1696 /* Don't call compute_barrier_args_size () if the only
1697 BARRIER is at the end of function. */
1698 if (barrier_args_size == NULL && next_nonnote_insn (insn))
1699 compute_barrier_args_size ();
1700 if (barrier_args_size == NULL)
1701 offset = 0;
1702 else
1704 offset = barrier_args_size[INSN_UID (insn)];
1705 if (offset < 0)
1706 offset = 0;
1709 offset -= args_size;
1710 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1711 offset = -offset;
1712 #endif
1714 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1715 offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn), args_size, 0);
1716 else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1717 || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1719 /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns. Search
1720 for them. */
1721 for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1722 if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1723 offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i),
1724 args_size, offset);
1726 else
1727 return;
1729 if (offset == 0)
1730 return;
1732 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
1733 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (offset, label);
1736 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1737 of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered. This clusters
1738 register saves so that there are fewer pc advances. */
1740 struct GTY(()) queued_reg_save {
1741 struct queued_reg_save *next;
1742 rtx reg;
1743 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1744 rtx saved_reg;
1747 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1749 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG. */
1750 struct GTY(()) reg_saved_in_data {
1751 rtx orig_reg;
1752 rtx saved_in_reg;
1755 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1756 The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1757 port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1758 more efficient data structure. */
1759 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1760 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1762 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1764 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1765 SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA. */
1767 static void
1768 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1770 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1772 /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1773 for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1774 order. */
1775 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1776 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1777 break;
1779 if (q == NULL)
1781 q = ggc_alloc_queued_reg_save ();
1782 q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1783 queued_reg_saves = q;
1786 q->reg = reg;
1787 q->cfa_offset = offset;
1788 q->saved_reg = sreg;
1790 last_reg_save_label = label;
1793 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES. */
1795 void
1796 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1798 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1800 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1802 size_t i;
1803 unsigned int reg, sreg;
1805 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1806 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1807 break;
1808 if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1810 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1811 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1813 if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1815 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1816 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1819 reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1820 if (q->saved_reg)
1821 sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1822 else
1823 sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1824 reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1827 queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1828 last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1831 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1832 location for? Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1833 said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1834 have a new location for? */
1836 static bool
1837 clobbers_queued_reg_save (const_rtx insn)
1839 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1841 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1843 size_t i;
1844 if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1845 return true;
1846 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1847 if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1848 && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1849 return true;
1852 return false;
1855 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second. */
1857 void
1858 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1860 size_t i;
1861 unsigned int regno, sregno;
1863 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1864 if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1865 break;
1866 if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1868 gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1869 num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1871 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1872 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1874 regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1875 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1876 reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1879 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG? */
1881 static rtx
1882 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1884 unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1885 size_t i;
1886 struct queued_reg_save *q;
1888 for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1889 if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1890 return q->reg;
1892 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1893 if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1894 && regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1895 return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1897 return NULL_RTX;
1901 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1902 or setting up the store_reg. The "offset" field holds the integer
1903 value, not an offset. */
1904 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1906 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_DEF_CFA note. */
1908 static void
1909 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1911 memset (&cfa, 0, sizeof (cfa));
1913 switch (GET_CODE (pat))
1915 case PLUS:
1916 cfa.reg = REGNO (XEXP (pat, 0));
1917 cfa.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (pat, 1));
1918 break;
1920 case REG:
1921 cfa.reg = REGNO (pat);
1922 break;
1924 case MEM:
1925 cfa.indirect = 1;
1926 pat = XEXP (pat, 0);
1927 if (GET_CODE (pat) == PLUS)
1929 cfa.base_offset = INTVAL (XEXP (pat, 1));
1930 pat = XEXP (pat, 0);
1932 cfa.reg = REGNO (pat);
1933 break;
1935 default:
1936 /* Recurse and define an expression. */
1937 gcc_unreachable ();
1940 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1943 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_ADJUST_CFA note. */
1945 static void
1946 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (rtx pat, const char *label)
1948 rtx src, dest;
1950 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (pat) == SET);
1951 dest = XEXP (pat, 0);
1952 src = XEXP (pat, 1);
1954 switch (GET_CODE (src))
1956 case PLUS:
1957 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1958 cfa.offset -= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1959 break;
1961 case REG:
1962 break;
1964 default:
1965 gcc_unreachable ();
1968 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1969 gcc_assert (cfa.indirect == 0);
1971 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1974 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_OFFSET note. */
1976 static void
1977 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (rtx set, const char *label)
1979 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1980 rtx src, addr, span;
1982 src = XEXP (set, 1);
1983 addr = XEXP (set, 0);
1984 gcc_assert (MEM_P (addr));
1985 addr = XEXP (addr, 0);
1987 /* As documented, only consider extremely simple addresses. */
1988 switch (GET_CODE (addr))
1990 case REG:
1991 gcc_assert (REGNO (addr) == cfa.reg);
1992 offset = -cfa.offset;
1993 break;
1994 case PLUS:
1995 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (addr, 0)) == cfa.reg);
1996 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (addr, 1)) - cfa.offset;
1997 break;
1998 default:
1999 gcc_unreachable ();
2002 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
2004 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
2005 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
2006 if (!span)
2007 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src)), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
2008 else
2010 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC live.
2011 Queue register saves for each piece of the PARALLEL. */
2012 int par_index;
2013 int limit;
2014 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
2016 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
2018 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
2019 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2021 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
2023 reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (elem)),
2024 INVALID_REGNUM, span_offset);
2025 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
2030 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_REGISTER note. */
2032 static void
2033 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (rtx set, const char *label)
2035 rtx src, dest;
2036 unsigned sregno, dregno;
2038 src = XEXP (set, 1);
2039 dest = XEXP (set, 0);
2041 if (src == pc_rtx)
2042 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
2043 else
2044 sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
2046 dregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (dest));
2048 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, but we need to come up with
2049 a different flushing heuristic for epilogues. */
2050 reg_save (label, sregno, dregno, 0);
2053 /* Helper function to get mode of MEM's address. */
2055 static inline enum machine_mode
2056 get_address_mode (rtx mem)
2058 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (mem, 0));
2059 if (mode != VOIDmode)
2060 return mode;
2061 return targetm.addr_space.address_mode (MEM_ADDR_SPACE (mem));
2064 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_EXPRESSION note. */
2066 static void
2067 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_expression (rtx set, const char *label)
2069 rtx src, dest, span;
2070 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
2072 dest = SET_DEST (set);
2073 src = SET_SRC (set);
2075 gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
2076 gcc_assert (MEM_P (dest));
2078 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
2079 gcc_assert (!span);
2081 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_expression;
2082 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src));
2083 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc
2084 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (dest, 0), get_address_mode (dest),
2085 GET_MODE (dest), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
2087 /* ??? We'd like to use queue_reg_save, were the interface different,
2088 and, as above, we could manage flushing for epilogues. */
2089 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2092 /* A subroutine of dwarf2out_frame_debug, process a REG_CFA_RESTORE note. */
2094 static void
2095 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (rtx reg, const char *label)
2097 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
2098 unsigned int regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
2100 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = (regno & ~0x3f ? DW_CFA_restore_extended : DW_CFA_restore);
2101 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = regno;
2103 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
2106 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
2107 which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
2108 address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
2109 LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
2111 This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
2112 cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg. We describe these rules so
2113 users need not read the source code.
2115 The High-Level Picture
2117 Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
2118 assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
2119 should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
2120 work pretty well. If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
2121 enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
2123 Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
2124 This is usually SP, but not always. Again, we deduce that if you
2125 copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
2126 then the new register is the one we will be using for register
2127 saves. This also seems to work.
2129 Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
2130 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
2131 register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
2132 had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
2133 It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
2134 register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
2135 that instruction. If the copy is from a call-saved register to
2136 the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
2137 value as in the caller.
2139 Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
2140 offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
2141 use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression. If the offset is 0, we assume that
2142 the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
2144 In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
2145 register,
2147 Invariants / Summaries of Rules
2149 cfa current rule for calculating the CFA. It usually
2150 consists of a register and an offset.
2151 cfa_store register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
2152 cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
2153 cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
2154 cfa_temp register holding an integral value. cfa_temp.offset
2155 stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
2156 stack pointer. cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
2157 to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
2159 Rules 1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
2160 with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
2161 cfa.offset. Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
2162 cfa_temp.offset.
2164 Rules 6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
2165 expression yielding a constant. This sets cfa_temp.reg
2166 and cfa_temp.offset.
2168 Rule 5: Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
2169 stack.
2171 Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack. Define offset as the
2172 difference of the original location and cfa_store's
2173 location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
2175 Rules 16-20: If AND operation happens on sp in prologue, we assume
2176 stack is realigned. We will use a group of DW_OP_XXX
2177 expressions to represent the location of the stored
2178 register instead of CFA+offset.
2180 The Rules
2182 "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
2183 "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
2185 Rule 1:
2186 (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
2187 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2188 cfa.offset unchanged
2189 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2190 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2192 Rule 2:
2193 (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
2194 {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
2195 effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
2196 cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
2197 cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
2198 if cfa_store.reg==sp
2200 Rule 3:
2201 (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2202 effects: cfa.reg = fp
2203 cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
2205 Rule 4:
2206 (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
2207 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2208 <reg1> != sp
2209 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2210 cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2211 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
2213 Rule 5:
2214 (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
2215 constraints: <reg1> != fp
2216 <reg1> != sp
2217 effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
2218 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
2220 Rule 6:
2221 (set <reg> <const_int>)
2222 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2223 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2225 Rule 7:
2226 (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
2227 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
2228 cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
2230 Rule 8:
2231 (set <reg> (high <exp>))
2232 effects: none
2234 Rule 9:
2235 (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
2236 effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
2237 cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
2239 Rule 10:
2240 (set (mem ({pre,post}_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
2241 effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
2242 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2243 cfa.reg = sp
2244 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2246 Rule 11:
2247 (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec,post_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
2248 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2249 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
2250 cfa.reg = sp
2251 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
2253 Rule 12:
2254 (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
2256 <reg2>)
2257 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2258 cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2260 Rule 13:
2261 (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
2262 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2263 cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
2265 Rule 14:
2266 (set (mem (post_inc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
2267 effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
2268 cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
2269 cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
2271 Rule 15:
2272 (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
2273 effects: target-dependent
2275 Rule 16:
2276 (set sp (and: sp <const_int>))
2277 constraints: cfa_store.reg == sp
2278 effects: current_fde.stack_realign = 1
2279 cfa_store.offset = 0
2280 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg if cfa.reg != sp and cfa.reg != fp
2282 Rule 17:
2283 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) (mem (plus (cfa.reg) (const_int))))
2284 effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
2286 Rule 18:
2287 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) fp)
2288 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2289 effects: cfa_store.offset = 0
2290 cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2292 Rule 19:
2293 (set (mem ({pre_inc, pre_dec} sp)) cfa.reg)
2294 constraints: fde->stack_realign == 1
2295 && cfa.offset == 0
2296 && cfa.indirect == 0
2297 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2298 effects: Use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression to define cfa
2299 cfa.reg == fde->drap_reg */
2301 static void
2302 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
2304 rtx src, dest, span;
2305 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
2306 dw_fde_ref fde;
2308 /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
2309 the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
2310 it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility. Other elements
2311 are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
2312 flag is set in them. */
2313 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2315 int par_index;
2316 int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
2317 rtx elem;
2319 /* PARALLELs have strict read-modify-write semantics, so we
2320 ought to evaluate every rvalue before changing any lvalue.
2321 It's cumbersome to do that in general, but there's an
2322 easy approximation that is enough for all current users:
2323 handle register saves before register assignments. */
2324 if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL)
2325 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2327 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2328 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2329 && MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem))
2330 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2331 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2334 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2336 elem = XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index);
2337 if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2338 && (!MEM_P (SET_DEST (elem)) || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
2339 && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem) || par_index == 0))
2340 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (elem, label);
2341 else if (GET_CODE (elem) == SET
2342 && par_index != 0
2343 && !RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (elem))
2345 /* Stack adjustment combining might combine some post-prologue
2346 stack adjustment into a prologue stack adjustment. */
2347 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = stack_adjust_offset (elem, args_size, 0);
2349 if (offset != 0)
2350 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (offset, label);
2353 return;
2356 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
2358 src = SET_SRC (expr);
2359 dest = SET_DEST (expr);
2361 if (REG_P (src))
2363 rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
2364 if (rsi)
2365 src = rsi;
2368 fde = current_fde ();
2370 switch (GET_CODE (dest))
2372 case REG:
2373 switch (GET_CODE (src))
2375 /* Setting FP from SP. */
2376 case REG:
2377 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
2379 /* Rule 1 */
2380 /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP. Make sure src is
2381 relative to the current CFA register.
2383 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
2384 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
2385 FP. So we just rely on the backends to only set
2386 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns. */
2387 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2388 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2389 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2391 else
2393 /* Saving a register in a register. */
2394 gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
2395 /* For the SPARC and its register window. */
2396 || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
2397 == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
2399 /* After stack is aligned, we can only save SP in FP
2400 if drap register is used. In this case, we have
2401 to restore stack pointer with the CFA value and we
2402 don't generate this DWARF information. */
2403 if (fde
2404 && fde->stack_realign
2405 && REGNO (src) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2406 gcc_assert (REGNO (dest) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2407 && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM
2408 && cfa.reg != REGNO (src));
2409 else
2410 queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
2412 break;
2414 case PLUS:
2415 case MINUS:
2416 case LO_SUM:
2417 if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
2419 /* Rule 2 */
2420 /* Adjusting SP. */
2421 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
2423 case CONST_INT:
2424 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2425 break;
2426 case REG:
2427 gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
2428 == cfa_temp.reg);
2429 offset = cfa_temp.offset;
2430 break;
2431 default:
2432 gcc_unreachable ();
2435 if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2437 /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue. */
2438 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2439 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2441 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
2442 /* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp. */
2444 else
2445 gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
2447 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2448 offset = -offset;
2449 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2450 cfa.offset += offset;
2451 if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2452 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2454 else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2456 /* Rule 3 */
2457 /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
2458 or adjusting the FP */
2459 gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
2461 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2462 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2463 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2464 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2465 if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
2466 offset = -offset;
2467 cfa.offset += offset;
2468 cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2470 else
2472 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
2474 /* Rule 4 */
2475 if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2476 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
2477 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2479 /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
2480 into the FP later on. */
2481 offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2482 cfa.offset += offset;
2483 cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
2484 /* Or used to save regs to the stack. */
2485 cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
2486 cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
2489 /* Rule 5 */
2490 else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2491 && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2492 && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2494 /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
2495 of SP for saving registers to the stack. */
2496 gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2497 cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
2498 cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
2501 /* Rule 9 */
2502 else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
2503 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)))
2505 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2506 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2508 else
2509 gcc_unreachable ();
2511 break;
2513 /* Rule 6 */
2514 case CONST_INT:
2515 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2516 cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
2517 break;
2519 /* Rule 7 */
2520 case IOR:
2521 gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
2522 && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
2523 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (src, 1)));
2525 if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
2526 cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
2527 cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2528 break;
2530 /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
2531 which will fill in all of the bits. */
2532 /* Rule 8 */
2533 case HIGH:
2534 break;
2536 /* Rule 15 */
2537 case UNSPEC:
2538 case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
2539 gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
2540 targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
2541 return;
2543 /* Rule 16 */
2544 case AND:
2545 /* If this AND operation happens on stack pointer in prologue,
2546 we assume the stack is realigned and we extract the
2547 alignment. */
2548 if (fde && XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
2550 /* We interpret reg_save differently with stack_realign set.
2551 Thus we must flush whatever we have queued first. */
2552 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2554 gcc_assert (cfa_store.reg == REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)));
2555 fde->stack_realign = 1;
2556 fde->stack_realignment = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
2557 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2559 if (cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2560 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2561 fde->drap_reg = cfa.reg;
2563 return;
2565 default:
2566 gcc_unreachable ();
2569 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2570 break;
2572 case MEM:
2574 /* Saving a register to the stack. Make sure dest is relative to the
2575 CFA register. */
2576 switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
2578 /* Rule 10 */
2579 /* With a push. */
2580 case PRE_MODIFY:
2581 case POST_MODIFY:
2582 /* We can't handle variable size modifications. */
2583 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
2584 == CONST_INT);
2585 offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
2587 gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2588 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2590 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2591 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2592 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2594 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == POST_MODIFY)
2595 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
2596 else
2597 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2598 break;
2600 /* Rule 11 */
2601 case PRE_INC:
2602 case PRE_DEC:
2603 case POST_DEC:
2604 offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2605 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
2606 offset = -offset;
2608 gcc_assert ((REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0))
2609 == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2610 && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
2612 cfa_store.offset += offset;
2614 /* Rule 18: If stack is aligned, we will use FP as a
2615 reference to represent the address of the stored
2616 regiser. */
2617 if (fde
2618 && fde->stack_realign
2619 && src == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
2621 gcc_assert (cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
2622 cfa_store.offset = 0;
2625 if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
2626 cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
2628 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == POST_DEC)
2629 offset += -cfa_store.offset;
2630 else
2631 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2632 break;
2634 /* Rule 12 */
2635 /* With an offset. */
2636 case PLUS:
2637 case MINUS:
2638 case LO_SUM:
2640 int regno;
2642 gcc_assert (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1))
2643 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2644 offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
2645 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
2646 offset = -offset;
2648 regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
2650 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2651 offset -= cfa.offset;
2652 else if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2653 offset -= cfa_store.offset;
2654 else
2656 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2657 offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
2660 break;
2662 /* Rule 13 */
2663 /* Without an offset. */
2664 case REG:
2666 int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
2668 if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2669 offset = -cfa.offset;
2670 else if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
2671 offset = -cfa_store.offset;
2672 else
2674 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
2675 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2678 break;
2680 /* Rule 14 */
2681 case POST_INC:
2682 gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
2683 == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
2684 offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
2685 cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
2686 break;
2688 default:
2689 gcc_unreachable ();
2692 /* Rule 17 */
2693 /* If the source operand of this MEM operation is not a
2694 register, basically the source is return address. Here
2695 we only care how much stack grew and we don't save it. */
2696 if (!REG_P (src))
2697 break;
2699 if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
2700 && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
2701 && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
2703 /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack. */
2705 if (cfa.offset == 0)
2707 /* Rule 19 */
2708 /* If stack is aligned, putting CFA reg into stack means
2709 we can no longer use reg + offset to represent CFA.
2710 Here we use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instead. The
2711 result of this expression equals to the original CFA
2712 value. */
2713 if (fde
2714 && fde->stack_realign
2715 && cfa.indirect == 0
2716 && cfa.reg != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)
2718 dw_cfa_location cfa_exp;
2720 gcc_assert (fde->drap_reg == cfa.reg);
2722 cfa_exp.indirect = 1;
2723 cfa_exp.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
2724 cfa_exp.base_offset = offset;
2725 cfa_exp.offset = 0;
2727 fde->drap_reg_saved = 1;
2729 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa_exp);
2730 break;
2733 /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
2734 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
2735 on the ARM. */
2736 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2737 queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
2738 break;
2740 else
2742 /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
2743 calculate the CFA. */
2744 rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
2746 if (!REG_P (x))
2747 x = XEXP (x, 0);
2748 gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
2750 cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
2751 cfa.base_offset = offset;
2752 cfa.indirect = 1;
2753 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2754 break;
2758 def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
2760 span = targetm.dwarf_register_span (src);
2762 if (!span)
2763 queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
2764 else
2766 /* We have a PARALLEL describing where the contents of SRC
2767 live. Queue register saves for each piece of the
2768 PARALLEL. */
2769 int par_index;
2770 int limit;
2771 HOST_WIDE_INT span_offset = offset;
2773 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (span) == PARALLEL);
2775 limit = XVECLEN (span, 0);
2776 for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
2778 rtx elem = XVECEXP (span, 0, par_index);
2780 queue_reg_save (label, elem, NULL_RTX, span_offset);
2781 span_offset += GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (elem));
2785 break;
2787 default:
2788 gcc_unreachable ();
2792 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
2793 sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
2794 register to the stack. If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
2796 If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
2797 otherwise after. Call instructions get invoked twice. */
2799 void
2800 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
2802 const char *label;
2803 rtx note, n;
2804 bool handled_one = false;
2806 if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
2807 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2809 if (!RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
2811 /* ??? This should be done unconditionally since stack adjustments
2812 matter if the stack pointer is not the CFA register anymore but
2813 is still used to save registers. */
2814 if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
2815 dwarf2out_notice_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
2816 return;
2819 label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
2820 any_cfis_emitted = false;
2822 for (note = REG_NOTES (insn); note; note = XEXP (note, 1))
2823 switch (REG_NOTE_KIND (note))
2825 case REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR:
2826 insn = XEXP (note, 0);
2827 goto found;
2829 case REG_CFA_DEF_CFA:
2830 dwarf2out_frame_debug_def_cfa (XEXP (note, 0), label);
2831 handled_one = true;
2832 break;
2834 case REG_CFA_ADJUST_CFA:
2835 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2836 if (n == NULL)
2838 n = PATTERN (insn);
2839 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2840 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2842 dwarf2out_frame_debug_adjust_cfa (n, label);
2843 handled_one = true;
2844 break;
2846 case REG_CFA_OFFSET:
2847 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2848 if (n == NULL)
2849 n = single_set (insn);
2850 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_offset (n, label);
2851 handled_one = true;
2852 break;
2854 case REG_CFA_REGISTER:
2855 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2856 if (n == NULL)
2858 n = PATTERN (insn);
2859 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2860 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2862 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_register (n, label);
2863 handled_one = true;
2864 break;
2866 case REG_CFA_EXPRESSION:
2867 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2868 if (n == NULL)
2869 n = single_set (insn);
2870 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_expression (n, label);
2871 handled_one = true;
2872 break;
2874 case REG_CFA_RESTORE:
2875 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2876 if (n == NULL)
2878 n = PATTERN (insn);
2879 if (GET_CODE (n) == PARALLEL)
2880 n = XVECEXP (n, 0, 0);
2881 n = XEXP (n, 0);
2883 dwarf2out_frame_debug_cfa_restore (n, label);
2884 handled_one = true;
2885 break;
2887 case REG_CFA_SET_VDRAP:
2888 n = XEXP (note, 0);
2889 if (REG_P (n))
2891 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
2892 if (fde)
2894 gcc_assert (fde->vdrap_reg == INVALID_REGNUM);
2895 if (REG_P (n))
2896 fde->vdrap_reg = REGNO (n);
2899 handled_one = true;
2900 break;
2902 default:
2903 break;
2905 if (handled_one)
2907 if (any_cfis_emitted)
2908 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2909 return;
2912 insn = PATTERN (insn);
2913 found:
2914 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
2916 /* Check again. A parallel can save and update the same register.
2917 We could probably check just once, here, but this is safer than
2918 removing the check above. */
2919 if (any_cfis_emitted || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
2920 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2923 /* Called once at the start of final to initialize some data for the
2924 current function. */
2925 void
2926 dwarf2out_frame_debug_init (void)
2928 size_t i;
2930 /* Flush any queued register saves. */
2931 dwarf2out_flush_queued_reg_saves ();
2933 /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info. */
2934 lookup_cfa (&cfa);
2935 gcc_assert (cfa.reg
2936 == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
2938 cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
2939 cfa_store = cfa;
2940 cfa_temp.reg = -1;
2941 cfa_temp.offset = 0;
2943 for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
2945 regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
2946 regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
2948 num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
2950 if (barrier_args_size)
2952 XDELETEVEC (barrier_args_size);
2953 barrier_args_size = NULL;
2957 /* Determine if we need to save and restore CFI information around this
2958 epilogue. If SIBCALL is true, then this is a sibcall epilogue. If
2959 we do need to save/restore, then emit the save now, and insert a
2960 NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE at the appropriate place in the stream. */
2962 void
2963 dwarf2out_cfi_begin_epilogue (rtx insn)
2965 bool saw_frp = false;
2966 rtx i;
2968 /* Scan forward to the return insn, noticing if there are possible
2969 frame related insns. */
2970 for (i = NEXT_INSN (insn); i ; i = NEXT_INSN (i))
2972 if (!INSN_P (i))
2973 continue;
2975 /* Look for both regular and sibcalls to end the block. */
2976 if (returnjump_p (i))
2977 break;
2978 if (CALL_P (i) && SIBLING_CALL_P (i))
2979 break;
2981 if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (i)) == SEQUENCE)
2983 int idx;
2984 rtx seq = PATTERN (i);
2986 if (returnjump_p (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2987 break;
2988 if (CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0))
2989 && SIBLING_CALL_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, 0)))
2990 break;
2992 for (idx = 0; idx < XVECLEN (seq, 0); idx++)
2993 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (seq, 0, idx)))
2994 saw_frp = true;
2997 if (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (i))
2998 saw_frp = true;
3001 /* If the port doesn't emit epilogue unwind info, we don't need a
3002 save/restore pair. */
3003 if (!saw_frp)
3004 return;
3006 /* Otherwise, search forward to see if the return insn was the last
3007 basic block of the function. If so, we don't need save/restore. */
3008 gcc_assert (i != NULL);
3009 i = next_real_insn (i);
3010 if (i == NULL)
3011 return;
3013 /* Insert the restore before that next real insn in the stream, and before
3014 a potential NOTE_INSN_EPILOGUE_BEG -- we do need these notes to be
3015 properly nested. This should be after any label or alignment. This
3016 will be pushed into the CFI stream by the function below. */
3017 while (1)
3019 rtx p = PREV_INSN (i);
3020 if (!NOTE_P (p))
3021 break;
3022 if (NOTE_KIND (p) == NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK)
3023 break;
3024 i = p;
3026 emit_note_before (NOTE_INSN_CFA_RESTORE_STATE, i);
3028 emit_cfa_remember = true;
3030 /* And emulate the state save. */
3031 gcc_assert (!cfa_remember.in_use);
3032 cfa_remember = cfa;
3033 cfa_remember.in_use = 1;
3036 /* A "subroutine" of dwarf2out_cfi_begin_epilogue. Emit the restore
3037 required. */
3039 void
3040 dwarf2out_frame_debug_restore_state (void)
3042 dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
3043 const char *label = dwarf2out_cfi_label (false);
3045 cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_restore_state;
3046 add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
3048 gcc_assert (cfa_remember.in_use);
3049 cfa = cfa_remember;
3050 cfa_remember.in_use = 0;
3053 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used. */
3054 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
3055 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
3057 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
3058 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
3060 switch (cfi)
3062 case DW_CFA_nop:
3063 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3064 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3065 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
3066 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
3068 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3069 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3070 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3071 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3072 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3073 return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
3075 case DW_CFA_offset:
3076 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3077 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3078 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3079 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3080 case DW_CFA_restore:
3081 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3082 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3083 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3084 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3085 case DW_CFA_register:
3086 case DW_CFA_expression:
3087 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
3089 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3090 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3091 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3092 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
3094 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3095 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
3097 default:
3098 gcc_unreachable ();
3102 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used. */
3103 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
3104 (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
3106 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
3107 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
3109 switch (cfi)
3111 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3112 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3113 case DW_CFA_offset:
3114 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3115 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3116 return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
3118 case DW_CFA_register:
3119 return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
3121 case DW_CFA_expression:
3122 return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
3124 default:
3125 return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
3129 /* Switch [BACK] to eh_frame_section. If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
3130 switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic start label
3131 for collect2 the first time around. */
3133 static void
3134 switch_to_eh_frame_section (bool back)
3136 tree label;
3138 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
3139 if (eh_frame_section == 0)
3141 int flags;
3143 if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
3145 int fde_encoding;
3146 int per_encoding;
3147 int lsda_encoding;
3149 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
3150 /*global=*/0);
3151 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
3152 /*global=*/1);
3153 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
3154 /*global=*/0);
3155 flags = ((! flag_pic
3156 || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3157 && (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
3158 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3159 && (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
3160 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
3161 && (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
3162 ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
3164 else
3165 flags = SECTION_WRITE;
3166 eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
3168 #endif /* EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME */
3170 if (eh_frame_section)
3171 switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
3172 else
3174 /* We have no special eh_frame section. Put the information in
3175 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2. */
3176 switch_to_section (data_section);
3178 if (!back)
3180 label = get_file_function_name ("F");
3181 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3182 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
3183 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3184 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
3189 /* Switch [BACK] to the eh or debug frame table section, depending on
3190 FOR_EH. */
3192 static void
3193 switch_to_frame_table_section (int for_eh, bool back)
3195 if (for_eh)
3196 switch_to_eh_frame_section (back);
3197 else
3199 if (!debug_frame_section)
3200 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
3201 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
3202 switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
3206 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s). */
3208 static void
3209 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
3211 unsigned long r;
3212 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
3214 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
3215 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
3216 | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
3217 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
3218 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT)
3219 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset));
3220 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
3222 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3223 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3224 "DW_CFA_offset, column %#lx", r);
3225 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3226 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3228 else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
3230 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3231 dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
3232 "DW_CFA_restore, column %#lx", r);
3234 else
3236 dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
3237 "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
3239 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3241 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3242 if (for_eh)
3243 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
3244 ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
3245 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
3246 false, NULL);
3247 else
3248 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3249 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
3250 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3251 break;
3253 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3254 dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3255 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3256 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3257 break;
3259 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3260 dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3261 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3262 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3263 break;
3265 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3266 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3267 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3268 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3269 break;
3271 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3272 dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
3273 fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
3274 fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
3275 break;
3277 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3278 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3279 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3280 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3281 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (off, NULL);
3282 break;
3284 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3285 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3286 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3287 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3288 break;
3290 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3291 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3292 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3293 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3294 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3295 break;
3297 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3298 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3299 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3300 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3301 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3302 break;
3304 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3305 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3306 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3307 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3308 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3309 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3310 break;
3312 case DW_CFA_register:
3313 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3314 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3315 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
3316 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
3317 break;
3319 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3320 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3321 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
3322 break;
3324 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3325 off = div_data_align (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3326 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (off, NULL);
3327 break;
3329 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3330 break;
3332 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3333 case DW_CFA_expression:
3334 output_cfa_loc (cfi, for_eh);
3335 break;
3337 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3338 /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf. */
3339 gcc_unreachable ();
3341 default:
3342 break;
3347 /* Similar, but do it via assembler directives instead. */
3349 static void
3350 output_cfi_directive (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3352 unsigned long r, r2;
3354 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
3356 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3357 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3358 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3359 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3360 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3361 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3362 /* Should only be created by add_fde_cfi in a code path not
3363 followed when emitting via directives. The assembler is
3364 going to take care of this for us. */
3365 gcc_unreachable ();
3367 case DW_CFA_offset:
3368 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3369 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3370 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3371 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_offset %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3372 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3373 break;
3375 case DW_CFA_restore:
3376 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3377 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3378 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore %lu\n", r);
3379 break;
3381 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3382 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3383 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_undefined %lu\n", r);
3384 break;
3386 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3387 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3388 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_same_value %lu\n", r);
3389 break;
3391 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3392 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3393 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3394 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa %lu, "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3395 r, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset);
3396 break;
3398 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3399 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3400 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_register %lu\n", r);
3401 break;
3403 case DW_CFA_register:
3404 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3405 r2 = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
3406 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_register %lu, %lu\n", r, r2);
3407 break;
3409 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3410 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3411 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_def_cfa_offset "
3412 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC"\n",
3413 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3414 break;
3416 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3417 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_remember_state\n");
3418 break;
3419 case DW_CFA_restore_state:
3420 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_restore_state\n");
3421 break;
3423 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3424 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape %#x,", DW_CFA_GNU_args_size);
3425 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3426 if (flag_debug_asm)
3427 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s args_size "HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC,
3428 ASM_COMMENT_START, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
3429 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3430 break;
3432 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3433 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_window_save\n");
3434 break;
3436 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3437 case DW_CFA_expression:
3438 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_escape %#x,", cfi->dw_cfi_opc);
3439 output_cfa_loc_raw (cfi);
3440 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3441 break;
3443 default:
3444 gcc_unreachable ();
3448 /* Output CFIs from VEC, up to index UPTO, to bring current FDE to the
3449 same state as after executing CFIs in CFI chain. DO_CFI_ASM is
3450 true if .cfi_* directives shall be emitted, false otherwise. If it
3451 is false, FDE and FOR_EH are the other arguments to pass to
3452 output_cfi. */
3454 static void
3455 output_cfis (cfi_vec vec, int upto, bool do_cfi_asm,
3456 dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh)
3458 int ix;
3459 struct dw_cfi_struct cfi_buf;
3460 dw_cfi_ref cfi2;
3461 dw_cfi_ref cfi_args_size = NULL, cfi_cfa = NULL, cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3462 VEC(dw_cfi_ref, heap) *regs = VEC_alloc (dw_cfi_ref, heap, 32);
3463 unsigned int len, idx;
3465 for (ix = 0; ix < upto + 1; ix++)
3467 dw_cfi_ref cfi = ix < upto ? VEC_index (dw_cfi_ref, vec, ix) : NULL;
3468 switch (cfi ? cfi->dw_cfi_opc : DW_CFA_nop)
3470 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
3471 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
3472 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
3473 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
3474 case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
3475 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
3476 /* All advances should be ignored. */
3477 break;
3478 case DW_CFA_remember_state:
3480 dw_cfi_ref args_size = cfi_args_size;
3482 /* Skip everything between .cfi_remember_state and
3483 .cfi_restore_state. */
3484 ix++;
3485 if (ix == upto)
3486 goto flush_all;
3488 for (; ix < upto; ix++)
3490 cfi2 = VEC_index (dw_cfi_ref, vec, ix);
3491 if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore_state)
3492 break;
3493 else if (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_GNU_args_size)
3494 args_size = cfi2;
3495 else
3496 gcc_assert (cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_remember_state);
3499 cfi_args_size = args_size;
3500 break;
3502 case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
3503 cfi_args_size = cfi;
3504 break;
3505 case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
3506 goto flush_all;
3507 case DW_CFA_offset:
3508 case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
3509 case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
3510 case DW_CFA_restore:
3511 case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
3512 case DW_CFA_undefined:
3513 case DW_CFA_same_value:
3514 case DW_CFA_register:
3515 case DW_CFA_val_offset:
3516 case DW_CFA_val_offset_sf:
3517 case DW_CFA_expression:
3518 case DW_CFA_val_expression:
3519 case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
3520 if (VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs)
3521 <= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num)
3522 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs,
3523 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num + 1);
3524 VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num,
3525 cfi);
3526 break;
3527 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3528 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3529 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
3530 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3531 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3532 break;
3533 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
3534 cfi_cfa = cfi;
3535 break;
3536 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3537 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3538 cfi_cfa_offset = cfi;
3539 break;
3540 case DW_CFA_nop:
3541 gcc_assert (cfi == NULL);
3542 flush_all:
3543 len = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, regs);
3544 for (idx = 0; idx < len; idx++)
3546 cfi2 = VEC_replace (dw_cfi_ref, regs, idx, NULL);
3547 if (cfi2 != NULL
3548 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore
3549 && cfi2->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_restore_extended)
3551 if (do_cfi_asm)
3552 output_cfi_directive (cfi2);
3553 else
3554 output_cfi (cfi2, fde, for_eh);
3557 if (cfi_cfa && cfi_cfa_offset && cfi_cfa_offset != cfi_cfa)
3559 gcc_assert (cfi_cfa->dw_cfi_opc != DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression);
3560 cfi_buf = *cfi_cfa;
3561 switch (cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc)
3563 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
3564 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
3565 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3566 break;
3567 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
3568 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
3569 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd1;
3570 break;
3571 case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
3572 case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
3573 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_opc = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_opc;
3574 cfi_buf.dw_cfi_oprnd2 = cfi_cfa_offset->dw_cfi_oprnd2;
3575 break;
3576 default:
3577 gcc_unreachable ();
3579 cfi_cfa = &cfi_buf;
3581 else if (cfi_cfa_offset)
3582 cfi_cfa = cfi_cfa_offset;
3583 if (cfi_cfa)
3585 if (do_cfi_asm)
3586 output_cfi_directive (cfi_cfa);
3587 else
3588 output_cfi (cfi_cfa, fde, for_eh);
3590 cfi_cfa = NULL;
3591 cfi_cfa_offset = NULL;
3592 if (cfi_args_size
3593 && cfi_args_size->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset)
3595 if (do_cfi_asm)
3596 output_cfi_directive (cfi_args_size);
3597 else
3598 output_cfi (cfi_args_size, fde, for_eh);
3600 cfi_args_size = NULL;
3601 if (cfi == NULL)
3603 VEC_free (dw_cfi_ref, heap, regs);
3604 return;
3606 else if (do_cfi_asm)
3607 output_cfi_directive (cfi);
3608 else
3609 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3610 break;
3611 default:
3612 gcc_unreachable ();
3617 /* Like output_cfis, but emit all CFIs in the vector. */
3618 static void
3619 output_all_cfis (cfi_vec vec, bool do_cfi_asm,
3620 dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh)
3622 output_cfis (vec, VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, vec), do_cfi_asm, fde, for_eh);
3625 /* Output one FDE. */
3627 static void
3628 output_fde (dw_fde_ref fde, bool for_eh, bool second,
3629 char *section_start_label, int fde_encoding, char *augmentation,
3630 bool any_lsda_needed, int lsda_encoding)
3632 int ix;
3633 const char *begin, *end;
3634 static unsigned int j;
3635 char l1[20], l2[20];
3636 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3638 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh,
3639 /* empty */ 0);
3640 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL,
3641 for_eh + j);
3642 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3643 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + j);
3644 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3645 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff, "Initial length escape value"
3646 " indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3647 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3648 "FDE Length");
3649 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3651 if (for_eh)
3652 dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
3653 else
3654 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
3655 debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
3657 begin = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_begin : fde->dw_fde_begin;
3658 end = second ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end;
3660 if (for_eh)
3662 rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, begin);
3663 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
3664 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref, false,
3665 "FDE initial location");
3666 dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
3667 end, begin, "FDE address range");
3669 else
3671 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, begin, "FDE initial location");
3672 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, end, begin, "FDE address range");
3675 if (augmentation[0])
3677 if (any_lsda_needed)
3679 int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
3681 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3683 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3684 + 4 /* CIE offset */
3685 + 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
3686 + 1 /* Augmentation size */ );
3687 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3689 size += pad;
3690 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
3693 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
3695 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3697 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
3698 fde->funcdef_number);
3699 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (lsda_encoding,
3700 gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
3701 false,
3702 "Language Specific Data Area");
3704 else
3706 if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3707 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
3708 dw2_asm_output_data (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
3709 "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
3712 else
3713 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
3716 /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
3717 this FDE. */
3718 fde->dw_fde_current_label = begin;
3719 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
3720 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
3721 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3722 else if (!second)
3724 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index > 0)
3725 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
3727 if (ix == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
3728 break;
3729 output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
3732 else
3734 int i, from = 0;
3735 int until = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi);
3737 if (fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index > 0)
3739 from = fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index;
3740 output_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, from, false, fde, for_eh);
3742 for (i = from; i < until; i++)
3743 output_cfi (VEC_index (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi, i),
3744 fde, for_eh);
3747 /* If we are to emit a ref/link from function bodies to their frame tables,
3748 do it now. This is typically performed to make sure that tables
3749 associated with functions are dragged with them and not discarded in
3750 garbage collecting links. We need to do this on a per function basis to
3751 cope with -ffunction-sections. */
3753 #ifdef ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF
3754 /* Switch to the function section, emit the ref to the tables, and
3755 switch *back* into the table section. */
3756 switch_to_section (function_section (fde->decl));
3757 ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (section_start_label);
3758 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, true);
3759 #endif
3761 /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary. */
3762 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3763 floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
3764 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3766 j += 2;
3769 /* Return true if frame description entry FDE is needed for EH. */
3771 static bool
3772 fde_needed_for_eh_p (dw_fde_ref fde)
3774 if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
3775 return true;
3777 if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde->decl))
3778 return true;
3780 if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
3781 return true;
3783 /* If exceptions are enabled, we have collected nothrow info. */
3784 if (flag_exceptions && (fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls || fde->nothrow))
3785 return false;
3787 return true;
3790 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
3791 that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
3792 location of saved registers. */
3794 static void
3795 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
3797 unsigned int i;
3798 dw_fde_ref fde;
3799 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
3800 char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
3801 bool any_lsda_needed = false;
3802 char augmentation[6];
3803 int augmentation_size;
3804 int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3805 int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3806 int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
3807 int return_reg;
3808 rtx personality = NULL;
3809 int dw_cie_version;
3811 /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs. */
3812 if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
3813 return;
3815 /* Nothing to do if the assembler's doing it all. */
3816 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
3817 return;
3819 /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't emit
3820 any EH unwind information. If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to
3821 emit an empty label for an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted. We
3822 want to avoid having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to
3823 is discarded. Example where this matters: a primary function template
3824 in C++ requires EH information, an explicit specialization doesn't. */
3825 if (for_eh)
3827 bool any_eh_needed = false;
3829 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3830 if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
3831 any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
3832 else if (fde_needed_for_eh_p (&fde_table[i]))
3833 any_eh_needed = true;
3834 else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO)
3835 targetm.asm_out.emit_unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
3836 1, 1);
3838 if (!any_eh_needed)
3839 return;
3842 /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app. */
3843 if (flag_debug_asm)
3844 app_enable ();
3846 /* Switch to the proper frame section, first time. */
3847 switch_to_frame_table_section (for_eh, false);
3849 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
3850 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
3852 /* Output the CIE. */
3853 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
3854 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
3855 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
3856 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
3857 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
3858 dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
3859 "Length of Common Information Entry");
3860 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
3862 /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
3863 use 0 to identify the CIE. */
3864 dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
3865 (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
3866 "CIE Identifier Tag");
3868 /* Use the CIE version 3 for DWARF3; allow DWARF2 to continue to
3869 use CIE version 1, unless that would produce incorrect results
3870 due to overflowing the return register column. */
3871 return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
3872 dw_cie_version = 1;
3873 if (return_reg >= 256 || dwarf_version > 2)
3874 dw_cie_version = 3;
3875 dw2_asm_output_data (1, dw_cie_version, "CIE Version");
3877 augmentation[0] = 0;
3878 augmentation_size = 0;
3880 personality = current_unit_personality;
3881 if (for_eh)
3883 char *p;
3885 /* Augmentation:
3886 z Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
3887 augmentation section.
3888 L Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
3889 an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
3890 R Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
3891 FDE code pointers.
3892 P Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
3893 personality routine in the CIE augmentation. */
3895 fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
3896 per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
3897 lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
3899 p = augmentation + 1;
3900 if (personality)
3902 *p++ = 'P';
3903 augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
3904 assemble_external_libcall (personality);
3906 if (any_lsda_needed)
3908 *p++ = 'L';
3909 augmentation_size += 1;
3911 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3913 *p++ = 'R';
3914 augmentation_size += 1;
3916 if (p > augmentation + 1)
3918 augmentation[0] = 'z';
3919 *p = '\0';
3922 /* Ug. Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all. */
3923 if (personality && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
3925 int offset = ( 4 /* Length */
3926 + 4 /* CIE Id */
3927 + 1 /* CIE version */
3928 + strlen (augmentation) + 1 /* Augmentation */
3929 + size_of_uleb128 (1) /* Code alignment */
3930 + size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
3931 + 1 /* RA column */
3932 + 1 /* Augmentation size */
3933 + 1 /* Personality encoding */ );
3934 int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
3936 augmentation_size += pad;
3938 /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
3939 iterate for a solution. Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte. */
3940 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
3944 dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
3945 if (dw_cie_version >= 4)
3947 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "CIE Address Size");
3948 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "CIE Segment Size");
3950 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
3951 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
3952 "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
3954 if (dw_cie_version == 1)
3955 dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3956 else
3957 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
3959 if (augmentation[0])
3961 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
3962 if (personality)
3964 dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
3965 eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
3966 dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
3967 personality,
3968 true, NULL);
3971 if (any_lsda_needed)
3972 dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
3973 eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
3975 if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
3976 dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
3977 eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
3980 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, cie_cfi_vec, i, cfi)
3981 output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
3983 /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary. */
3984 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
3985 floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
3986 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
3988 /* Loop through all of the FDE's. */
3989 for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
3991 unsigned int k;
3992 fde = &fde_table[i];
3994 /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it. */
3995 if (for_eh && !fde_needed_for_eh_p (fde))
3996 continue;
3998 for (k = 0; k < (fde->dw_fde_second_begin ? 2 : 1); k++)
3999 output_fde (fde, for_eh, k, section_start_label, fde_encoding,
4000 augmentation, any_lsda_needed, lsda_encoding);
4003 if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
4004 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
4005 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
4006 /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
4007 get a value of 0. Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it. */
4008 ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
4009 #endif
4011 /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker. */
4012 if (flag_debug_asm)
4013 app_disable ();
4016 /* Emit .cfi_startproc and .cfi_personality/.cfi_lsda if needed. */
4018 static void
4019 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (bool second)
4021 int enc;
4022 rtx ref;
4023 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
4025 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_startproc\n");
4027 if (personality)
4029 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
4030 ref = personality;
4032 /* ??? The GAS support isn't entirely consistent. We have to
4033 handle indirect support ourselves, but PC-relative is done
4034 in the assembler. Further, the assembler can't handle any
4035 of the weirder relocation types. */
4036 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
4037 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
4039 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_personality %#x,", enc);
4040 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
4041 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
4044 if (crtl->uses_eh_lsda)
4046 char lab[20];
4048 enc = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
4049 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (lab, second ? "LLSDAC" : "LLSDA",
4050 current_function_funcdef_no);
4051 ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, lab);
4052 SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (ref) = SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
4054 if (enc & DW_EH_PE_indirect)
4055 ref = dw2_force_const_mem (ref, true);
4057 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_lsda %#x,", enc);
4058 output_addr_const (asm_out_file, ref);
4059 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
4063 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
4064 the prologue. */
4066 void
4067 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4068 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4070 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4071 char * dup_label;
4072 dw_fde_ref fde;
4073 section *fnsec;
4074 bool do_frame;
4076 current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
4078 do_frame = dwarf2out_do_frame ();
4080 /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c for
4081 call-site information. We must emit this label if it might be used. */
4082 if (!do_frame
4083 && (!flag_exceptions
4084 || targetm.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_TARGET))
4085 return;
4087 fnsec = function_section (current_function_decl);
4088 switch_to_section (fnsec);
4089 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
4090 current_function_funcdef_no);
4091 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
4092 current_function_funcdef_no);
4093 dup_label = xstrdup (label);
4094 current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
4096 /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info. */
4097 if (!do_frame)
4098 return;
4100 /* Expand the fde table if necessary. */
4101 if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
4103 fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
4104 fde_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_fde_node, fde_table, fde_table_allocated);
4105 memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
4106 FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
4109 /* Record the FDE associated with this function. */
4110 current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
4112 /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table. */
4113 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
4114 fde->decl = current_function_decl;
4115 fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
4116 fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
4117 fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
4118 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = NULL;
4119 fde->dw_fde_second_end = NULL;
4120 fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = NULL;
4121 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = NULL;
4122 fde->dw_fde_cfi = VEC_alloc (dw_cfi_ref, gc, 20);
4123 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index = 0;
4124 fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
4125 fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = crtl->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
4126 fde->uses_eh_lsda = crtl->uses_eh_lsda;
4127 fde->nothrow = crtl->nothrow;
4128 fde->drap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
4129 fde->vdrap_reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
4130 fde->in_std_section = (fnsec == text_section
4131 || (cold_text_section && fnsec == cold_text_section));
4132 fde->second_in_std_section = 0;
4134 args_size = old_args_size = 0;
4136 /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
4137 prologue case, not the eh frame case. */
4138 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4139 if (file)
4140 dwarf2out_source_line (line, file, 0, true);
4141 #endif
4143 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4144 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (false);
4145 else
4147 rtx personality = get_personality_function (current_function_decl);
4148 if (!current_unit_personality)
4149 current_unit_personality = personality;
4151 /* We cannot keep a current personality per function as without CFI
4152 asm, at the point where we emit the CFI data, there is no current
4153 function anymore. */
4154 if (personality && current_unit_personality != personality)
4155 sorry ("multiple EH personalities are supported only with assemblers "
4156 "supporting .cfi_personality directive");
4160 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code
4161 for a function prologue. This gets called *after* the prologue code has
4162 been generated. */
4164 void
4165 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4166 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4168 dw_fde_ref fde;
4169 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4171 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4172 function. */
4173 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
4174 current_function_funcdef_no);
4175 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
4176 current_function_funcdef_no);
4177 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
4178 fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue = xstrdup (label);
4181 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code
4182 for a function epilogue. This gets called *before* the prologue code has
4183 been generated. */
4185 void
4186 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4187 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4189 dw_fde_ref fde;
4190 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4192 fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
4193 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
4194 return;
4196 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4197 function. */
4198 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
4199 current_function_funcdef_no);
4200 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, EPILOGUE_BEGIN_LABEL,
4201 current_function_funcdef_no);
4202 fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue = xstrdup (label);
4205 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
4206 for a function definition. This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
4207 been generated. */
4209 void
4210 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4211 const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
4213 dw_fde_ref fde;
4214 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4216 last_var_location_insn = NULL_RTX;
4218 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4219 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4221 /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
4222 function. */
4223 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
4224 current_function_funcdef_no);
4225 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
4226 fde = current_fde ();
4227 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
4228 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL)
4229 fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
4232 void
4233 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
4235 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table. */
4236 fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_fde_node (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
4237 fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
4238 fde_table_in_use = 0;
4240 /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's. Do it now for the
4241 sake of lookup_cfa. */
4243 /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP. */
4244 dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
4246 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2
4247 || targetm.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
4248 initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
4251 void
4252 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
4254 /* Output call frame information. */
4255 if (targetm.debug_unwind_info () == UI_DWARF2)
4256 output_call_frame_info (0);
4258 /* Output another copy for the unwinder. */
4259 if ((flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
4260 && targetm.except_unwind_info (&global_options) == UI_DWARF2)
4261 output_call_frame_info (1);
4264 /* Note that the current function section is being used for code. */
4266 static void
4267 dwarf2out_note_section_used (void)
4269 section *sec = current_function_section ();
4270 if (sec == text_section)
4271 text_section_used = true;
4272 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
4273 cold_text_section_used = true;
4276 static void var_location_switch_text_section (void);
4277 static void set_cur_line_info_table (section *);
4279 void
4280 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
4282 section *sect;
4283 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
4285 gcc_assert (cfun && fde && fde->dw_fde_second_begin == NULL);
4287 if (!in_cold_section_p)
4289 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
4290 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.hot_section_label;
4291 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
4293 else
4295 fde->dw_fde_end = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
4296 fde->dw_fde_second_begin = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
4297 fde->dw_fde_second_end = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
4299 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
4301 /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
4302 don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections. */
4303 fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
4305 /* There is no need to mark used sections when not debugging. */
4306 if (cold_text_section != NULL)
4307 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
4309 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4310 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_endproc\n");
4312 /* Now do the real section switch. */
4313 sect = current_function_section ();
4314 switch_to_section (sect);
4316 fde->second_in_std_section
4317 = (sect == text_section
4318 || (cold_text_section && sect == cold_text_section));
4320 if (dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ())
4322 dwarf2out_do_cfi_startproc (true);
4323 /* As this is a different FDE, insert all current CFI instructions
4324 again. */
4325 output_all_cfis (fde->dw_fde_cfi, true, fde, true);
4327 fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index = VEC_length (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi);
4328 var_location_switch_text_section ();
4330 set_cur_line_info_table (sect);
4333 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
4334 for emitting location expressions. */
4336 /* Data about a single source file. */
4337 struct GTY(()) dwarf_file_data {
4338 const char * filename;
4339 int emitted_number;
4342 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
4343 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
4344 typedef const struct die_struct *const_dw_die_ref;
4345 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
4346 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
4348 typedef struct GTY(()) deferred_locations_struct
4350 tree variable;
4351 dw_die_ref die;
4352 } deferred_locations;
4354 DEF_VEC_O(deferred_locations);
4355 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(deferred_locations,gc);
4357 static GTY(()) VEC(deferred_locations, gc) *deferred_locations_list;
4359 DEF_VEC_P(dw_die_ref);
4360 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_die_ref,heap);
4362 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs. Values
4363 can take on several forms. The forms that are used in this
4364 implementation are listed below. */
4366 enum dw_val_class
4368 dw_val_class_addr,
4369 dw_val_class_offset,
4370 dw_val_class_loc,
4371 dw_val_class_loc_list,
4372 dw_val_class_range_list,
4373 dw_val_class_const,
4374 dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
4375 dw_val_class_const_double,
4376 dw_val_class_vec,
4377 dw_val_class_flag,
4378 dw_val_class_die_ref,
4379 dw_val_class_fde_ref,
4380 dw_val_class_lbl_id,
4381 dw_val_class_lineptr,
4382 dw_val_class_str,
4383 dw_val_class_macptr,
4384 dw_val_class_file,
4385 dw_val_class_data8,
4386 dw_val_class_decl_ref,
4387 dw_val_class_vms_delta
4390 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value. */
4392 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_vec_struct {
4393 unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
4394 unsigned length;
4395 unsigned elt_size;
4397 dw_vec_const;
4399 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
4400 represented internally. */
4402 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_val_struct {
4403 enum dw_val_class val_class;
4404 union dw_val_struct_union
4406 rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
4407 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
4408 dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
4409 dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
4410 HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
4411 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
4412 double_int GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_const_double"))) val_double;
4413 dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
4414 struct dw_val_die_union
4416 dw_die_ref die;
4417 int external;
4418 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
4419 unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
4420 struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
4421 char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
4422 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
4423 struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
4424 unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_data8"))) val_data8[8];
4425 tree GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_decl_ref"))) val_decl_ref;
4426 struct dw_val_vms_delta_union
4428 char * lbl1;
4429 char * lbl2;
4430 } GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vms_delta"))) val_vms_delta;
4432 GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
4434 dw_val_node;
4436 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
4437 operations. */
4439 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_descr_struct {
4440 dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
4441 ENUM_BITFIELD (dwarf_location_atom) dw_loc_opc : 8;
4442 /* Used to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol relocation
4443 from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation. */
4444 unsigned int dtprel : 1;
4445 int dw_loc_addr;
4446 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
4447 dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
4449 dw_loc_descr_node;
4451 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
4452 so you can track variables that are in different places over
4453 their entire life. */
4454 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_loc_list_struct {
4455 dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
4456 const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
4457 const char *end; /* Label for end address of range */
4458 char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
4459 Only on head of list */
4460 const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
4461 dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
4462 hashval_t hash;
4463 /* True if all addresses in this and subsequent lists are known to be
4464 resolved. */
4465 bool resolved_addr;
4466 /* True if this list has been replaced by dw_loc_next. */
4467 bool replaced;
4468 bool emitted;
4469 } dw_loc_list_node;
4471 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4473 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name. */
4475 static const char *
4476 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
4478 switch (op)
4480 case DW_OP_addr:
4481 return "DW_OP_addr";
4482 case DW_OP_deref:
4483 return "DW_OP_deref";
4484 case DW_OP_const1u:
4485 return "DW_OP_const1u";
4486 case DW_OP_const1s:
4487 return "DW_OP_const1s";
4488 case DW_OP_const2u:
4489 return "DW_OP_const2u";
4490 case DW_OP_const2s:
4491 return "DW_OP_const2s";
4492 case DW_OP_const4u:
4493 return "DW_OP_const4u";
4494 case DW_OP_const4s:
4495 return "DW_OP_const4s";
4496 case DW_OP_const8u:
4497 return "DW_OP_const8u";
4498 case DW_OP_const8s:
4499 return "DW_OP_const8s";
4500 case DW_OP_constu:
4501 return "DW_OP_constu";
4502 case DW_OP_consts:
4503 return "DW_OP_consts";
4504 case DW_OP_dup:
4505 return "DW_OP_dup";
4506 case DW_OP_drop:
4507 return "DW_OP_drop";
4508 case DW_OP_over:
4509 return "DW_OP_over";
4510 case DW_OP_pick:
4511 return "DW_OP_pick";
4512 case DW_OP_swap:
4513 return "DW_OP_swap";
4514 case DW_OP_rot:
4515 return "DW_OP_rot";
4516 case DW_OP_xderef:
4517 return "DW_OP_xderef";
4518 case DW_OP_abs:
4519 return "DW_OP_abs";
4520 case DW_OP_and:
4521 return "DW_OP_and";
4522 case DW_OP_div:
4523 return "DW_OP_div";
4524 case DW_OP_minus:
4525 return "DW_OP_minus";
4526 case DW_OP_mod:
4527 return "DW_OP_mod";
4528 case DW_OP_mul:
4529 return "DW_OP_mul";
4530 case DW_OP_neg:
4531 return "DW_OP_neg";
4532 case DW_OP_not:
4533 return "DW_OP_not";
4534 case DW_OP_or:
4535 return "DW_OP_or";
4536 case DW_OP_plus:
4537 return "DW_OP_plus";
4538 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4539 return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
4540 case DW_OP_shl:
4541 return "DW_OP_shl";
4542 case DW_OP_shr:
4543 return "DW_OP_shr";
4544 case DW_OP_shra:
4545 return "DW_OP_shra";
4546 case DW_OP_xor:
4547 return "DW_OP_xor";
4548 case DW_OP_bra:
4549 return "DW_OP_bra";
4550 case DW_OP_eq:
4551 return "DW_OP_eq";
4552 case DW_OP_ge:
4553 return "DW_OP_ge";
4554 case DW_OP_gt:
4555 return "DW_OP_gt";
4556 case DW_OP_le:
4557 return "DW_OP_le";
4558 case DW_OP_lt:
4559 return "DW_OP_lt";
4560 case DW_OP_ne:
4561 return "DW_OP_ne";
4562 case DW_OP_skip:
4563 return "DW_OP_skip";
4564 case DW_OP_lit0:
4565 return "DW_OP_lit0";
4566 case DW_OP_lit1:
4567 return "DW_OP_lit1";
4568 case DW_OP_lit2:
4569 return "DW_OP_lit2";
4570 case DW_OP_lit3:
4571 return "DW_OP_lit3";
4572 case DW_OP_lit4:
4573 return "DW_OP_lit4";
4574 case DW_OP_lit5:
4575 return "DW_OP_lit5";
4576 case DW_OP_lit6:
4577 return "DW_OP_lit6";
4578 case DW_OP_lit7:
4579 return "DW_OP_lit7";
4580 case DW_OP_lit8:
4581 return "DW_OP_lit8";
4582 case DW_OP_lit9:
4583 return "DW_OP_lit9";
4584 case DW_OP_lit10:
4585 return "DW_OP_lit10";
4586 case DW_OP_lit11:
4587 return "DW_OP_lit11";
4588 case DW_OP_lit12:
4589 return "DW_OP_lit12";
4590 case DW_OP_lit13:
4591 return "DW_OP_lit13";
4592 case DW_OP_lit14:
4593 return "DW_OP_lit14";
4594 case DW_OP_lit15:
4595 return "DW_OP_lit15";
4596 case DW_OP_lit16:
4597 return "DW_OP_lit16";
4598 case DW_OP_lit17:
4599 return "DW_OP_lit17";
4600 case DW_OP_lit18:
4601 return "DW_OP_lit18";
4602 case DW_OP_lit19:
4603 return "DW_OP_lit19";
4604 case DW_OP_lit20:
4605 return "DW_OP_lit20";
4606 case DW_OP_lit21:
4607 return "DW_OP_lit21";
4608 case DW_OP_lit22:
4609 return "DW_OP_lit22";
4610 case DW_OP_lit23:
4611 return "DW_OP_lit23";
4612 case DW_OP_lit24:
4613 return "DW_OP_lit24";
4614 case DW_OP_lit25:
4615 return "DW_OP_lit25";
4616 case DW_OP_lit26:
4617 return "DW_OP_lit26";
4618 case DW_OP_lit27:
4619 return "DW_OP_lit27";
4620 case DW_OP_lit28:
4621 return "DW_OP_lit28";
4622 case DW_OP_lit29:
4623 return "DW_OP_lit29";
4624 case DW_OP_lit30:
4625 return "DW_OP_lit30";
4626 case DW_OP_lit31:
4627 return "DW_OP_lit31";
4628 case DW_OP_reg0:
4629 return "DW_OP_reg0";
4630 case DW_OP_reg1:
4631 return "DW_OP_reg1";
4632 case DW_OP_reg2:
4633 return "DW_OP_reg2";
4634 case DW_OP_reg3:
4635 return "DW_OP_reg3";
4636 case DW_OP_reg4:
4637 return "DW_OP_reg4";
4638 case DW_OP_reg5:
4639 return "DW_OP_reg5";
4640 case DW_OP_reg6:
4641 return "DW_OP_reg6";
4642 case DW_OP_reg7:
4643 return "DW_OP_reg7";
4644 case DW_OP_reg8:
4645 return "DW_OP_reg8";
4646 case DW_OP_reg9:
4647 return "DW_OP_reg9";
4648 case DW_OP_reg10:
4649 return "DW_OP_reg10";
4650 case DW_OP_reg11:
4651 return "DW_OP_reg11";
4652 case DW_OP_reg12:
4653 return "DW_OP_reg12";
4654 case DW_OP_reg13:
4655 return "DW_OP_reg13";
4656 case DW_OP_reg14:
4657 return "DW_OP_reg14";
4658 case DW_OP_reg15:
4659 return "DW_OP_reg15";
4660 case DW_OP_reg16:
4661 return "DW_OP_reg16";
4662 case DW_OP_reg17:
4663 return "DW_OP_reg17";
4664 case DW_OP_reg18:
4665 return "DW_OP_reg18";
4666 case DW_OP_reg19:
4667 return "DW_OP_reg19";
4668 case DW_OP_reg20:
4669 return "DW_OP_reg20";
4670 case DW_OP_reg21:
4671 return "DW_OP_reg21";
4672 case DW_OP_reg22:
4673 return "DW_OP_reg22";
4674 case DW_OP_reg23:
4675 return "DW_OP_reg23";
4676 case DW_OP_reg24:
4677 return "DW_OP_reg24";
4678 case DW_OP_reg25:
4679 return "DW_OP_reg25";
4680 case DW_OP_reg26:
4681 return "DW_OP_reg26";
4682 case DW_OP_reg27:
4683 return "DW_OP_reg27";
4684 case DW_OP_reg28:
4685 return "DW_OP_reg28";
4686 case DW_OP_reg29:
4687 return "DW_OP_reg29";
4688 case DW_OP_reg30:
4689 return "DW_OP_reg30";
4690 case DW_OP_reg31:
4691 return "DW_OP_reg31";
4692 case DW_OP_breg0:
4693 return "DW_OP_breg0";
4694 case DW_OP_breg1:
4695 return "DW_OP_breg1";
4696 case DW_OP_breg2:
4697 return "DW_OP_breg2";
4698 case DW_OP_breg3:
4699 return "DW_OP_breg3";
4700 case DW_OP_breg4:
4701 return "DW_OP_breg4";
4702 case DW_OP_breg5:
4703 return "DW_OP_breg5";
4704 case DW_OP_breg6:
4705 return "DW_OP_breg6";
4706 case DW_OP_breg7:
4707 return "DW_OP_breg7";
4708 case DW_OP_breg8:
4709 return "DW_OP_breg8";
4710 case DW_OP_breg9:
4711 return "DW_OP_breg9";
4712 case DW_OP_breg10:
4713 return "DW_OP_breg10";
4714 case DW_OP_breg11:
4715 return "DW_OP_breg11";
4716 case DW_OP_breg12:
4717 return "DW_OP_breg12";
4718 case DW_OP_breg13:
4719 return "DW_OP_breg13";
4720 case DW_OP_breg14:
4721 return "DW_OP_breg14";
4722 case DW_OP_breg15:
4723 return "DW_OP_breg15";
4724 case DW_OP_breg16:
4725 return "DW_OP_breg16";
4726 case DW_OP_breg17:
4727 return "DW_OP_breg17";
4728 case DW_OP_breg18:
4729 return "DW_OP_breg18";
4730 case DW_OP_breg19:
4731 return "DW_OP_breg19";
4732 case DW_OP_breg20:
4733 return "DW_OP_breg20";
4734 case DW_OP_breg21:
4735 return "DW_OP_breg21";
4736 case DW_OP_breg22:
4737 return "DW_OP_breg22";
4738 case DW_OP_breg23:
4739 return "DW_OP_breg23";
4740 case DW_OP_breg24:
4741 return "DW_OP_breg24";
4742 case DW_OP_breg25:
4743 return "DW_OP_breg25";
4744 case DW_OP_breg26:
4745 return "DW_OP_breg26";
4746 case DW_OP_breg27:
4747 return "DW_OP_breg27";
4748 case DW_OP_breg28:
4749 return "DW_OP_breg28";
4750 case DW_OP_breg29:
4751 return "DW_OP_breg29";
4752 case DW_OP_breg30:
4753 return "DW_OP_breg30";
4754 case DW_OP_breg31:
4755 return "DW_OP_breg31";
4756 case DW_OP_regx:
4757 return "DW_OP_regx";
4758 case DW_OP_fbreg:
4759 return "DW_OP_fbreg";
4760 case DW_OP_bregx:
4761 return "DW_OP_bregx";
4762 case DW_OP_piece:
4763 return "DW_OP_piece";
4764 case DW_OP_deref_size:
4765 return "DW_OP_deref_size";
4766 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
4767 return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
4768 case DW_OP_nop:
4769 return "DW_OP_nop";
4771 case DW_OP_push_object_address:
4772 return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
4773 case DW_OP_call2:
4774 return "DW_OP_call2";
4775 case DW_OP_call4:
4776 return "DW_OP_call4";
4777 case DW_OP_call_ref:
4778 return "DW_OP_call_ref";
4779 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
4780 return "DW_OP_implicit_value";
4781 case DW_OP_stack_value:
4782 return "DW_OP_stack_value";
4783 case DW_OP_form_tls_address:
4784 return "DW_OP_form_tls_address";
4785 case DW_OP_call_frame_cfa:
4786 return "DW_OP_call_frame_cfa";
4787 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
4788 return "DW_OP_bit_piece";
4790 case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
4791 return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
4792 case DW_OP_GNU_uninit:
4793 return "DW_OP_GNU_uninit";
4794 case DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr:
4795 return "DW_OP_GNU_encoded_addr";
4796 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
4797 return "DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer";
4798 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
4799 return "DW_OP_GNU_entry_value";
4800 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
4801 return "DW_OP_GNU_const_type";
4802 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
4803 return "DW_OP_GNU_regval_type";
4804 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
4805 return "DW_OP_GNU_deref_type";
4806 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
4807 return "DW_OP_GNU_convert";
4808 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
4809 return "DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret";
4811 default:
4812 return "OP_<unknown>";
4816 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description. Location
4817 descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
4818 together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions. */
4820 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4821 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
4822 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
4824 dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_descr_node ();
4826 descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
4827 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4828 descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
4829 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4830 descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
4832 return descr;
4835 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description for
4836 REG and OFFSET. */
4838 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
4839 new_reg_loc_descr (unsigned int reg, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4841 if (reg <= 31)
4842 return new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + reg),
4843 offset, 0);
4844 else
4845 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, reg, offset);
4848 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression. */
4850 static inline void
4851 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
4853 dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
4855 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4856 for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
4859 *d = descr;
4862 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location expression. */
4864 static void
4865 loc_descr_plus_const (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4867 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
4868 HOST_WIDE_INT *p;
4870 gcc_assert (*list_head != NULL);
4872 if (!offset)
4873 return;
4875 /* Find the end of the chain. */
4876 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
4879 p = NULL;
4880 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg
4881 || (loc->dw_loc_opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && loc->dw_loc_opc <= DW_OP_breg31))
4882 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
4883 else if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bregx)
4884 p = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
4886 /* If the last operation is fbreg, breg{0..31,x}, optimize by adjusting its
4887 offset. Don't optimize if an signed integer overflow would happen. */
4888 if (p != NULL
4889 && ((offset > 0 && *p <= INTTYPE_MAXIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)
4890 || (offset < 0 && *p >= INTTYPE_MINIMUM (HOST_WIDE_INT) - offset)))
4891 *p += offset;
4893 else if (offset > 0)
4894 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
4896 else
4898 loc->dw_loc_next = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
4899 add_loc_descr (&loc->dw_loc_next, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
4903 /* Add a constant OFFSET to a location list. */
4905 static void
4906 loc_list_plus_const (dw_loc_list_ref list_head, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
4908 dw_loc_list_ref d;
4909 for (d = list_head; d != NULL; d = d->dw_loc_next)
4910 loc_descr_plus_const (&d->expr, offset);
4913 #define DWARF_REF_SIZE \
4914 (dwarf_version == 2 ? DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
4916 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
4917 static unsigned long int get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref);
4919 /* Return the size of a location descriptor. */
4921 static unsigned long
4922 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
4924 unsigned long size = 1;
4926 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
4928 case DW_OP_addr:
4929 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
4930 break;
4931 case DW_OP_const1u:
4932 case DW_OP_const1s:
4933 size += 1;
4934 break;
4935 case DW_OP_const2u:
4936 case DW_OP_const2s:
4937 size += 2;
4938 break;
4939 case DW_OP_const4u:
4940 case DW_OP_const4s:
4941 size += 4;
4942 break;
4943 case DW_OP_const8u:
4944 case DW_OP_const8s:
4945 size += 8;
4946 break;
4947 case DW_OP_constu:
4948 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4949 break;
4950 case DW_OP_consts:
4951 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4952 break;
4953 case DW_OP_pick:
4954 size += 1;
4955 break;
4956 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
4957 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4958 break;
4959 case DW_OP_skip:
4960 case DW_OP_bra:
4961 size += 2;
4962 break;
4963 case DW_OP_breg0:
4964 case DW_OP_breg1:
4965 case DW_OP_breg2:
4966 case DW_OP_breg3:
4967 case DW_OP_breg4:
4968 case DW_OP_breg5:
4969 case DW_OP_breg6:
4970 case DW_OP_breg7:
4971 case DW_OP_breg8:
4972 case DW_OP_breg9:
4973 case DW_OP_breg10:
4974 case DW_OP_breg11:
4975 case DW_OP_breg12:
4976 case DW_OP_breg13:
4977 case DW_OP_breg14:
4978 case DW_OP_breg15:
4979 case DW_OP_breg16:
4980 case DW_OP_breg17:
4981 case DW_OP_breg18:
4982 case DW_OP_breg19:
4983 case DW_OP_breg20:
4984 case DW_OP_breg21:
4985 case DW_OP_breg22:
4986 case DW_OP_breg23:
4987 case DW_OP_breg24:
4988 case DW_OP_breg25:
4989 case DW_OP_breg26:
4990 case DW_OP_breg27:
4991 case DW_OP_breg28:
4992 case DW_OP_breg29:
4993 case DW_OP_breg30:
4994 case DW_OP_breg31:
4995 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
4996 break;
4997 case DW_OP_regx:
4998 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
4999 break;
5000 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5001 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
5002 break;
5003 case DW_OP_bregx:
5004 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
5005 size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
5006 break;
5007 case DW_OP_piece:
5008 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
5009 break;
5010 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
5011 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
5012 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned);
5013 break;
5014 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5015 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5016 size += 1;
5017 break;
5018 case DW_OP_call2:
5019 size += 2;
5020 break;
5021 case DW_OP_call4:
5022 size += 4;
5023 break;
5024 case DW_OP_call_ref:
5025 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE;
5026 break;
5027 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5028 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
5029 + loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
5030 break;
5031 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
5032 size += DWARF_REF_SIZE + size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
5033 break;
5034 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
5036 unsigned long op_size = size_of_locs (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
5037 size += size_of_uleb128 (op_size) + op_size;
5038 break;
5040 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
5042 unsigned long o
5043 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
5044 size += size_of_uleb128 (o) + 1;
5045 switch (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class)
5047 case dw_val_class_vec:
5048 size += loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length
5049 * loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size;
5050 break;
5051 case dw_val_class_const:
5052 size += HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
5053 break;
5054 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5055 size += 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / BITS_PER_UNIT;
5056 break;
5057 default:
5058 gcc_unreachable ();
5060 break;
5062 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
5064 unsigned long o
5065 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
5066 size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned)
5067 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
5069 break;
5070 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
5072 unsigned long o
5073 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die);
5074 size += 1 + size_of_uleb128 (o);
5076 break;
5077 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
5078 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
5080 unsigned long o
5081 = get_base_type_offset (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die);
5082 size += size_of_uleb128 (o);
5084 default:
5085 break;
5088 return size;
5091 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors. */
5093 static unsigned long
5094 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5096 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
5097 unsigned long size;
5099 /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
5100 field, to avoid writing to a PCH file. */
5101 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
5103 if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
5104 break;
5105 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
5107 if (! l)
5108 return size;
5110 for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
5112 l->dw_loc_addr = size;
5113 size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
5116 return size;
5119 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
5120 static void get_ref_die_offset_label (char *, dw_die_ref);
5121 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref, int);
5123 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
5124 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
5125 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
5126 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
5127 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
5128 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
5130 static void
5131 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
5133 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
5134 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
5136 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
5138 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5139 case DW_OP_const2u:
5140 case DW_OP_const2s:
5141 dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5142 break;
5143 case DW_OP_const4u:
5144 if (loc->dtprel)
5146 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
5147 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 4,
5148 val1->v.val_addr);
5149 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5150 break;
5152 /* FALLTHRU */
5153 case DW_OP_const4s:
5154 dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5155 break;
5156 case DW_OP_const8u:
5157 if (loc->dtprel)
5159 gcc_assert (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel);
5160 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file, 8,
5161 val1->v.val_addr);
5162 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5163 break;
5165 /* FALLTHRU */
5166 case DW_OP_const8s:
5167 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
5168 dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5169 break;
5170 case DW_OP_skip:
5171 case DW_OP_bra:
5173 int offset;
5175 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
5176 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
5178 dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
5180 break;
5181 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5182 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5183 switch (val2->val_class)
5185 case dw_val_class_const:
5186 dw2_asm_output_data (val1->v.val_unsigned, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5187 break;
5188 case dw_val_class_vec:
5190 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
5191 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
5192 unsigned int i;
5193 unsigned char *p;
5195 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
5197 elt_size /= 2;
5198 len *= 2;
5200 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
5201 i < len;
5202 i++, p += elt_size)
5203 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
5204 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
5206 break;
5207 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5209 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
5211 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
5213 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
5214 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
5216 else
5218 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
5219 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
5221 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
5222 first, NULL);
5223 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
5224 second, NULL);
5226 break;
5227 case dw_val_class_addr:
5228 gcc_assert (val1->v.val_unsigned == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
5229 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val2->v.val_addr, NULL);
5230 break;
5231 default:
5232 gcc_unreachable ();
5234 break;
5235 #else
5236 case DW_OP_const2u:
5237 case DW_OP_const2s:
5238 case DW_OP_const4u:
5239 case DW_OP_const4s:
5240 case DW_OP_const8u:
5241 case DW_OP_const8s:
5242 case DW_OP_skip:
5243 case DW_OP_bra:
5244 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5245 /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
5246 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
5247 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
5248 only doing unwinding. */
5249 gcc_unreachable ();
5250 #endif
5251 case DW_OP_const1u:
5252 case DW_OP_const1s:
5253 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5254 break;
5255 case DW_OP_constu:
5256 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5257 break;
5258 case DW_OP_consts:
5259 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5260 break;
5261 case DW_OP_pick:
5262 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5263 break;
5264 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5265 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5266 break;
5267 case DW_OP_breg0:
5268 case DW_OP_breg1:
5269 case DW_OP_breg2:
5270 case DW_OP_breg3:
5271 case DW_OP_breg4:
5272 case DW_OP_breg5:
5273 case DW_OP_breg6:
5274 case DW_OP_breg7:
5275 case DW_OP_breg8:
5276 case DW_OP_breg9:
5277 case DW_OP_breg10:
5278 case DW_OP_breg11:
5279 case DW_OP_breg12:
5280 case DW_OP_breg13:
5281 case DW_OP_breg14:
5282 case DW_OP_breg15:
5283 case DW_OP_breg16:
5284 case DW_OP_breg17:
5285 case DW_OP_breg18:
5286 case DW_OP_breg19:
5287 case DW_OP_breg20:
5288 case DW_OP_breg21:
5289 case DW_OP_breg22:
5290 case DW_OP_breg23:
5291 case DW_OP_breg24:
5292 case DW_OP_breg25:
5293 case DW_OP_breg26:
5294 case DW_OP_breg27:
5295 case DW_OP_breg28:
5296 case DW_OP_breg29:
5297 case DW_OP_breg30:
5298 case DW_OP_breg31:
5299 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5300 break;
5301 case DW_OP_regx:
5303 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
5304 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
5305 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
5306 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
5307 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
5308 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
5310 break;
5311 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5312 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5313 break;
5314 case DW_OP_bregx:
5316 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
5317 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
5318 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
5319 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
5320 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
5321 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
5322 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5324 break;
5325 case DW_OP_piece:
5326 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5327 break;
5328 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
5329 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5330 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val2->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
5331 break;
5332 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5333 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5334 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5335 break;
5337 case DW_OP_addr:
5338 if (loc->dtprel)
5340 if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
5342 targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
5343 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
5344 val1->v.val_addr);
5345 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
5347 else
5348 gcc_unreachable ();
5350 else
5352 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
5353 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
5354 #else
5355 gcc_unreachable ();
5356 #endif
5358 break;
5360 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
5362 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES
5363 + HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / 2 + 2];
5364 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5365 get_ref_die_offset_label (label, val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
5366 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_REF_SIZE, label, debug_info_section, NULL);
5367 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5369 break;
5371 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
5372 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size_of_locs (val1->v.val_loc), NULL);
5373 output_loc_sequence (val1->v.val_loc, for_eh_or_skip);
5374 break;
5376 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
5378 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die), l;
5379 gcc_assert (o);
5380 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
5381 switch (val2->val_class)
5383 case dw_val_class_const:
5384 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
5385 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
5386 dw2_asm_output_data (l, val2->v.val_int, NULL);
5387 break;
5388 case dw_val_class_vec:
5390 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
5391 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
5392 unsigned int i;
5393 unsigned char *p;
5395 l = len * elt_size;
5396 dw2_asm_output_data (1, l, NULL);
5397 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
5399 elt_size /= 2;
5400 len *= 2;
5402 for (i = 0, p = val2->v.val_vec.array;
5403 i < len;
5404 i++, p += elt_size)
5405 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
5406 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
5408 break;
5409 case dw_val_class_const_double:
5411 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
5412 l = HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
5414 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 2 * l, NULL);
5415 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
5417 first = val2->v.val_double.high;
5418 second = val2->v.val_double.low;
5420 else
5422 first = val2->v.val_double.low;
5423 second = val2->v.val_double.high;
5425 dw2_asm_output_data (l, first, NULL);
5426 dw2_asm_output_data (l, second, NULL);
5428 break;
5429 default:
5430 gcc_unreachable ();
5433 break;
5434 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
5436 unsigned r = val1->v.val_unsigned;
5437 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
5438 gcc_assert (o);
5439 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0)
5441 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
5442 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
5443 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
5445 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
5446 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
5448 break;
5449 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
5451 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val2->v.val_die_ref.die);
5452 gcc_assert (o);
5453 dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
5454 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
5456 break;
5457 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
5458 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
5460 unsigned long o = get_base_type_offset (val1->v.val_die_ref.die);
5461 gcc_assert (o);
5462 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (o, NULL);
5464 break;
5466 default:
5467 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5468 break;
5472 /* Output a sequence of location operations.
5473 The for_eh_or_skip parameter controls whether register numbers are
5474 converted using DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT, which is needed in the case that
5475 hard reg numbers have been processed via DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i.e. for unwind
5476 info). This should be suppressed for the cases that have not been converted
5477 (i.e. symbolic debug info), by setting the parameter < 0. See PR47324. */
5479 static void
5480 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, int for_eh_or_skip)
5482 for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5484 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
5485 /* Output the opcode. */
5486 if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
5487 && opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
5489 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
5490 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
5491 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
5492 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
5494 else if (for_eh_or_skip >= 0
5495 && opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
5497 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
5498 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, for_eh_or_skip);
5499 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
5500 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
5503 dw2_asm_output_data (1, opc,
5504 "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (opc));
5506 /* Output the operand(s) (if any). */
5507 output_loc_operands (loc, for_eh_or_skip);
5511 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).
5512 The output is single bytes on a line, suitable for .cfi_escape. */
5514 static void
5515 output_loc_operands_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5517 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
5518 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
5520 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
5522 case DW_OP_addr:
5523 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
5524 /* We cannot output addresses in .cfi_escape, only bytes. */
5525 gcc_unreachable ();
5527 case DW_OP_const1u:
5528 case DW_OP_const1s:
5529 case DW_OP_pick:
5530 case DW_OP_deref_size:
5531 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
5532 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5533 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (1, val1->v.val_int);
5534 break;
5536 case DW_OP_const2u:
5537 case DW_OP_const2s:
5538 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5539 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, val1->v.val_int);
5540 break;
5542 case DW_OP_const4u:
5543 case DW_OP_const4s:
5544 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5545 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (4, val1->v.val_int);
5546 break;
5548 case DW_OP_const8u:
5549 case DW_OP_const8s:
5550 gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64);
5551 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5552 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (8, val1->v.val_int);
5553 break;
5555 case DW_OP_skip:
5556 case DW_OP_bra:
5558 int offset;
5560 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
5561 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
5563 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5564 dw2_asm_output_data_raw (2, offset);
5566 break;
5568 case DW_OP_regx:
5570 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
5571 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
5572 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
5573 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5574 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
5576 break;
5578 case DW_OP_constu:
5579 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5580 case DW_OP_piece:
5581 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5582 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5583 break;
5585 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
5586 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5587 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val1->v.val_unsigned);
5588 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (val2->v.val_unsigned);
5589 break;
5591 case DW_OP_consts:
5592 case DW_OP_breg0:
5593 case DW_OP_breg1:
5594 case DW_OP_breg2:
5595 case DW_OP_breg3:
5596 case DW_OP_breg4:
5597 case DW_OP_breg5:
5598 case DW_OP_breg6:
5599 case DW_OP_breg7:
5600 case DW_OP_breg8:
5601 case DW_OP_breg9:
5602 case DW_OP_breg10:
5603 case DW_OP_breg11:
5604 case DW_OP_breg12:
5605 case DW_OP_breg13:
5606 case DW_OP_breg14:
5607 case DW_OP_breg15:
5608 case DW_OP_breg16:
5609 case DW_OP_breg17:
5610 case DW_OP_breg18:
5611 case DW_OP_breg19:
5612 case DW_OP_breg20:
5613 case DW_OP_breg21:
5614 case DW_OP_breg22:
5615 case DW_OP_breg23:
5616 case DW_OP_breg24:
5617 case DW_OP_breg25:
5618 case DW_OP_breg26:
5619 case DW_OP_breg27:
5620 case DW_OP_breg28:
5621 case DW_OP_breg29:
5622 case DW_OP_breg30:
5623 case DW_OP_breg31:
5624 case DW_OP_fbreg:
5625 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5626 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val1->v.val_int);
5627 break;
5629 case DW_OP_bregx:
5631 unsigned r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (val1->v.val_unsigned, 1);
5632 gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (r)
5633 == size_of_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned));
5634 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5635 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (r);
5636 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5637 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128_raw (val2->v.val_int);
5639 break;
5641 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
5642 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
5643 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
5644 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
5645 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
5646 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
5647 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
5648 gcc_unreachable ();
5649 break;
5651 default:
5652 /* Other codes have no operands. */
5653 break;
5657 static void
5658 output_loc_sequence_raw (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5660 while (1)
5662 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = loc->dw_loc_opc;
5663 /* Output the opcode. */
5664 if (opc >= DW_OP_breg0 && opc <= DW_OP_breg31)
5666 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_breg0);
5667 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
5668 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
5669 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + r);
5671 else if (opc >= DW_OP_reg0 && opc <= DW_OP_reg31)
5673 unsigned r = (opc - DW_OP_reg0);
5674 r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (r, 1);
5675 gcc_assert (r <= 31);
5676 opc = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + r);
5678 /* Output the opcode. */
5679 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x", opc);
5680 output_loc_operands_raw (loc);
5682 if (!loc->dw_loc_next)
5683 break;
5684 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
5686 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5690 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
5691 description based on a cfi entry with a complex address. */
5693 static void
5694 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi, int for_eh)
5696 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5697 unsigned long size;
5699 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5701 unsigned r =
5702 DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
5703 dw2_asm_output_data (1, r, NULL);
5704 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc;
5706 else
5707 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5709 /* Output the size of the block. */
5710 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5711 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
5713 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5714 output_loc_sequence (loc, for_eh);
5717 /* Similar, but used for .cfi_escape. */
5719 static void
5720 output_cfa_loc_raw (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
5722 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5723 unsigned long size;
5725 if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_expression)
5727 unsigned r =
5728 DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, 1);
5729 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%#x,", r);
5730 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_loc;
5732 else
5733 loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
5735 /* Output the size of the block. */
5736 size = size_of_locs (loc);
5737 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128_raw (size);
5738 fputc (',', asm_out_file);
5740 /* Now output the operations themselves. */
5741 output_loc_sequence_raw (loc);
5744 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
5745 dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
5746 expression. */
5748 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5749 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5751 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
5753 offset += cfa->offset;
5755 if (cfa->indirect)
5757 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
5758 head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
5759 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
5760 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5761 if (offset != 0)
5763 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
5764 add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
5767 else
5768 head = new_reg_loc_descr (cfa->reg, offset);
5770 return head;
5773 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence for
5774 the address at OFFSET from the CFA when stack is aligned to
5775 ALIGNMENT byte. */
5777 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
5778 build_cfa_aligned_loc (HOST_WIDE_INT offset, HOST_WIDE_INT alignment)
5780 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head;
5781 unsigned int dwarf_fp
5782 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
5784 /* When CFA is defined as FP+OFFSET, emulate stack alignment. */
5785 if (cfa.reg == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM && cfa.indirect == 0)
5787 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, 0);
5788 add_loc_descr (&head, int_loc_descriptor (alignment));
5789 add_loc_descr (&head, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
5790 loc_descr_plus_const (&head, offset);
5792 else
5793 head = new_reg_loc_descr (dwarf_fp, offset);
5794 return head;
5797 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
5798 descriptor sequence. */
5800 static void
5801 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
5803 struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
5804 cfa->offset = 0;
5805 cfa->base_offset = 0;
5806 cfa->indirect = 0;
5807 cfa->reg = -1;
5809 for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
5811 enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
5813 switch (op)
5815 case DW_OP_reg0:
5816 case DW_OP_reg1:
5817 case DW_OP_reg2:
5818 case DW_OP_reg3:
5819 case DW_OP_reg4:
5820 case DW_OP_reg5:
5821 case DW_OP_reg6:
5822 case DW_OP_reg7:
5823 case DW_OP_reg8:
5824 case DW_OP_reg9:
5825 case DW_OP_reg10:
5826 case DW_OP_reg11:
5827 case DW_OP_reg12:
5828 case DW_OP_reg13:
5829 case DW_OP_reg14:
5830 case DW_OP_reg15:
5831 case DW_OP_reg16:
5832 case DW_OP_reg17:
5833 case DW_OP_reg18:
5834 case DW_OP_reg19:
5835 case DW_OP_reg20:
5836 case DW_OP_reg21:
5837 case DW_OP_reg22:
5838 case DW_OP_reg23:
5839 case DW_OP_reg24:
5840 case DW_OP_reg25:
5841 case DW_OP_reg26:
5842 case DW_OP_reg27:
5843 case DW_OP_reg28:
5844 case DW_OP_reg29:
5845 case DW_OP_reg30:
5846 case DW_OP_reg31:
5847 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
5848 break;
5849 case DW_OP_regx:
5850 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5851 break;
5852 case DW_OP_breg0:
5853 case DW_OP_breg1:
5854 case DW_OP_breg2:
5855 case DW_OP_breg3:
5856 case DW_OP_breg4:
5857 case DW_OP_breg5:
5858 case DW_OP_breg6:
5859 case DW_OP_breg7:
5860 case DW_OP_breg8:
5861 case DW_OP_breg9:
5862 case DW_OP_breg10:
5863 case DW_OP_breg11:
5864 case DW_OP_breg12:
5865 case DW_OP_breg13:
5866 case DW_OP_breg14:
5867 case DW_OP_breg15:
5868 case DW_OP_breg16:
5869 case DW_OP_breg17:
5870 case DW_OP_breg18:
5871 case DW_OP_breg19:
5872 case DW_OP_breg20:
5873 case DW_OP_breg21:
5874 case DW_OP_breg22:
5875 case DW_OP_breg23:
5876 case DW_OP_breg24:
5877 case DW_OP_breg25:
5878 case DW_OP_breg26:
5879 case DW_OP_breg27:
5880 case DW_OP_breg28:
5881 case DW_OP_breg29:
5882 case DW_OP_breg30:
5883 case DW_OP_breg31:
5884 cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
5885 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5886 break;
5887 case DW_OP_bregx:
5888 cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
5889 cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
5890 break;
5891 case DW_OP_deref:
5892 cfa->indirect = 1;
5893 break;
5894 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
5895 cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
5896 break;
5897 default:
5898 internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
5899 dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
5904 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information. */
5906 /* .debug_str support. */
5907 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
5909 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
5910 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
5911 static void dwarf2out_assembly_start (void);
5912 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
5913 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
5914 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
5915 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
5916 static void dwarf2out_function_decl (tree);
5917 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5918 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
5919 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree);
5920 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
5921 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
5922 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree, tree, bool);
5923 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree, tree, tree,
5924 dw_die_ref);
5925 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
5926 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
5927 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
5928 static void dwarf2out_set_name (tree, tree);
5930 /* The debug hooks structure. */
5932 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
5934 dwarf2out_init,
5935 dwarf2out_finish,
5936 dwarf2out_assembly_start,
5937 dwarf2out_define,
5938 dwarf2out_undef,
5939 dwarf2out_start_source_file,
5940 dwarf2out_end_source_file,
5941 dwarf2out_begin_block,
5942 dwarf2out_end_block,
5943 dwarf2out_ignore_block,
5944 dwarf2out_source_line,
5945 dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
5946 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5947 dwarf2out_vms_end_prologue,
5948 dwarf2out_vms_begin_epilogue,
5949 #else
5950 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
5951 debug_nothing_int_charstar,
5952 #endif
5953 dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
5954 dwarf2out_begin_function,
5955 debug_nothing_int, /* end_function */
5956 dwarf2out_function_decl, /* function_decl */
5957 dwarf2out_global_decl,
5958 dwarf2out_type_decl, /* type_decl */
5959 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
5960 debug_nothing_tree, /* deferred_inline_function */
5961 /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
5962 emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
5963 something tries to reference them. */
5964 dwarf2out_abstract_function, /* outlining_inline_function */
5965 debug_nothing_rtx, /* label */
5966 debug_nothing_int, /* handle_pch */
5967 dwarf2out_var_location,
5968 dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
5969 dwarf2out_set_name,
5970 1, /* start_end_main_source_file */
5971 TYPE_SYMTAB_IS_DIE /* tree_type_symtab_field */
5974 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
5975 "Debugging Information Entries". This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
5976 throughout the remainder of this file. */
5978 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
5979 walked to generate the DWARF debugging info. The walk of the internal
5980 representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
5981 The types below are used to describe the internal representation. */
5983 /* Whether to put type DIEs into their own section .debug_types instead
5984 of making them part of the .debug_info section. Only supported for
5985 Dwarf V4 or higher and the user didn't disable them through
5986 -fno-debug-types-section. It is more efficient to put them in a
5987 separate comdat sections since the linker will then be able to
5988 remove duplicates. But not all tools support .debug_types sections
5989 yet. */
5991 #define use_debug_types (dwarf_version >= 4 && flag_debug_types_section)
5993 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
5994 .debug_info section to refer to each other. */
5996 typedef long int dw_offset;
5998 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies. */
6000 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
6001 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
6002 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
6003 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
6004 typedef struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct *dw_ranges_by_label_ref;
6005 typedef struct comdat_type_struct *comdat_type_node_ref;
6007 /* The entries in the line_info table more-or-less mirror the opcodes
6008 that are used in the real dwarf line table. Arrays of these entries
6009 are collected per section when DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO is not
6010 supported. */
6012 enum dw_line_info_opcode {
6013 /* Emit DW_LNE_set_address; the operand is the label index. */
6014 LI_set_address,
6016 /* Emit a row to the matrix with the given line. This may be done
6017 via any combination of DW_LNS_copy, DW_LNS_advance_line, and
6018 special opcodes. */
6019 LI_set_line,
6021 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_file. */
6022 LI_set_file,
6024 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_column. */
6025 LI_set_column,
6027 /* Emit a DW_LNS_negate_stmt; the operand is ignored. */
6028 LI_negate_stmt,
6030 /* Emit a DW_LNS_set_prologue_end/epilogue_begin; the operand is ignored. */
6031 LI_set_prologue_end,
6032 LI_set_epilogue_begin,
6034 /* Emit a DW_LNE_set_discriminator. */
6035 LI_set_discriminator
6038 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_struct {
6039 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode;
6040 unsigned int val;
6041 } dw_line_info_entry;
6043 DEF_VEC_O(dw_line_info_entry);
6044 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_line_info_entry, gc);
6046 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_line_info_table_struct {
6047 /* The label that marks the end of this section. */
6048 const char *end_label;
6050 /* The values for the last row of the matrix, as collected in the table.
6051 These are used to minimize the changes to the next row. */
6052 unsigned int file_num;
6053 unsigned int line_num;
6054 unsigned int column_num;
6055 int discrim_num;
6056 bool is_stmt;
6057 bool in_use;
6059 VEC(dw_line_info_entry, gc) *entries;
6060 } dw_line_info_table;
6062 typedef dw_line_info_table *dw_line_info_table_p;
6064 DEF_VEC_P(dw_line_info_table_p);
6065 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_P(dw_line_info_table_p, gc);
6067 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
6068 a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
6069 Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify. */
6071 typedef struct GTY(()) dw_attr_struct {
6072 enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
6073 dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
6075 dw_attr_node;
6077 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
6078 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
6080 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure. DIEs form a tree.
6081 The children of each node form a circular list linked by
6082 die_sib. die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node. */
6084 typedef struct GTY((chain_circular ("%h.die_sib"))) die_struct {
6085 union die_symbol_or_type_node
6087 char * GTY ((tag ("0"))) die_symbol;
6088 comdat_type_node_ref GTY ((tag ("1"))) die_type_node;
6090 GTY ((desc ("use_debug_types"))) die_id;
6091 VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
6092 dw_die_ref die_parent;
6093 dw_die_ref die_child;
6094 dw_die_ref die_sib;
6095 dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
6096 dw_offset die_offset;
6097 unsigned long die_abbrev;
6098 int die_mark;
6099 /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused. */
6100 int die_perennial_p;
6101 unsigned int decl_id;
6102 enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
6104 die_node;
6106 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order. */
6107 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do { \
6108 c = die->die_child; \
6109 if (c) do { \
6110 c = c->die_sib; \
6111 expr; \
6112 } while (c != die->die_child); \
6113 } while (0)
6115 /* The pubname structure */
6117 typedef struct GTY(()) pubname_struct {
6118 dw_die_ref die;
6119 const char *name;
6121 pubname_entry;
6123 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
6124 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
6126 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_struct {
6127 /* If this is positive, it's a block number, otherwise it's a
6128 bitwise-negated index into dw_ranges_by_label. */
6129 int num;
6132 /* A structure to hold a macinfo entry. */
6134 typedef struct GTY(()) macinfo_struct {
6135 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT code;
6136 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT lineno;
6137 const char *info;
6139 macinfo_entry;
6141 DEF_VEC_O(macinfo_entry);
6142 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(macinfo_entry, gc);
6144 struct GTY(()) dw_ranges_by_label_struct {
6145 const char *begin;
6146 const char *end;
6149 /* The comdat type node structure. */
6150 typedef struct GTY(()) comdat_type_struct
6152 dw_die_ref root_die;
6153 dw_die_ref type_die;
6154 char signature[DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE];
6155 struct comdat_type_struct *next;
6157 comdat_type_node;
6159 /* The limbo die list structure. */
6160 typedef struct GTY(()) limbo_die_struct {
6161 dw_die_ref die;
6162 tree created_for;
6163 struct limbo_die_struct *next;
6165 limbo_die_node;
6167 typedef struct skeleton_chain_struct
6169 dw_die_ref old_die;
6170 dw_die_ref new_die;
6171 struct skeleton_chain_struct *parent;
6173 skeleton_chain_node;
6175 /* How to start an assembler comment. */
6176 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
6177 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
6178 #endif
6180 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
6181 implicitly generated for a tagged type.
6183 Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
6184 TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
6185 each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
6186 _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
6187 These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
6188 generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them. */
6190 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl) \
6191 (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE \
6192 || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl) \
6193 && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)) \
6194 && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))) \
6195 /* This is necessary for stub decls that \
6196 appear in nested inline functions. */ \
6197 || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE \
6198 && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl) \
6199 == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
6201 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
6202 language, and compiler version. */
6204 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header. */
6205 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
6206 (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
6208 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF comdat type unit header. */
6209 #define DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
6210 (DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE \
6211 + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6213 /* Fixed size portion of public names info. */
6214 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
6216 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info. */
6217 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE \
6218 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
6219 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
6220 - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
6222 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info. It must be
6223 aligned to twice the pointer size. */
6224 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
6225 (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
6226 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
6227 - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
6229 /* Use assembler line directives if available. */
6230 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
6231 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
6232 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
6233 #else
6234 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
6235 #endif
6236 #endif
6238 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
6239 This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values. */
6240 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE -10
6242 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes. */
6243 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE ((int)DW_LNS_set_isa + 1)
6245 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode. */
6246 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
6248 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
6249 In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
6250 the beginning of a source statement, because that information
6251 is not made available by the GCC front-end. */
6252 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
6254 /* Maximum number of operations per instruction bundle. */
6255 #ifndef DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN
6256 #define DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN 1
6257 #endif
6259 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
6260 the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section. */
6261 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
6263 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
6264 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref single_comp_unit_die;
6266 /* A list of type DIEs that have been separated into comdat sections. */
6267 static GTY(()) comdat_type_node *comdat_type_list;
6269 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated. */
6270 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
6272 /* A list of DIEs for which we may have to generate
6273 DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name once their DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAMEs are set. */
6274 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *deferred_asm_name;
6276 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit. */
6277 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
6279 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
6280 The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl. */
6281 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
6283 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe COMMON blocks.
6284 The key is DECL_UID() ^ die_parent. */
6285 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t common_block_die_table;
6287 typedef struct GTY(()) die_arg_entry_struct {
6288 dw_die_ref die;
6289 tree arg;
6290 } die_arg_entry;
6292 DEF_VEC_O(die_arg_entry);
6293 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(die_arg_entry,gc);
6295 /* Node of the variable location list. */
6296 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) var_loc_node {
6297 /* Either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION, or, for SRA optimized variables,
6298 EXPR_LIST chain. For small bitsizes, bitsize is encoded
6299 in mode of the EXPR_LIST node and first EXPR_LIST operand
6300 is either NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION for a piece with a known
6301 location or NULL for padding. For larger bitsizes,
6302 mode is 0 and first operand is a CONCAT with bitsize
6303 as first CONCAT operand and NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION resp.
6304 NULL as second operand. */
6305 rtx GTY (()) loc;
6306 const char * GTY (()) label;
6307 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
6310 /* Variable location list. */
6311 struct GTY (()) var_loc_list_def {
6312 struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
6314 /* Pointer to the last but one or last element of the
6315 chained list. If the list is empty, both first and
6316 last are NULL, if the list contains just one node
6317 or the last node certainly is not redundant, it points
6318 to the last node, otherwise points to the last but one.
6319 Do not mark it for GC because it is marked through the chain. */
6320 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
6322 /* Pointer to the last element before section switch,
6323 if NULL, either sections weren't switched or first
6324 is after section switch. */
6325 struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last_before_switch;
6327 /* DECL_UID of the variable decl. */
6328 unsigned int decl_id;
6330 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
6332 /* Call argument location list. */
6333 struct GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next"))) call_arg_loc_node {
6334 rtx GTY (()) call_arg_loc_note;
6335 const char * GTY (()) label;
6336 tree GTY (()) block;
6337 bool tail_call_p;
6338 rtx GTY (()) symbol_ref;
6339 struct call_arg_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
6343 /* Table of decl location linked lists. */
6344 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
6346 /* Head and tail of call_arg_loc chain. */
6347 static GTY (()) struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_locations;
6348 static struct call_arg_loc_node *call_arg_loc_last;
6350 /* Number of call sites in the current function. */
6351 static int call_site_count = -1;
6352 /* Number of tail call sites in the current function. */
6353 static int tail_call_site_count = -1;
6355 /* Vector mapping block numbers to DW_TAG_{lexical_block,inlined_subroutine}
6356 DIEs. */
6357 static VEC (dw_die_ref, heap) *block_map;
6359 /* A cached location list. */
6360 struct GTY (()) cached_dw_loc_list_def {
6361 /* The DECL_UID of the decl that this entry describes. */
6362 unsigned int decl_id;
6364 /* The cached location list. */
6365 dw_loc_list_ref loc_list;
6367 typedef struct cached_dw_loc_list_def cached_dw_loc_list;
6369 /* Table of cached location lists. */
6370 static GTY ((param_is (cached_dw_loc_list))) htab_t cached_dw_loc_list_table;
6372 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
6373 are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
6374 children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs. */
6375 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
6376 dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
6378 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table. */
6379 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
6381 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use. */
6382 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6384 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
6385 abbrev_die_table. */
6386 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
6388 /* A global counter for generating labels for line number data. */
6389 static unsigned int line_info_label_num;
6391 /* The current table to which we should emit line number information
6392 for the current function. This will be set up at the beginning of
6393 assembly for the function. */
6394 static dw_line_info_table *cur_line_info_table;
6396 /* The two default tables of line number info. */
6397 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *text_section_line_info;
6398 static GTY(()) dw_line_info_table *cold_text_section_line_info;
6400 /* The set of all non-default tables of line number info. */
6401 static GTY(()) VEC (dw_line_info_table_p, gc) *separate_line_info;
6403 /* A flag to tell pubnames/types export if there is an info section to
6404 refer to. */
6405 static bool info_section_emitted;
6407 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
6408 accessible names. */
6409 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubname_table;
6411 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
6412 accessible types. */
6413 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
6415 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of macro
6416 defines/undefines (and file start/end markers). */
6417 static GTY (()) VEC (macinfo_entry, gc) * macinfo_table;
6419 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info. */
6420 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
6422 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table. */
6423 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
6425 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use. */
6426 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
6428 /* Array of pairs of labels referenced in ranges_table. */
6429 static GTY ((length ("ranges_by_label_allocated")))
6430 dw_ranges_by_label_ref ranges_by_label;
6432 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_by_label. */
6433 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_allocated;
6435 /* Number of elements in ranges_by_label currently in use. */
6436 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_by_label_in_use;
6438 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
6439 ranges_table. */
6440 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
6442 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
6443 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
6445 /* Unique label counter. */
6446 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
6448 /* Unique label counter for point-of-call tables. */
6449 static GTY(()) unsigned int poc_label_num;
6451 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions. */
6452 static int current_function_has_inlines;
6454 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file(). */
6455 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
6457 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym(). */
6458 static GTY(()) int label_num;
6460 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename. */
6461 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
6463 static GTY(()) VEC(die_arg_entry,gc) *tmpl_value_parm_die_table;
6465 /* Instances of generic types for which we need to generate debug
6466 info that describe their generic parameters and arguments. That
6467 generation needs to happen once all types are properly laid out so
6468 we do it at the end of compilation. */
6469 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *generic_type_instances;
6471 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
6472 within the current function. */
6473 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
6475 static VEC (dw_die_ref, heap) *base_types;
6477 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file. */
6479 static int is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx);
6480 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
6481 static int is_tagged_type (const_tree);
6482 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
6483 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
6484 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
6485 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree);
6486 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
6487 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
6488 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
6489 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
6490 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
6491 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
6492 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
6493 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6494 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
6495 static void add_AT_double (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6496 HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6497 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
6498 unsigned int, unsigned char *);
6499 static void add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned char *);
6500 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
6501 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
6502 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6503 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
6504 static enum dwarf_form AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
6505 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
6506 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6507 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
6508 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
6509 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
6510 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
6511 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
6512 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
6513 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6514 dw_loc_list_ref);
6515 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
6516 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
6517 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
6518 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6519 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6520 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
6521 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6522 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6523 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6524 unsigned long);
6525 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
6526 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6527 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
6528 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
6529 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6530 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6531 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6532 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6533 static bool is_cxx (void);
6534 static bool is_fortran (void);
6535 static bool is_ada (void);
6536 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
6537 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
6538 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6539 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
6540 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
6541 static dw_die_ref strip_naming_typedef (tree, dw_die_ref);
6542 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree);
6543 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6544 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
6545 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6546 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
6547 static hashval_t common_block_die_table_hash (const void *);
6548 static int common_block_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6549 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
6550 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
6551 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (const_tree);
6552 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6553 static struct var_loc_node *add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, rtx, const char *);
6554 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
6555 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
6556 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6557 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
6558 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6559 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6560 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6561 static void checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
6562 static void checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, struct md5_ctx *);
6563 static void loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6564 static void attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag, dw_attr_ref,
6565 struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6566 struct checksum_attributes;
6567 static void collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *, dw_die_ref);
6568 static void die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
6569 static void checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
6570 static void generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref, comdat_type_node *);
6571 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
6572 static int same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *, const dw_val_node *, int *);
6573 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
6574 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
6575 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6576 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
6577 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
6578 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
6579 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
6580 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
6581 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
6582 static int is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref);
6583 static int should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref);
6584 static dw_die_ref clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref);
6585 static dw_die_ref clone_die (dw_die_ref);
6586 static dw_die_ref clone_tree (dw_die_ref);
6587 static void copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6588 static void generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *);
6589 static void generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *);
6590 static dw_die_ref generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref);
6591 static dw_die_ref remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref,
6592 dw_die_ref);
6593 static void break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref);
6594 static dw_die_ref copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6595 static void copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, htab_t);
6596 static void copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref);
6598 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
6599 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
6600 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
6601 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
6602 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
6603 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
6604 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
6605 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
6606 static int constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
6607 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
6608 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
6609 static void calc_base_type_die_sizes (void);
6610 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6611 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6612 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
6613 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6614 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
6615 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6616 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
6617 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
6618 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
6619 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
6620 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
6621 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
6622 static void output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *);
6623 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
6624 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
6625 static void add_pubname_string (const char *, dw_die_ref);
6626 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
6627 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
6628 static void output_aranges (unsigned long);
6629 static unsigned int add_ranges_num (int);
6630 static unsigned int add_ranges (const_tree);
6631 static void add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref, const char *, const char *,
6632 bool *);
6633 static void output_ranges (void);
6634 static dw_line_info_table *new_line_info_table (void);
6635 static void output_line_info (void);
6636 static void output_file_names (void);
6637 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
6638 static int is_base_type (tree);
6639 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6640 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6641 static dw_die_ref generic_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6642 static dw_die_ref template_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6643 static int type_is_enum (const_tree);
6644 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (const_rtx);
6645 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
6646 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum var_init_status);
6647 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int,
6648 enum var_init_status);
6649 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6650 enum var_init_status);
6651 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT,
6652 enum var_init_status);
6653 static int is_based_loc (const_rtx);
6654 static int resolve_one_addr (rtx *, void *);
6655 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx,
6656 enum var_init_status);
6657 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode,
6658 enum var_init_status);
6659 static dw_loc_list_ref loc_list_from_tree (tree, int);
6660 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree, int);
6661 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
6662 static tree field_type (const_tree);
6663 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6664 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree);
6665 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree);
6666 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (const_tree);
6667 static void add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6668 dw_loc_list_ref);
6669 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6670 static bool add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
6671 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
6672 static void insert_double (double_int, unsigned char *);
6673 static void insert_float (const_rtx, unsigned char *);
6674 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
6675 static bool add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, bool,
6676 enum dwarf_attribute);
6677 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6678 static bool tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref, tree);
6679 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
6680 static void add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, dw_die_ref);
6681 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
6682 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
6683 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree, bool);
6684 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6685 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6686 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6687 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6688 static dw_die_ref add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6689 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6690 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6691 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
6692 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
6693 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
6694 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
6695 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6696 static inline int class_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6697 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
6698 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
6699 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
6700 static const char *type_tag (const_tree);
6701 static tree member_declared_type (const_tree);
6702 #if 0
6703 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
6704 #endif
6705 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6706 static void gen_descr_array_type_die (tree, struct array_descr_info *, dw_die_ref);
6707 #if 0
6708 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6709 #endif
6710 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6711 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, tree, bool, dw_die_ref);
6712 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref, tree*);
6713 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6714 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6715 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6716 static void gen_variable_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6717 static void gen_const_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6718 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6719 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6720 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6721 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6722 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6723 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
6724 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6725 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6726 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
6727 enum debug_info_usage);
6728 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6729 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6730 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6731 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6732 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
6733 static inline int is_redundant_typedef (const_tree);
6734 static bool is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree);
6735 static inline dw_die_ref get_context_die (tree);
6736 static void gen_namespace_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
6737 static dw_die_ref gen_decl_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6738 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
6739 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
6740 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
6741 static dw_die_ref declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
6742 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
6743 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
6744 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
6745 static void gen_generic_params_dies (tree);
6746 static void gen_tagged_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
6747 static void gen_type_die_with_usage (tree, dw_die_ref, enum debug_info_usage);
6748 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
6749 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
6750 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
6751 const char *, const char *);
6752 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
6753 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
6755 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
6756 static void prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref);
6757 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
6758 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
6759 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
6760 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
6761 static void prune_unused_types (void);
6762 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
6763 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref);
6764 static inline const char *AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref);
6765 static inline void add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
6766 const char *, const char *);
6767 static void append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref, tree);
6768 static void gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void);
6769 static bool generic_type_p (tree);
6770 static void schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t);
6771 static void gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void);
6773 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information. */
6774 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
6775 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION ".debug_info"
6776 #endif
6777 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
6778 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION ".debug_abbrev"
6779 #endif
6780 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
6781 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION ".debug_aranges"
6782 #endif
6783 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
6784 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION ".debug_macinfo"
6785 #endif
6786 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
6787 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION ".debug_line"
6788 #endif
6789 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
6790 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION ".debug_loc"
6791 #endif
6792 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
6793 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION ".debug_pubnames"
6794 #endif
6795 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
6796 #define DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION ".debug_pubtypes"
6797 #endif
6798 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
6799 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION ".debug_str"
6800 #endif
6801 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
6802 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION ".debug_ranges"
6803 #endif
6805 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data. */
6806 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
6807 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME ".text"
6808 #endif
6810 /* Section flags for .debug_str section. */
6811 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
6812 (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_debug_strings \
6813 ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1 \
6814 : SECTION_DEBUG)
6816 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
6817 the section names themselves. */
6819 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6820 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext"
6821 #endif
6822 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
6823 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL "Ltext_cold"
6824 #endif
6825 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
6826 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_line"
6827 #endif
6828 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
6829 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_info"
6830 #endif
6831 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
6832 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_abbrev"
6833 #endif
6834 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
6835 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_loc"
6836 #endif
6837 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
6838 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_ranges"
6839 #endif
6840 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
6841 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL "Ldebug_macinfo"
6842 #endif
6845 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
6846 (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
6847 options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
6848 If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
6849 typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary. */
6851 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6852 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6853 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6854 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6855 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6856 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6857 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6858 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6859 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6860 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
6862 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
6863 #define TEXT_END_LABEL "Letext"
6864 #endif
6865 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
6866 #define COLD_END_LABEL "Letext_cold"
6867 #endif
6868 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
6869 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL "LBB"
6870 #endif
6871 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
6872 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL "LBE"
6873 #endif
6874 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
6875 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL "LM"
6876 #endif
6879 /* Return the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit. */
6880 static dw_die_ref
6881 comp_unit_die (void)
6883 if (!single_comp_unit_die)
6884 single_comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
6885 return single_comp_unit_die;
6888 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
6889 called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE. */
6891 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
6893 void
6894 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
6896 demangle_name_func = func;
6899 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register. */
6901 static inline int
6902 is_pseudo_reg (const_rtx rtl)
6904 return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
6905 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
6906 && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
6909 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
6910 removed. */
6912 static inline tree
6913 type_main_variant (tree type)
6915 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6917 /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
6918 variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
6919 members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
6920 front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
6921 here. */
6922 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
6923 while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
6924 type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
6926 return type;
6929 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type. */
6931 static inline int
6932 is_tagged_type (const_tree type)
6934 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
6936 return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
6937 || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
6940 /* Set label to debug_info_section_label + die_offset of a DIE reference. */
6942 static void
6943 get_ref_die_offset_label (char *label, dw_die_ref ref)
6945 sprintf (label, "%s+%ld", debug_info_section_label, ref->die_offset);
6948 /* Return die_offset of a DIE reference to a base type. */
6950 static unsigned long int
6951 get_base_type_offset (dw_die_ref ref)
6953 if (ref->die_offset)
6954 return ref->die_offset;
6955 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_abbrev)
6957 calc_base_type_die_sizes ();
6958 gcc_assert (ref->die_offset);
6960 return ref->die_offset;
6963 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name. */
6965 static const char *
6966 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
6968 switch (tag)
6970 case DW_TAG_padding:
6971 return "DW_TAG_padding";
6972 case DW_TAG_array_type:
6973 return "DW_TAG_array_type";
6974 case DW_TAG_class_type:
6975 return "DW_TAG_class_type";
6976 case DW_TAG_entry_point:
6977 return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
6978 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6979 return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
6980 case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
6981 return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
6982 case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
6983 return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
6984 case DW_TAG_label:
6985 return "DW_TAG_label";
6986 case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
6987 return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
6988 case DW_TAG_member:
6989 return "DW_TAG_member";
6990 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6991 return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
6992 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6993 return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
6994 case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
6995 return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
6996 case DW_TAG_string_type:
6997 return "DW_TAG_string_type";
6998 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6999 return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
7000 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
7001 return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
7002 case DW_TAG_typedef:
7003 return "DW_TAG_typedef";
7004 case DW_TAG_union_type:
7005 return "DW_TAG_union_type";
7006 case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
7007 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
7008 case DW_TAG_variant:
7009 return "DW_TAG_variant";
7010 case DW_TAG_common_block:
7011 return "DW_TAG_common_block";
7012 case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
7013 return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
7014 case DW_TAG_inheritance:
7015 return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
7016 case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
7017 return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
7018 case DW_TAG_module:
7019 return "DW_TAG_module";
7020 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
7021 return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
7022 case DW_TAG_set_type:
7023 return "DW_TAG_set_type";
7024 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
7025 return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
7026 case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
7027 return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
7028 case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
7029 return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
7030 case DW_TAG_base_type:
7031 return "DW_TAG_base_type";
7032 case DW_TAG_catch_block:
7033 return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
7034 case DW_TAG_const_type:
7035 return "DW_TAG_const_type";
7036 case DW_TAG_constant:
7037 return "DW_TAG_constant";
7038 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
7039 return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
7040 case DW_TAG_file_type:
7041 return "DW_TAG_file_type";
7042 case DW_TAG_friend:
7043 return "DW_TAG_friend";
7044 case DW_TAG_namelist:
7045 return "DW_TAG_namelist";
7046 case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
7047 return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
7048 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
7049 return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
7050 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
7051 return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
7052 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
7053 return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
7054 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
7055 return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
7056 case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
7057 return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
7058 case DW_TAG_try_block:
7059 return "DW_TAG_try_block";
7060 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
7061 return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
7062 case DW_TAG_variable:
7063 return "DW_TAG_variable";
7064 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
7065 return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
7066 case DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure:
7067 return "DW_TAG_dwarf_procedure";
7068 case DW_TAG_restrict_type:
7069 return "DW_TAG_restrict_type";
7070 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
7071 return "DW_TAG_interface_type";
7072 case DW_TAG_namespace:
7073 return "DW_TAG_namespace";
7074 case DW_TAG_imported_module:
7075 return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
7076 case DW_TAG_unspecified_type:
7077 return "DW_TAG_unspecified_type";
7078 case DW_TAG_partial_unit:
7079 return "DW_TAG_partial_unit";
7080 case DW_TAG_imported_unit:
7081 return "DW_TAG_imported_unit";
7082 case DW_TAG_condition:
7083 return "DW_TAG_condition";
7084 case DW_TAG_shared_type:
7085 return "DW_TAG_shared_type";
7086 case DW_TAG_type_unit:
7087 return "DW_TAG_type_unit";
7088 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
7089 return "DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type";
7090 case DW_TAG_template_alias:
7091 return "DW_TAG_template_alias";
7092 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
7093 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack";
7094 case DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack:
7095 return "DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack";
7096 case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
7097 return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
7098 case DW_TAG_format_label:
7099 return "DW_TAG_format_label";
7100 case DW_TAG_function_template:
7101 return "DW_TAG_function_template";
7102 case DW_TAG_class_template:
7103 return "DW_TAG_class_template";
7104 case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
7105 return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
7106 case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
7107 return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
7108 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
7109 return "DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param";
7110 case DW_TAG_GNU_call_site:
7111 return "DW_TAG_GNU_call_site";
7112 case DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter:
7113 return "DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter";
7114 default:
7115 return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
7119 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name. */
7121 static const char *
7122 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
7124 switch (attr)
7126 case DW_AT_sibling:
7127 return "DW_AT_sibling";
7128 case DW_AT_location:
7129 return "DW_AT_location";
7130 case DW_AT_name:
7131 return "DW_AT_name";
7132 case DW_AT_ordering:
7133 return "DW_AT_ordering";
7134 case DW_AT_subscr_data:
7135 return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
7136 case DW_AT_byte_size:
7137 return "DW_AT_byte_size";
7138 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
7139 return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
7140 case DW_AT_bit_size:
7141 return "DW_AT_bit_size";
7142 case DW_AT_element_list:
7143 return "DW_AT_element_list";
7144 case DW_AT_stmt_list:
7145 return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
7146 case DW_AT_low_pc:
7147 return "DW_AT_low_pc";
7148 case DW_AT_high_pc:
7149 return "DW_AT_high_pc";
7150 case DW_AT_language:
7151 return "DW_AT_language";
7152 case DW_AT_member:
7153 return "DW_AT_member";
7154 case DW_AT_discr:
7155 return "DW_AT_discr";
7156 case DW_AT_discr_value:
7157 return "DW_AT_discr_value";
7158 case DW_AT_visibility:
7159 return "DW_AT_visibility";
7160 case DW_AT_import:
7161 return "DW_AT_import";
7162 case DW_AT_string_length:
7163 return "DW_AT_string_length";
7164 case DW_AT_common_reference:
7165 return "DW_AT_common_reference";
7166 case DW_AT_comp_dir:
7167 return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
7168 case DW_AT_const_value:
7169 return "DW_AT_const_value";
7170 case DW_AT_containing_type:
7171 return "DW_AT_containing_type";
7172 case DW_AT_default_value:
7173 return "DW_AT_default_value";
7174 case DW_AT_inline:
7175 return "DW_AT_inline";
7176 case DW_AT_is_optional:
7177 return "DW_AT_is_optional";
7178 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
7179 return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
7180 case DW_AT_producer:
7181 return "DW_AT_producer";
7182 case DW_AT_prototyped:
7183 return "DW_AT_prototyped";
7184 case DW_AT_return_addr:
7185 return "DW_AT_return_addr";
7186 case DW_AT_start_scope:
7187 return "DW_AT_start_scope";
7188 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
7189 return "DW_AT_bit_stride";
7190 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
7191 return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
7192 case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
7193 return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
7194 case DW_AT_accessibility:
7195 return "DW_AT_accessibility";
7196 case DW_AT_address_class:
7197 return "DW_AT_address_class";
7198 case DW_AT_artificial:
7199 return "DW_AT_artificial";
7200 case DW_AT_base_types:
7201 return "DW_AT_base_types";
7202 case DW_AT_calling_convention:
7203 return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
7204 case DW_AT_count:
7205 return "DW_AT_count";
7206 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
7207 return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
7208 case DW_AT_decl_column:
7209 return "DW_AT_decl_column";
7210 case DW_AT_decl_file:
7211 return "DW_AT_decl_file";
7212 case DW_AT_decl_line:
7213 return "DW_AT_decl_line";
7214 case DW_AT_declaration:
7215 return "DW_AT_declaration";
7216 case DW_AT_discr_list:
7217 return "DW_AT_discr_list";
7218 case DW_AT_encoding:
7219 return "DW_AT_encoding";
7220 case DW_AT_external:
7221 return "DW_AT_external";
7222 case DW_AT_explicit:
7223 return "DW_AT_explicit";
7224 case DW_AT_frame_base:
7225 return "DW_AT_frame_base";
7226 case DW_AT_friend:
7227 return "DW_AT_friend";
7228 case DW_AT_identifier_case:
7229 return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
7230 case DW_AT_macro_info:
7231 return "DW_AT_macro_info";
7232 case DW_AT_namelist_items:
7233 return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
7234 case DW_AT_priority:
7235 return "DW_AT_priority";
7236 case DW_AT_segment:
7237 return "DW_AT_segment";
7238 case DW_AT_specification:
7239 return "DW_AT_specification";
7240 case DW_AT_static_link:
7241 return "DW_AT_static_link";
7242 case DW_AT_type:
7243 return "DW_AT_type";
7244 case DW_AT_use_location:
7245 return "DW_AT_use_location";
7246 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
7247 return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
7248 case DW_AT_virtuality:
7249 return "DW_AT_virtuality";
7250 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
7251 return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
7253 case DW_AT_allocated:
7254 return "DW_AT_allocated";
7255 case DW_AT_associated:
7256 return "DW_AT_associated";
7257 case DW_AT_data_location:
7258 return "DW_AT_data_location";
7259 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
7260 return "DW_AT_byte_stride";
7261 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
7262 return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
7263 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
7264 return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
7265 case DW_AT_extension:
7266 return "DW_AT_extension";
7267 case DW_AT_ranges:
7268 return "DW_AT_ranges";
7269 case DW_AT_trampoline:
7270 return "DW_AT_trampoline";
7271 case DW_AT_call_column:
7272 return "DW_AT_call_column";
7273 case DW_AT_call_file:
7274 return "DW_AT_call_file";
7275 case DW_AT_call_line:
7276 return "DW_AT_call_line";
7277 case DW_AT_object_pointer:
7278 return "DW_AT_object_pointer";
7280 case DW_AT_signature:
7281 return "DW_AT_signature";
7282 case DW_AT_main_subprogram:
7283 return "DW_AT_main_subprogram";
7284 case DW_AT_data_bit_offset:
7285 return "DW_AT_data_bit_offset";
7286 case DW_AT_const_expr:
7287 return "DW_AT_const_expr";
7288 case DW_AT_enum_class:
7289 return "DW_AT_enum_class";
7290 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
7291 return "DW_AT_linkage_name";
7293 case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
7294 return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
7295 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
7296 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
7297 case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
7298 return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
7299 case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
7300 return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
7301 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7302 case DW_AT_HP_prologue:
7303 return "DW_AT_HP_prologue";
7304 #else
7305 case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
7306 return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
7307 #endif
7308 case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
7309 return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
7310 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
7311 return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
7312 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
7313 case DW_AT_HP_epilogue:
7314 return "DW_AT_HP_epilogue";
7315 #else
7316 case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
7317 return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
7318 #endif
7319 case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
7320 return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
7321 case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
7322 return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
7323 case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
7324 return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
7326 case DW_AT_sf_names:
7327 return "DW_AT_sf_names";
7328 case DW_AT_src_info:
7329 return "DW_AT_src_info";
7330 case DW_AT_mac_info:
7331 return "DW_AT_mac_info";
7332 case DW_AT_src_coords:
7333 return "DW_AT_src_coords";
7334 case DW_AT_body_begin:
7335 return "DW_AT_body_begin";
7336 case DW_AT_body_end:
7337 return "DW_AT_body_end";
7339 case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
7340 return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
7341 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by:
7342 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded_by";
7343 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by:
7344 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded_by";
7345 case DW_AT_GNU_guarded:
7346 return "DW_AT_GNU_guarded";
7347 case DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded:
7348 return "DW_AT_GNU_pt_guarded";
7349 case DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded:
7350 return "DW_AT_GNU_locks_excluded";
7351 case DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required:
7352 return "DW_AT_GNU_exclusive_locks_required";
7353 case DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required:
7354 return "DW_AT_GNU_shared_locks_required";
7355 case DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature:
7356 return "DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature";
7357 case DW_AT_GNU_template_name:
7358 return "DW_AT_GNU_template_name";
7359 case DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value:
7360 return "DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value";
7361 case DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value:
7362 return "DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value";
7363 case DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target:
7364 return "DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target";
7365 case DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered:
7366 return "DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered";
7367 case DW_AT_GNU_tail_call:
7368 return "DW_AT_GNU_tail_call";
7369 case DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites:
7370 return "DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites";
7371 case DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites:
7372 return "DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites";
7373 case DW_AT_GNU_all_source_call_sites:
7374 return "DW_AT_GNU_all_source_call_sites";
7376 case DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type:
7377 return "DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type";
7379 case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
7380 return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
7382 default:
7383 return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
7387 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name. */
7389 static const char *
7390 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
7392 switch (form)
7394 case DW_FORM_addr:
7395 return "DW_FORM_addr";
7396 case DW_FORM_block2:
7397 return "DW_FORM_block2";
7398 case DW_FORM_block4:
7399 return "DW_FORM_block4";
7400 case DW_FORM_data2:
7401 return "DW_FORM_data2";
7402 case DW_FORM_data4:
7403 return "DW_FORM_data4";
7404 case DW_FORM_data8:
7405 return "DW_FORM_data8";
7406 case DW_FORM_string:
7407 return "DW_FORM_string";
7408 case DW_FORM_block:
7409 return "DW_FORM_block";
7410 case DW_FORM_block1:
7411 return "DW_FORM_block1";
7412 case DW_FORM_data1:
7413 return "DW_FORM_data1";
7414 case DW_FORM_flag:
7415 return "DW_FORM_flag";
7416 case DW_FORM_sdata:
7417 return "DW_FORM_sdata";
7418 case DW_FORM_strp:
7419 return "DW_FORM_strp";
7420 case DW_FORM_udata:
7421 return "DW_FORM_udata";
7422 case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
7423 return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
7424 case DW_FORM_ref1:
7425 return "DW_FORM_ref1";
7426 case DW_FORM_ref2:
7427 return "DW_FORM_ref2";
7428 case DW_FORM_ref4:
7429 return "DW_FORM_ref4";
7430 case DW_FORM_ref8:
7431 return "DW_FORM_ref8";
7432 case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
7433 return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
7434 case DW_FORM_indirect:
7435 return "DW_FORM_indirect";
7436 case DW_FORM_sec_offset:
7437 return "DW_FORM_sec_offset";
7438 case DW_FORM_exprloc:
7439 return "DW_FORM_exprloc";
7440 case DW_FORM_flag_present:
7441 return "DW_FORM_flag_present";
7442 case DW_FORM_ref_sig8:
7443 return "DW_FORM_ref_sig8";
7444 default:
7445 return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
7449 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl. The decl may be an inlined
7450 instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
7451 function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
7452 to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
7453 given block. */
7455 static tree
7456 decl_ultimate_origin (const_tree decl)
7458 if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
7459 return NULL_TREE;
7461 /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
7462 nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
7463 we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function. */
7464 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
7465 return NULL_TREE;
7467 /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
7468 most distant ancestor, this should never happen. */
7469 gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
7471 return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
7474 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any. In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
7475 of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
7476 parameter. */
7478 static tree
7479 decl_class_context (tree decl)
7481 tree context = NULL_TREE;
7483 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
7484 context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
7485 else
7486 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
7487 (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
7489 if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
7490 context = NULL_TREE;
7492 return context;
7495 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE. */
7497 static inline void
7498 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
7500 /* Maybe this should be an assert? */
7501 if (die == NULL)
7502 return;
7504 if (die->die_attr == NULL)
7505 die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
7506 VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
7509 static inline enum dw_val_class
7510 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
7512 return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
7515 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE. */
7517 static inline void
7518 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
7520 dw_attr_node attr;
7522 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7523 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
7524 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
7525 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7528 static inline unsigned
7529 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
7531 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
7532 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
7535 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7537 static inline void
7538 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
7540 dw_attr_node attr;
7542 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7543 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
7544 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
7545 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7548 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
7549 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
7551 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
7552 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
7555 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7557 static inline void
7558 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7559 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
7561 dw_attr_node attr;
7563 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7564 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
7565 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
7566 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7569 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
7570 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
7572 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
7573 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
7576 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE. */
7578 static inline void
7579 add_AT_double (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7580 HOST_WIDE_INT high, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT low)
7582 dw_attr_node attr;
7584 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7585 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
7586 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high = high;
7587 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low = low;
7588 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7591 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it. */
7593 static inline void
7594 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7595 unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
7597 dw_attr_node attr;
7599 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7600 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
7601 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
7602 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
7603 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
7604 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7607 /* Add an 8-byte data attribute value to a DIE. */
7609 static inline void
7610 add_AT_data8 (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7611 unsigned char data8[8])
7613 dw_attr_node attr;
7615 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7616 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_data8;
7617 memcpy (attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_data8, data8, 8);
7618 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7621 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash. */
7623 static hashval_t
7624 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
7626 return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
7629 static int
7630 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
7632 return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
7633 (const char *)x2) == 0;
7636 /* Add STR to the indirect string hash table. */
7638 static struct indirect_string_node *
7639 find_AT_string (const char *str)
7641 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7642 void **slot;
7644 if (! debug_str_hash)
7645 debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
7646 debug_str_eq, NULL);
7648 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
7649 htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
7650 if (*slot == NULL)
7652 node = ggc_alloc_cleared_indirect_string_node ();
7653 node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
7654 *slot = node;
7656 else
7657 node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
7659 node->refcount++;
7660 return node;
7663 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE. */
7665 static inline void
7666 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
7668 dw_attr_node attr;
7669 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7671 node = find_AT_string (str);
7673 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7674 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
7675 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
7676 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7679 static inline const char *
7680 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
7682 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7683 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
7686 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
7687 or out-of-line in .debug_str section. */
7689 static enum dwarf_form
7690 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
7692 struct indirect_string_node *node;
7693 unsigned int len;
7694 char label[32];
7696 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
7698 node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
7699 if (node->form)
7700 return node->form;
7702 len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
7704 /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
7705 always better to put it inline. */
7706 if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
7707 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7709 /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
7710 section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
7711 single module. */
7712 if (DWARF2_INDIRECT_STRING_SUPPORT_MISSING_ON_TARGET
7713 || ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
7714 && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len))
7715 return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
7717 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
7718 ++dw2_string_counter;
7719 node->label = xstrdup (label);
7721 return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
7724 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7726 static inline void
7727 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7729 dw_attr_node attr;
7731 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
7732 gcc_assert (targ_die != NULL);
7733 #else
7734 /* With LTO we can end up trying to reference something we didn't create
7735 a DIE for. Avoid crashing later on a NULL referenced DIE. */
7736 if (targ_die == NULL)
7737 return;
7738 #endif
7740 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7741 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
7742 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
7743 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
7744 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7747 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
7748 pointer from the specification to the definition. */
7750 static inline void
7751 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
7753 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
7754 gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
7755 targ_die->die_definition = die;
7758 static inline dw_die_ref
7759 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
7761 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7762 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
7765 static inline int
7766 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
7768 if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
7769 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
7771 return 0;
7774 static inline void
7775 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
7777 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
7778 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
7781 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE. */
7783 static inline void
7784 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
7786 dw_attr_node attr;
7788 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7789 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
7790 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
7791 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7794 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE. */
7796 static inline void
7797 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
7799 dw_attr_node attr;
7801 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7802 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
7803 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
7804 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7807 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
7808 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
7810 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7811 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
7814 static inline void
7815 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
7817 dw_attr_node attr;
7819 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7820 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
7821 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
7822 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7823 have_location_lists = true;
7826 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
7827 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
7829 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7830 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7833 static inline dw_loc_list_ref *
7834 AT_loc_list_ptr (dw_attr_ref a)
7836 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
7837 return &a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
7840 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE. */
7842 static inline void
7843 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
7845 dw_attr_node attr;
7847 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7848 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
7849 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
7850 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7853 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute. */
7855 static inline rtx
7856 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
7858 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
7859 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
7862 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE. */
7864 static inline void
7865 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7866 struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
7868 dw_attr_node attr;
7870 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7871 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
7872 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
7873 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7876 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute. */
7878 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
7879 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
7881 gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
7882 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
7885 /* Add a vms delta attribute value to a DIE. */
7887 static inline void
7888 add_AT_vms_delta (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7889 const char *lbl1, const char *lbl2)
7891 dw_attr_node attr;
7893 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7894 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vms_delta;
7895 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1 = xstrdup (lbl1);
7896 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2 = xstrdup (lbl2);
7897 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7900 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE. */
7902 static inline void
7903 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
7905 dw_attr_node attr;
7907 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7908 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
7909 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
7910 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7913 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7914 debug_line section. */
7916 static inline void
7917 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7918 const char *label)
7920 dw_attr_node attr;
7922 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7923 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
7924 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7925 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7928 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
7929 debug_macinfo section. */
7931 static inline void
7932 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7933 const char *label)
7935 dw_attr_node attr;
7937 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7938 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
7939 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
7940 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7943 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE. */
7945 static inline void
7946 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7947 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
7949 dw_attr_node attr;
7951 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7952 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
7953 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7954 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7957 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE. */
7959 static void
7960 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
7961 long unsigned int offset)
7963 dw_attr_node attr;
7965 attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
7966 attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
7967 attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
7968 add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
7971 /* Return the start label of a delta attribute. */
7973 static inline const char *
7974 AT_vms_delta1 (dw_attr_ref a)
7976 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
7977 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl1;
7980 /* Return the end label of a delta attribute. */
7982 static inline const char *
7983 AT_vms_delta2 (dw_attr_ref a)
7985 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_vms_delta));
7986 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vms_delta.lbl2;
7989 static inline const char *
7990 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
7992 gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
7993 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
7994 || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
7995 return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
7998 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind. */
8000 static dw_attr_ref
8001 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
8003 dw_attr_ref a;
8004 unsigned ix;
8005 dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
8007 if (! die)
8008 return NULL;
8010 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
8011 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
8012 return a;
8013 else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
8014 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
8015 spec = AT_ref (a);
8017 if (spec)
8018 return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
8020 return NULL;
8023 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
8024 DIE. Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
8025 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
8027 static inline const char *
8028 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
8030 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
8032 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
8035 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
8036 DIE. Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
8037 cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier. */
8039 static inline const char *
8040 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
8042 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
8044 return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
8047 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
8048 NULL if it is not present. */
8050 static inline const char *
8051 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
8053 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
8055 return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
8058 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
8059 if it is not present. */
8061 static inline int
8062 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
8064 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
8066 return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
8069 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
8070 if it is not present. */
8072 static inline unsigned
8073 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
8075 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
8077 return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
8080 static inline dw_die_ref
8081 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
8083 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
8085 return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
8088 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
8089 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
8091 dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
8093 return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
8096 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++. */
8098 static inline bool
8099 is_cxx (void)
8101 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
8103 return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
8106 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran. */
8108 static inline bool
8109 is_fortran (void)
8111 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
8113 return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
8114 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
8115 || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
8118 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada. */
8120 static inline bool
8121 is_ada (void)
8123 unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language);
8125 return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
8128 /* Remove the specified attribute if present. */
8130 static void
8131 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
8133 dw_attr_ref a;
8134 unsigned ix;
8136 if (! die)
8137 return;
8139 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
8140 if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
8142 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
8143 if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
8144 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
8146 /* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
8147 that are needed. */
8148 VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
8149 return;
8153 /* Remove CHILD from its parent. PREV must have the property that
8154 PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD. Does not alter CHILD. */
8156 static void
8157 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
8159 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
8160 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
8161 if (prev == child)
8163 gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
8164 prev = NULL;
8166 else
8167 prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
8168 if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
8169 child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
8172 /* Replace OLD_CHILD with NEW_CHILD. PREV must have the property that
8173 PREV->DIE_SIB == OLD_CHILD. Does not alter OLD_CHILD. */
8175 static void
8176 replace_child (dw_die_ref old_child, dw_die_ref new_child, dw_die_ref prev)
8178 dw_die_ref parent = old_child->die_parent;
8180 gcc_assert (parent == prev->die_parent);
8181 gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == old_child);
8183 new_child->die_parent = parent;
8184 if (prev == old_child)
8186 gcc_assert (parent->die_child == old_child);
8187 new_child->die_sib = new_child;
8189 else
8191 prev->die_sib = new_child;
8192 new_child->die_sib = old_child->die_sib;
8194 if (old_child->die_parent->die_child == old_child)
8195 old_child->die_parent->die_child = new_child;
8198 /* Move all children from OLD_PARENT to NEW_PARENT. */
8200 static void
8201 move_all_children (dw_die_ref old_parent, dw_die_ref new_parent)
8203 dw_die_ref c;
8204 new_parent->die_child = old_parent->die_child;
8205 old_parent->die_child = NULL;
8206 FOR_EACH_CHILD (new_parent, c, c->die_parent = new_parent);
8209 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG. Do nothing if no child
8210 matches TAG. */
8212 static void
8213 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
8215 dw_die_ref c;
8217 c = die->die_child;
8218 if (c) do {
8219 dw_die_ref prev = c;
8220 c = c->die_sib;
8221 while (c->die_tag == tag)
8223 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
8224 /* Might have removed every child. */
8225 if (c == c->die_sib)
8226 return;
8227 c = c->die_sib;
8229 } while (c != die->die_child);
8232 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE. */
8234 static void
8235 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
8237 /* FIXME this should probably be an assert. */
8238 if (! die || ! child_die)
8239 return;
8240 gcc_assert (die != child_die);
8242 child_die->die_parent = die;
8243 if (die->die_child)
8245 child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
8246 die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
8248 else
8249 child_die->die_sib = child_die;
8250 die->die_child = child_die;
8253 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
8254 is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
8255 This is done by removing and re-adding it. */
8257 static void
8258 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
8260 dw_die_ref p;
8262 /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
8263 specification DIE at toplevel. */
8264 if (child->die_parent != parent)
8266 dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
8268 if (tmp)
8269 child = tmp;
8272 gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
8273 || (child->die_parent
8274 == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
8276 for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
8277 if (p->die_sib == child)
8279 remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
8280 break;
8283 add_child_die (parent, child);
8286 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node. */
8288 static inline dw_die_ref
8289 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
8291 dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
8293 die->die_tag = tag_value;
8295 if (parent_die != NULL)
8296 add_child_die (parent_die, die);
8297 else
8299 limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
8301 limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
8302 limbo_node->die = die;
8303 limbo_node->created_for = t;
8304 limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
8305 limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
8308 return die;
8311 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier. */
8313 static inline dw_die_ref
8314 lookup_type_die (tree type)
8316 return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
8319 /* Given a TYPE_DIE representing the type TYPE, if TYPE is an
8320 anonymous type named by the typedef TYPE_DIE, return the DIE of the
8321 anonymous type instead the one of the naming typedef. */
8323 static inline dw_die_ref
8324 strip_naming_typedef (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
8326 if (type
8327 && TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
8328 && type_die
8329 && type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef
8330 && is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
8331 type_die = get_AT_ref (type_die, DW_AT_type);
8332 return type_die;
8335 /* Like lookup_type_die, but if type is an anonymous type named by a
8336 typedef[1], return the DIE of the anonymous type instead the one of
8337 the naming typedef. This is because in gen_typedef_die, we did
8338 equate the anonymous struct named by the typedef with the DIE of
8339 the naming typedef. So by default, lookup_type_die on an anonymous
8340 struct yields the DIE of the naming typedef.
8342 [1]: Read the comment of is_naming_typedef_decl to learn about what
8343 a naming typedef is. */
8345 static inline dw_die_ref
8346 lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (tree type)
8348 dw_die_ref die = lookup_type_die (type);
8349 return strip_naming_typedef (type, die);
8352 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier. */
8354 static inline void
8355 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
8357 TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
8360 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
8362 static hashval_t
8363 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
8365 return (hashval_t) ((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
8368 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y. */
8370 static int
8371 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
8373 return (((const_dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
8376 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration. */
8378 static inline dw_die_ref
8379 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
8381 return (dw_die_ref) htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
8384 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list). */
8386 static hashval_t
8387 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
8389 return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
8392 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
8393 UID of decl *Y. */
8395 static int
8396 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
8398 return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
8401 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration. */
8403 static inline var_loc_list *
8404 lookup_decl_loc (const_tree decl)
8406 if (!decl_loc_table)
8407 return NULL;
8408 return (var_loc_list *)
8409 htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
8412 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a cached_dw_loc_list_list). */
8414 static hashval_t
8415 cached_dw_loc_list_table_hash (const void *x)
8417 return (hashval_t) ((const cached_dw_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
8420 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of cached_dw_loc_list X is the same as
8421 UID of decl *Y. */
8423 static int
8424 cached_dw_loc_list_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
8426 return (((const cached_dw_loc_list *) x)->decl_id
8427 == DECL_UID ((const_tree) y));
8430 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration. */
8432 static void
8433 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
8435 unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
8436 void **slot;
8438 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
8439 *slot = decl_die;
8440 decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
8443 /* Return how many bits covers PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
8445 static int
8446 decl_piece_bitsize (rtx piece)
8448 int ret = (int) GET_MODE (piece);
8449 if (ret)
8450 return ret;
8451 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (piece, 0)) == CONCAT
8452 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0)));
8453 return INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 0));
8456 /* Return pointer to the location of location note in PIECE EXPR_LIST. */
8458 static rtx *
8459 decl_piece_varloc_ptr (rtx piece)
8461 if ((int) GET_MODE (piece))
8462 return &XEXP (piece, 0);
8463 else
8464 return &XEXP (XEXP (piece, 0), 1);
8467 /* Create an EXPR_LIST for location note LOC_NOTE covering BITSIZE bits.
8468 Next is the chain of following piece nodes. */
8470 static rtx
8471 decl_piece_node (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx next)
8473 if (bitsize <= (int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE)
8474 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (bitsize, loc_note, next);
8475 else
8476 return alloc_EXPR_LIST (0, gen_rtx_CONCAT (VOIDmode,
8477 GEN_INT (bitsize),
8478 loc_note), next);
8481 /* Return rtx that should be stored into loc field for
8482 LOC_NOTE and BITPOS/BITSIZE. */
8484 static rtx
8485 construct_piece_list (rtx loc_note, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
8486 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize)
8488 if (bitsize != -1)
8490 loc_note = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, NULL_RTX);
8491 if (bitpos != 0)
8492 loc_note = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos, loc_note);
8494 return loc_note;
8497 /* This function either modifies location piece list *DEST in
8498 place (if SRC and INNER is NULL), or copies location piece list
8499 *SRC to *DEST while modifying it. Location BITPOS is modified
8500 to contain LOC_NOTE, any pieces overlapping it are removed resp.
8501 not copied and if needed some padding around it is added.
8502 When modifying in place, DEST should point to EXPR_LIST where
8503 earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits, when copying SRC points
8504 to the start of the whole list and INNER points to the EXPR_LIST
8505 where earlier pieces cover PIECE_BITPOS bits. */
8507 static void
8508 adjust_piece_list (rtx *dest, rtx *src, rtx *inner,
8509 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, HOST_WIDE_INT piece_bitpos,
8510 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, rtx loc_note)
8512 int diff;
8513 bool copy = inner != NULL;
8515 if (copy)
8517 /* First copy all nodes preceeding the current bitpos. */
8518 while (src != inner)
8520 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
8521 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
8522 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8523 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
8526 /* Add padding if needed. */
8527 if (bitpos != piece_bitpos)
8529 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, bitpos - piece_bitpos,
8530 copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8531 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8533 else if (*dest && decl_piece_bitsize (*dest) == bitsize)
8535 gcc_assert (!copy);
8536 /* A piece with correct bitpos and bitsize already exist,
8537 just update the location for it and return. */
8538 *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*dest) = loc_note;
8539 return;
8541 /* Add the piece that changed. */
8542 *dest = decl_piece_node (loc_note, bitsize, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8543 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8544 /* Skip over pieces that overlap it. */
8545 diff = bitpos - piece_bitpos + bitsize;
8546 if (!copy)
8547 src = dest;
8548 while (diff > 0 && *src)
8550 rtx piece = *src;
8551 diff -= decl_piece_bitsize (piece);
8552 if (copy)
8553 src = &XEXP (piece, 1);
8554 else
8556 *src = XEXP (piece, 1);
8557 free_EXPR_LIST_node (piece);
8560 /* Add padding if needed. */
8561 if (diff < 0 && *src)
8563 if (!copy)
8564 dest = src;
8565 *dest = decl_piece_node (NULL_RTX, -diff, copy ? NULL_RTX : *dest);
8566 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8568 if (!copy)
8569 return;
8570 /* Finally copy all nodes following it. */
8571 while (*src)
8573 *dest = decl_piece_node (*decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*src),
8574 decl_piece_bitsize (*src), NULL_RTX);
8575 dest = &XEXP (*dest, 1);
8576 src = &XEXP (*src, 1);
8580 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL. */
8582 static struct var_loc_node *
8583 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, rtx loc_note, const char *label)
8585 unsigned int decl_id;
8586 var_loc_list *temp;
8587 void **slot;
8588 struct var_loc_node *loc = NULL;
8589 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = -1, bitpos = -1;
8591 if (DECL_DEBUG_EXPR_IS_FROM (decl))
8593 tree realdecl = DECL_DEBUG_EXPR (decl);
8594 if (realdecl && handled_component_p (realdecl))
8596 HOST_WIDE_INT maxsize;
8597 tree innerdecl;
8598 innerdecl
8599 = get_ref_base_and_extent (realdecl, &bitpos, &bitsize, &maxsize);
8600 if (!DECL_P (innerdecl)
8601 || DECL_IGNORED_P (innerdecl)
8602 || TREE_STATIC (innerdecl)
8603 || bitsize <= 0
8604 || bitpos + bitsize > 256
8605 || bitsize != maxsize)
8606 return NULL;
8607 decl = innerdecl;
8611 decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
8612 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
8613 if (*slot == NULL)
8615 temp = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_list ();
8616 temp->decl_id = decl_id;
8617 *slot = temp;
8619 else
8620 temp = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
8622 if (temp->last)
8624 struct var_loc_node *last = temp->last, *unused = NULL;
8625 rtx *piece_loc = NULL, last_loc_note;
8626 int piece_bitpos = 0;
8627 if (last->next)
8629 last = last->next;
8630 gcc_assert (last->next == NULL);
8632 if (bitsize != -1 && GET_CODE (last->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
8634 piece_loc = &last->loc;
8637 int cur_bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc);
8638 if (piece_bitpos + cur_bitsize > bitpos)
8639 break;
8640 piece_bitpos += cur_bitsize;
8641 piece_loc = &XEXP (*piece_loc, 1);
8643 while (*piece_loc);
8645 /* TEMP->LAST here is either pointer to the last but one or
8646 last element in the chained list, LAST is pointer to the
8647 last element. */
8648 if (label && strcmp (last->label, label) == 0)
8650 /* For SRA optimized variables if there weren't any real
8651 insns since last note, just modify the last node. */
8652 if (piece_loc != NULL)
8654 adjust_piece_list (piece_loc, NULL, NULL,
8655 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
8656 return NULL;
8658 /* If the last note doesn't cover any instructions, remove it. */
8659 if (temp->last != last)
8661 temp->last->next = NULL;
8662 unused = last;
8663 last = temp->last;
8664 gcc_assert (strcmp (last->label, label) != 0);
8666 else
8668 gcc_assert (temp->first == temp->last);
8669 memset (temp->last, '\0', sizeof (*temp->last));
8670 temp->last->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8671 return temp->last;
8674 if (bitsize == -1 && NOTE_P (last->loc))
8675 last_loc_note = last->loc;
8676 else if (piece_loc != NULL
8677 && *piece_loc != NULL_RTX
8678 && piece_bitpos == bitpos
8679 && decl_piece_bitsize (*piece_loc) == bitsize)
8680 last_loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (*piece_loc);
8681 else
8682 last_loc_note = NULL_RTX;
8683 /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
8684 and either both or neither of the locations is uninitialized,
8685 we have nothing to do. */
8686 if (last_loc_note == NULL_RTX
8687 || (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (last_loc_note),
8688 NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note)))
8689 || ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
8690 != NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note))
8691 && ((NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (last_loc_note)
8692 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
8693 || (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note)
8694 == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED))))
8696 /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST. If the last
8697 element of the list has been removed above, reuse its
8698 memory for the new node, otherwise allocate a new one. */
8699 if (unused)
8701 loc = unused;
8702 memset (loc, '\0', sizeof (*loc));
8704 else
8705 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
8706 if (bitsize == -1 || piece_loc == NULL)
8707 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8708 else
8709 adjust_piece_list (&loc->loc, &last->loc, piece_loc,
8710 bitpos, piece_bitpos, bitsize, loc_note);
8711 last->next = loc;
8712 /* Ensure TEMP->LAST will point either to the new last but one
8713 element of the chain, or to the last element in it. */
8714 if (last != temp->last)
8715 temp->last = last;
8717 else if (unused)
8718 ggc_free (unused);
8720 else
8722 loc = ggc_alloc_cleared_var_loc_node ();
8723 temp->first = loc;
8724 temp->last = loc;
8725 loc->loc = construct_piece_list (loc_note, bitpos, bitsize);
8727 return loc;
8730 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
8731 output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
8732 the DIE internal representation. */
8733 static int print_indent;
8735 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent. */
8737 static inline void
8738 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
8740 fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
8743 /* Print a type signature in hex. */
8745 static inline void
8746 print_signature (FILE *outfile, char *sig)
8748 int i;
8750 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
8751 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", sig[i] & 0xff);
8754 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
8755 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8757 static void
8758 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
8760 dw_attr_ref a;
8761 dw_die_ref c;
8762 unsigned ix;
8764 print_spaces (outfile);
8765 fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s (%p)\n",
8766 die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag),
8767 (void*) die);
8768 print_spaces (outfile);
8769 fprintf (outfile, " abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
8770 fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld", die->die_offset);
8771 fprintf (outfile, " mark: %d\n", die->die_mark);
8773 if (use_debug_types && die->die_id.die_type_node)
8775 print_spaces (outfile);
8776 fprintf (outfile, " signature: ");
8777 print_signature (outfile, die->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
8778 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8781 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
8783 print_spaces (outfile);
8784 fprintf (outfile, " %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
8786 switch (AT_class (a))
8788 case dw_val_class_addr:
8789 fprintf (outfile, "address");
8790 break;
8791 case dw_val_class_offset:
8792 fprintf (outfile, "offset");
8793 break;
8794 case dw_val_class_loc:
8795 fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
8796 break;
8797 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
8798 fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
8799 AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
8800 break;
8801 case dw_val_class_range_list:
8802 fprintf (outfile, "range list");
8803 break;
8804 case dw_val_class_const:
8805 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
8806 break;
8807 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8808 fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
8809 break;
8810 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8811 fprintf (outfile, "constant ("HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC","\
8812 HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED")",
8813 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high,
8814 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low);
8815 break;
8816 case dw_val_class_vec:
8817 fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
8818 break;
8819 case dw_val_class_flag:
8820 fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
8821 break;
8822 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8823 if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
8825 if (use_debug_types && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node)
8827 fprintf (outfile, "die -> signature: ");
8828 print_signature (outfile,
8829 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node->signature);
8831 else if (! use_debug_types && AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol)
8832 fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s",
8833 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
8834 else
8835 fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
8836 fprintf (outfile, " (%p)", (void *) AT_ref (a));
8838 else
8839 fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
8840 break;
8841 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
8842 fprintf (outfile, "delta: @slotcount(%s-%s)",
8843 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a));
8844 break;
8845 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
8846 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
8847 case dw_val_class_macptr:
8848 fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
8849 break;
8850 case dw_val_class_str:
8851 if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
8852 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
8853 else
8854 fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
8855 break;
8856 case dw_val_class_file:
8857 fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
8858 AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
8859 break;
8860 case dw_val_class_data8:
8862 int i;
8864 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
8865 fprintf (outfile, "%02x", a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i]);
8866 break;
8868 default:
8869 break;
8872 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8875 if (die->die_child != NULL)
8877 print_indent += 4;
8878 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
8879 print_indent -= 4;
8881 if (print_indent == 0)
8882 fprintf (outfile, "\n");
8885 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE. */
8887 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
8888 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
8890 print_die (die, stderr);
8893 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
8894 This routine is a debugging aid only. */
8896 DEBUG_FUNCTION void
8897 debug_dwarf (void)
8899 print_indent = 0;
8900 print_die (comp_unit_die (), stderr);
8903 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file. OLD_UNIT is the CU
8904 for the enclosing include file, if any. BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
8905 DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file. */
8907 static dw_die_ref
8908 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
8910 const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
8911 dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
8913 new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
8914 return new_unit;
8917 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one. */
8919 static dw_die_ref
8920 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
8922 dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
8924 old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
8925 return new_unit;
8928 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
8929 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
8931 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
8933 static inline void
8934 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
8936 int tem;
8938 tem = (loc->dtprel << 8) | ((unsigned int) loc->dw_loc_opc);
8939 CHECKSUM (tem);
8940 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
8941 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
8944 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
8946 static void
8947 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
8949 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8950 rtx r;
8952 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
8954 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
8955 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
8956 if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
8957 return;
8959 switch (AT_class (at))
8961 case dw_val_class_const:
8962 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
8963 break;
8964 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
8965 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
8966 break;
8967 case dw_val_class_const_double:
8968 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
8969 break;
8970 case dw_val_class_vec:
8971 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
8972 break;
8973 case dw_val_class_flag:
8974 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
8975 break;
8976 case dw_val_class_str:
8977 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
8978 break;
8980 case dw_val_class_addr:
8981 r = AT_addr (at);
8982 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
8983 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
8984 break;
8986 case dw_val_class_offset:
8987 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
8988 break;
8990 case dw_val_class_loc:
8991 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8992 loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
8993 break;
8995 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
8996 die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
8997 break;
8999 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9000 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9001 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9002 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9003 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9004 break;
9006 case dw_val_class_file:
9007 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
9008 break;
9010 case dw_val_class_data8:
9011 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
9012 break;
9014 default:
9015 break;
9019 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE. */
9021 static void
9022 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
9024 dw_die_ref c;
9025 dw_attr_ref a;
9026 unsigned ix;
9028 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
9029 if (die->die_mark)
9031 CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
9032 return;
9034 die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
9036 CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
9038 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
9039 attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
9041 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
9044 #undef CHECKSUM
9045 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
9047 /* For DWARF-4 types, include the trailing NULL when checksumming strings. */
9048 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
9049 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO) + 1, ctx)
9050 #define CHECKSUM_SLEB128(FOO) checksum_sleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
9051 #define CHECKSUM_ULEB128(FOO) checksum_uleb128 ((FOO), ctx)
9052 #define CHECKSUM_ATTR(FOO) \
9053 if (FOO) attr_checksum_ordered (die->die_tag, (FOO), ctx, mark)
9055 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in signed LEB128 format. */
9057 static void
9058 checksum_sleb128 (HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
9060 unsigned char byte;
9061 bool more;
9063 while (1)
9065 byte = (value & 0x7f);
9066 value >>= 7;
9067 more = !((value == 0 && (byte & 0x40) == 0)
9068 || (value == -1 && (byte & 0x40) != 0));
9069 if (more)
9070 byte |= 0x80;
9071 CHECKSUM (byte);
9072 if (!more)
9073 break;
9077 /* Calculate the checksum of a number in unsigned LEB128 format. */
9079 static void
9080 checksum_uleb128 (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
9082 while (1)
9084 unsigned char byte = (value & 0x7f);
9085 value >>= 7;
9086 if (value != 0)
9087 /* More bytes to follow. */
9088 byte |= 0x80;
9089 CHECKSUM (byte);
9090 if (value == 0)
9091 break;
9095 /* Checksum the context of the DIE. This adds the names of any
9096 surrounding namespaces or structures to the checksum. */
9098 static void
9099 checksum_die_context (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
9101 const char *name;
9102 dw_die_ref spec;
9103 int tag = die->die_tag;
9105 if (tag != DW_TAG_namespace
9106 && tag != DW_TAG_structure_type
9107 && tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
9108 return;
9110 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
9112 spec = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9113 if (spec != NULL)
9114 die = spec;
9116 if (die->die_parent != NULL)
9117 checksum_die_context (die->die_parent, ctx);
9119 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('C');
9120 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (tag);
9121 if (name != NULL)
9122 CHECKSUM_STRING (name);
9125 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression. */
9127 static inline void
9128 loc_checksum_ordered (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
9130 /* Special case for lone DW_OP_plus_uconst: checksum as if the location
9131 were emitted as a DW_FORM_sdata instead of a location expression. */
9132 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_plus_uconst && loc->dw_loc_next == NULL)
9134 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
9135 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((HOST_WIDE_INT) loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
9136 return;
9139 /* Otherwise, just checksum the raw location expression. */
9140 while (loc != NULL)
9142 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (loc->dw_loc_opc);
9143 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
9144 CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
9145 loc = loc->dw_loc_next;
9149 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute. */
9151 static void
9152 attr_checksum_ordered (enum dwarf_tag tag, dw_attr_ref at,
9153 struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
9155 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
9156 rtx r;
9158 if (AT_class (at) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
9160 dw_die_ref target_die = AT_ref (at);
9162 /* For pointer and reference types, we checksum only the (qualified)
9163 name of the target type (if there is a name). For friend entries,
9164 we checksum only the (qualified) name of the target type or function.
9165 This allows the checksum to remain the same whether the target type
9166 is complete or not. */
9167 if ((at->dw_attr == DW_AT_type
9168 && (tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
9169 || tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
9170 || tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
9171 || tag == DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type))
9172 || (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_friend
9173 && tag == DW_TAG_friend))
9175 dw_attr_ref name_attr = get_AT (target_die, DW_AT_name);
9177 if (name_attr != NULL)
9179 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
9181 if (decl == NULL)
9182 decl = target_die;
9183 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('N');
9184 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
9185 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
9186 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
9187 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('E');
9188 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
9189 return;
9193 /* For all other references to another DIE, we check to see if the
9194 target DIE has already been visited. If it has, we emit a
9195 backward reference; if not, we descend recursively. */
9196 if (target_die->die_mark > 0)
9198 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('R');
9199 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
9200 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (target_die->die_mark);
9202 else
9204 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (target_die, DW_AT_specification);
9206 if (decl == NULL)
9207 decl = target_die;
9208 target_die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
9209 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('T');
9210 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
9211 if (decl->die_parent != NULL)
9212 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, ctx);
9213 die_checksum_ordered (target_die, ctx, mark);
9215 return;
9218 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('A');
9219 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr);
9221 switch (AT_class (at))
9223 case dw_val_class_const:
9224 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
9225 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
9226 break;
9228 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9229 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
9230 CHECKSUM_SLEB128 ((int) at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
9231 break;
9233 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9234 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
9235 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double));
9236 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_double);
9237 break;
9239 case dw_val_class_vec:
9240 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_block);
9241 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (sizeof (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec));
9242 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
9243 break;
9245 case dw_val_class_flag:
9246 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_flag);
9247 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag ? 1 : 0);
9248 break;
9250 case dw_val_class_str:
9251 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
9252 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
9253 break;
9255 case dw_val_class_addr:
9256 r = AT_addr (at);
9257 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
9258 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
9259 CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
9260 break;
9262 case dw_val_class_offset:
9263 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_sdata);
9264 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
9265 break;
9267 case dw_val_class_loc:
9268 for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
9269 loc_checksum_ordered (loc, ctx);
9270 break;
9272 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9273 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9274 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9275 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9276 break;
9278 case dw_val_class_file:
9279 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (DW_FORM_string);
9280 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
9281 break;
9283 case dw_val_class_data8:
9284 CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8);
9285 break;
9287 default:
9288 break;
9292 struct checksum_attributes
9294 dw_attr_ref at_name;
9295 dw_attr_ref at_type;
9296 dw_attr_ref at_friend;
9297 dw_attr_ref at_accessibility;
9298 dw_attr_ref at_address_class;
9299 dw_attr_ref at_allocated;
9300 dw_attr_ref at_artificial;
9301 dw_attr_ref at_associated;
9302 dw_attr_ref at_binary_scale;
9303 dw_attr_ref at_bit_offset;
9304 dw_attr_ref at_bit_size;
9305 dw_attr_ref at_bit_stride;
9306 dw_attr_ref at_byte_size;
9307 dw_attr_ref at_byte_stride;
9308 dw_attr_ref at_const_value;
9309 dw_attr_ref at_containing_type;
9310 dw_attr_ref at_count;
9311 dw_attr_ref at_data_location;
9312 dw_attr_ref at_data_member_location;
9313 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_scale;
9314 dw_attr_ref at_decimal_sign;
9315 dw_attr_ref at_default_value;
9316 dw_attr_ref at_digit_count;
9317 dw_attr_ref at_discr;
9318 dw_attr_ref at_discr_list;
9319 dw_attr_ref at_discr_value;
9320 dw_attr_ref at_encoding;
9321 dw_attr_ref at_endianity;
9322 dw_attr_ref at_explicit;
9323 dw_attr_ref at_is_optional;
9324 dw_attr_ref at_location;
9325 dw_attr_ref at_lower_bound;
9326 dw_attr_ref at_mutable;
9327 dw_attr_ref at_ordering;
9328 dw_attr_ref at_picture_string;
9329 dw_attr_ref at_prototyped;
9330 dw_attr_ref at_small;
9331 dw_attr_ref at_segment;
9332 dw_attr_ref at_string_length;
9333 dw_attr_ref at_threads_scaled;
9334 dw_attr_ref at_upper_bound;
9335 dw_attr_ref at_use_location;
9336 dw_attr_ref at_use_UTF8;
9337 dw_attr_ref at_variable_parameter;
9338 dw_attr_ref at_virtuality;
9339 dw_attr_ref at_visibility;
9340 dw_attr_ref at_vtable_elem_location;
9343 /* Collect the attributes that we will want to use for the checksum. */
9345 static void
9346 collect_checksum_attributes (struct checksum_attributes *attrs, dw_die_ref die)
9348 dw_attr_ref a;
9349 unsigned ix;
9351 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
9353 switch (a->dw_attr)
9355 case DW_AT_name:
9356 attrs->at_name = a;
9357 break;
9358 case DW_AT_type:
9359 attrs->at_type = a;
9360 break;
9361 case DW_AT_friend:
9362 attrs->at_friend = a;
9363 break;
9364 case DW_AT_accessibility:
9365 attrs->at_accessibility = a;
9366 break;
9367 case DW_AT_address_class:
9368 attrs->at_address_class = a;
9369 break;
9370 case DW_AT_allocated:
9371 attrs->at_allocated = a;
9372 break;
9373 case DW_AT_artificial:
9374 attrs->at_artificial = a;
9375 break;
9376 case DW_AT_associated:
9377 attrs->at_associated = a;
9378 break;
9379 case DW_AT_binary_scale:
9380 attrs->at_binary_scale = a;
9381 break;
9382 case DW_AT_bit_offset:
9383 attrs->at_bit_offset = a;
9384 break;
9385 case DW_AT_bit_size:
9386 attrs->at_bit_size = a;
9387 break;
9388 case DW_AT_bit_stride:
9389 attrs->at_bit_stride = a;
9390 break;
9391 case DW_AT_byte_size:
9392 attrs->at_byte_size = a;
9393 break;
9394 case DW_AT_byte_stride:
9395 attrs->at_byte_stride = a;
9396 break;
9397 case DW_AT_const_value:
9398 attrs->at_const_value = a;
9399 break;
9400 case DW_AT_containing_type:
9401 attrs->at_containing_type = a;
9402 break;
9403 case DW_AT_count:
9404 attrs->at_count = a;
9405 break;
9406 case DW_AT_data_location:
9407 attrs->at_data_location = a;
9408 break;
9409 case DW_AT_data_member_location:
9410 attrs->at_data_member_location = a;
9411 break;
9412 case DW_AT_decimal_scale:
9413 attrs->at_decimal_scale = a;
9414 break;
9415 case DW_AT_decimal_sign:
9416 attrs->at_decimal_sign = a;
9417 break;
9418 case DW_AT_default_value:
9419 attrs->at_default_value = a;
9420 break;
9421 case DW_AT_digit_count:
9422 attrs->at_digit_count = a;
9423 break;
9424 case DW_AT_discr:
9425 attrs->at_discr = a;
9426 break;
9427 case DW_AT_discr_list:
9428 attrs->at_discr_list = a;
9429 break;
9430 case DW_AT_discr_value:
9431 attrs->at_discr_value = a;
9432 break;
9433 case DW_AT_encoding:
9434 attrs->at_encoding = a;
9435 break;
9436 case DW_AT_endianity:
9437 attrs->at_endianity = a;
9438 break;
9439 case DW_AT_explicit:
9440 attrs->at_explicit = a;
9441 break;
9442 case DW_AT_is_optional:
9443 attrs->at_is_optional = a;
9444 break;
9445 case DW_AT_location:
9446 attrs->at_location = a;
9447 break;
9448 case DW_AT_lower_bound:
9449 attrs->at_lower_bound = a;
9450 break;
9451 case DW_AT_mutable:
9452 attrs->at_mutable = a;
9453 break;
9454 case DW_AT_ordering:
9455 attrs->at_ordering = a;
9456 break;
9457 case DW_AT_picture_string:
9458 attrs->at_picture_string = a;
9459 break;
9460 case DW_AT_prototyped:
9461 attrs->at_prototyped = a;
9462 break;
9463 case DW_AT_small:
9464 attrs->at_small = a;
9465 break;
9466 case DW_AT_segment:
9467 attrs->at_segment = a;
9468 break;
9469 case DW_AT_string_length:
9470 attrs->at_string_length = a;
9471 break;
9472 case DW_AT_threads_scaled:
9473 attrs->at_threads_scaled = a;
9474 break;
9475 case DW_AT_upper_bound:
9476 attrs->at_upper_bound = a;
9477 break;
9478 case DW_AT_use_location:
9479 attrs->at_use_location = a;
9480 break;
9481 case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
9482 attrs->at_use_UTF8 = a;
9483 break;
9484 case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
9485 attrs->at_variable_parameter = a;
9486 break;
9487 case DW_AT_virtuality:
9488 attrs->at_virtuality = a;
9489 break;
9490 case DW_AT_visibility:
9491 attrs->at_visibility = a;
9492 break;
9493 case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
9494 attrs->at_vtable_elem_location = a;
9495 break;
9496 default:
9497 break;
9502 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE, using an ordered subset of attributes. */
9504 static void
9505 die_checksum_ordered (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
9507 dw_die_ref c;
9508 dw_die_ref decl;
9509 struct checksum_attributes attrs;
9511 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('D');
9512 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (die->die_tag);
9514 memset (&attrs, 0, sizeof (attrs));
9516 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9517 if (decl != NULL)
9518 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, decl);
9519 collect_checksum_attributes (&attrs, die);
9521 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_name);
9522 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_accessibility);
9523 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_address_class);
9524 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_allocated);
9525 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_artificial);
9526 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_associated);
9527 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_binary_scale);
9528 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_offset);
9529 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_size);
9530 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_bit_stride);
9531 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_size);
9532 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_byte_stride);
9533 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_const_value);
9534 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_containing_type);
9535 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_count);
9536 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_location);
9537 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_data_member_location);
9538 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_scale);
9539 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_decimal_sign);
9540 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_default_value);
9541 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_digit_count);
9542 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr);
9543 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_list);
9544 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_discr_value);
9545 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_encoding);
9546 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_endianity);
9547 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_explicit);
9548 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_is_optional);
9549 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_location);
9550 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_lower_bound);
9551 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_mutable);
9552 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_ordering);
9553 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_picture_string);
9554 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_prototyped);
9555 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_small);
9556 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_segment);
9557 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_string_length);
9558 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_threads_scaled);
9559 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_upper_bound);
9560 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_location);
9561 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_use_UTF8);
9562 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_variable_parameter);
9563 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_virtuality);
9564 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_visibility);
9565 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_vtable_elem_location);
9566 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_type);
9567 CHECKSUM_ATTR (attrs.at_friend);
9569 /* Checksum the child DIEs, except for nested types and member functions. */
9570 c = die->die_child;
9571 if (c) do {
9572 dw_attr_ref name_attr;
9574 c = c->die_sib;
9575 name_attr = get_AT (c, DW_AT_name);
9576 if ((is_type_die (c) || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
9577 && name_attr != NULL)
9579 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 ('S');
9580 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (c->die_tag);
9581 CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (name_attr));
9583 else
9585 /* Mark this DIE so it gets processed when unmarking. */
9586 if (c->die_mark == 0)
9587 c->die_mark = -1;
9588 die_checksum_ordered (c, ctx, mark);
9590 } while (c != die->die_child);
9592 CHECKSUM_ULEB128 (0);
9595 #undef CHECKSUM
9596 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
9597 #undef CHECKSUM_ATTR
9598 #undef CHECKSUM_LEB128
9599 #undef CHECKSUM_ULEB128
9601 /* Generate the type signature for DIE. This is computed by generating an
9602 MD5 checksum over the DIE's tag, its relevant attributes, and its
9603 children. Attributes that are references to other DIEs are processed
9604 by recursion, using the MARK field to prevent infinite recursion.
9605 If the DIE is nested inside a namespace or another type, we also
9606 need to include that context in the signature. The lower 64 bits
9607 of the resulting MD5 checksum comprise the signature. */
9609 static void
9610 generate_type_signature (dw_die_ref die, comdat_type_node *type_node)
9612 int mark;
9613 const char *name;
9614 unsigned char checksum[16];
9615 struct md5_ctx ctx;
9616 dw_die_ref decl;
9618 name = get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name);
9619 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
9621 /* First, compute a signature for just the type name (and its surrounding
9622 context, if any. This is stored in the type unit DIE for link-time
9623 ODR (one-definition rule) checking. */
9625 if (is_cxx() && name != NULL)
9627 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9629 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
9630 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
9631 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
9633 md5_process_bytes (&die->die_tag, sizeof (die->die_tag), &ctx);
9634 md5_process_bytes (name, strlen (name) + 1, &ctx);
9635 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9637 add_AT_data8 (type_node->root_die, DW_AT_GNU_odr_signature, &checksum[8]);
9640 /* Next, compute the complete type signature. */
9642 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9643 mark = 1;
9644 die->die_mark = mark;
9646 /* Checksum the names of surrounding namespaces and structures. */
9647 if (decl != NULL && decl->die_parent != NULL)
9648 checksum_die_context (decl->die_parent, &ctx);
9650 /* Checksum the DIE and its children. */
9651 die_checksum_ordered (die, &ctx, &mark);
9652 unmark_all_dies (die);
9653 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9655 /* Store the signature in the type node and link the type DIE and the
9656 type node together. */
9657 memcpy (type_node->signature, &checksum[16 - DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE],
9658 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE);
9659 die->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
9660 type_node->type_die = die;
9662 /* If the DIE is a specification, link its declaration to the type node
9663 as well. */
9664 if (decl != NULL)
9665 decl->die_id.die_type_node = type_node;
9668 /* Do the location expressions look same? */
9669 static inline int
9670 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
9672 return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
9673 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
9674 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
9677 /* Do the values look the same? */
9678 static int
9679 same_dw_val_p (const dw_val_node *v1, const dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
9681 dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
9682 rtx r1, r2;
9684 if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
9685 return 0;
9687 switch (v1->val_class)
9689 case dw_val_class_const:
9690 return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
9691 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
9692 return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
9693 case dw_val_class_const_double:
9694 return v1->v.val_double.high == v2->v.val_double.high
9695 && v1->v.val_double.low == v2->v.val_double.low;
9696 case dw_val_class_vec:
9697 if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
9698 || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
9699 return 0;
9700 if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
9701 v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
9702 return 0;
9703 return 1;
9704 case dw_val_class_flag:
9705 return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
9706 case dw_val_class_str:
9707 return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
9709 case dw_val_class_addr:
9710 r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
9711 r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
9712 if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
9713 return 0;
9714 return !rtx_equal_p (r1, r2);
9716 case dw_val_class_offset:
9717 return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
9719 case dw_val_class_loc:
9720 for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
9721 loc1 && loc2;
9722 loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
9723 if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
9724 return 0;
9725 return !loc1 && !loc2;
9727 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
9728 return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
9730 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
9731 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
9732 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
9733 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
9734 case dw_val_class_macptr:
9735 return 1;
9737 case dw_val_class_file:
9738 return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
9740 case dw_val_class_data8:
9741 return !memcmp (v1->v.val_data8, v2->v.val_data8, 8);
9743 default:
9744 return 1;
9748 /* Do the attributes look the same? */
9750 static int
9751 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
9753 if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
9754 return 0;
9756 /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
9757 snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
9758 if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
9759 return 1;
9761 return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
9764 /* Do the dies look the same? */
9766 static int
9767 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
9769 dw_die_ref c1, c2;
9770 dw_attr_ref a1;
9771 unsigned ix;
9773 /* To avoid infinite recursion. */
9774 if (die1->die_mark)
9775 return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
9776 die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
9778 if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
9779 return 0;
9781 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
9782 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
9783 return 0;
9785 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1)
9786 if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
9787 return 0;
9789 c1 = die1->die_child;
9790 c2 = die2->die_child;
9791 if (! c1)
9793 if (c2)
9794 return 0;
9796 else
9797 for (;;)
9799 if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
9800 return 0;
9801 c1 = c1->die_sib;
9802 c2 = c2->die_sib;
9803 if (c1 == die1->die_child)
9805 if (c2 == die2->die_child)
9806 break;
9807 else
9808 return 0;
9812 return 1;
9815 /* Do the dies look the same? Wrapper around same_die_p. */
9817 static int
9818 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
9820 int mark = 0;
9821 int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
9823 unmark_all_dies (die1);
9824 unmark_all_dies (die2);
9826 return ret;
9829 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
9830 info section. */
9831 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
9833 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU. */
9834 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
9836 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
9837 children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly. */
9839 static void
9840 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
9842 const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
9843 const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
9844 char *name = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (base) + 64);
9845 char *p;
9846 int i, mark;
9847 unsigned char checksum[16];
9848 struct md5_ctx ctx;
9850 /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
9851 the name filename of the unit. */
9853 md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
9854 mark = 0;
9855 die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
9856 unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
9857 md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
9859 sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
9860 clean_symbol_name (name);
9862 p = name + strlen (name);
9863 for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
9865 sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
9866 p += 2;
9869 comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
9870 comdat_symbol_number = 0;
9873 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P. */
9875 static int
9876 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
9878 switch (die->die_tag)
9880 case DW_TAG_array_type:
9881 case DW_TAG_class_type:
9882 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
9883 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
9884 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
9885 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
9886 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
9887 case DW_TAG_string_type:
9888 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
9889 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
9890 case DW_TAG_union_type:
9891 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
9892 case DW_TAG_set_type:
9893 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
9894 case DW_TAG_base_type:
9895 case DW_TAG_const_type:
9896 case DW_TAG_file_type:
9897 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
9898 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
9899 case DW_TAG_typedef:
9900 return 1;
9901 default:
9902 return 0;
9906 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
9907 Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
9908 compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
9909 compilations (functions). */
9911 static int
9912 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
9914 /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
9915 we do for stabs. The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
9916 objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
9917 put the base types in a different comdat). jason 8/28/00 */
9919 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
9920 return 0;
9922 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
9923 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
9924 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type
9925 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
9926 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
9928 dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
9930 return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
9933 return is_type_die (c);
9936 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
9937 compilation unit. */
9939 static int
9940 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
9942 return (is_type_die (c)
9943 || is_declaration_die (c)
9944 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
9945 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_module);
9948 /* Returns true iff C is a compile-unit DIE. */
9950 static inline bool
9951 is_cu_die (dw_die_ref c)
9953 return c && c->die_tag == DW_TAG_compile_unit;
9956 static char *
9957 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
9959 char buf[256];
9961 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
9962 return xstrdup (buf);
9965 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE. */
9967 static void
9968 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
9970 dw_die_ref c;
9972 if (is_symbol_die (die))
9974 if (comdat_symbol_id)
9976 char *p = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
9978 sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
9979 comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
9980 die->die_id.die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
9982 else
9983 die->die_id.die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
9986 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
9989 struct cu_hash_table_entry
9991 dw_die_ref cu;
9992 unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
9993 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
9996 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs. */
9997 static hashval_t
9998 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
10000 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry =
10001 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of;
10003 return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_id.die_symbol);
10006 static int
10007 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
10009 const struct cu_hash_table_entry *const entry1 =
10010 (const struct cu_hash_table_entry *) of1;
10011 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
10013 return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_id.die_symbol, entry2->die_id.die_symbol);
10016 static void
10017 htab_cu_del (void *what)
10019 struct cu_hash_table_entry *next,
10020 *entry = (struct cu_hash_table_entry *) what;
10022 while (entry)
10024 next = entry->next;
10025 free (entry);
10026 entry = next;
10030 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
10031 accordingly. */
10032 static int
10033 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
10035 struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
10036 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
10038 dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
10040 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
10041 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
10042 INSERT);
10043 entry = *slot;
10045 for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
10047 if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
10048 break;
10051 if (entry)
10053 *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
10054 return 1;
10057 entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
10058 entry->cu = cu;
10059 entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
10060 entry->next = *slot;
10061 *slot = entry;
10063 return 0;
10066 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE. */
10067 static void
10068 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
10070 struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
10072 slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
10073 htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_id.die_symbol),
10074 NO_INSERT);
10075 entry = *slot;
10077 entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
10080 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
10081 additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
10082 bracketed by BINCL/EINCL. */
10084 static void
10085 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
10087 dw_die_ref c;
10088 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
10089 limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
10090 htab_t cu_hash_table;
10092 c = die->die_child;
10093 if (c) do {
10094 dw_die_ref prev = c;
10095 c = c->die_sib;
10096 while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
10097 || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
10099 dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
10101 /* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one. */
10102 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
10104 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
10105 unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
10106 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
10107 unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
10108 else
10109 add_child_die (unit, c);
10110 c = next;
10111 if (c == die->die_child)
10112 break;
10114 } while (c != die->die_child);
10116 #if 0
10117 /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
10118 to make sure that we leave every include file we enter. */
10119 gcc_assert (!unit);
10120 #endif
10122 assign_symbol_names (die);
10123 cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
10124 for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
10125 node;
10126 node = node->next)
10128 int is_dupl;
10130 compute_section_prefix (node->die);
10131 is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
10132 &comdat_symbol_number);
10133 assign_symbol_names (node->die);
10134 if (is_dupl)
10135 *pnode = node->next;
10136 else
10138 pnode = &node->next;
10139 record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
10140 comdat_symbol_number);
10143 htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
10146 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is a declaration. */
10148 static int
10149 is_declaration_die (dw_die_ref die)
10151 dw_attr_ref a;
10152 unsigned ix;
10154 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10155 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_declaration)
10156 return 1;
10158 return 0;
10161 /* Return non-zero if this DIE is nested inside a subprogram. */
10163 static int
10164 is_nested_in_subprogram (dw_die_ref die)
10166 dw_die_ref decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
10168 if (decl == NULL)
10169 decl = die;
10170 return local_scope_p (decl);
10173 /* Return non-zero if this DIE contains a defining declaration of a
10174 subprogram. */
10176 static int
10177 contains_subprogram_definition (dw_die_ref die)
10179 dw_die_ref c;
10181 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram && ! is_declaration_die (die))
10182 return 1;
10183 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, if (contains_subprogram_definition(c)) return 1);
10184 return 0;
10187 /* Return non-zero if this is a type DIE that should be moved to a
10188 COMDAT .debug_types section. */
10190 static int
10191 should_move_die_to_comdat (dw_die_ref die)
10193 switch (die->die_tag)
10195 case DW_TAG_class_type:
10196 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
10197 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
10198 case DW_TAG_union_type:
10199 /* Don't move declarations, inlined instances, or types nested in a
10200 subprogram. */
10201 if (is_declaration_die (die)
10202 || get_AT (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin)
10203 || is_nested_in_subprogram (die))
10204 return 0;
10205 /* A type definition should never contain a subprogram definition. */
10206 gcc_assert (!contains_subprogram_definition (die));
10207 return 1;
10208 case DW_TAG_array_type:
10209 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
10210 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
10211 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
10212 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
10213 case DW_TAG_string_type:
10214 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
10215 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
10216 case DW_TAG_set_type:
10217 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
10218 case DW_TAG_base_type:
10219 case DW_TAG_const_type:
10220 case DW_TAG_file_type:
10221 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
10222 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
10223 case DW_TAG_typedef:
10224 default:
10225 return 0;
10229 /* Make a clone of DIE. */
10231 static dw_die_ref
10232 clone_die (dw_die_ref die)
10234 dw_die_ref clone;
10235 dw_attr_ref a;
10236 unsigned ix;
10238 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
10239 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
10241 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10242 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
10244 return clone;
10247 /* Make a clone of the tree rooted at DIE. */
10249 static dw_die_ref
10250 clone_tree (dw_die_ref die)
10252 dw_die_ref c;
10253 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (die);
10255 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_child_die (clone, clone_tree(c)));
10257 return clone;
10260 /* Make a clone of DIE as a declaration. */
10262 static dw_die_ref
10263 clone_as_declaration (dw_die_ref die)
10265 dw_die_ref clone;
10266 dw_die_ref decl;
10267 dw_attr_ref a;
10268 unsigned ix;
10270 /* If the DIE is already a declaration, just clone it. */
10271 if (is_declaration_die (die))
10272 return clone_die (die);
10274 /* If the DIE is a specification, just clone its declaration DIE. */
10275 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
10276 if (decl != NULL)
10277 return clone_die (decl);
10279 clone = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
10280 clone->die_tag = die->die_tag;
10282 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10284 /* We don't want to copy over all attributes.
10285 For example we don't want DW_AT_byte_size because otherwise we will no
10286 longer have a declaration and GDB will treat it as a definition. */
10288 switch (a->dw_attr)
10290 case DW_AT_artificial:
10291 case DW_AT_containing_type:
10292 case DW_AT_external:
10293 case DW_AT_name:
10294 case DW_AT_type:
10295 case DW_AT_virtuality:
10296 case DW_AT_linkage_name:
10297 case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
10298 add_dwarf_attr (clone, a);
10299 break;
10300 case DW_AT_byte_size:
10301 default:
10302 break;
10306 if (die->die_id.die_type_node)
10307 add_AT_die_ref (clone, DW_AT_signature, die);
10309 add_AT_flag (clone, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
10310 return clone;
10313 /* Copy the declaration context to the new compile unit DIE. This includes
10314 any surrounding namespace or type declarations. If the DIE has an
10315 AT_specification attribute, it also includes attributes and children
10316 attached to the specification. */
10318 static void
10319 copy_declaration_context (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die)
10321 dw_die_ref decl;
10322 dw_die_ref new_decl;
10324 decl = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_specification);
10325 if (decl == NULL)
10326 decl = die;
10327 else
10329 unsigned ix;
10330 dw_die_ref c;
10331 dw_attr_ref a;
10333 /* Copy the type node pointer from the new DIE to the original
10334 declaration DIE so we can forward references later. */
10335 decl->die_id.die_type_node = die->die_id.die_type_node;
10337 remove_AT (die, DW_AT_specification);
10339 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, decl->die_attr, ix, a)
10341 if (a->dw_attr != DW_AT_name
10342 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_declaration
10343 && a->dw_attr != DW_AT_external)
10344 add_dwarf_attr (die, a);
10347 FOR_EACH_CHILD (decl, c, add_child_die (die, clone_tree(c)));
10350 if (decl->die_parent != NULL
10351 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
10352 && decl->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
10354 new_decl = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, decl, NULL);
10355 if (new_decl != NULL)
10357 remove_AT (new_decl, DW_AT_signature);
10358 add_AT_specification (die, new_decl);
10363 /* Generate the skeleton ancestor tree for the given NODE, then clone
10364 the DIE and add the clone into the tree. */
10366 static void
10367 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (skeleton_chain_node *node)
10369 if (node->new_die != NULL)
10370 return;
10372 node->new_die = clone_as_declaration (node->old_die);
10374 if (node->parent != NULL)
10376 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (node->parent);
10377 add_child_die (node->parent->new_die, node->new_die);
10381 /* Generate a skeleton tree of DIEs containing any declarations that are
10382 found in the original tree. We traverse the tree looking for declaration
10383 DIEs, and construct the skeleton from the bottom up whenever we find one. */
10385 static void
10386 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (skeleton_chain_node *parent)
10388 skeleton_chain_node node;
10389 dw_die_ref c;
10390 dw_die_ref first;
10391 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
10392 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
10394 node.parent = parent;
10396 first = c = parent->old_die->die_child;
10397 if (c)
10398 next = c->die_sib;
10399 if (c) do {
10400 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
10401 prev = c;
10402 c = next;
10403 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
10404 node.old_die = c;
10405 node.new_die = NULL;
10406 if (is_declaration_die (c))
10408 /* Clone the existing DIE, move the original to the skeleton
10409 tree (which is in the main CU), and put the clone, with
10410 all the original's children, where the original came from. */
10411 dw_die_ref clone = clone_die (c);
10412 move_all_children (c, clone);
10414 replace_child (c, clone, prev);
10415 generate_skeleton_ancestor_tree (parent);
10416 add_child_die (parent->new_die, c);
10417 node.new_die = c;
10418 c = clone;
10420 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
10421 } while (next != NULL);
10424 /* Wrapper function for generate_skeleton_bottom_up. */
10426 static dw_die_ref
10427 generate_skeleton (dw_die_ref die)
10429 skeleton_chain_node node;
10431 node.old_die = die;
10432 node.new_die = NULL;
10433 node.parent = NULL;
10435 /* If this type definition is nested inside another type,
10436 always leave at least a declaration in its place. */
10437 if (die->die_parent != NULL && is_type_die (die->die_parent))
10438 node.new_die = clone_as_declaration (die);
10440 generate_skeleton_bottom_up (&node);
10441 return node.new_die;
10444 /* Remove the DIE from its parent, possibly replacing it with a cloned
10445 declaration. The original DIE will be moved to a new compile unit
10446 so that existing references to it follow it to the new location. If
10447 any of the original DIE's descendants is a declaration, we need to
10448 replace the original DIE with a skeleton tree and move the
10449 declarations back into the skeleton tree. */
10451 static dw_die_ref
10452 remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
10454 dw_die_ref skeleton;
10456 skeleton = generate_skeleton (child);
10457 if (skeleton == NULL)
10458 remove_child_with_prev (child, prev);
10459 else
10461 skeleton->die_id.die_type_node = child->die_id.die_type_node;
10462 replace_child (child, skeleton, prev);
10465 return skeleton;
10468 /* Traverse the DIE and set up additional .debug_types sections for each
10469 type worthy of being placed in a COMDAT section. */
10471 static void
10472 break_out_comdat_types (dw_die_ref die)
10474 dw_die_ref c;
10475 dw_die_ref first;
10476 dw_die_ref prev = NULL;
10477 dw_die_ref next = NULL;
10478 dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
10480 first = c = die->die_child;
10481 if (c)
10482 next = c->die_sib;
10483 if (c) do {
10484 if (prev == NULL || prev->die_sib == c)
10485 prev = c;
10486 c = next;
10487 next = (c == first ? NULL : c->die_sib);
10488 if (should_move_die_to_comdat (c))
10490 dw_die_ref replacement;
10491 comdat_type_node_ref type_node;
10493 /* Create a new type unit DIE as the root for the new tree, and
10494 add it to the list of comdat types. */
10495 unit = new_die (DW_TAG_type_unit, NULL, NULL);
10496 add_AT_unsigned (unit, DW_AT_language,
10497 get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language));
10498 type_node = ggc_alloc_cleared_comdat_type_node ();
10499 type_node->root_die = unit;
10500 type_node->next = comdat_type_list;
10501 comdat_type_list = type_node;
10503 /* Generate the type signature. */
10504 generate_type_signature (c, type_node);
10506 /* Copy the declaration context, attributes, and children of the
10507 declaration into the new compile unit DIE. */
10508 copy_declaration_context (unit, c);
10510 /* Remove this DIE from the main CU. */
10511 replacement = remove_child_or_replace_with_skeleton (c, prev);
10513 /* Break out nested types into their own type units. */
10514 break_out_comdat_types (c);
10516 /* Add the DIE to the new compunit. */
10517 add_child_die (unit, c);
10519 if (replacement != NULL)
10520 c = replacement;
10522 else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace
10523 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
10524 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
10525 || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type)
10527 /* Look for nested types that can be broken out. */
10528 break_out_comdat_types (c);
10530 } while (next != NULL);
10533 /* Structure to map a DIE in one CU to its copy in a comdat type unit. */
10535 struct decl_table_entry
10537 dw_die_ref orig;
10538 dw_die_ref copy;
10541 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of copied declarations. */
10543 static hashval_t
10544 htab_decl_hash (const void *of)
10546 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry =
10547 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of;
10549 return htab_hash_pointer (entry->orig);
10552 static int
10553 htab_decl_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
10555 const struct decl_table_entry *const entry1 =
10556 (const struct decl_table_entry *) of1;
10557 const struct die_struct *const entry2 = (const struct die_struct *) of2;
10559 return entry1->orig == entry2;
10562 static void
10563 htab_decl_del (void *what)
10565 struct decl_table_entry *entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) what;
10567 free (entry);
10570 /* Copy DIE and its ancestors, up to, but not including, the compile unit
10571 or type unit entry, to a new tree. Adds the new tree to UNIT and returns
10572 a pointer to the copy of DIE. If DECL_TABLE is provided, it is used
10573 to check if the ancestor has already been copied into UNIT. */
10575 static dw_die_ref
10576 copy_ancestor_tree (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
10578 dw_die_ref parent = die->die_parent;
10579 dw_die_ref new_parent = unit;
10580 dw_die_ref copy;
10581 void **slot = NULL;
10582 struct decl_table_entry *entry = NULL;
10584 if (decl_table)
10586 /* Check if the entry has already been copied to UNIT. */
10587 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, die,
10588 htab_hash_pointer (die), INSERT);
10589 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
10591 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
10592 return entry->copy;
10595 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that DIE has been copied to UNIT. */
10596 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
10597 entry->orig = die;
10598 entry->copy = NULL;
10599 *slot = entry;
10602 if (parent != NULL)
10604 dw_die_ref spec = get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification);
10605 if (spec != NULL)
10606 parent = spec;
10607 if (parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
10608 && parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
10609 new_parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, parent, decl_table);
10612 copy = clone_as_declaration (die);
10613 add_child_die (new_parent, copy);
10615 if (decl_table != NULL)
10617 /* Record the pointer to the copy. */
10618 entry->copy = copy;
10621 return copy;
10624 /* Walk the DIE and its children, looking for references to incomplete
10625 or trivial types that are unmarked (i.e., that are not in the current
10626 type_unit). */
10628 static void
10629 copy_decls_walk (dw_die_ref unit, dw_die_ref die, htab_t decl_table)
10631 dw_die_ref c;
10632 dw_attr_ref a;
10633 unsigned ix;
10635 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10637 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
10639 dw_die_ref targ = AT_ref (a);
10640 comdat_type_node_ref type_node = targ->die_id.die_type_node;
10641 void **slot;
10642 struct decl_table_entry *entry;
10644 if (targ->die_mark != 0 || type_node != NULL)
10645 continue;
10647 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_table, targ,
10648 htab_hash_pointer (targ), INSERT);
10650 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
10652 /* TARG has already been copied, so we just need to
10653 modify the reference to point to the copy. */
10654 entry = (struct decl_table_entry *) *slot;
10655 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = entry->copy;
10657 else
10659 dw_die_ref parent = unit;
10660 dw_die_ref copy = clone_tree (targ);
10662 /* Make sure the cloned tree is marked as part of the
10663 type unit. */
10664 mark_dies (copy);
10666 /* Record in DECL_TABLE that TARG has been copied.
10667 Need to do this now, before the recursive call,
10668 because DECL_TABLE may be expanded and SLOT
10669 would no longer be a valid pointer. */
10670 entry = XCNEW (struct decl_table_entry);
10671 entry->orig = targ;
10672 entry->copy = copy;
10673 *slot = entry;
10675 /* If TARG has surrounding context, copy its ancestor tree
10676 into the new type unit. */
10677 if (targ->die_parent != NULL
10678 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_compile_unit
10679 && targ->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_type_unit)
10680 parent = copy_ancestor_tree (unit, targ->die_parent,
10681 decl_table);
10683 add_child_die (parent, copy);
10684 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = copy;
10686 /* Make sure the newly-copied DIE is walked. If it was
10687 installed in a previously-added context, it won't
10688 get visited otherwise. */
10689 if (parent != unit)
10691 /* Find the highest point of the newly-added tree,
10692 mark each node along the way, and walk from there. */
10693 parent->die_mark = 1;
10694 while (parent->die_parent
10695 && parent->die_parent->die_mark == 0)
10697 parent = parent->die_parent;
10698 parent->die_mark = 1;
10700 copy_decls_walk (unit, parent, decl_table);
10706 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, copy_decls_walk (unit, c, decl_table));
10709 /* Copy declarations for "unworthy" types into the new comdat section.
10710 Incomplete types, modified types, and certain other types aren't broken
10711 out into comdat sections of their own, so they don't have a signature,
10712 and we need to copy the declaration into the same section so that we
10713 don't have an external reference. */
10715 static void
10716 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (dw_die_ref unit)
10718 htab_t decl_table;
10720 mark_dies (unit);
10721 decl_table = htab_create (10, htab_decl_hash, htab_decl_eq, htab_decl_del);
10722 copy_decls_walk (unit, unit, decl_table);
10723 htab_delete (decl_table);
10724 unmark_dies (unit);
10727 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
10728 effect of speeding up access to siblings. To save some space,
10729 avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children. */
10731 static void
10732 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
10734 dw_die_ref c;
10736 if (! die->die_child)
10737 return;
10739 if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
10740 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
10742 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
10745 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children. */
10747 static void
10748 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
10750 dw_die_ref c;
10751 dw_attr_ref a;
10752 unsigned ix;
10754 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10755 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
10756 output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
10758 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
10761 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
10762 abbreviation table. This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
10763 a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry. The children of each
10764 die are visited recursively. */
10766 static void
10767 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
10769 unsigned long abbrev_id;
10770 unsigned int n_alloc;
10771 dw_die_ref c;
10772 dw_attr_ref a;
10773 unsigned ix;
10775 /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
10776 DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked). */
10777 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10778 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
10779 && AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
10781 gcc_assert (use_debug_types || AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol);
10782 set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
10785 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
10787 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
10788 dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
10789 unsigned ix;
10790 bool ok = true;
10792 if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
10793 continue;
10794 if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
10795 continue;
10797 if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
10798 != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
10799 continue;
10801 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a)
10803 abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
10804 if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
10805 || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
10807 ok = false;
10808 break;
10811 if (ok)
10812 break;
10815 if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
10817 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
10819 n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
10820 abbrev_die_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (dw_die_ref, abbrev_die_table,
10821 n_alloc);
10823 memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
10824 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
10825 abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
10828 ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
10829 abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
10832 die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
10833 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
10836 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE. */
10838 static int
10839 constant_size (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT value)
10841 int log;
10843 if (value == 0)
10844 log = 0;
10845 else
10846 log = floor_log2 (value);
10848 log = log / 8;
10849 log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
10851 return log;
10854 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
10855 .debug_info section. */
10857 static unsigned long
10858 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
10860 unsigned long size = 0;
10861 dw_attr_ref a;
10862 unsigned ix;
10864 size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
10865 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
10867 switch (AT_class (a))
10869 case dw_val_class_addr:
10870 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10871 break;
10872 case dw_val_class_offset:
10873 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10874 break;
10875 case dw_val_class_loc:
10877 unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
10879 /* Block length. */
10880 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10881 size += size_of_uleb128 (lsize);
10882 else
10883 size += constant_size (lsize);
10884 size += lsize;
10886 break;
10887 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
10888 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10889 break;
10890 case dw_val_class_range_list:
10891 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10892 break;
10893 case dw_val_class_const:
10894 size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
10895 break;
10896 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
10897 size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
10898 break;
10899 case dw_val_class_const_double:
10900 size += 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR;
10901 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
10902 size++; /* block */
10903 break;
10904 case dw_val_class_vec:
10905 size += constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10906 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size)
10907 + a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
10908 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size; /* block */
10909 break;
10910 case dw_val_class_flag:
10911 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
10912 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
10913 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
10914 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
10915 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
10916 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
10917 the same abbrev entry. */
10918 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
10919 else
10920 size += 1;
10921 break;
10922 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
10923 if (AT_ref_external (a))
10925 /* In DWARF4, we use DW_FORM_ref_sig8; for earlier versions
10926 we use DW_FORM_ref_addr. In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr
10927 is sized by target address length, whereas in DWARF3
10928 it's always sized as an offset. */
10929 if (use_debug_types)
10930 size += DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE;
10931 else if (dwarf_version == 2)
10932 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10933 else
10934 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10936 else
10937 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10938 break;
10939 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
10940 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10941 break;
10942 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
10943 size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
10944 break;
10945 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
10946 case dw_val_class_macptr:
10947 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10948 break;
10949 case dw_val_class_str:
10950 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
10951 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10952 else
10953 size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
10954 break;
10955 case dw_val_class_file:
10956 size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
10957 break;
10958 case dw_val_class_data8:
10959 size += 8;
10960 break;
10961 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
10962 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
10963 break;
10964 default:
10965 gcc_unreachable ();
10969 return size;
10972 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE. Visits the
10973 DIE's children recursively. Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
10974 each time through. Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
10975 die_offset field in each DIE. */
10977 static void
10978 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
10980 dw_die_ref c;
10982 gcc_assert (die->die_offset == 0
10983 || (unsigned long int) die->die_offset == next_die_offset);
10984 die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
10985 next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
10987 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
10989 if (die->die_child != NULL)
10990 /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists. */
10991 next_die_offset += 1;
10994 /* Size just the base type children at the start of the CU.
10995 This is needed because build_abbrev needs to size locs
10996 and sizing of type based stack ops needs to know die_offset
10997 values for the base types. */
10999 static void
11000 calc_base_type_die_sizes (void)
11002 unsigned long die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11003 unsigned int i;
11004 dw_die_ref base_type;
11005 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
11006 dw_die_ref prev = comp_unit_die ()->die_child;
11007 #endif
11009 die_offset += size_of_die (comp_unit_die ());
11010 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_die_ref, base_types, i, base_type); i++)
11012 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
11013 gcc_assert (base_type->die_offset == 0
11014 && prev->die_sib == base_type
11015 && base_type->die_child == NULL
11016 && base_type->die_abbrev);
11017 prev = base_type;
11018 #endif
11019 base_type->die_offset = die_offset;
11020 die_offset += size_of_die (base_type);
11024 /* Set the marks for a die and its children. We do this so
11025 that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
11026 DIEs in the same CU will be marked. We used to clear out the offset
11027 and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems. */
11029 static void
11030 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
11032 dw_die_ref c;
11034 gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
11036 die->die_mark = 1;
11037 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
11040 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children. */
11042 static void
11043 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
11045 dw_die_ref c;
11047 if (! use_debug_types)
11048 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
11050 die->die_mark = 0;
11051 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
11054 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies. */
11056 static void
11057 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
11059 dw_die_ref c;
11060 dw_attr_ref a;
11061 unsigned ix;
11063 if (!die->die_mark)
11064 return;
11065 die->die_mark = 0;
11067 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
11069 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
11070 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
11071 unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
11074 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
11075 generated for the compilation unit. */
11077 static unsigned long
11078 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
11080 unsigned long size;
11081 unsigned i;
11082 pubname_ref p;
11084 size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
11085 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, names, i, p)
11086 if (names != pubtype_table
11087 || p->die->die_offset != 0
11088 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
11089 size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
11091 size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
11092 return size;
11095 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section. */
11097 static unsigned long
11098 size_of_aranges (void)
11100 unsigned long size;
11102 size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
11104 /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit. */
11105 if (text_section_used)
11106 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11107 if (cold_text_section_used)
11108 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11109 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
11111 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
11113 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
11115 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
11117 if (!fde->in_std_section)
11118 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11119 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
11120 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11124 /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table. */
11125 size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11126 return size;
11129 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value. */
11131 static enum dwarf_form
11132 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
11134 switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
11136 case dw_val_class_addr:
11137 /* Only very few attributes allow DW_FORM_addr. */
11138 switch (a->dw_attr)
11140 case DW_AT_low_pc:
11141 case DW_AT_high_pc:
11142 case DW_AT_entry_pc:
11143 case DW_AT_trampoline:
11144 return DW_FORM_addr;
11145 default:
11146 break;
11148 switch (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
11150 case 1:
11151 return DW_FORM_data1;
11152 case 2:
11153 return DW_FORM_data2;
11154 case 4:
11155 return DW_FORM_data4;
11156 case 8:
11157 return DW_FORM_data8;
11158 default:
11159 gcc_unreachable ();
11161 case dw_val_class_range_list:
11162 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
11163 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11164 return DW_FORM_sec_offset;
11165 /* FALLTHRU */
11166 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
11167 case dw_val_class_offset:
11168 switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
11170 case 4:
11171 return DW_FORM_data4;
11172 case 8:
11173 return DW_FORM_data8;
11174 default:
11175 gcc_unreachable ();
11177 case dw_val_class_loc:
11178 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11179 return DW_FORM_exprloc;
11180 switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
11182 case 1:
11183 return DW_FORM_block1;
11184 case 2:
11185 return DW_FORM_block2;
11186 default:
11187 gcc_unreachable ();
11189 case dw_val_class_const:
11190 return DW_FORM_sdata;
11191 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
11192 switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
11194 case 1:
11195 return DW_FORM_data1;
11196 case 2:
11197 return DW_FORM_data2;
11198 case 4:
11199 return DW_FORM_data4;
11200 case 8:
11201 return DW_FORM_data8;
11202 default:
11203 gcc_unreachable ();
11205 case dw_val_class_const_double:
11206 switch (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
11208 case 8:
11209 return DW_FORM_data2;
11210 case 16:
11211 return DW_FORM_data4;
11212 case 32:
11213 return DW_FORM_data8;
11214 case 64:
11215 default:
11216 return DW_FORM_block1;
11218 case dw_val_class_vec:
11219 switch (constant_size (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
11220 * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size))
11222 case 1:
11223 return DW_FORM_block1;
11224 case 2:
11225 return DW_FORM_block2;
11226 case 4:
11227 return DW_FORM_block4;
11228 default:
11229 gcc_unreachable ();
11231 case dw_val_class_flag:
11232 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11234 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
11235 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
11236 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
11237 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
11238 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
11239 the same abbrev entry. */
11240 gcc_assert (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag == 1);
11241 return DW_FORM_flag_present;
11243 return DW_FORM_flag;
11244 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
11245 if (AT_ref_external (a))
11246 return use_debug_types ? DW_FORM_ref_sig8 : DW_FORM_ref_addr;
11247 else
11248 return DW_FORM_ref;
11249 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
11250 return DW_FORM_data;
11251 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
11252 return DW_FORM_addr;
11253 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
11254 case dw_val_class_macptr:
11255 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? DW_FORM_sec_offset : DW_FORM_data;
11256 case dw_val_class_str:
11257 return AT_string_form (a);
11258 case dw_val_class_file:
11259 switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
11261 case 1:
11262 return DW_FORM_data1;
11263 case 2:
11264 return DW_FORM_data2;
11265 case 4:
11266 return DW_FORM_data4;
11267 default:
11268 gcc_unreachable ();
11271 case dw_val_class_data8:
11272 return DW_FORM_data8;
11274 default:
11275 gcc_unreachable ();
11279 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value. */
11281 static void
11282 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
11284 enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
11286 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
11289 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
11290 table. */
11292 static void
11293 output_abbrev_section (void)
11295 unsigned long abbrev_id;
11297 if (abbrev_die_table_in_use == 1)
11298 return;
11300 for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
11302 dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
11303 unsigned ix;
11304 dw_attr_ref a_attr;
11306 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
11307 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
11308 dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
11310 if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
11311 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
11312 else
11313 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
11315 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
11316 ix++)
11318 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
11319 dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
11320 output_value_format (a_attr);
11323 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
11324 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
11327 /* Terminate the table. */
11328 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
11331 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU. */
11333 static inline void
11334 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
11336 char *sym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
11338 if (sym == 0)
11339 return;
11341 if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
11342 /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
11343 .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
11344 will break. */
11345 targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
11347 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
11350 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
11351 expression. */
11353 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
11354 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
11355 const char *section)
11357 dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_loc_list_node ();
11359 retlist->begin = begin;
11360 retlist->end = end;
11361 retlist->expr = expr;
11362 retlist->section = section;
11364 return retlist;
11367 /* Generate a new internal symbol for this location list node, if it
11368 hasn't got one yet. */
11370 static inline void
11371 gen_llsym (dw_loc_list_ref list)
11373 gcc_assert (!list->ll_symbol);
11374 list->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
11377 /* Output the location list given to us. */
11379 static void
11380 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
11382 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
11384 if (list_head->emitted)
11385 return;
11386 list_head->emitted = true;
11388 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
11390 /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression. */
11391 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
11393 unsigned long size;
11394 /* Don't output an entry that starts and ends at the same address. */
11395 if (strcmp (curr->begin, curr->end) == 0)
11396 continue;
11397 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
11399 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
11400 "Location list begin address (%s)",
11401 list_head->ll_symbol);
11402 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
11403 "Location list end address (%s)",
11404 list_head->ll_symbol);
11406 else
11408 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
11409 "Location list begin address (%s)",
11410 list_head->ll_symbol);
11411 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
11412 "Location list end address (%s)",
11413 list_head->ll_symbol);
11415 size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
11417 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
11418 gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
11419 dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
11421 output_loc_sequence (curr->expr, -1);
11424 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
11425 "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
11426 list_head->ll_symbol);
11427 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
11428 "Location list terminator end (%s)",
11429 list_head->ll_symbol);
11432 /* Output a type signature. */
11434 static inline void
11435 output_signature (const char *sig, const char *name)
11437 int i;
11439 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11440 dw2_asm_output_data (1, sig[i], i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
11443 /* Output the DIE and its attributes. Called recursively to generate
11444 the definitions of each child DIE. */
11446 static void
11447 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
11449 dw_attr_ref a;
11450 dw_die_ref c;
11451 unsigned long size;
11452 unsigned ix;
11454 /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
11455 them to point to. */
11456 if (! use_debug_types && die->die_id.die_symbol)
11457 output_die_symbol (die);
11459 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (%#lx) %s)",
11460 (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
11461 dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
11463 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
11465 const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
11467 switch (AT_class (a))
11469 case dw_val_class_addr:
11470 dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
11471 break;
11473 case dw_val_class_offset:
11474 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
11475 "%s", name);
11476 break;
11478 case dw_val_class_range_list:
11480 char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
11482 sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
11483 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
11484 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
11485 debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
11486 *p = '\0';
11488 break;
11490 case dw_val_class_loc:
11491 size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
11493 /* Output the block length for this list of location operations. */
11494 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11495 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "%s", name);
11496 else
11497 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
11499 output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a), -1);
11500 break;
11502 case dw_val_class_const:
11503 /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
11504 used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
11505 extend. Gdb 5.x does sign extend. */
11506 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
11507 break;
11509 case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
11510 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
11511 AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
11512 break;
11514 case dw_val_class_const_double:
11516 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
11518 if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64)
11519 dw2_asm_output_data (1,
11520 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
11521 / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
11522 NULL);
11524 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
11526 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
11527 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
11529 else
11531 first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.low;
11532 second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_double.high;
11535 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
11536 first, name);
11537 dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
11538 second, NULL);
11540 break;
11542 case dw_val_class_vec:
11544 unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
11545 unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
11546 unsigned int i;
11547 unsigned char *p;
11549 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (len * elt_size),
11550 len * elt_size, "%s", name);
11551 if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
11553 elt_size /= 2;
11554 len *= 2;
11556 for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
11557 i < len;
11558 i++, p += elt_size)
11559 dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
11560 "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
11561 break;
11564 case dw_val_class_flag:
11565 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
11567 /* Currently all add_AT_flag calls pass in 1 as last argument,
11568 so DW_FORM_flag_present can be used. If that ever changes,
11569 we'll need to use DW_FORM_flag and have some optimization
11570 in build_abbrev_table that will change those to
11571 DW_FORM_flag_present if it is set to 1 in all DIEs using
11572 the same abbrev entry. */
11573 gcc_assert (AT_flag (a) == 1);
11574 if (flag_debug_asm)
11575 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t\t\t%s %s\n",
11576 ASM_COMMENT_START, name);
11577 break;
11579 dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
11580 break;
11582 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
11584 char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
11586 gcc_assert (sym);
11587 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
11588 "%s", name);
11590 break;
11592 case dw_val_class_die_ref:
11593 if (AT_ref_external (a))
11595 if (use_debug_types)
11597 comdat_type_node_ref type_node =
11598 AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_type_node;
11600 gcc_assert (type_node);
11601 output_signature (type_node->signature, name);
11603 else
11605 char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_id.die_symbol;
11606 int size;
11608 gcc_assert (sym);
11609 /* In DWARF2, DW_FORM_ref_addr is sized by target address
11610 length, whereas in DWARF3 it's always sized as an
11611 offset. */
11612 if (dwarf_version == 2)
11613 size = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
11614 else
11615 size = DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
11616 dw2_asm_output_offset (size, sym, debug_info_section, "%s",
11617 name);
11620 else
11622 gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
11623 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
11624 "%s", name);
11626 break;
11628 case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
11630 char l1[20];
11632 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
11633 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
11634 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
11635 "%s", name);
11637 break;
11639 case dw_val_class_vms_delta:
11640 dw2_asm_output_vms_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11641 AT_vms_delta2 (a), AT_vms_delta1 (a),
11642 "%s", name);
11643 break;
11645 case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
11646 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
11647 break;
11649 case dw_val_class_lineptr:
11650 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
11651 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
11652 break;
11654 case dw_val_class_macptr:
11655 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
11656 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
11657 break;
11659 case dw_val_class_str:
11660 if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
11661 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11662 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
11663 debug_str_section,
11664 "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
11665 else
11666 dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
11667 break;
11669 case dw_val_class_file:
11671 int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
11673 dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
11674 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
11675 break;
11678 case dw_val_class_data8:
11680 int i;
11682 for (i = 0; i < 8; i++)
11683 dw2_asm_output_data (1, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_data8[i],
11684 i == 0 ? "%s" : NULL, name);
11685 break;
11688 default:
11689 gcc_unreachable ();
11693 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
11695 /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list. */
11696 if (die->die_child != NULL)
11697 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE %#lx",
11698 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
11701 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
11702 .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions. */
11704 static void
11705 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
11707 int ver = dwarf_version;
11709 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11710 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11711 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11712 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
11713 next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
11714 "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
11715 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF version number");
11716 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
11717 debug_abbrev_section,
11718 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
11719 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
11722 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children. */
11724 static void
11725 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
11727 const char *secname;
11728 char *oldsym, *tmp;
11730 /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones. */
11731 if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
11732 return;
11734 /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
11735 about the compilation unit. Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
11736 will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm'
11737 will then complain when examining the file. First mark all the DIEs in
11738 this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11739 mark_dies (die);
11741 build_abbrev_table (die);
11743 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11744 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11745 calc_die_sizes (die);
11747 oldsym = die->die_id.die_symbol;
11748 if (oldsym)
11750 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, strlen (oldsym) + 24);
11752 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
11753 secname = tmp;
11754 die->die_id.die_symbol = NULL;
11755 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11757 else
11759 switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
11760 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
11761 info_section_emitted = true;
11764 /* Output debugging information. */
11765 output_compilation_unit_header ();
11766 output_die (die);
11768 /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
11769 output_pubnames. */
11770 if (oldsym)
11772 unmark_dies (die);
11773 die->die_id.die_symbol = oldsym;
11777 /* Output a comdat type unit DIE and its children. */
11779 static void
11780 output_comdat_type_unit (comdat_type_node *node)
11782 const char *secname;
11783 char *tmp;
11784 int i;
11785 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11786 tree comdat_key;
11787 #endif
11789 /* First mark all the DIEs in this CU so we know which get local refs. */
11790 mark_dies (node->root_die);
11792 build_abbrev_table (node->root_die);
11794 /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets. */
11795 next_die_offset = DWARF_COMDAT_TYPE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
11796 calc_die_sizes (node->root_die);
11798 #if defined (OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF)
11799 secname = ".debug_types";
11800 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 4 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11801 sprintf (tmp, "wt.");
11802 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11803 sprintf (tmp + 3 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11804 comdat_key = get_identifier (tmp);
11805 targetm.asm_out.named_section (secname,
11806 SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_LINKONCE,
11807 comdat_key);
11808 #else
11809 tmp = XALLOCAVEC (char, 18 + DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE * 2);
11810 sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wt.");
11811 for (i = 0; i < DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE; i++)
11812 sprintf (tmp + 17 + i * 2, "%02x", node->signature[i] & 0xff);
11813 secname = tmp;
11814 switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
11815 #endif
11817 /* Output debugging information. */
11818 output_compilation_unit_header ();
11819 output_signature (node->signature, "Type Signature");
11820 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, node->type_die->die_offset,
11821 "Offset to Type DIE");
11822 output_die (node->root_die);
11824 unmark_dies (node->root_die);
11827 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl. */
11829 static const char *
11830 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
11832 if (DECL_NAMELESS (decl))
11833 return NULL;
11834 return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
11837 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate. */
11839 static void
11840 add_pubname_string (const char *str, dw_die_ref die)
11842 if (targetm.want_debug_pub_sections)
11844 pubname_entry e;
11846 e.die = die;
11847 e.name = xstrdup (str);
11848 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
11852 static void
11853 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11855 if (targetm.want_debug_pub_sections && TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11857 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11858 if (name)
11859 add_pubname_string (name, die);
11863 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate. */
11865 static void
11866 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
11868 pubname_entry e;
11870 if (!targetm.want_debug_pub_sections)
11871 return;
11873 e.name = NULL;
11874 if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11875 || is_cu_die (die->die_parent))
11876 && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
11878 e.die = die;
11879 if (TYPE_P (decl))
11881 if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
11883 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11884 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TYPE_NAME (decl));
11885 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
11886 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
11887 e.name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
11888 else
11889 e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
11892 else
11894 e.name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
11895 if (e.name)
11896 e.name = xstrdup (e.name);
11899 /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
11900 it to the table. */
11901 if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
11902 VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
11906 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
11907 visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions. */
11909 static void
11910 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
11912 unsigned i;
11913 unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
11914 pubname_ref pub;
11916 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11917 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11918 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11919 if (names == pubname_table)
11920 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11921 "Length of Public Names Info");
11922 else
11923 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
11924 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
11925 /* Version number for pubnames/pubtypes is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
11926 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
11927 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11928 debug_info_section,
11929 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11930 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
11931 "Compilation Unit Length");
11933 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, names, i, pub)
11935 /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU. */
11936 if (names == pubname_table)
11937 gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
11939 if (names != pubtype_table
11940 || pub->die->die_offset != 0
11941 || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
11943 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
11944 "DIE offset");
11946 dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
11950 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
11953 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
11954 Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
11955 text section generated for this compilation unit. */
11957 static void
11958 output_aranges (unsigned long aranges_length)
11960 unsigned i;
11962 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
11963 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
11964 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
11965 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
11966 "Length of Address Ranges Info");
11967 /* Version number for aranges is still 2, even in DWARF3. */
11968 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 2, "DWARF Version");
11969 dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
11970 debug_info_section,
11971 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
11972 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
11973 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
11975 /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here. */
11976 if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
11978 /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
11979 pointer size. */
11980 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
11981 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
11982 for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
11983 dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
11986 /* It is necessary not to output these entries if the sections were
11987 not used; if the sections were not used, the length will be 0 and
11988 the address may end up as 0 if the section is discarded by ld
11989 --gc-sections, leaving an invalid (0, 0) entry that can be
11990 confused with the terminator. */
11991 if (text_section_used)
11993 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
11994 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
11995 text_section_label, "Length");
11997 if (cold_text_section_used)
11999 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
12000 "Address");
12001 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
12002 cold_text_section_label, "Length");
12005 if (have_multiple_function_sections)
12007 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
12009 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
12011 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
12013 if (!fde->in_std_section)
12015 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
12016 "Address");
12017 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_end,
12018 fde->dw_fde_begin, "Length");
12020 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
12022 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
12023 "Address");
12024 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_second_end,
12025 fde->dw_fde_second_begin, "Length");
12030 /* Output the terminator words. */
12031 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
12032 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
12035 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges. Return the offset at which it
12036 was placed. */
12038 static unsigned int
12039 add_ranges_num (int num)
12041 unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
12043 if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
12045 ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12046 ranges_table = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_struct, ranges_table,
12047 ranges_table_allocated);
12048 memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
12049 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
12052 ranges_table[in_use].num = num;
12053 ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
12055 return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
12058 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a block, or a
12059 range terminator if BLOCK is NULL. */
12061 static unsigned int
12062 add_ranges (const_tree block)
12064 return add_ranges_num (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
12067 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges corresponding to a pair of
12068 labels. */
12070 static void
12071 add_ranges_by_labels (dw_die_ref die, const char *begin, const char *end,
12072 bool *added)
12074 unsigned int in_use = ranges_by_label_in_use;
12075 unsigned int offset;
12077 if (in_use == ranges_by_label_allocated)
12079 ranges_by_label_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
12080 ranges_by_label = GGC_RESIZEVEC (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct,
12081 ranges_by_label,
12082 ranges_by_label_allocated);
12083 memset (ranges_by_label + ranges_by_label_in_use, 0,
12084 RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT
12085 * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_by_label_struct));
12088 ranges_by_label[in_use].begin = begin;
12089 ranges_by_label[in_use].end = end;
12090 ranges_by_label_in_use = in_use + 1;
12092 offset = add_ranges_num (-(int)in_use - 1);
12093 if (!*added)
12095 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, offset);
12096 *added = true;
12100 static void
12101 output_ranges (void)
12103 unsigned i;
12104 static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset %#x";
12105 const char *fmt = start_fmt;
12107 for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
12109 int block_num = ranges_table[i].num;
12111 if (block_num > 0)
12113 char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12114 char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12116 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
12117 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
12119 /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
12120 unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
12121 base of the text section. */
12122 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
12124 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
12125 text_section_label,
12126 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
12127 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
12128 text_section_label, NULL);
12131 /* Otherwise, the compilation unit base address is zero,
12132 which allows us to use absolute addresses, and not worry
12133 about whether the target supports cross-section
12134 arithmetic. */
12135 else
12137 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
12138 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
12139 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
12142 fmt = NULL;
12145 /* Negative block_num stands for an index into ranges_by_label. */
12146 else if (block_num < 0)
12148 int lab_idx = - block_num - 1;
12150 if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
12152 gcc_unreachable ();
12153 #if 0
12154 /* If we ever use add_ranges_by_labels () for a single
12155 function section, all we have to do is to take out
12156 the #if 0 above. */
12157 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
12158 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
12159 text_section_label,
12160 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
12161 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
12162 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
12163 text_section_label, NULL);
12164 #endif
12166 else
12168 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
12169 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].begin,
12170 fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
12171 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
12172 ranges_by_label[lab_idx].end,
12173 NULL);
12176 else
12178 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
12179 dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
12180 fmt = start_fmt;
12185 /* Data structure containing information about input files. */
12186 struct file_info
12188 const char *path; /* Complete file name. */
12189 const char *fname; /* File name part. */
12190 int length; /* Length of entire string. */
12191 struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx; /* Index in input file table. */
12192 int dir_idx; /* Index in directory table. */
12195 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
12196 files. */
12197 struct dir_info
12199 const char *path; /* Path including directory name. */
12200 int length; /* Path length. */
12201 int prefix; /* Index of directory entry which is a prefix. */
12202 int count; /* Number of files in this directory. */
12203 int dir_idx; /* Index of directory used as base. */
12206 /* Callback function for file_info comparison. We sort by looking at
12207 the directories in the path. */
12209 static int
12210 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
12212 const struct file_info *const s1 = (const struct file_info *) p1;
12213 const struct file_info *const s2 = (const struct file_info *) p2;
12214 const unsigned char *cp1;
12215 const unsigned char *cp2;
12217 /* Take care of file names without directories. We need to make sure that
12218 we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
12219 we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
12220 orders. So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
12221 1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory. */
12222 if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
12223 return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
12225 cp1 = (const unsigned char *) s1->path;
12226 cp2 = (const unsigned char *) s2->path;
12228 while (1)
12230 ++cp1;
12231 ++cp2;
12232 /* Reached the end of the first path? If so, handle like above. */
12233 if ((cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname)
12234 || (cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname))
12235 return ((cp2 == (const unsigned char *) s2->fname)
12236 - (cp1 == (const unsigned char *) s1->fname));
12238 /* Character of current path component the same? */
12239 else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
12240 return *cp1 - *cp2;
12244 struct file_name_acquire_data
12246 struct file_info *files;
12247 int used_files;
12248 int max_files;
12251 /* Traversal function for the hash table. */
12253 static int
12254 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
12256 struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = (struct file_name_acquire_data *) data;
12257 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
12258 struct file_info *fi;
12259 const char *f;
12261 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
12263 if (! d->emitted_number)
12264 return 1;
12266 gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
12268 fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
12270 /* Skip all leading "./". */
12271 f = d->filename;
12272 while (f[0] == '.' && IS_DIR_SEPARATOR (f[1]))
12273 f += 2;
12275 /* Create a new array entry. */
12276 fi->path = f;
12277 fi->length = strlen (f);
12278 fi->file_idx = d;
12280 /* Search for the file name part. */
12281 f = strrchr (f, DIR_SEPARATOR);
12282 #if defined (DIR_SEPARATOR_2)
12284 char *g = strrchr (fi->path, DIR_SEPARATOR_2);
12286 if (g != NULL)
12288 if (f == NULL || f < g)
12289 f = g;
12292 #endif
12294 fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
12295 return 1;
12298 /* Output the directory table and the file name table. We try to minimize
12299 the total amount of memory needed. A heuristic is used to avoid large
12300 slowdowns with many input files. */
12302 static void
12303 output_file_names (void)
12305 struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
12306 int numfiles;
12307 struct file_info *files;
12308 struct dir_info *dirs;
12309 int *saved;
12310 int *savehere;
12311 int *backmap;
12312 int ndirs;
12313 int idx_offset;
12314 int i;
12316 if (!last_emitted_file)
12318 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
12319 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
12320 return;
12323 numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
12325 /* Allocate the various arrays we need. */
12326 files = XALLOCAVEC (struct file_info, numfiles);
12327 dirs = XALLOCAVEC (struct dir_info, numfiles);
12329 fnad.files = files;
12330 fnad.used_files = 0;
12331 fnad.max_files = numfiles;
12332 htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
12333 gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
12335 qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
12337 /* Find all the different directories used. */
12338 dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
12339 dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
12340 dirs[0].prefix = -1;
12341 dirs[0].count = 1;
12342 dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
12343 files[0].dir_idx = 0;
12344 ndirs = 1;
12346 for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
12347 if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
12348 && memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
12349 dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
12351 /* Same directory as last entry. */
12352 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
12353 ++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
12355 else
12357 int j;
12359 /* This is a new directory. */
12360 dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
12361 dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
12362 dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
12363 dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
12364 files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
12366 /* Search for a prefix. */
12367 dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
12368 for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
12369 if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
12370 && dirs[j].length > 1
12371 && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
12372 || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
12373 && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
12374 dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
12376 ++ndirs;
12379 /* Now to the actual work. We have to find a subset of the directories which
12380 allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
12381 with the least amount of characters. We do not do an exhaustive search
12382 where we would have to check out every combination of every single
12383 possible prefix. Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
12384 results in most cases and never is much off. */
12385 saved = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
12386 savehere = XALLOCAVEC (int, ndirs);
12388 memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
12389 for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
12391 int j;
12392 int total;
12394 /* We can always save some space for the current directory. But this
12395 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory. */
12396 savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
12397 total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
12399 for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
12401 savehere[j] = 0;
12402 if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
12404 /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
12405 dirs[j] path. */
12406 int k;
12408 k = dirs[j].prefix;
12409 while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
12410 k = dirs[k].prefix;
12412 if (k == (int) i)
12414 /* Yes it is. We can possibly save some memory by
12415 writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
12416 dirs[i]. */
12417 savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
12418 total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
12423 /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
12424 directory. */
12425 if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
12427 /* It's worthwhile adding. */
12428 for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
12429 if (savehere[j] > 0)
12431 /* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far. */
12432 saved[j] = savehere[j];
12434 /* Remember the prefix directory. */
12435 dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
12440 /* Emit the directory name table. */
12441 idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
12442 for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
12443 dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path,
12444 dirs[i].length
12445 - !DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR,
12446 "Directory Entry: %#x", i + idx_offset);
12448 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
12450 /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
12451 used in the debug info generation. To do this efficiently we
12452 generate a back-mapping of the indices first. */
12453 backmap = XALLOCAVEC (int, numfiles);
12454 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12455 backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
12457 /* Now write all the file names. */
12458 for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
12460 int file_idx = backmap[i];
12461 int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
12463 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12464 #define MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN 6 /* ";32768" */
12466 /* Setting these fields can lead to debugger miscomparisons,
12467 but VMS Debug requires them to be set correctly. */
12469 int ver;
12470 long long cdt;
12471 long siz;
12472 int maxfilelen = strlen (files[file_idx].path)
12473 + dirs[dir_idx].length
12474 + MAX_VMS_VERSION_LEN + 1;
12475 char *filebuf = XALLOCAVEC (char, maxfilelen);
12477 vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, 0, 0, &ver);
12478 snprintf (filebuf, maxfilelen, "%s;%d",
12479 files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, ver);
12481 dw2_asm_output_nstring
12482 (filebuf, -1, "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
12484 /* Include directory index. */
12485 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12487 /* Modification time. */
12488 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
12489 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, &cdt, 0, 0, 0) == 0)
12490 ? cdt : 0,
12491 NULL);
12493 /* File length in bytes. */
12494 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
12495 ((vms_file_stats_name (files[file_idx].path, 0, &siz, 0, 0) == 0)
12496 ? siz : 0,
12497 NULL);
12498 #else
12499 dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
12500 "File Entry: %#x", (unsigned) i + 1);
12502 /* Include directory index. */
12503 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
12505 /* Modification time. */
12506 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12508 /* File length in bytes. */
12509 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
12510 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
12513 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
12517 /* Output one line number table into the .debug_line section. */
12519 static void
12520 output_one_line_info_table (dw_line_info_table *table)
12522 char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12523 unsigned int current_line = 1;
12524 bool current_is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
12525 dw_line_info_entry *ent;
12526 size_t i;
12528 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_line_info_entry, table->entries, i, ent)
12530 switch (ent->opcode)
12532 case LI_set_address:
12533 /* ??? Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and
12534 must always use the most general form. GCC does not know the
12535 address delta itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc. Many
12536 ports do have length attributes which will give an upper bound
12537 on the address range. We could perhaps use length attributes
12538 to determine when it is safe to use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc. */
12539 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, ent->val);
12541 /* This can handle any delta. This takes
12542 4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes. */
12543 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", line_label);
12544 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12545 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12546 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
12547 break;
12549 case LI_set_line:
12550 if (ent->val == current_line)
12552 /* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn. */
12553 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy,
12554 "copy line %u", current_line);
12556 else
12558 int line_offset = ent->val - current_line;
12559 int line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
12561 current_line = ent->val;
12562 if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
12564 /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
12565 definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.
12566 This takes 1 byte. */
12567 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
12568 "line %u", current_line);
12570 else
12572 /* This can handle any delta. This takes at least 4 bytes,
12573 depending on the value being encoded. */
12574 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
12575 "advance to line %u", current_line);
12576 dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
12577 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, NULL);
12580 break;
12582 case LI_set_file:
12583 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "set file %u", ent->val);
12584 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
12585 break;
12587 case LI_set_column:
12588 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_column, "column %u", ent->val);
12589 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, "%u", ent->val);
12590 break;
12592 case LI_negate_stmt:
12593 current_is_stmt = !current_is_stmt;
12594 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_negate_stmt,
12595 "is_stmt %d", current_is_stmt);
12596 break;
12598 case LI_set_prologue_end:
12599 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_prologue_end,
12600 "set prologue end");
12601 break;
12603 case LI_set_epilogue_begin:
12604 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_epilogue_begin,
12605 "set epilogue begin");
12606 break;
12608 case LI_set_discriminator:
12609 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "discriminator %u", ent->val);
12610 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + size_of_uleb128 (ent->val), NULL);
12611 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_discriminator, NULL);
12612 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ent->val, NULL);
12613 break;
12617 /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the table. */
12618 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "set address %s", table->end_label);
12619 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
12620 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
12621 dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, table->end_label, NULL);
12623 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end sequence");
12624 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
12625 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
12628 /* Output the source line number correspondence information. This
12629 information goes into the .debug_line section. */
12631 static void
12632 output_line_info (void)
12634 char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
12635 int ver = dwarf_version;
12636 bool saw_one = false;
12637 int opc;
12639 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
12640 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
12641 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
12642 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
12644 if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
12645 dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
12646 "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
12647 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
12648 "Length of Source Line Info");
12649 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
12651 dw2_asm_output_data (2, ver, "DWARF Version");
12652 dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
12653 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
12655 /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in bytes).
12656 In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for information
12657 purposes only. Since GCC generates assembly language, we have no
12658 a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are generated for each
12659 source line, and therefore can use only the DW_LNE_set_address and
12660 DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information commands. Accordingly, we fix
12661 this as '1', which is "correct enough" for all architectures,
12662 and don't let the target override. */
12663 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1, "Minimum Instruction Length");
12665 if (ver >= 4)
12666 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_MAX_OPS_PER_INSN,
12667 "Maximum Operations Per Instruction");
12668 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
12669 "Default is_stmt_start flag");
12670 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
12671 "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
12672 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
12673 "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
12674 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
12675 "Special Opcode Base");
12677 for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
12679 int n_op_args;
12680 switch (opc)
12682 case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
12683 case DW_LNS_advance_line:
12684 case DW_LNS_set_file:
12685 case DW_LNS_set_column:
12686 case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
12687 case DW_LNS_set_isa:
12688 n_op_args = 1;
12689 break;
12690 default:
12691 n_op_args = 0;
12692 break;
12695 dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: %#x has %d args",
12696 opc, n_op_args);
12699 /* Write out the information about the files we use. */
12700 output_file_names ();
12701 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
12703 if (separate_line_info)
12705 dw_line_info_table *table;
12706 size_t i;
12708 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_line_info_table_p, separate_line_info, i, table)
12709 if (table->in_use)
12711 output_one_line_info_table (table);
12712 saw_one = true;
12715 if (cold_text_section_line_info && cold_text_section_line_info->in_use)
12717 output_one_line_info_table (cold_text_section_line_info);
12718 saw_one = true;
12721 /* ??? Some Darwin linkers crash on a .debug_line section with no
12722 sequences. Further, merely a DW_LNE_end_sequence entry is not
12723 sufficient -- the address column must also be initialized.
12724 Make sure to output at least one set_address/end_sequence pair,
12725 choosing .text since that section is always present. */
12726 if (text_section_line_info->in_use || !saw_one)
12727 output_one_line_info_table (text_section_line_info);
12729 /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info. */
12730 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
12733 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
12734 a DIE that describes the given type.
12736 This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
12737 Dwarf base (fundamental) types. */
12739 static dw_die_ref
12740 base_type_die (tree type)
12742 dw_die_ref base_type_result;
12743 enum dwarf_type encoding;
12745 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
12746 return 0;
12748 /* If this is a subtype that should not be emitted as a subrange type,
12749 use the base type. See subrange_type_for_debug_p. */
12750 if (TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE)
12751 type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12753 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12755 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12756 if ((dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
12757 && TYPE_NAME (type)
12758 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12759 && DECL_IS_BUILTIN (TYPE_NAME (type))
12760 && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12762 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type)));
12763 if (strcmp (name, "char16_t") == 0
12764 || strcmp (name, "char32_t") == 0)
12766 encoding = DW_ATE_UTF;
12767 break;
12770 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
12772 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12773 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
12774 else
12775 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
12777 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12778 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
12779 else
12780 encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
12781 break;
12783 case REAL_TYPE:
12784 if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
12786 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
12787 encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
12788 else
12789 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12791 else
12792 encoding = DW_ATE_float;
12793 break;
12795 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12796 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
12797 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12798 else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
12799 encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_fixed;
12800 else
12801 encoding = DW_ATE_signed_fixed;
12802 break;
12804 /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
12805 a user defined type for it. */
12806 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12807 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
12808 encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
12809 else
12810 encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
12811 break;
12813 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12814 /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type. */
12815 encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
12816 break;
12818 default:
12819 /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types. */
12820 gcc_unreachable ();
12823 base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
12825 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
12826 int_size_in_bytes (type));
12827 add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
12829 return base_type_result;
12832 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
12833 given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type. Otherwise return null. */
12835 static inline int
12836 is_base_type (tree type)
12838 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12840 case ERROR_MARK:
12841 case VOID_TYPE:
12842 case INTEGER_TYPE:
12843 case REAL_TYPE:
12844 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
12845 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12846 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12847 return 1;
12849 case ARRAY_TYPE:
12850 case RECORD_TYPE:
12851 case UNION_TYPE:
12852 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12853 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12854 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12855 case METHOD_TYPE:
12856 case POINTER_TYPE:
12857 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12858 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
12859 case OFFSET_TYPE:
12860 case LANG_TYPE:
12861 case VECTOR_TYPE:
12862 return 0;
12864 default:
12865 gcc_unreachable ();
12868 return 0;
12871 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
12872 node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
12873 return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
12874 else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
12875 ERROR_MARK node. */
12877 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
12878 simple_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12880 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12881 return BITS_PER_WORD;
12882 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12883 return 0;
12884 else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
12885 return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
12886 else
12887 return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
12890 /* Similarly, but return a double_int instead of UHWI. */
12892 static inline double_int
12893 double_int_type_size_in_bits (const_tree type)
12895 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
12896 return uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_WORD);
12897 else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
12898 return double_int_zero;
12899 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (type)) == INTEGER_CST)
12900 return tree_to_double_int (TYPE_SIZE (type));
12901 else
12902 return uhwi_to_double_int (TYPE_ALIGN (type));
12905 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
12906 to a DIE that describes the given type. */
12908 static dw_die_ref
12909 subrange_type_die (tree type, tree low, tree high, dw_die_ref context_die)
12911 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
12912 const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
12914 if (context_die == NULL)
12915 context_die = comp_unit_die ();
12917 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
12919 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
12921 /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
12922 so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type. */
12923 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
12926 if (low)
12927 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, low);
12928 if (high)
12929 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, high);
12931 return subrange_die;
12934 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
12935 entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type. */
12937 static dw_die_ref
12938 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
12939 dw_die_ref context_die)
12941 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
12942 dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
12943 dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
12944 tree item_type = NULL;
12945 tree qualified_type;
12946 tree name, low, high;
12948 if (code == ERROR_MARK)
12949 return NULL;
12951 /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
12952 this type. */
12953 qualified_type
12954 = get_qualified_type (type,
12955 ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
12956 | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
12958 if (qualified_type == sizetype
12959 && TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)
12960 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type)) == TYPE_DECL)
12962 tree t = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (qualified_type));
12964 gcc_checking_assert (TREE_CODE (t) == INTEGER_TYPE
12965 && TYPE_PRECISION (t)
12966 == TYPE_PRECISION (qualified_type)
12967 && TYPE_UNSIGNED (t)
12968 == TYPE_UNSIGNED (qualified_type));
12969 qualified_type = t;
12972 /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists. */
12973 if (qualified_type)
12975 mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12976 if (mod_type_die)
12977 return mod_type_die;
12980 name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
12982 /* Handle C typedef types. */
12983 if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name)
12984 && !DECL_ARTIFICIAL (name))
12986 tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
12988 if (qualified_type == dtype)
12990 /* For a named type, use the typedef. */
12991 gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
12992 return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
12994 else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12995 || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12996 || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
12997 && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
12998 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
12999 /* cv-unqualified version of named type. Just use the unnamed
13000 type to which it refers. */
13001 return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
13002 is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
13003 context_die);
13004 /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through. */
13007 if (is_const_type
13008 /* If both is_const_type and is_volatile_type, prefer the path
13009 which leads to a qualified type. */
13010 && (!is_volatile_type
13011 || get_qualified_type (type, TYPE_QUAL_CONST) == NULL_TREE
13012 || get_qualified_type (type, TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE) != NULL_TREE))
13014 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
13015 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
13017 else if (is_volatile_type)
13019 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
13020 sub_die = modified_type_die (type, is_const_type, 0, context_die);
13022 else if (code == POINTER_TYPE)
13024 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
13025 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
13026 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
13027 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13028 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
13029 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
13030 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
13032 else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
13034 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
13035 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, comp_unit_die (),
13036 type);
13037 else
13038 mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
13039 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
13040 simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
13041 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13042 if (!ADDR_SPACE_GENERIC_P (TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type)))
13043 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_address_class,
13044 TYPE_ADDR_SPACE (item_type));
13046 else if (code == INTEGER_TYPE
13047 && TREE_TYPE (type) != NULL_TREE
13048 && subrange_type_for_debug_p (type, &low, &high))
13050 mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, low, high, context_die);
13051 item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
13053 else if (is_base_type (type))
13054 mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
13055 else
13057 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13059 /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
13060 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
13061 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
13062 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
13063 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
13064 ..._TYPE node. */
13065 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
13066 return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
13067 else
13068 /* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
13069 not the main variant. */
13070 return lookup_type_die (type);
13073 /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE. For those,
13074 don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
13075 user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.
13076 Don't attach a DW_AT_name to DW_TAG_const_type or DW_TAG_volatile_type
13077 if the base type already has the same name. */
13078 if (name
13079 && ((TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL
13080 && (qualified_type == TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type)
13081 || (!is_const_type && !is_volatile_type)))
13082 || (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL
13083 && TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type
13084 && DECL_NAME (name))))
13086 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
13087 /* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
13088 but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
13089 useful source coordinates anyway. */
13090 name = DECL_NAME (name);
13091 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
13092 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (mod_type_die, type, context_die);
13094 /* This probably indicates a bug. */
13095 else if (mod_type_die && mod_type_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
13096 add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, "__unknown__");
13098 if (qualified_type)
13099 equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
13101 if (item_type)
13102 /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
13103 this is a recursive type. This ensures that the modified_type_die
13104 recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive. Recursive
13105 types are possible in Ada. */
13106 sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
13107 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
13108 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
13109 context_die);
13111 if (sub_die != NULL)
13112 add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
13114 return mod_type_die;
13117 /* Generate DIEs for the generic parameters of T.
13118 T must be either a generic type or a generic function.
13119 See http://gcc.gnu.org/wiki/TemplateParmsDwarf for more. */
13121 static void
13122 gen_generic_params_dies (tree t)
13124 tree parms, args;
13125 int parms_num, i;
13126 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
13128 if (!t || (TYPE_P (t) && !COMPLETE_TYPE_P (t)))
13129 return;
13131 if (TYPE_P (t))
13132 die = lookup_type_die (t);
13133 else if (DECL_P (t))
13134 die = lookup_decl_die (t);
13136 gcc_assert (die);
13138 parms = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t);
13139 if (!parms)
13140 /* T has no generic parameter. It means T is neither a generic type
13141 or function. End of story. */
13142 return;
13144 parms_num = TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parms);
13145 args = lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_args (t);
13146 for (i = 0; i < parms_num; i++)
13148 tree parm, arg, arg_pack_elems;
13150 parm = TREE_VEC_ELT (parms, i);
13151 arg = TREE_VEC_ELT (args, i);
13152 arg_pack_elems = lang_hooks.types.get_argument_pack_elems (arg);
13153 gcc_assert (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg);
13155 if (parm && TREE_VALUE (parm) && arg)
13157 /* If PARM represents a template parameter pack,
13158 emit a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE, followed
13159 by DW_TAG_template_*_parameter DIEs for the argument
13160 pack elements of ARG. Note that ARG would then be
13161 an argument pack. */
13162 if (arg_pack_elems)
13163 template_parameter_pack_die (TREE_VALUE (parm),
13164 arg_pack_elems,
13165 die);
13166 else
13167 generic_parameter_die (TREE_VALUE (parm), arg,
13168 true /* Emit DW_AT_name */, die);
13173 /* Create and return a DIE for PARM which should be
13174 the representation of a generic type parameter.
13175 For instance, in the C++ front end, PARM would be a template parameter.
13176 ARG is the argument to PARM.
13177 EMIT_NAME_P if tree, the DIE will have DW_AT_name attribute set to the
13178 name of the PARM.
13179 PARENT_DIE is the parent DIE which the new created DIE should be added to,
13180 as a child node. */
13182 static dw_die_ref
13183 generic_parameter_die (tree parm, tree arg,
13184 bool emit_name_p,
13185 dw_die_ref parent_die)
13187 dw_die_ref tmpl_die = NULL;
13188 const char *name = NULL;
13190 if (!parm || !DECL_NAME (parm) || !arg)
13191 return NULL;
13193 /* We support non-type generic parameters and arguments,
13194 type generic parameters and arguments, as well as
13195 generic generic parameters (a.k.a. template template parameters in C++)
13196 and arguments. */
13197 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13198 /* PARM is a nontype generic parameter */
13199 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_value_param, parent_die, parm);
13200 else if (TREE_CODE (parm) == TYPE_DECL)
13201 /* PARM is a type generic parameter. */
13202 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_template_type_param, parent_die, parm);
13203 else if (lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
13204 /* PARM is a generic generic parameter.
13205 Its DIE is a GNU extension. It shall have a
13206 DW_AT_name attribute to represent the name of the template template
13207 parameter, and a DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute to represent the
13208 name of the template template argument. */
13209 tmpl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param,
13210 parent_die, parm);
13211 else
13212 gcc_unreachable ();
13214 if (tmpl_die)
13216 tree tmpl_type;
13218 /* If PARM is a generic parameter pack, it means we are
13219 emitting debug info for a template argument pack element.
13220 In other terms, ARG is a template argument pack element.
13221 In that case, we don't emit any DW_AT_name attribute for
13222 the die. */
13223 if (emit_name_p)
13225 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm));
13226 gcc_assert (name);
13227 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_name, name);
13230 if (!lang_hooks.decls.generic_generic_parameter_decl_p (parm))
13232 /* DWARF3, 5.6.8 says if PARM is a non-type generic parameter
13233 TMPL_DIE should have a child DW_AT_type attribute that is set
13234 to the type of the argument to PARM, which is ARG.
13235 If PARM is a type generic parameter, TMPL_DIE should have a
13236 child DW_AT_type that is set to ARG. */
13237 tmpl_type = TYPE_P (arg) ? arg : TREE_TYPE (arg);
13238 add_type_attribute (tmpl_die, tmpl_type, 0,
13239 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (tmpl_type),
13240 parent_die);
13242 else
13244 /* So TMPL_DIE is a DIE representing a
13245 a generic generic template parameter, a.k.a template template
13246 parameter in C++ and arg is a template. */
13248 /* The DW_AT_GNU_template_name attribute of the DIE must be set
13249 to the name of the argument. */
13250 name = dwarf2_name (TYPE_P (arg) ? TYPE_NAME (arg) : arg, 1);
13251 if (name)
13252 add_AT_string (tmpl_die, DW_AT_GNU_template_name, name);
13255 if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
13256 /* So PARM is a non-type generic parameter.
13257 DWARF3 5.6.8 says we must set a DW_AT_const_value child
13258 attribute of TMPL_DIE which value represents the value
13259 of ARG.
13260 We must be careful here:
13261 The value of ARG might reference some function decls.
13262 We might currently be emitting debug info for a generic
13263 type and types are emitted before function decls, we don't
13264 know if the function decls referenced by ARG will actually be
13265 emitted after cgraph computations.
13266 So must defer the generation of the DW_AT_const_value to
13267 after cgraph is ready. */
13268 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (tmpl_die, arg);
13271 return tmpl_die;
13274 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack DIE representing.
13275 PARM_PACK must be a template parameter pack. The returned DIE
13276 will be child DIE of PARENT_DIE. */
13278 static dw_die_ref
13279 template_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
13280 tree parm_pack_args,
13281 dw_die_ref parent_die)
13283 dw_die_ref die;
13284 int j;
13286 gcc_assert (parent_die && parm_pack);
13288 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack, parent_die, parm_pack);
13289 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (die, parm_pack);
13290 for (j = 0; j < TREE_VEC_LENGTH (parm_pack_args); j++)
13291 generic_parameter_die (parm_pack,
13292 TREE_VEC_ELT (parm_pack_args, j),
13293 false /* Don't emit DW_AT_name */,
13294 die);
13295 return die;
13298 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
13299 an enumerated type. */
13301 static inline int
13302 type_is_enum (const_tree type)
13304 return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
13307 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node. */
13309 static unsigned int
13310 dbx_reg_number (const_rtx rtl)
13312 unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
13314 gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
13316 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13317 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
13319 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
13320 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13321 regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13323 #endif
13325 return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
13328 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
13329 DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
13330 doesn't end with DW_OP_piece. */
13332 static void
13333 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
13335 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
13337 if (*list_head != NULL)
13339 /* Find the end of the chain. */
13340 for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
13343 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
13344 loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
13348 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
13349 zero if there is none. */
13351 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13352 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum var_init_status initialized)
13354 rtx regs;
13356 if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
13357 return 0;
13359 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13360 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13361 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13362 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.
13363 Use DW_OP_fbreg offset DW_OP_stack_value in this case. */
13364 if ((rtl == arg_pointer_rtx || rtl == frame_pointer_rtx)
13365 && eliminate_regs (rtl, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX) != rtl)
13367 dw_loc_descr_ref result = NULL;
13369 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
13371 result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, GET_MODE (rtl), VOIDmode,
13372 initialized);
13373 if (result)
13374 add_loc_descr (&result,
13375 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13377 return result;
13380 regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
13382 if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
13383 return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs, initialized);
13384 else
13385 return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl), initialized);
13388 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
13389 a given hard register number. */
13391 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13392 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno, enum var_init_status initialized)
13394 dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descr;
13396 if (regno <= 31)
13397 reg_loc_descr
13398 = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_reg0 + regno), 0, 0);
13399 else
13400 reg_loc_descr = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
13402 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13403 add_loc_descr (&reg_loc_descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13405 return reg_loc_descr;
13408 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
13409 designates a value that spans more than one register. */
13411 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13412 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs,
13413 enum var_init_status initialized)
13415 int nregs, size, i;
13416 unsigned reg;
13417 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13419 reg = REGNO (rtl);
13420 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
13421 if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
13423 int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
13424 if (leaf_reg != -1)
13425 reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
13427 #endif
13428 gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
13429 nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
13431 /* Simple, contiguous registers. */
13432 if (regs == NULL_RTX)
13434 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
13436 loc_result = NULL;
13437 while (nregs--)
13439 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13441 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg),
13442 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13443 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13444 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13445 ++reg;
13447 return loc_result;
13450 /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations. */
13452 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
13454 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13455 loc_result = NULL;
13457 for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
13459 dw_loc_descr_ref t;
13461 t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)),
13462 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13463 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
13464 size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
13465 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
13468 if (loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13469 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13470 return loc_result;
13473 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant. */
13475 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13476 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13478 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
13480 /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
13481 defaulting to the LEB encoding. */
13482 if (i >= 0)
13484 if (i <= 31)
13485 op = (enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_lit0 + i);
13486 else if (i <= 0xff)
13487 op = DW_OP_const1u;
13488 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13489 op = DW_OP_const2u;
13490 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13491 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13492 op = DW_OP_const4u;
13493 else
13494 op = DW_OP_constu;
13496 else
13498 if (i >= -0x80)
13499 op = DW_OP_const1s;
13500 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13501 op = DW_OP_const2s;
13502 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13503 || i >= -0x80000000)
13504 op = DW_OP_const4s;
13505 else
13506 op = DW_OP_consts;
13509 return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
13512 /* Return loc description representing "address" of integer value.
13513 This can appear only as toplevel expression. */
13515 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13516 address_of_int_loc_descriptor (int size, HOST_WIDE_INT i)
13518 int litsize;
13519 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
13521 if (!(dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
13522 return NULL;
13524 if (i >= 0)
13526 if (i <= 31)
13527 litsize = 1;
13528 else if (i <= 0xff)
13529 litsize = 2;
13530 else if (i <= 0xffff)
13531 litsize = 3;
13532 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13533 || i <= 0xffffffff)
13534 litsize = 5;
13535 else
13536 litsize = 1 + size_of_uleb128 ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) i);
13538 else
13540 if (i >= -0x80)
13541 litsize = 2;
13542 else if (i >= -0x8000)
13543 litsize = 3;
13544 else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
13545 || i >= -0x80000000)
13546 litsize = 5;
13547 else
13548 litsize = 1 + size_of_sleb128 (i);
13550 /* Determine if DW_OP_stack_value or DW_OP_implicit_value
13551 is more compact. For DW_OP_stack_value we need:
13552 litsize + 1 (DW_OP_stack_value)
13553 and for DW_OP_implicit_value:
13554 1 (DW_OP_implicit_value) + 1 (length) + size. */
13555 if ((int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE >= size && litsize + 1 <= 1 + 1 + size)
13557 loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (i);
13558 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
13559 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
13560 return loc_result;
13563 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
13564 size, 0);
13565 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
13566 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int = i;
13567 return loc_result;
13570 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location. */
13572 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13573 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset,
13574 enum var_init_status initialized)
13576 unsigned int regno;
13577 dw_loc_descr_ref result;
13578 dw_fde_ref fde = current_fde ();
13580 /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
13581 post-prologue local stack frame. We do this by *not* running
13582 register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
13583 argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's. */
13584 if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13586 rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
13588 if (elim != reg)
13590 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
13592 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
13593 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
13595 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
13596 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13597 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
13598 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
13599 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
13600 : stack_pointer_rtx));
13602 /* If drap register is used to align stack, use frame
13603 pointer + offset to access stack variables. If stack
13604 is aligned without drap, use stack pointer + offset to
13605 access stack variables. */
13606 if (crtl->stack_realign_tried
13607 && reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
13609 int base_reg
13610 = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM ((fde && fde->drap_reg != INVALID_REGNUM)
13611 ? HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
13612 : REGNO (elim));
13613 return new_reg_loc_descr (base_reg, offset);
13616 offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
13617 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13620 else if (!optimize
13621 && fde
13622 && (fde->drap_reg == REGNO (reg)
13623 || fde->vdrap_reg == REGNO (reg)))
13625 /* Use cfa+offset to represent the location of arguments passed
13626 on the stack when drap is used to align stack.
13627 Only do this when not optimizing, for optimized code var-tracking
13628 is supposed to track where the arguments live and the register
13629 used as vdrap or drap in some spot might be used for something
13630 else in other part of the routine. */
13631 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
13634 regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
13635 if (regno <= 31)
13636 result = new_loc_descr ((enum dwarf_location_atom) (DW_OP_breg0 + regno),
13637 offset, 0);
13638 else
13639 result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
13641 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
13642 add_loc_descr (&result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
13644 return result;
13647 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation. */
13649 static inline int
13650 is_based_loc (const_rtx rtl)
13652 return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
13653 && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13654 && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
13655 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))));
13658 /* Try to handle TLS MEMs, for which mem_loc_descriptor on XEXP (mem, 0)
13659 failed. */
13661 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13662 tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtx mem)
13664 tree base;
13665 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
13667 if (MEM_EXPR (mem) == NULL_TREE || MEM_OFFSET (mem) == NULL_RTX)
13668 return NULL;
13670 base = get_base_address (MEM_EXPR (mem));
13671 if (base == NULL
13672 || TREE_CODE (base) != VAR_DECL
13673 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (base))
13674 return NULL;
13676 loc_result = loc_descriptor_from_tree (MEM_EXPR (mem), 1);
13677 if (loc_result == NULL)
13678 return NULL;
13680 if (INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)))
13681 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc_result, INTVAL (MEM_OFFSET (mem)));
13683 return loc_result;
13686 /* Output debug info about reason why we failed to expand expression as dwarf
13687 expression. */
13689 static void
13690 expansion_failed (tree expr, rtx rtl, char const *reason)
13692 if (dump_file && (dump_flags & TDF_DETAILS))
13694 fprintf (dump_file, "Failed to expand as dwarf: ");
13695 if (expr)
13696 print_generic_expr (dump_file, expr, dump_flags);
13697 if (rtl)
13699 fprintf (dump_file, "\n");
13700 print_rtl (dump_file, rtl);
13702 fprintf (dump_file, "\nReason: %s\n", reason);
13706 /* Helper function for const_ok_for_output, called either directly
13707 or via for_each_rtx. */
13709 static int
13710 const_ok_for_output_1 (rtx *rtlp, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13712 rtx rtl = *rtlp;
13714 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSPEC)
13716 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, assume
13717 we can't express it in the debug info. */
13718 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
13719 /* Don't complain about TLS UNSPECs, those are just too hard to
13720 delegitimize. */
13721 if (XVECLEN (rtl, 0) != 1
13722 || GET_CODE (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
13723 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0)) == NULL
13724 || TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0))) != VAR_DECL
13725 || !DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XVECEXP (rtl, 0, 0))))
13726 inform (current_function_decl
13727 ? DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (current_function_decl)
13728 : UNKNOWN_LOCATION,
13729 #if NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES > 0
13730 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %s (%d) found in variable location",
13731 ((XINT (rtl, 1) >= 0 && XINT (rtl, 1) < NUM_UNSPEC_VALUES)
13732 ? unspec_strings[XINT (rtl, 1)] : "unknown"),
13733 XINT (rtl, 1));
13734 #else
13735 "non-delegitimized UNSPEC %d found in variable location",
13736 XINT (rtl, 1));
13737 #endif
13738 #endif
13739 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13740 "UNSPEC hasn't been delegitimized.\n");
13741 return 1;
13744 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != SYMBOL_REF)
13745 return 0;
13747 if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
13749 bool marked;
13750 get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
13751 /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
13752 it was not output and thus we can't represent it. */
13753 if (!marked)
13755 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13756 "Constant was removed from constant pool.\n");
13757 return 1;
13761 if (SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
13762 return 1;
13764 /* Avoid references to external symbols in debug info, on several targets
13765 the linker might even refuse to link when linking a shared library,
13766 and in many other cases the relocations for .debug_info/.debug_loc are
13767 dropped, so the address becomes zero anyway. Hidden symbols, guaranteed
13768 to be defined within the same shared library or executable are fine. */
13769 if (SYMBOL_REF_EXTERNAL_P (rtl))
13771 tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl);
13773 if (decl == NULL || !targetm.binds_local_p (decl))
13775 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
13776 "Symbol not defined in current TU.\n");
13777 return 1;
13781 return 0;
13784 /* Return true if constant RTL can be emitted in DW_OP_addr or
13785 DW_AT_const_value. TLS SYMBOL_REFs, external SYMBOL_REFs or
13786 non-marked constant pool SYMBOL_REFs can't be referenced in it. */
13788 static bool
13789 const_ok_for_output (rtx rtl)
13791 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF)
13792 return const_ok_for_output_1 (&rtl, NULL) == 0;
13794 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST)
13795 return for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), const_ok_for_output_1, NULL) == 0;
13797 return true;
13800 /* Return a reference to DW_TAG_base_type corresponding to MODE and UNSIGNEDP
13801 if possible, NULL otherwise. */
13803 static dw_die_ref
13804 base_type_for_mode (enum machine_mode mode, bool unsignedp)
13806 dw_die_ref type_die;
13807 tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
13809 if (type == NULL)
13810 return NULL;
13811 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
13813 case INTEGER_TYPE:
13814 case REAL_TYPE:
13815 break;
13816 default:
13817 return NULL;
13819 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13820 if (!type_die)
13821 type_die = modified_type_die (type, false, false, comp_unit_die ());
13822 if (type_die == NULL || type_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_base_type)
13823 return NULL;
13824 return type_die;
13827 /* For OP descriptor assumed to be in unsigned MODE, convert it to a signed
13828 type matching MODE, or, if MODE is narrower than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, signed
13829 type matching DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE. Return NULL if the conversion is not
13830 possible. */
13832 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13833 convert_descriptor_to_signed (enum machine_mode mode, dw_loc_descr_ref op)
13835 enum machine_mode outer_mode = mode;
13836 dw_die_ref type_die;
13837 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
13839 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13841 outer_mode = mode_for_size (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT,
13842 MODE_INT, 0);
13843 if (outer_mode == BLKmode
13844 || GET_MODE_SIZE (outer_mode) != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13845 return NULL;
13847 type_die = base_type_for_mode (outer_mode, 0);
13848 if (type_die == NULL)
13849 return NULL;
13850 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
13851 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
13852 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
13853 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
13854 add_loc_descr (&op, cvt);
13855 return op;
13858 /* Return location descriptor for comparison OP with operands OP0 and OP1. */
13860 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13861 compare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, dw_loc_descr_ref op0,
13862 dw_loc_descr_ref op1)
13864 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = op0;
13865 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
13866 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
13867 if (STORE_FLAG_VALUE != 1)
13869 add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (STORE_FLAG_VALUE));
13870 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
13872 return ret;
13875 /* Return location descriptor for signed comparison OP RTL. */
13877 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13878 scompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
13879 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
13881 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13882 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
13883 int shift;
13885 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13886 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13887 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13888 return NULL;
13890 if (dwarf_strict
13891 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
13892 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
13893 return NULL;
13895 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
13896 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13897 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
13898 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13900 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
13901 return NULL;
13903 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT
13904 || GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) >= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13905 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13907 shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
13908 /* For eq/ne, if the operands are known to be zero-extended,
13909 there is no need to do the fancy shifting up. */
13910 if (op == DW_OP_eq || op == DW_OP_ne)
13912 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
13913 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
13915 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
13917 /* deref_size zero extends, and for constants we can check
13918 whether they are zero extended or not. */
13919 if (((last0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13920 && last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13921 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13922 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0))
13923 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode))))
13924 && ((last1->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_deref_size
13925 && last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int <= GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13926 || (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13927 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
13928 == (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode)))))
13929 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13931 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13932 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13933 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13934 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) << shift);
13935 else
13937 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
13938 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
13940 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
13943 /* Return location descriptor for unsigned comparison OP RTL. */
13945 static dw_loc_descr_ref
13946 ucompare_loc_descriptor (enum dwarf_location_atom op, rtx rtl,
13947 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
13949 enum machine_mode op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
13950 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
13952 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13953 op_mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 1));
13954 if (op_mode == VOIDmode)
13955 return NULL;
13956 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
13957 return NULL;
13959 if (dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13960 return NULL;
13962 if (op_mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_CLASS (op_mode) != MODE_INT)
13963 return NULL;
13965 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), op_mode, mem_mode,
13966 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13967 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), op_mode, mem_mode,
13968 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
13970 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
13971 return NULL;
13973 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
13975 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (op_mode);
13976 dw_loc_descr_ref last0, last1;
13977 for (last0 = op0; last0->dw_loc_next != NULL; last0 = last0->dw_loc_next)
13979 for (last1 = op1; last1->dw_loc_next != NULL; last1 = last1->dw_loc_next)
13981 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
13982 op0 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) & mask);
13983 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
13984 else if (last0->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
13985 || last0->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13987 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13988 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
13990 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
13991 op1 = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) & mask);
13992 /* deref_size zero extends, so no need to mask it again. */
13993 else if (last1->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_deref_size
13994 || last1->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int > GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode))
13996 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
13997 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14000 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (op_mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14002 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14003 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14004 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14005 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
14006 op1 = int_loc_descriptor ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bias
14007 + INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14008 else
14009 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14010 bias, 0));
14012 else
14014 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (op_mode, 1);
14015 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14017 if (type_die == NULL)
14018 return NULL;
14019 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14020 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14021 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14022 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14023 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14024 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14025 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14026 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14027 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14028 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14030 return compare_loc_descriptor (op, op0, op1);
14033 /* Return location descriptor for {U,S}{MIN,MAX}. */
14035 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14036 minmax_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14037 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
14039 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14040 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret;
14041 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, drop_node;
14043 if (dwarf_strict
14044 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14045 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
14046 return NULL;
14048 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14049 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14050 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14051 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14053 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14054 return NULL;
14056 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14057 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14058 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14059 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMAX)
14061 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14063 HOST_WIDE_INT mask = GET_MODE_MASK (mode);
14064 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14065 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14066 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (mask));
14067 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14069 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14071 HOST_WIDE_INT bias = 1;
14072 bias <<= (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * BITS_PER_UNIT - 1);
14073 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14074 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bias, 0));
14076 else
14078 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
14079 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14080 if (type_die == NULL)
14081 return NULL;
14082 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14083 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14084 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14085 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14086 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
14087 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14088 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14089 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14090 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14091 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
14094 else if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
14095 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14097 int shift = (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
14098 add_loc_descr (&op0, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14099 add_loc_descr (&op0, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14100 add_loc_descr (&op1, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14101 add_loc_descr (&op1, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14104 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SMIN || GET_CODE (rtl) == UMIN)
14105 op = DW_OP_lt;
14106 else
14107 op = DW_OP_gt;
14108 ret = op0;
14109 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14110 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14111 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14112 add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
14113 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14114 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14115 add_loc_descr (&ret, drop_node);
14116 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14117 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
14118 return ret;
14121 /* CLZ (where constV is CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO computed value,
14122 const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14123 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant
14124 and constMSB is constant with just the MSB bit set
14125 for the mode):
14126 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14127 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14128 L2: DW_OP_dup constMSB DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shl
14129 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14130 L3: DW_OP_drop
14131 L4: DW_OP_nop
14133 CTZ is similar:
14134 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop constV DW_OP_skip <L4>
14135 L1: const0 DW_OP_swap
14136 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14137 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14138 L3: DW_OP_drop
14139 L4: DW_OP_nop
14141 FFS is similar:
14142 DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L1> DW_OP_drop const0 DW_OP_skip <L4>
14143 L1: const1 DW_OP_swap
14144 L2: DW_OP_dup const1 DW_OP_and DW_OP_bra <L3> const1 DW_OP_shr
14145 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_plus_uconst <1> DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L2>
14146 L3: DW_OP_drop
14147 L4: DW_OP_nop */
14149 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14150 clz_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14151 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
14153 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14154 HOST_WIDE_INT valv;
14155 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14156 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14157 dw_loc_descr_ref l3jump, l3label;
14158 dw_loc_descr_ref l4jump, l4label;
14159 rtx msb;
14161 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14162 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode
14163 || (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
14164 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) > 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))
14165 return NULL;
14167 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14168 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14169 if (op0 == NULL)
14170 return NULL;
14171 ret = op0;
14172 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ)
14174 if (!CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14175 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14177 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS)
14178 valv = 0;
14179 else if (!CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (mode, valv))
14180 valv = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
14181 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14182 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14183 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14184 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14185 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (valv), mode, mem_mode,
14186 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14187 if (tmp == NULL)
14188 return NULL;
14189 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14190 l4jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14191 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4jump);
14192 l1label = mem_loc_descriptor (GET_CODE (rtl) == FFS
14193 ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx,
14194 mode, mem_mode,
14195 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14196 if (l1label == NULL)
14197 return NULL;
14198 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14199 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14200 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14201 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14202 if (GET_CODE (rtl) != CLZ)
14203 msb = const1_rtx;
14204 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14205 msb = GEN_INT ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
14206 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 1));
14207 else
14208 msb = immed_double_const (0, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
14209 << (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)
14210 - HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT - 1), mode);
14211 if (GET_CODE (msb) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (msb) < 0)
14212 tmp = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14213 ? DW_OP_const4u : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14214 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu, INTVAL (msb), 0);
14215 else
14216 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (msb, mode, mem_mode,
14217 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14218 if (tmp == NULL)
14219 return NULL;
14220 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14221 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14222 l3jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14223 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3jump);
14224 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14225 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14226 if (tmp == NULL)
14227 return NULL;
14228 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14229 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == CLZ
14230 ? DW_OP_shl : DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14231 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14232 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, 1, 0));
14233 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14234 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14235 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14236 l3label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14237 add_loc_descr (&ret, l3label);
14238 l4label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
14239 add_loc_descr (&ret, l4label);
14240 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14241 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14242 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14243 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14244 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14245 l3jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l3label;
14246 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14247 l4jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l4label;
14248 return ret;
14251 /* POPCOUNT (const0 is DW_OP_lit0 or corresponding typed constant,
14252 const1 is DW_OP_lit1 or corresponding typed constant):
14253 const0 DW_OP_swap
14254 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14255 DW_OP_plus DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14256 L2: DW_OP_drop
14258 PARITY is similar:
14259 L1: DW_OP_dup DW_OP_bra <L2> DW_OP_dup DW_OP_rot const1 DW_OP_and
14260 DW_OP_xor DW_OP_swap const1 DW_OP_shr DW_OP_skip <L1>
14261 L2: DW_OP_drop */
14263 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14264 popcount_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14265 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
14267 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14268 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14269 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14271 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14272 || GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != mode)
14273 return NULL;
14275 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14276 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14277 if (op0 == NULL)
14278 return NULL;
14279 ret = op0;
14280 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14281 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14282 if (tmp == NULL)
14283 return NULL;
14284 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14285 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14286 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
14287 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14288 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14289 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14290 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14291 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14292 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14293 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14294 if (tmp == NULL)
14295 return NULL;
14296 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14297 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14298 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (GET_CODE (rtl) == POPCOUNT
14299 ? DW_OP_plus : DW_OP_xor, 0, 0));
14300 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14301 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const1_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14302 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14303 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14304 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14305 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14306 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14307 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14308 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14309 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14310 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14311 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14312 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14313 return ret;
14316 /* BSWAP (constS is initial shift count, either 56 or 24):
14317 constS const0
14318 L1: DW_OP_pick <2> constS DW_OP_pick <3> DW_OP_minus DW_OP_shr
14319 const255 DW_OP_and DW_OP_pick <2> DW_OP_shl DW_OP_or
14320 DW_OP_swap DW_OP_dup const0 DW_OP_eq DW_OP_bra <L2> const8
14321 DW_OP_minus DW_OP_swap DW_OP_skip <L1>
14322 L2: DW_OP_drop DW_OP_swap DW_OP_drop */
14324 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14325 bswap_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14326 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
14328 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, ret, tmp;
14329 dw_loc_descr_ref l1jump, l1label;
14330 dw_loc_descr_ref l2jump, l2label;
14332 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14333 || BITS_PER_UNIT != 8
14334 || (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 32
14335 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 64))
14336 return NULL;
14338 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14339 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14340 if (op0 == NULL)
14341 return NULL;
14343 ret = op0;
14344 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14345 mode, mem_mode,
14346 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14347 if (tmp == NULL)
14348 return NULL;
14349 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14350 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14351 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14352 if (tmp == NULL)
14353 return NULL;
14354 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14355 l1label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0);
14356 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1label);
14357 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) - 8),
14358 mode, mem_mode,
14359 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14360 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14361 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 3, 0));
14362 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14363 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14364 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (255), mode, mem_mode,
14365 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14366 if (tmp == NULL)
14367 return NULL;
14368 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14369 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14370 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_pick, 2, 0));
14371 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14372 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14373 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14374 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0));
14375 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (const0_rtx, mode, mem_mode,
14376 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14377 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14378 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_eq, 0, 0));
14379 l2jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
14380 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2jump);
14381 tmp = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (8), mode, mem_mode,
14382 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14383 add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
14384 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14385 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14386 l1jump = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
14387 add_loc_descr (&ret, l1jump);
14388 l2label = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
14389 add_loc_descr (&ret, l2label);
14390 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14391 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0));
14392 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14393 l1jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l1label;
14394 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14395 l2jump->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = l2label;
14396 return ret;
14399 /* ROTATE (constMASK is mode mask, BITSIZE is bitsize of mode):
14400 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14401 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_neg
14402 DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE> DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or
14404 ROTATERT is similar:
14405 DW_OP_over DW_OP_over DW_OP_neg DW_OP_plus_uconst <BITSIZE>
14406 DW_OP_shl [ constMASK DW_OP_and ] DW_OP_rot
14407 [ DW_OP_swap constMASK DW_OP_and DW_OP_swap ] DW_OP_shr DW_OP_or */
14409 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14410 rotate_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14411 enum machine_mode mem_mode)
14413 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14414 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1, ret, mask[2] = { NULL, NULL };
14415 int i;
14417 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
14418 return NULL;
14420 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
14421 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1)) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
14422 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
14423 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14424 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14425 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
14426 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14427 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL)
14428 return NULL;
14429 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14430 for (i = 0; i < 2; i++)
14432 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14433 mask[i] = mem_loc_descriptor (GEN_INT (GET_MODE_MASK (mode)),
14434 mode, mem_mode,
14435 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14436 else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
14437 mask[i] = new_loc_descr (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
14438 ? DW_OP_const4u
14439 : HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 64
14440 ? DW_OP_const8u : DW_OP_constu,
14441 GET_MODE_MASK (mode), 0);
14442 else
14443 mask[i] = NULL;
14444 if (mask[i] == NULL)
14445 return NULL;
14446 add_loc_descr (&mask[i], new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14448 ret = op0;
14449 add_loc_descr (&ret, op1);
14450 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14451 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14452 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATERT)
14454 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14455 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14456 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14458 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14459 if (mask[0] != NULL)
14460 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[0]);
14461 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_rot, 0, 0));
14462 if (mask[1] != NULL)
14464 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14465 add_loc_descr (&ret, mask[1]);
14466 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
14468 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ROTATE)
14470 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_neg, 0, 0));
14471 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
14472 GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode), 0));
14474 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shr, 0, 0));
14475 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_or, 0, 0));
14476 return ret;
14479 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
14480 (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
14481 mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
14482 hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
14484 When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
14485 the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
14486 equivalent. This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
14487 it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
14489 MODE is the mode that should be assumed for the rtl if it is VOIDmode.
14491 MEM_MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
14492 autoincrement addressing modes.
14494 Return 0 if we can't represent the location. */
14496 static dw_loc_descr_ref
14497 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
14498 enum machine_mode mem_mode,
14499 enum var_init_status initialized)
14501 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
14502 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
14503 dw_loc_descr_ref op0, op1;
14505 if (mode == VOIDmode)
14506 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
14508 /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
14509 description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
14510 actually within the array. That's *not* necessarily the same as the
14511 zeroth element of the array. */
14513 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
14515 if (mode != GET_MODE (rtl) && GET_MODE (rtl) != VOIDmode)
14516 return NULL;
14518 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
14520 case POST_INC:
14521 case POST_DEC:
14522 case POST_MODIFY:
14523 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14525 case SUBREG:
14526 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
14527 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
14528 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
14529 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
14530 contains the given subreg. */
14531 if (!subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
14532 break;
14533 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
14534 && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))) == MODE_INT
14535 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14536 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14537 || (mode == Pmode && mem_mode != VOIDmode)
14538 #endif
14540 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14542 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
14543 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)),
14544 mem_mode, initialized);
14545 break;
14547 if (dwarf_strict)
14548 break;
14549 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))))
14550 break;
14551 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)))
14552 && (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14553 || GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))) != MODE_INT))
14554 break;
14555 else
14557 dw_die_ref type_die;
14558 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14560 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl),
14561 GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl)),
14562 mem_mode, initialized);
14563 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14564 break;
14565 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
14566 if (type_die == NULL)
14568 mem_loc_result = NULL;
14569 break;
14571 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
14572 != GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (rtl))))
14573 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14574 else
14575 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret, 0, 0);
14576 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14577 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14578 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14579 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14581 break;
14583 case REG:
14584 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14585 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14586 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14587 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
14588 #endif
14591 dw_die_ref type_die;
14593 if (dwarf_strict)
14594 break;
14595 if (REGNO (rtl) > FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14596 break;
14597 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
14598 if (type_die == NULL)
14599 break;
14600 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_regval_type,
14601 dbx_reg_number (rtl), 0);
14602 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14603 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14604 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14605 break;
14607 /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
14608 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
14609 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
14610 a "base register". This distinction is not based in any way upon
14611 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
14612 belongs to. This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
14613 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
14614 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
14615 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
14616 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg). This may look deceptively like
14617 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
14618 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
14619 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG. */
14620 if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14621 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14622 else if (stack_realign_drap
14623 && crtl->drap_reg
14624 && crtl->args.internal_arg_pointer == rtl
14625 && REGNO (crtl->drap_reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
14627 /* If RTL is internal_arg_pointer, which has been optimized
14628 out, use DRAP instead. */
14629 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (crtl->drap_reg, 0,
14630 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14632 break;
14634 case SIGN_EXTEND:
14635 case ZERO_EXTEND:
14636 gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT);
14637 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
14638 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14639 if (op0 == 0)
14640 break;
14641 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND
14642 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14643 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
14644 < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
14645 /* If DW_OP_const{1,2,4}u won't be used, it is shorter
14646 to expand zero extend as two shifts instead of
14647 masking. */
14648 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= 4)
14650 enum machine_mode imode = GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0));
14651 mem_loc_result = op0;
14652 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14653 int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_MASK (imode)));
14654 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_and, 0, 0));
14656 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14658 int shift = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14659 - GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)));
14660 shift *= BITS_PER_UNIT;
14661 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTEND)
14662 op = DW_OP_shra;
14663 else
14664 op = DW_OP_shr;
14665 mem_loc_result = op0;
14666 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14667 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
14668 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, int_loc_descriptor (shift));
14669 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14671 else if (!dwarf_strict)
14673 dw_die_ref type_die1, type_die2;
14674 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14676 type_die1 = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
14677 GET_CODE (rtl) == ZERO_EXTEND);
14678 if (type_die1 == NULL)
14679 break;
14680 type_die2 = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
14681 if (type_die2 == NULL)
14682 break;
14683 mem_loc_result = op0;
14684 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14685 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14686 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die1;
14687 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14688 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14689 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14690 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14691 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die2;
14692 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14693 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, cvt);
14695 break;
14697 case MEM:
14698 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
14699 get_address_mode (rtl), mode,
14700 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14701 if (mem_loc_result == NULL)
14702 mem_loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
14703 if (mem_loc_result != 0)
14705 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14706 || GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
14708 dw_die_ref type_die;
14709 dw_loc_descr_ref deref;
14711 if (dwarf_strict)
14712 return NULL;
14713 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
14714 if (type_die == NULL)
14715 return NULL;
14716 deref = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_deref_type,
14717 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
14718 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
14719 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
14720 deref->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
14721 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, deref);
14723 else if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14724 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
14725 else
14726 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14727 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size,
14728 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0));
14730 else
14732 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
14733 if (new_rtl != rtl)
14734 return mem_loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14736 break;
14738 case LO_SUM:
14739 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode, initialized);
14741 case LABEL_REF:
14742 /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
14743 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
14744 pool. */
14745 case CONST:
14746 case SYMBOL_REF:
14747 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14748 || (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14749 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
14750 && (mode != Pmode || mem_mode == VOIDmode)
14751 #endif
14753 break;
14754 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
14755 && SYMBOL_REF_TLS_MODEL (rtl) != TLS_MODEL_NONE)
14757 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
14759 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data. */
14760 if (!targetm.have_tls || !targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
14761 break;
14763 /* We used to emit DW_OP_addr here, but that's wrong, since
14764 DW_OP_addr should be relocated by the debug info consumer,
14765 while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address operand should not. */
14766 temp = new_loc_descr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4
14767 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u, 0, 0);
14768 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14769 temp->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14770 temp->dtprel = true;
14772 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
14773 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, temp);
14775 break;
14778 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
14779 break;
14781 symref:
14782 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
14783 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
14784 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
14785 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
14786 break;
14788 case CONCAT:
14789 case CONCATN:
14790 case VAR_LOCATION:
14791 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
14792 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, rtl,
14793 "CONCAT/CONCATN/VAR_LOCATION is handled only by loc_descriptor");
14794 return 0;
14796 case ENTRY_VALUE:
14797 if (dwarf_strict)
14798 return NULL;
14799 if (REG_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)))
14801 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT
14802 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14803 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
14804 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14805 else
14807 = one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl)),
14808 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14810 else if (MEM_P (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl))
14811 && REG_P (XEXP (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), 0)))
14813 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (ENTRY_VALUE_EXP (rtl), mode,
14814 VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14815 if (op0 && op0->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_fbreg)
14816 return NULL;
14818 else
14819 gcc_unreachable ();
14820 if (op0 == NULL)
14821 return NULL;
14822 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_entry_value, 0, 0);
14823 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
14824 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = op0;
14825 return mem_loc_result;
14827 case PRE_MODIFY:
14828 /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
14829 PLUS code below. */
14830 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14831 goto plus;
14833 case PRE_INC:
14834 case PRE_DEC:
14835 /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
14836 below. */
14837 rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
14838 GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
14839 ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)
14840 : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mem_mode)));
14842 /* ... fall through ... */
14844 case PLUS:
14845 plus:
14846 if (is_based_loc (rtl)
14847 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
14848 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
14849 mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
14850 INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)),
14851 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14852 else
14854 mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14855 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14856 if (mem_loc_result == 0)
14857 break;
14859 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
14860 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
14861 loc_descr_plus_const (&mem_loc_result, INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
14862 else
14864 dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result2
14865 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14866 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14867 if (mem_loc_result2 == 0)
14868 break;
14869 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, mem_loc_result2);
14870 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
14871 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
14874 break;
14876 /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
14877 be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift. */
14878 case MINUS:
14879 op = DW_OP_minus;
14880 goto do_binop;
14882 case MULT:
14883 op = DW_OP_mul;
14884 goto do_binop;
14886 case DIV:
14887 op = DW_OP_div;
14888 goto do_binop;
14890 case UMOD:
14891 op = DW_OP_mod;
14892 goto do_binop;
14894 case ASHIFT:
14895 op = DW_OP_shl;
14896 goto do_shift;
14898 case ASHIFTRT:
14899 op = DW_OP_shra;
14900 goto do_shift;
14902 case LSHIFTRT:
14903 op = DW_OP_shr;
14904 goto do_shift;
14906 do_shift:
14907 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
14908 break;
14909 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14910 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14912 rtx rtlop1 = XEXP (rtl, 1);
14913 if (GET_MODE (rtlop1) != VOIDmode
14914 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (rtlop1))
14915 < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
14916 rtlop1 = gen_rtx_ZERO_EXTEND (mode, rtlop1);
14917 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (rtlop1, mode, mem_mode,
14918 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14921 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
14922 break;
14924 mem_loc_result = op0;
14925 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
14926 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14927 break;
14929 case AND:
14930 op = DW_OP_and;
14931 goto do_binop;
14933 case IOR:
14934 op = DW_OP_or;
14935 goto do_binop;
14937 case XOR:
14938 op = DW_OP_xor;
14939 goto do_binop;
14941 do_binop:
14942 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14943 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14944 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14945 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14947 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
14948 break;
14950 mem_loc_result = op0;
14951 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
14952 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
14953 break;
14955 case MOD:
14956 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE && !dwarf_strict)
14958 /* If MODE is wider than DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, mem_loc_descriptor
14959 should return signed typed values and therefore DW_OP_mod
14960 won't be unsigned as it defaults for untyped stack values,
14961 but signed. */
14962 op = DW_OP_mod;
14963 goto do_binop;
14966 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14967 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14968 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14969 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14971 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
14972 break;
14974 mem_loc_result = op0;
14975 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
14976 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14977 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
14978 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
14979 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
14980 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
14981 break;
14983 case UDIV:
14984 if (!dwarf_strict && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
14986 dw_die_ref type_die;
14987 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
14989 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 1);
14990 if (type_die == NULL)
14991 break;
14992 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
14993 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14994 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
14995 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
14996 if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
14997 break;
14998 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
14999 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15000 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15001 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15002 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15003 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
15004 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15005 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15006 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15007 add_loc_descr (&op1, cvt);
15008 mem_loc_result = op0;
15009 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
15010 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
15011 mem_loc_result = convert_descriptor_to_signed (mode, mem_loc_result);
15013 break;
15015 case NOT:
15016 op = DW_OP_not;
15017 goto do_unop;
15019 case ABS:
15020 op = DW_OP_abs;
15021 goto do_unop;
15023 case NEG:
15024 op = DW_OP_neg;
15025 goto do_unop;
15027 do_unop:
15028 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, mem_mode,
15029 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15031 if (op0 == 0)
15032 break;
15034 mem_loc_result = op0;
15035 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15036 break;
15038 case CONST_INT:
15039 if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15040 #ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
15041 || (mode == Pmode
15042 && mem_mode != VOIDmode
15043 && trunc_int_for_mode (INTVAL (rtl), ptr_mode) == INTVAL (rtl))
15044 #endif
15047 mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
15048 break;
15050 if (!dwarf_strict
15051 && (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
15052 || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))
15054 dw_die_ref type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
15055 if (type_die == NULL)
15056 return NULL;
15057 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0,
15058 INTVAL (rtl));
15059 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15060 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15061 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15062 if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
15063 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15064 else
15066 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15067 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15068 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15069 = shwi_to_double_int (INTVAL (rtl));
15072 break;
15074 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15075 if (!dwarf_strict)
15077 dw_die_ref type_die;
15079 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
15080 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15081 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
15082 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15083 if (mode == VOIDmode
15084 || (GET_MODE (rtl) == VOIDmode
15085 && GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) != 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))
15086 break;
15087 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, 0);
15088 if (type_die == NULL)
15089 return NULL;
15090 mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_const_type, 0, 0);
15091 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15092 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15093 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15094 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15096 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
15097 unsigned char *array
15098 = (unsigned char*) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
15100 insert_float (rtl, array);
15101 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15102 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15103 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15104 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15106 else
15108 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class
15109 = dw_val_class_const_double;
15110 mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15111 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15114 break;
15116 case EQ:
15117 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_eq, rtl, mem_mode);
15118 break;
15120 case GE:
15121 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15122 break;
15124 case GT:
15125 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15126 break;
15128 case LE:
15129 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15130 break;
15132 case LT:
15133 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15134 break;
15136 case NE:
15137 mem_loc_result = scompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ne, rtl, mem_mode);
15138 break;
15140 case GEU:
15141 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_ge, rtl, mem_mode);
15142 break;
15144 case GTU:
15145 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_gt, rtl, mem_mode);
15146 break;
15148 case LEU:
15149 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_le, rtl, mem_mode);
15150 break;
15152 case LTU:
15153 mem_loc_result = ucompare_loc_descriptor (DW_OP_lt, rtl, mem_mode);
15154 break;
15156 case UMIN:
15157 case UMAX:
15158 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT)
15159 break;
15160 /* FALLTHRU */
15161 case SMIN:
15162 case SMAX:
15163 mem_loc_result = minmax_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15164 break;
15166 case ZERO_EXTRACT:
15167 case SIGN_EXTRACT:
15168 if (CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15169 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15170 && ((unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1))
15171 + (unsigned) INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2))
15172 <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
15173 && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
15174 && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15175 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15177 int shift, size;
15178 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15179 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15180 if (op0 == 0)
15181 break;
15182 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SIGN_EXTRACT)
15183 op = DW_OP_shra;
15184 else
15185 op = DW_OP_shr;
15186 mem_loc_result = op0;
15187 size = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
15188 shift = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 2));
15189 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15190 shift = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15191 - shift - size;
15192 if (shift + size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15194 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15195 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15196 - shift - size));
15197 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_shl, 0, 0));
15199 if (size != (int) DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15201 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
15202 int_loc_descriptor (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE - size));
15203 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
15206 break;
15208 case IF_THEN_ELSE:
15210 dw_loc_descr_ref op2, bra_node, drop_node;
15211 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0),
15212 GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == VOIDmode
15213 ? word_mode : GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15214 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15215 op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode, mem_mode,
15216 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15217 op2 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 2), mode, mem_mode,
15218 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15219 if (op0 == NULL || op1 == NULL || op2 == NULL)
15220 break;
15222 mem_loc_result = op1;
15223 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op2);
15224 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op0);
15225 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
15226 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, bra_node);
15227 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_swap, 0, 0));
15228 drop_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_drop, 0, 0);
15229 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, drop_node);
15230 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
15231 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = drop_node;
15233 break;
15235 case FLOAT_EXTEND:
15236 case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
15237 case FLOAT:
15238 case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
15239 case FIX:
15240 case UNSIGNED_FIX:
15241 if (!dwarf_strict)
15243 dw_die_ref type_die;
15244 dw_loc_descr_ref cvt;
15246 op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15247 mem_mode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15248 if (op0 == NULL)
15249 break;
15250 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0))) == MODE_INT
15251 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT
15252 || GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
15253 <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15255 type_die = base_type_for_mode (GET_MODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)),
15256 GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
15257 if (type_die == NULL)
15258 break;
15259 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
15260 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15261 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15262 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15263 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15265 type_die = base_type_for_mode (mode, GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX);
15266 if (type_die == NULL)
15267 break;
15268 cvt = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_convert, 0, 0);
15269 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15270 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = type_die;
15271 cvt->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15272 add_loc_descr (&op0, cvt);
15273 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
15274 && (GET_CODE (rtl) == UNSIGNED_FIX
15275 || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) < DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE))
15277 op0 = convert_descriptor_to_signed (mode, op0);
15278 if (op0 == NULL)
15279 break;
15281 mem_loc_result = op0;
15283 break;
15285 case CLZ:
15286 case CTZ:
15287 case FFS:
15288 mem_loc_result = clz_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15289 break;
15291 case POPCOUNT:
15292 case PARITY:
15293 mem_loc_result = popcount_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15294 break;
15296 case BSWAP:
15297 mem_loc_result = bswap_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15298 break;
15300 case ROTATE:
15301 case ROTATERT:
15302 mem_loc_result = rotate_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode);
15303 break;
15305 case COMPARE:
15306 case TRUNCATE:
15307 /* In theory, we could implement the above. */
15308 /* DWARF cannot represent the unsigned compare operations
15309 natively. */
15310 case SS_MULT:
15311 case US_MULT:
15312 case SS_DIV:
15313 case US_DIV:
15314 case SS_PLUS:
15315 case US_PLUS:
15316 case SS_MINUS:
15317 case US_MINUS:
15318 case SS_NEG:
15319 case US_NEG:
15320 case SS_ABS:
15321 case SS_ASHIFT:
15322 case US_ASHIFT:
15323 case SS_TRUNCATE:
15324 case US_TRUNCATE:
15325 case UNORDERED:
15326 case ORDERED:
15327 case UNEQ:
15328 case UNGE:
15329 case UNGT:
15330 case UNLE:
15331 case UNLT:
15332 case LTGT:
15333 case FRACT_CONVERT:
15334 case UNSIGNED_FRACT_CONVERT:
15335 case SAT_FRACT:
15336 case UNSIGNED_SAT_FRACT:
15337 case SQRT:
15338 case ASM_OPERANDS:
15339 case VEC_MERGE:
15340 case VEC_SELECT:
15341 case VEC_CONCAT:
15342 case VEC_DUPLICATE:
15343 case UNSPEC:
15344 case HIGH:
15345 case FMA:
15346 case STRICT_LOW_PART:
15347 case CONST_VECTOR:
15348 case CONST_FIXED:
15349 /* If delegitimize_address couldn't do anything with the UNSPEC, we
15350 can't express it in the debug info. This can happen e.g. with some
15351 TLS UNSPECs. */
15352 break;
15354 case CONST_STRING:
15355 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
15356 goto symref;
15358 default:
15359 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
15360 print_rtl (stderr, rtl);
15361 gcc_unreachable ();
15362 #else
15363 break;
15364 #endif
15367 if (mem_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15368 add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15370 return mem_loc_result;
15373 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
15374 This is typically a complex variable. */
15376 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15377 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1, enum var_init_status initialized)
15379 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15380 dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref
15381 = loc_descriptor (x0, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15382 dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref
15383 = loc_descriptor (x1, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15385 if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
15386 return 0;
15388 cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
15389 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
15391 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
15392 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
15394 if (initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15395 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15397 return cc_loc_result;
15400 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of N
15401 locations. */
15403 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15404 concatn_loc_descriptor (rtx concatn, enum var_init_status initialized)
15406 unsigned int i;
15407 dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
15408 unsigned int n = XVECLEN (concatn, 0);
15410 for (i = 0; i < n; ++i)
15412 dw_loc_descr_ref ref;
15413 rtx x = XVECEXP (concatn, 0, i);
15415 ref = loc_descriptor (x, VOIDmode, VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
15416 if (ref == NULL)
15417 return NULL;
15419 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, ref);
15420 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x)));
15423 if (cc_loc_result && initialized == VAR_INIT_STATUS_UNINITIALIZED)
15424 add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_uninit, 0, 0));
15426 return cc_loc_result;
15429 /* Helper function for loc_descriptor. Return DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer
15430 for DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR RTL. */
15432 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15433 implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtx rtl, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
15435 dw_loc_descr_ref ret;
15436 dw_die_ref ref;
15438 if (dwarf_strict)
15439 return NULL;
15440 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == VAR_DECL
15441 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == PARM_DECL
15442 || TREE_CODE (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl)) == RESULT_DECL);
15443 ref = lookup_decl_die (DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl));
15444 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer, 0, offset);
15445 ret->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
15446 if (ref)
15448 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
15449 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
15450 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
15452 else
15454 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_decl_ref;
15455 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref = DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR_DECL (rtl);
15457 return ret;
15460 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
15461 which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location. For a
15462 register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number. For a
15463 memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
15464 generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
15466 MODE is mode of the decl if this loc_descriptor is going to be used in
15467 .debug_loc section where DW_OP_stack_value and DW_OP_implicit_value are
15468 allowed, VOIDmode otherwise.
15470 If we don't know how to describe it, return 0. */
15472 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15473 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode,
15474 enum var_init_status initialized)
15476 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
15478 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
15480 case SUBREG:
15481 /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
15482 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
15483 up an entire register. For now, just assume that it is
15484 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
15485 contains the given subreg. */
15486 if (REG_P (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) && subreg_lowpart_p (rtl))
15487 loc_result = loc_descriptor (SUBREG_REG (rtl), mode, initialized);
15488 else
15489 goto do_default;
15490 break;
15492 case REG:
15493 loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15494 break;
15496 case MEM:
15497 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
15498 GET_MODE (rtl), initialized);
15499 if (loc_result == NULL)
15500 loc_result = tls_mem_loc_descriptor (rtl);
15501 if (loc_result == NULL)
15503 rtx new_rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
15504 if (new_rtl != rtl)
15505 loc_result = loc_descriptor (new_rtl, mode, initialized);
15507 break;
15509 case CONCAT:
15510 loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1),
15511 initialized);
15512 break;
15514 case CONCATN:
15515 loc_result = concatn_loc_descriptor (rtl, initialized);
15516 break;
15518 case VAR_LOCATION:
15519 /* Single part. */
15520 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl)) != PARALLEL)
15522 rtx loc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (rtl);
15523 if (GET_CODE (loc) == EXPR_LIST)
15524 loc = XEXP (loc, 0);
15525 loc_result = loc_descriptor (loc, mode, initialized);
15526 break;
15529 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
15530 /* FALLTHRU */
15532 case PARALLEL:
15534 rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
15535 int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
15536 enum machine_mode mode;
15537 int i;
15539 /* Create the first one, so we have something to add to. */
15540 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0),
15541 VOIDmode, initialized);
15542 if (loc_result == NULL)
15543 return NULL;
15544 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
15545 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15546 for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
15548 dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
15550 temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0),
15551 VOIDmode, initialized);
15552 if (temp == NULL)
15553 return NULL;
15554 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
15555 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
15556 add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
15559 break;
15561 case CONST_INT:
15562 if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
15563 loc_result = address_of_int_loc_descriptor (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode),
15564 INTVAL (rtl));
15565 break;
15567 case CONST_DOUBLE:
15568 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15569 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15571 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15573 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
15575 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer
15576 or a floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever
15577 the constant requires more than one word in order to be
15578 adequately represented. We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks. */
15579 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15580 GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), 0);
15581 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
15583 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
15584 unsigned char *array
15585 = (unsigned char*) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
15587 insert_float (rtl, array);
15588 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15589 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length / 4;
15590 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = 4;
15591 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15593 else
15595 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_const_double;
15596 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_double
15597 = rtx_to_double_int (rtl);
15600 break;
15602 case CONST_VECTOR:
15603 if (mode == VOIDmode)
15604 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
15606 if (mode != VOIDmode && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15608 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
15609 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
15610 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
15611 ggc_alloc_atomic (length * elt_size);
15612 unsigned int i;
15613 unsigned char *p;
15615 gcc_assert (mode == GET_MODE (rtl) || VOIDmode == GET_MODE (rtl));
15616 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
15618 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
15619 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15621 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15622 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
15624 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
15625 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
15626 else
15628 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
15629 insert_double (val, p);
15632 break;
15634 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
15635 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
15637 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
15638 insert_float (elt, p);
15640 break;
15642 default:
15643 gcc_unreachable ();
15646 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_implicit_value,
15647 length * elt_size, 0);
15648 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
15649 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.length = length;
15650 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
15651 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_vec.array = array;
15653 break;
15655 case CONST:
15656 if (mode == VOIDmode
15657 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_INT
15658 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_DOUBLE
15659 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_VECTOR)
15661 loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode, initialized);
15662 break;
15664 /* FALLTHROUGH */
15665 case SYMBOL_REF:
15666 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
15667 break;
15668 case LABEL_REF:
15669 if (mode != VOIDmode && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15670 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15672 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
15673 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
15674 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
15675 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15676 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
15678 break;
15680 case DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR:
15681 loc_result = implicit_ptr_descriptor (rtl, 0);
15682 break;
15684 case PLUS:
15685 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == DEBUG_IMPLICIT_PTR
15686 && CONST_INT_P (XEXP (rtl, 1)))
15688 loc_result
15689 = implicit_ptr_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
15690 break;
15692 /* FALLTHRU */
15693 do_default:
15694 default:
15695 if ((GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE (rtl) == mode
15696 && GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
15697 && dwarf_version >= 4)
15698 || (!dwarf_strict && mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode))
15700 /* Value expression. */
15701 loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
15702 if (loc_result)
15703 add_loc_descr (&loc_result,
15704 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15706 break;
15709 return loc_result;
15712 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
15713 address ranges where a given location is valid.
15714 1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
15715 2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
15716 3. Otherwise, use the text section.
15717 XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice. */
15719 static const char *
15720 secname_for_decl (const_tree decl)
15722 const char *secname;
15724 if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
15726 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
15727 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
15729 else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
15731 tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
15732 secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
15734 else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
15735 secname = crtl->subsections.cold_section_label;
15736 else
15737 secname = text_section_label;
15739 return secname;
15742 /* Return true when DECL_BY_REFERENCE is defined and set for DECL. */
15744 static bool
15745 decl_by_reference_p (tree decl)
15747 return ((TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL
15748 || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
15749 && DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl));
15752 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
15753 for VARLOC. */
15755 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15756 dw_loc_list_1 (tree loc, rtx varloc, int want_address,
15757 enum var_init_status initialized)
15759 int have_address = 0;
15760 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
15761 enum machine_mode mode;
15763 if (want_address != 2)
15765 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION);
15766 /* Single part. */
15767 if (GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
15769 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
15770 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
15771 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
15772 mode = GET_MODE (varloc);
15773 if (MEM_P (varloc))
15775 rtx addr = XEXP (varloc, 0);
15776 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (addr, get_address_mode (varloc),
15777 mode, initialized);
15778 if (descr)
15779 have_address = 1;
15780 else
15782 rtx x = avoid_constant_pool_reference (varloc);
15783 if (x != varloc)
15784 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (x, mode, VOIDmode,
15785 initialized);
15788 else
15789 descr = mem_loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, VOIDmode, initialized);
15791 else
15792 return 0;
15794 else
15796 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION)
15797 mode = DECL_MODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (varloc));
15798 else
15799 mode = DECL_MODE (loc);
15800 descr = loc_descriptor (varloc, mode, initialized);
15801 have_address = 1;
15804 if (!descr)
15805 return 0;
15807 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
15808 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
15810 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15812 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15813 "DWARF address size mismatch");
15814 return 0;
15816 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
15817 have_address = 1;
15819 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
15820 if (want_address && !have_address)
15822 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15823 "Want address and only have value");
15824 return 0;
15827 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
15828 if (!want_address && have_address)
15830 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
15831 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
15833 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
15835 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
15836 "DWARF address size mismatch");
15837 return 0;
15839 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
15840 op = DW_OP_deref;
15841 else
15842 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
15844 add_loc_descr (&descr, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
15847 return descr;
15850 /* Create a DW_OP_piece or DW_OP_bit_piece for bitsize, or return NULL
15851 if it is not possible. */
15853 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15854 new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
15856 if ((bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0 && offset == 0)
15857 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT, 0);
15858 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
15859 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bit_piece, bitsize, offset);
15860 else
15861 return NULL;
15864 /* Helper function for dw_loc_list. Compute proper Dwarf location descriptor
15865 for VAR_LOC_NOTE for variable DECL that has been optimized by SRA. */
15867 static dw_loc_descr_ref
15868 dw_sra_loc_expr (tree decl, rtx loc)
15870 rtx p;
15871 unsigned int padsize = 0;
15872 dw_loc_descr_ref descr, *descr_tail;
15873 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT decl_size;
15874 rtx varloc;
15875 enum var_init_status initialized;
15877 if (DECL_SIZE (decl) == NULL
15878 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
15879 return NULL;
15881 decl_size = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1);
15882 descr = NULL;
15883 descr_tail = &descr;
15885 for (p = loc; p; p = XEXP (p, 1))
15887 unsigned int bitsize = decl_piece_bitsize (p);
15888 rtx loc_note = *decl_piece_varloc_ptr (p);
15889 dw_loc_descr_ref cur_descr;
15890 dw_loc_descr_ref *tail, last = NULL;
15891 unsigned int opsize = 0;
15893 if (loc_note == NULL_RTX
15894 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_note) == NULL_RTX)
15896 padsize += bitsize;
15897 continue;
15899 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (loc_note);
15900 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_note);
15901 cur_descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, 2, initialized);
15902 if (cur_descr == NULL)
15904 padsize += bitsize;
15905 continue;
15908 /* Check that cur_descr either doesn't use
15909 DW_OP_*piece operations, or their sum is equal
15910 to bitsize. Otherwise we can't embed it. */
15911 for (tail = &cur_descr; *tail != NULL;
15912 tail = &(*tail)->dw_loc_next)
15913 if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_piece)
15915 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned
15916 * BITS_PER_UNIT;
15917 last = *tail;
15919 else if ((*tail)->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bit_piece)
15921 opsize += (*tail)->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
15922 last = *tail;
15925 if (last != NULL && opsize != bitsize)
15927 padsize += bitsize;
15928 continue;
15931 /* If there is a hole, add DW_OP_*piece after empty DWARF
15932 expression, which means that those bits are optimized out. */
15933 if (padsize)
15935 if (padsize > decl_size)
15936 return NULL;
15937 decl_size -= padsize;
15938 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (padsize, 0);
15939 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
15940 return NULL;
15941 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
15942 padsize = 0;
15944 *descr_tail = cur_descr;
15945 descr_tail = tail;
15946 if (bitsize > decl_size)
15947 return NULL;
15948 decl_size -= bitsize;
15949 if (last == NULL)
15951 HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
15952 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == VAR_LOCATION
15953 && GET_CODE (PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc)) != PARALLEL)
15955 varloc = PAT_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (varloc);
15956 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == EXPR_LIST)
15957 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
15961 if (GET_CODE (varloc) == CONST
15962 || GET_CODE (varloc) == SIGN_EXTEND
15963 || GET_CODE (varloc) == ZERO_EXTEND)
15964 varloc = XEXP (varloc, 0);
15965 else if (GET_CODE (varloc) == SUBREG)
15966 varloc = SUBREG_REG (varloc);
15967 else
15968 break;
15970 while (1);
15971 /* DW_OP_bit_size offset should be zero for register
15972 or implicit location descriptions and empty location
15973 descriptions, but for memory addresses needs big endian
15974 adjustment. */
15975 if (MEM_P (varloc))
15977 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT memsize
15978 = INTVAL (MEM_SIZE (varloc)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
15979 if (memsize != bitsize)
15981 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN != WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
15982 && (memsize > BITS_PER_WORD || bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD))
15983 return NULL;
15984 if (memsize < bitsize)
15985 return NULL;
15986 if (BITS_BIG_ENDIAN)
15987 offset = memsize - bitsize;
15991 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (bitsize, offset);
15992 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
15993 return NULL;
15994 descr_tail = &(*descr_tail)->dw_loc_next;
15998 /* If there were any non-empty expressions, add padding till the end of
15999 the decl. */
16000 if (descr != NULL && decl_size != 0)
16002 *descr_tail = new_loc_descr_op_bit_piece (decl_size, 0);
16003 if (*descr_tail == NULL)
16004 return NULL;
16006 return descr;
16009 /* Return the dwarf representation of the location list LOC_LIST of
16010 DECL. WANT_ADDRESS has the same meaning as in loc_list_from_tree
16011 function. */
16013 static dw_loc_list_ref
16014 dw_loc_list (var_loc_list *loc_list, tree decl, int want_address)
16016 const char *endname, *secname;
16017 rtx varloc;
16018 enum var_init_status initialized;
16019 struct var_loc_node *node;
16020 dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
16021 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
16022 dw_loc_list_ref list = NULL;
16023 dw_loc_list_ref *listp = &list;
16025 /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
16026 actually construct the list of locations.
16027 The first location information is what is passed to the
16028 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
16029 locations just get added on to that list.
16030 Note that we only know the start address for a location
16031 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
16032 the range [current location start, next location start].
16033 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
16034 a range of [last location start, end of function label]. */
16036 secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
16038 for (node = loc_list->first; node; node = node->next)
16039 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST
16040 || NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc) != NULL_RTX)
16042 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16044 /* This requires DW_OP_{,bit_}piece, which is not usable
16045 inside DWARF expressions. */
16046 if (want_address != 2)
16047 continue;
16048 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16049 if (descr == NULL)
16050 continue;
16052 else
16054 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16055 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16056 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address, initialized);
16058 if (descr)
16060 bool range_across_switch = false;
16061 /* If section switch happens in between node->label
16062 and node->next->label (or end of function) and
16063 we can't emit it as a single entry list,
16064 emit two ranges, first one ending at the end
16065 of first partition and second one starting at the
16066 beginning of second partition. */
16067 if (node == loc_list->last_before_switch
16068 && (node != loc_list->first || loc_list->first->next)
16069 && current_function_decl)
16071 endname = current_fde ()->dw_fde_end;
16072 range_across_switch = true;
16074 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16075 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16076 else if (node->next)
16077 endname = node->next->label;
16078 /* If the variable has a location at the last label
16079 it keeps its location until the end of function. */
16080 else if (!current_function_decl)
16081 endname = text_end_label;
16082 else
16084 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
16085 current_function_funcdef_no);
16086 endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
16089 *listp = new_loc_list (descr, node->label, endname, secname);
16090 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16092 if (range_across_switch)
16094 if (GET_CODE (node->loc) == EXPR_LIST)
16095 descr = dw_sra_loc_expr (decl, node->loc);
16096 else
16098 initialized = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_STATUS (node->loc);
16099 varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->loc);
16100 descr = dw_loc_list_1 (decl, varloc, want_address,
16101 initialized);
16103 gcc_assert (descr);
16104 /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
16105 NODE->NEXT->LABEL. */
16106 if (node->next)
16107 endname = node->next->label;
16108 else
16109 endname = current_fde ()->dw_fde_second_end;
16110 *listp = new_loc_list (descr,
16111 current_fde ()->dw_fde_second_begin,
16112 endname, secname);
16113 listp = &(*listp)->dw_loc_next;
16118 /* Try to avoid the overhead of a location list emitting a location
16119 expression instead, but only if we didn't have more than one
16120 location entry in the first place. If some entries were not
16121 representable, we don't want to pretend a single entry that was
16122 applies to the entire scope in which the variable is
16123 available. */
16124 if (list && loc_list->first->next)
16125 gen_llsym (list);
16127 return list;
16130 /* Return if the loc_list has only single element and thus can be represented
16131 as location description. */
16133 static bool
16134 single_element_loc_list_p (dw_loc_list_ref list)
16136 gcc_assert (!list->dw_loc_next || list->ll_symbol);
16137 return !list->ll_symbol;
16140 /* To each location in list LIST add loc descr REF. */
16142 static void
16143 add_loc_descr_to_each (dw_loc_list_ref list, dw_loc_descr_ref ref)
16145 dw_loc_descr_ref copy;
16146 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, ref);
16147 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16148 while (list)
16150 copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
16151 memcpy (copy, ref, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
16152 add_loc_descr (&list->expr, copy);
16153 while (copy->dw_loc_next)
16155 dw_loc_descr_ref new_copy = ggc_alloc_dw_loc_descr_node ();
16156 memcpy (new_copy, copy->dw_loc_next, sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
16157 copy->dw_loc_next = new_copy;
16158 copy = new_copy;
16160 list = list->dw_loc_next;
16164 /* Given two lists RET and LIST
16165 produce location list that is result of adding expression in LIST
16166 to expression in RET on each possition in program.
16167 Might be destructive on both RET and LIST.
16169 TODO: We handle only simple cases of RET or LIST having at most one
16170 element. General case would inolve sorting the lists in program order
16171 and merging them that will need some additional work.
16172 Adding that will improve quality of debug info especially for SRA-ed
16173 structures. */
16175 static void
16176 add_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *ret, dw_loc_list_ref list)
16178 if (!list)
16179 return;
16180 if (!*ret)
16182 *ret = list;
16183 return;
16185 if (!list->dw_loc_next)
16187 add_loc_descr_to_each (*ret, list->expr);
16188 return;
16190 if (!(*ret)->dw_loc_next)
16192 add_loc_descr_to_each (list, (*ret)->expr);
16193 *ret = list;
16194 return;
16196 expansion_failed (NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX,
16197 "Don't know how to merge two non-trivial"
16198 " location lists.\n");
16199 *ret = NULL;
16200 return;
16203 /* LOC is constant expression. Try a luck, look it up in constant
16204 pool and return its loc_descr of its address. */
16206 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16207 cst_pool_loc_descr (tree loc)
16209 /* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted. */
16210 rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
16212 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
16214 gcc_assert (!rtl);
16215 return 0;
16217 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF);
16219 /* TODO: We might get more coverage if we was actually delaying expansion
16220 of all expressions till end of compilation when constant pools are fully
16221 populated. */
16222 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0))))
16224 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16225 "CST value in contant pool but not marked.");
16226 return 0;
16228 return mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), get_address_mode (rtl),
16229 GET_MODE (rtl), VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16232 /* Return dw_loc_list representing address of addr_expr LOC
16233 by looking for innder INDIRECT_REF expression and turing it
16234 into simple arithmetics. */
16236 static dw_loc_list_ref
16237 loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref (tree loc, bool toplev)
16239 tree obj, offset;
16240 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
16241 enum machine_mode mode;
16242 int volatilep;
16243 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16244 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
16246 obj = get_inner_reference (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0),
16247 &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
16248 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
16249 STRIP_NOPS (obj);
16250 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT)
16252 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "bitfield access");
16253 return 0;
16255 if (!INDIRECT_REF_P (obj))
16257 expansion_failed (obj,
16258 NULL_RTX, "no indirect ref in inner refrence");
16259 return 0;
16261 if (!offset && !bitpos)
16262 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), toplev ? 2 : 1);
16263 else if (toplev
16264 && int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) <= DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
16265 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16267 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (obj, 0), 0);
16268 if (!list_ret)
16269 return 0;
16270 if (offset)
16272 /* Variable offset. */
16273 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
16274 if (list_ret1 == 0)
16275 return 0;
16276 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16277 if (!list_ret)
16278 return 0;
16279 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16280 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16282 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16283 if (bytepos > 0)
16284 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16285 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
16286 bytepos, 0));
16287 else if (bytepos < 0)
16288 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
16289 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16290 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16292 return list_ret;
16296 /* Generate Dwarf location list representing LOC.
16297 If WANT_ADDRESS is false, expression computing LOC will be computed
16298 If WANT_ADDRESS is 1, expression computing address of LOC will be returned
16299 if WANT_ADDRESS is 2, expression computing address useable in location
16300 will be returned (i.e. DW_OP_reg can be used
16301 to refer to register values). */
16303 static dw_loc_list_ref
16304 loc_list_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
16306 dw_loc_descr_ref ret = NULL, ret1 = NULL;
16307 dw_loc_list_ref list_ret = NULL, list_ret1 = NULL;
16308 int have_address = 0;
16309 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
16311 /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
16312 extending the values properly. Hopefully this won't be a real
16313 problem... */
16315 switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
16317 case ERROR_MARK:
16318 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "ERROR_MARK");
16319 return 0;
16321 case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
16322 /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
16323 position of other fields. We don't try to encode this here. The
16324 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
16325 the names of types. */
16326 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PLACEHOLDER_EXPR");
16327 return 0;
16329 case CALL_EXPR:
16330 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CALL_EXPR");
16331 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
16332 return 0;
16334 case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
16335 case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
16336 case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
16337 case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
16338 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "PRE/POST INDCREMENT/DECREMENT");
16339 /* There are no opcodes for these operations. */
16340 return 0;
16342 case ADDR_EXPR:
16343 /* If we already want an address, see if there is INDIRECT_REF inside
16344 e.g. for &this->field. */
16345 if (want_address)
16347 list_ret = loc_list_for_address_of_addr_expr_of_indirect_ref
16348 (loc, want_address == 2);
16349 if (list_ret)
16350 have_address = 1;
16351 else if (decl_address_ip_invariant_p (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))
16352 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
16353 have_address = 1;
16355 /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address. */
16356 if (!list_ret && !ret)
16357 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
16358 else
16360 if (want_address)
16361 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "need address of ADDR_EXPR");
16362 return NULL;
16364 break;
16366 case VAR_DECL:
16367 if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
16369 rtx rtl;
16370 enum dwarf_location_atom first_op;
16371 enum dwarf_location_atom second_op;
16372 bool dtprel = false;
16374 if (targetm.have_tls)
16376 /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the
16377 data. */
16378 if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
16379 return 0;
16381 /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we
16382 can only look up addresses of objects in the current
16383 module. We used DW_OP_addr as first op, but that's
16384 wrong, because DW_OP_addr is relocated by the debug
16385 info consumer, while DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address
16386 operand shouldn't be. */
16387 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc) && !targetm.binds_local_p (loc))
16388 return 0;
16389 first_op = DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE == 4 ? DW_OP_const4u : DW_OP_const8u;
16390 dtprel = true;
16391 second_op = DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address;
16393 else
16395 if (!targetm.emutls.debug_form_tls_address
16396 || !(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
16397 return 0;
16398 /* We stuffed the control variable into the DECL_VALUE_EXPR
16399 to signal (via DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P) that the decl should
16400 no longer appear in gimple code. We used the control
16401 variable in specific so that we could pick it up here. */
16402 loc = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc);
16403 first_op = DW_OP_addr;
16404 second_op = DW_OP_form_tls_address;
16407 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
16408 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
16409 return 0;
16411 if (!MEM_P (rtl))
16412 return 0;
16413 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
16414 if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
16415 return 0;
16417 ret = new_loc_descr (first_op, 0, 0);
16418 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
16419 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
16420 ret->dtprel = dtprel;
16422 ret1 = new_loc_descr (second_op, 0, 0);
16423 add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
16425 have_address = 1;
16426 break;
16428 /* FALLTHRU */
16430 case PARM_DECL:
16431 case RESULT_DECL:
16432 if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
16433 return loc_list_from_tree (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
16434 want_address);
16435 /* FALLTHRU */
16437 case FUNCTION_DECL:
16439 rtx rtl;
16440 var_loc_list *loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (loc);
16442 if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
16444 list_ret = dw_loc_list (loc_list, loc, want_address);
16445 have_address = want_address != 0;
16446 break;
16448 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
16449 if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
16451 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "DECL has no RTL");
16452 return 0;
16454 else if (CONST_INT_P (rtl))
16456 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
16457 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
16458 val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
16459 ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
16461 else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
16463 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX, "CONST_STRING");
16464 return 0;
16466 else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl) && const_ok_for_output (rtl))
16468 ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
16469 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
16470 ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
16472 else
16474 enum machine_mode mode, mem_mode;
16476 /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level. */
16477 if (want_address == 2)
16479 ret = loc_descriptor (rtl, VOIDmode,
16480 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16481 have_address = 1;
16483 else
16485 mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
16486 mem_mode = VOIDmode;
16487 if (MEM_P (rtl))
16489 mem_mode = mode;
16490 mode = get_address_mode (rtl);
16491 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
16492 have_address = 1;
16494 ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode, mem_mode,
16495 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
16497 if (!ret)
16498 expansion_failed (loc, rtl,
16499 "failed to produce loc descriptor for rtl");
16502 break;
16504 case MEM_REF:
16505 /* ??? FIXME. */
16506 if (!integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)))
16507 return 0;
16508 /* Fallthru. */
16509 case INDIRECT_REF:
16510 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
16511 have_address = 1;
16512 break;
16514 case COMPOUND_EXPR:
16515 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
16517 CASE_CONVERT:
16518 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
16519 case SAVE_EXPR:
16520 case MODIFY_EXPR:
16521 return loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
16523 case COMPONENT_REF:
16524 case BIT_FIELD_REF:
16525 case ARRAY_REF:
16526 case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
16527 case REALPART_EXPR:
16528 case IMAGPART_EXPR:
16530 tree obj, offset;
16531 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
16532 enum machine_mode mode;
16533 int volatilep;
16534 int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16536 obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
16537 &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
16539 gcc_assert (obj != loc);
16541 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (obj,
16542 want_address == 2
16543 && !bitpos && !offset ? 2 : 1);
16544 /* TODO: We can extract value of the small expression via shifting even
16545 for nonzero bitpos. */
16546 if (list_ret == 0)
16547 return 0;
16548 if (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
16550 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16551 "bitfield access");
16552 return 0;
16555 if (offset != NULL_TREE)
16557 /* Variable offset. */
16558 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (offset, 0);
16559 if (list_ret1 == 0)
16560 return 0;
16561 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16562 if (!list_ret)
16563 return 0;
16564 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
16567 bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
16568 if (bytepos > 0)
16569 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
16570 else if (bytepos < 0)
16571 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, bytepos);
16573 have_address = 1;
16574 break;
16577 case INTEGER_CST:
16578 if ((want_address || !host_integerp (loc, 0))
16579 && (ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
16580 have_address = 1;
16581 else if (want_address == 2
16582 && host_integerp (loc, 0)
16583 && (ret = address_of_int_loc_descriptor
16584 (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)),
16585 tree_low_cst (loc, 0))))
16586 have_address = 1;
16587 else if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
16588 ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
16589 else
16591 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16592 "Integer operand is not host integer");
16593 return 0;
16595 break;
16597 case CONSTRUCTOR:
16598 case REAL_CST:
16599 case STRING_CST:
16600 case COMPLEX_CST:
16601 if ((ret = cst_pool_loc_descr (loc)))
16602 have_address = 1;
16603 else
16604 /* We can construct small constants here using int_loc_descriptor. */
16605 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16606 "constructor or constant not in constant pool");
16607 break;
16609 case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
16610 case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
16611 case BIT_AND_EXPR:
16612 op = DW_OP_and;
16613 goto do_binop;
16615 case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
16616 case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
16617 op = DW_OP_xor;
16618 goto do_binop;
16620 case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
16621 case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
16622 case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
16623 op = DW_OP_or;
16624 goto do_binop;
16626 case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
16627 case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
16628 case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
16629 case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
16630 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
16631 return 0;
16632 op = DW_OP_div;
16633 goto do_binop;
16635 case MINUS_EXPR:
16636 op = DW_OP_minus;
16637 goto do_binop;
16639 case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
16640 case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
16641 case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
16642 case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
16643 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
16645 op = DW_OP_mod;
16646 goto do_binop;
16648 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
16649 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
16650 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
16651 return 0;
16653 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16654 if (list_ret == 0)
16655 return 0;
16656 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16657 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_over, 0, 0));
16658 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_div, 0, 0));
16659 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_mul, 0, 0));
16660 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0));
16661 break;
16663 case MULT_EXPR:
16664 op = DW_OP_mul;
16665 goto do_binop;
16667 case LSHIFT_EXPR:
16668 op = DW_OP_shl;
16669 goto do_binop;
16671 case RSHIFT_EXPR:
16672 op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
16673 goto do_binop;
16675 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
16676 case PLUS_EXPR:
16677 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
16679 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
16680 if (list_ret == 0)
16681 return 0;
16683 loc_list_plus_const (list_ret, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0));
16684 break;
16687 op = DW_OP_plus;
16688 goto do_binop;
16690 case LE_EXPR:
16691 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
16692 return 0;
16694 op = DW_OP_le;
16695 goto do_binop;
16697 case GE_EXPR:
16698 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
16699 return 0;
16701 op = DW_OP_ge;
16702 goto do_binop;
16704 case LT_EXPR:
16705 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
16706 return 0;
16708 op = DW_OP_lt;
16709 goto do_binop;
16711 case GT_EXPR:
16712 if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
16713 return 0;
16715 op = DW_OP_gt;
16716 goto do_binop;
16718 case EQ_EXPR:
16719 op = DW_OP_eq;
16720 goto do_binop;
16722 case NE_EXPR:
16723 op = DW_OP_ne;
16724 goto do_binop;
16726 do_binop:
16727 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
16728 list_ret1 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
16729 if (list_ret == 0 || list_ret1 == 0)
16730 return 0;
16732 add_loc_list (&list_ret, list_ret1);
16733 if (list_ret == 0)
16734 return 0;
16735 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16736 break;
16738 case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
16739 case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
16740 op = DW_OP_not;
16741 goto do_unop;
16743 case ABS_EXPR:
16744 op = DW_OP_abs;
16745 goto do_unop;
16747 case NEGATE_EXPR:
16748 op = DW_OP_neg;
16749 goto do_unop;
16751 do_unop:
16752 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
16753 if (list_ret == 0)
16754 return 0;
16756 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
16757 break;
16759 case MIN_EXPR:
16760 case MAX_EXPR:
16762 const enum tree_code code =
16763 TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
16765 loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
16766 build2 (code, integer_type_node,
16767 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
16768 TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
16771 /* ... fall through ... */
16773 case COND_EXPR:
16775 dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
16776 = loc_descriptor_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
16777 dw_loc_list_ref rhs
16778 = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
16779 dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
16781 list_ret = loc_list_from_tree (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
16782 if (list_ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
16783 return 0;
16785 bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
16786 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, bra_node);
16788 add_loc_list (&list_ret, rhs);
16789 jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
16790 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, jump_node);
16792 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, lhs);
16793 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16794 bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
16796 /* ??? Need a node to point the skip at. Use a nop. */
16797 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
16798 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, tmp);
16799 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
16800 jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
16802 break;
16804 case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
16805 return 0;
16807 default:
16808 /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown. This comes
16809 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR. */
16810 if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
16811 >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
16813 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16814 "language specific tree node");
16815 return 0;
16818 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
16819 /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
16820 these explicitly. We forgot one. */
16821 gcc_unreachable ();
16822 #else
16823 /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
16824 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash. */
16825 return NULL;
16826 #endif
16829 if (!ret && !list_ret)
16830 return 0;
16832 if (want_address == 2 && !have_address
16833 && (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict))
16835 if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc)) > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16837 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16838 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16839 return 0;
16841 if (ret)
16842 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16843 else
16844 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret,
16845 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
16846 have_address = 1;
16848 /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address. */
16849 if (want_address && !have_address)
16851 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16852 "Want address and only have value");
16853 return 0;
16856 gcc_assert (!ret || !list_ret);
16858 /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference. */
16859 if (!want_address && have_address)
16861 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
16863 if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
16865 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16866 "DWARF address size mismatch");
16867 return 0;
16869 else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
16870 op = DW_OP_deref;
16871 else
16872 op = DW_OP_deref_size;
16874 if (ret)
16875 add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16876 else
16877 add_loc_descr_to_each (list_ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
16879 if (ret)
16880 list_ret = new_loc_list (ret, NULL, NULL, NULL);
16882 return list_ret;
16885 /* Same as above but return only single location expression. */
16886 static dw_loc_descr_ref
16887 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc, int want_address)
16889 dw_loc_list_ref ret = loc_list_from_tree (loc, want_address);
16890 if (!ret)
16891 return NULL;
16892 if (ret->dw_loc_next)
16894 expansion_failed (loc, NULL_RTX,
16895 "Location list where only loc descriptor needed");
16896 return NULL;
16898 return ret->expr;
16901 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
16902 which is not less than the value itself. */
16904 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
16905 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
16907 return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
16910 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
16911 pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
16912 `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
16913 ERROR_MARK node. */
16915 static inline tree
16916 field_type (const_tree decl)
16918 tree type;
16920 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16921 return integer_type_node;
16923 type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
16924 if (type == NULL_TREE)
16925 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
16927 return type;
16930 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
16931 it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
16932 be an ERROR_MARK node. */
16934 static inline unsigned
16935 simple_type_align_in_bits (const_tree type)
16937 return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
16940 static inline unsigned
16941 simple_decl_align_in_bits (const_tree decl)
16943 return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
16946 /* Return the result of rounding T up to ALIGN. */
16948 static inline double_int
16949 round_up_to_align (double_int t, unsigned int align)
16951 double_int alignd = uhwi_to_double_int (align);
16952 t = double_int_add (t, alignd);
16953 t = double_int_add (t, double_int_minus_one);
16954 t = double_int_div (t, alignd, true, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
16955 t = double_int_mul (t, alignd);
16956 return t;
16959 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
16960 lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
16961 or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
16962 because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
16963 because the offset is actually variable. (We can't handle the latter case
16964 just yet). */
16966 static HOST_WIDE_INT
16967 field_byte_offset (const_tree decl)
16969 double_int object_offset_in_bits;
16970 double_int object_offset_in_bytes;
16971 double_int bitpos_int;
16973 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
16974 return 0;
16976 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
16978 /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
16979 for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0. Someday, we may
16980 be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult. */
16981 if (TREE_CODE (bit_position (decl)) != INTEGER_CST)
16982 return 0;
16984 bitpos_int = tree_to_double_int (bit_position (decl));
16986 #ifdef PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
16987 if (PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS)
16989 tree type;
16990 tree field_size_tree;
16991 double_int deepest_bitpos;
16992 double_int field_size_in_bits;
16993 unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
16994 unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
16995 double_int type_size_in_bits;
16997 type = field_type (decl);
16998 type_size_in_bits = double_int_type_size_in_bits (type);
16999 type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
17001 field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
17003 /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
17004 a flexible array member. */
17005 if (!field_size_tree)
17006 field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
17008 /* If the size of the field is not constant, use the type size. */
17009 if (TREE_CODE (field_size_tree) == INTEGER_CST)
17010 field_size_in_bits = tree_to_double_int (field_size_tree);
17011 else
17012 field_size_in_bits = type_size_in_bits;
17014 decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
17016 /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the
17017 starting bit offset (relative to the start of the containing
17018 structure type) of the hypothetical "containing object" for a
17019 bit-field. Thus, when computing the byte offset value for the
17020 start of the "containing object" of a bit-field, we must deduce
17021 this information on our own. This can be rather tricky to do in
17022 some cases. For example, handling the following structure type
17023 definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only
17024 aligns long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
17026 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
17028 Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used
17029 in such cases. When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will
17030 allocate 8 bytes for the structure shown above. It decides to
17031 do this based upon one simple rule for bit-field allocation.
17032 GCC allocates each "containing object" for each bit-field at
17033 the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment boundary
17034 (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared
17035 type of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the
17036 condition that there is still enough available space remaining
17037 in the containing object (when allocated at the selected point)
17038 to fully accommodate all of the bits of the bit-field itself.
17040 This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for
17041 each object of the structure type shown above. When looking
17042 for a place to allocate the "containing object" for `field2',
17043 the compiler simply tries to allocate a 64-bit "containing
17044 object" at each successive 32-bit boundary (starting at zero)
17045 until it finds a place to allocate that 64- bit field such that
17046 at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated) bits remain
17047 within that selected 64 bit field. (As it turns out, for the
17048 example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the
17049 "containing object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the
17050 structure type.)
17052 Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts
17053 we're given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC
17054 must have believed that the containing object started (within
17055 the structure type). The value we deduce is then used (by the
17056 callers of this routine) to generate DW_AT_location and
17057 DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields and, in
17058 the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well). */
17060 /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to
17061 the "deepest" bit of the bit-field. */
17062 deepest_bitpos = double_int_add (bitpos_int, field_size_in_bits);
17064 /* This is the tricky part. Use some fancy footwork to deduce
17065 where the lowest addressed bit of the containing object must
17066 be. */
17067 object_offset_in_bits
17068 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
17070 /* Round up to type_align by default. This works best for
17071 bitfields. */
17072 object_offset_in_bits
17073 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, type_align_in_bits);
17075 if (double_int_ucmp (object_offset_in_bits, bitpos_int) > 0)
17077 object_offset_in_bits
17078 = double_int_sub (deepest_bitpos, type_size_in_bits);
17080 /* Round up to decl_align instead. */
17081 object_offset_in_bits
17082 = round_up_to_align (object_offset_in_bits, decl_align_in_bits);
17085 else
17086 #endif /* PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS */
17087 object_offset_in_bits = bitpos_int;
17089 object_offset_in_bytes
17090 = double_int_div (object_offset_in_bits,
17091 uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_UNIT), true,
17092 TRUNC_DIV_EXPR);
17093 return double_int_to_shwi (object_offset_in_bytes);
17096 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
17097 associated with them. */
17099 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
17101 This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
17102 whole parameters. Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
17103 generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below. */
17105 static inline void
17106 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
17107 dw_loc_list_ref descr)
17109 if (descr == 0)
17110 return;
17111 if (single_element_loc_list_p (descr))
17112 add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr->expr);
17113 else
17114 add_AT_loc_list (die, attr_kind, descr);
17117 /* Add DW_AT_accessibility attribute to DIE if needed. */
17119 static void
17120 add_accessibility_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17122 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
17123 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
17124 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_public. */
17125 if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
17126 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
17127 else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
17129 if (dwarf_version == 2
17130 || die->die_parent == NULL
17131 || die->die_parent->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
17132 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
17134 else if (dwarf_version > 2
17135 && die->die_parent
17136 && die->die_parent->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
17137 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
17140 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
17141 struct and union types. In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
17142 represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
17143 descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
17144 byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
17145 the "containing object" for the bit-field. (See the `field_byte_offset'
17146 function above).
17148 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
17149 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
17150 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
17151 declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
17152 DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this). Note that it is the size (in
17153 bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
17154 DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field. (See the
17155 `byte_size_attribute' function below.) It is also used when calculating the
17156 value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute. (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
17157 function below.) */
17159 static void
17160 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
17162 HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
17163 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
17165 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
17167 /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class. */
17168 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
17170 /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
17171 aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
17172 type. We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
17173 vtable. The following dwarf expression means
17175 BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
17177 This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course. */
17179 dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
17181 /* Make a copy of the object address. */
17182 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
17183 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
17185 /* Extract the vtable address. */
17186 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
17187 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
17189 /* Calculate the address of the offset. */
17190 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
17191 gcc_assert (offset < 0);
17193 tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
17194 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
17195 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
17196 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
17198 /* Extract the offset. */
17199 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
17200 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
17202 /* Add it to the object address. */
17203 tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
17204 add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
17206 else
17207 offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
17209 else
17210 offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
17212 if (! loc_descr)
17214 if (dwarf_version > 2)
17216 /* Don't need to output a location expression, just the constant. */
17217 if (offset < 0)
17218 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
17219 else
17220 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, offset);
17221 return;
17223 else
17225 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
17227 /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
17228 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure
17229 field address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst. */
17231 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
17232 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
17233 operator correctly. It works only if we leave the offset on the
17234 stack. */
17235 op = DW_OP_constu;
17236 #else
17237 op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
17238 #endif
17240 loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
17244 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
17247 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array. */
17249 static void
17250 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
17252 while (size != 0)
17254 *dest++ = val & 0xff;
17255 val >>= 8;
17256 --size;
17260 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array. Inverse of insert_int. */
17262 static HOST_WIDE_INT
17263 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
17265 HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
17267 src += size;
17268 while (size != 0)
17270 val <<= 8;
17271 val |= *--src & 0xff;
17272 --size;
17274 return val;
17277 /* Writes double_int values to dw_vec_const array. */
17279 static void
17280 insert_double (double_int val, unsigned char *dest)
17282 unsigned char *p0 = dest;
17283 unsigned char *p1 = dest + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
17285 if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
17287 p0 = p1;
17288 p1 = dest;
17291 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.low, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
17292 insert_int ((HOST_WIDE_INT) val.high, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
17295 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array. */
17297 static void
17298 insert_float (const_rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
17300 REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
17301 long val[4];
17302 int i;
17304 REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
17305 real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
17307 /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long. Pack them. */
17308 for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
17310 insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
17311 array += 4;
17315 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
17316 does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register. These
17317 things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
17318 to an inlined function. They can also arise in C++ where declared
17319 constants do not necessarily get memory "homes". */
17321 static bool
17322 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
17324 switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
17326 case CONST_INT:
17328 HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
17330 if (val < 0)
17331 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
17332 else
17333 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
17335 return true;
17337 case CONST_DOUBLE:
17338 /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
17339 floating-point constant. A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
17340 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
17341 represented. */
17343 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
17345 if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
17347 unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
17348 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (length);
17350 insert_float (rtl, array);
17351 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
17353 else
17354 add_AT_double (die, DW_AT_const_value,
17355 CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
17357 return true;
17359 case CONST_VECTOR:
17361 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
17362 unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
17363 unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
17364 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *) ggc_alloc_atomic
17365 (length * elt_size);
17366 unsigned int i;
17367 unsigned char *p;
17369 switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
17371 case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
17372 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
17374 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
17375 double_int val = rtx_to_double_int (elt);
17377 if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
17378 insert_int (double_int_to_shwi (val), elt_size, p);
17379 else
17381 gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
17382 insert_double (val, p);
17385 break;
17387 case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
17388 for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
17390 rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
17391 insert_float (elt, p);
17393 break;
17395 default:
17396 gcc_unreachable ();
17399 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
17401 return true;
17403 case CONST_STRING:
17404 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
17406 dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result;
17407 resolve_one_addr (&rtl, NULL);
17408 rtl_addr:
17409 loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
17410 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
17411 loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
17412 add_loc_descr (&loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_stack_value, 0, 0));
17413 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_location, loc_result);
17414 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
17415 return true;
17417 return false;
17419 case CONST:
17420 if (CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
17421 return add_const_value_attribute (die, XEXP (rtl, 0));
17422 /* FALLTHROUGH */
17423 case SYMBOL_REF:
17424 if (!const_ok_for_output (rtl))
17425 return false;
17426 case LABEL_REF:
17427 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
17428 goto rtl_addr;
17429 return false;
17431 case PLUS:
17432 /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
17433 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
17434 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
17435 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
17436 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
17437 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)). This is not
17438 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
17439 of the (artificial) local variable either. Rather, it represents the
17440 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
17441 lifetime. We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
17442 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing. */
17443 return false;
17445 case HIGH:
17446 case CONST_FIXED:
17447 return false;
17449 case MEM:
17450 if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == CONST_STRING
17451 && MEM_READONLY_P (rtl)
17452 && GET_MODE (rtl) == BLKmode)
17454 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (XEXP (rtl, 0), 0));
17455 return true;
17457 return false;
17459 default:
17460 /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here. */
17461 gcc_unreachable ();
17463 return false;
17466 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
17467 or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
17468 output). */
17469 static tree
17470 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
17471 void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
17473 if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
17474 *walk_subtrees = 0;
17476 if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
17477 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
17478 return *tp;
17479 /* ??? The C++ FE emits debug information for using decls, so
17480 putting gcc_unreachable here falls over. See PR31899. For now
17481 be conservative. */
17482 else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
17483 && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
17484 return *tp;
17485 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
17487 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (*tp);
17488 if (!node || !node->needed)
17489 return *tp;
17491 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
17492 && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
17494 /* The call graph machinery must have finished analyzing,
17495 optimizing and gimplifying the CU by now.
17496 So if *TP has no call graph node associated
17497 to it, it means *TP will not be emitted. */
17498 if (!cgraph_get_node (*tp))
17499 return *tp;
17501 else if (TREE_CODE (*tp) == STRING_CST && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
17502 return *tp;
17504 return NULL_TREE;
17507 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
17508 for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call. */
17510 static rtx
17511 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
17513 rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
17515 STRIP_NOPS (init);
17517 /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
17518 zeros, build CONST_STRING. */
17519 if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
17521 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
17522 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
17523 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
17525 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
17526 && domain
17527 && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
17528 && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
17529 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
17530 && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
17531 == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
17533 rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
17534 ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
17535 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, rtl);
17536 MEM_READONLY_P (rtl) = 1;
17539 /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
17540 CONCAT: FIXME! */
17541 else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type)
17542 || (TREE_CODE (init) == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR
17543 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0))))
17544 || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
17546 /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
17547 FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too. */
17548 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE
17549 && !VECTOR_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
17551 /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
17552 immediate RTL constant, expand it now. We must be careful not to
17553 reference variables which won't be output. */
17554 else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
17555 && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
17557 /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
17558 possible. */
17559 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
17560 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
17562 case VECTOR_CST:
17563 break;
17564 case CONSTRUCTOR:
17565 if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
17567 VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
17568 bool constant_p = true;
17569 tree value;
17570 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
17572 /* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
17573 elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
17574 belong into VECTOR_CST nodes. */
17575 FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
17576 if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
17578 constant_p = false;
17579 break;
17582 if (constant_p)
17584 init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
17585 break;
17588 /* FALLTHRU */
17590 default:
17591 return NULL;
17594 rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
17596 /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate. */
17597 gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
17600 return rtl;
17603 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location. */
17605 static rtx
17606 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
17608 rtx rtl;
17610 /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
17611 (as far as the debugger is concerned). We only have a couple of
17612 choices. GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
17614 DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
17615 activation of the function. If optimization is enabled however, this
17616 could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg. Both of those cases indicate
17617 that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
17618 generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
17619 activation. That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
17620 referenced within the function.
17622 We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
17623 non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
17624 a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
17625 where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
17627 Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
17628 a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases. In cases
17629 where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
17630 we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
17631 declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
17632 points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
17634 In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
17635 we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
17636 because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
17637 type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself. Thus,
17638 if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
17639 such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
17640 `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
17641 `double'. That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
17642 output at debug-time.
17644 So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
17645 in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl). There
17646 are a couple of exceptions however. On little-endian machines we can
17647 get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
17648 not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
17649 an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
17650 when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
17651 parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'. In such cases,
17652 TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
17653 be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
17654 passed `int' value. If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
17655 a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
17656 the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
17658 Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
17659 parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
17660 end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue). We'll do that as best
17661 as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
17662 sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
17663 debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
17664 value rather than the value which was originally passed in. This happens
17665 rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
17666 I'd like to fix it.
17668 A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
17669 any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
17670 type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
17671 to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
17672 "active location" for each parameter. This additional set of attributes
17673 could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
17674 sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
17675 This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
17676 parameters which are never referenced. This really shouldn't be
17677 happening. All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
17678 DECL_INCOMING_RTL values. FIXME. */
17680 /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better. */
17681 rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
17683 /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
17684 constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
17685 fixed registers. */
17686 if (! reload_completed)
17688 if (rtl
17689 && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
17690 || (MEM_P (rtl)
17691 && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
17692 || (REG_P (rtl)
17693 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17694 && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
17696 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
17697 return rtl;
17699 rtl = NULL_RTX;
17701 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
17703 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
17704 || is_pseudo_reg (rtl)
17705 || (MEM_P (rtl)
17706 && is_pseudo_reg (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17707 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl)
17708 && MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17709 && GET_MODE (rtl) == GET_MODE (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))))
17711 tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
17712 tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
17713 enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
17714 enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
17716 /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
17717 Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
17718 all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below. */
17719 if (dmode == pmode)
17720 rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
17721 else if ((rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
17722 && SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
17723 && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
17724 && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17726 rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
17727 if (REG_P (inc))
17728 rtl = inc;
17729 else if (MEM_P (inc))
17731 if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17732 rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
17733 GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
17734 - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
17735 else
17736 rtl = inc;
17741 /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
17742 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
17743 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl. */
17744 /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
17745 we reach the big endian correction code there. It isn't clear if all
17746 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
17747 thing to do. */
17748 else if (MEM_P (rtl)
17749 && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
17750 && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17751 /* Not passed in memory. */
17752 && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
17753 /* Not passed by invisible reference. */
17754 && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
17755 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
17756 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
17757 #if !HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
17758 || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
17759 #endif
17761 /* Big endian correction check. */
17762 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
17763 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
17764 && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
17765 < UNITS_PER_WORD))
17767 int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
17768 - GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
17770 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17771 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
17774 else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17775 && rtl
17776 && MEM_P (rtl)
17777 && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
17778 && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
17780 int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
17781 int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
17783 /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
17784 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
17785 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
17786 fact we are not. We need to adjust the offset of the
17787 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
17788 else gdb will not be able to display it. */
17789 if (rsize > dsize)
17790 rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
17791 plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
17794 /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
17795 and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
17796 C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do. */
17797 if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
17798 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
17800 if (rtl)
17801 rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
17803 /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
17804 reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
17805 code, and thus is not emitted. */
17806 if (rtl)
17807 rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
17809 /* Try harder to get a rtl. If this symbol ends up not being emitted
17810 in the current CU, resolve_addr will remove the expression referencing
17811 it. */
17812 if (rtl == NULL_RTX
17813 && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
17814 && !DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
17815 && TREE_STATIC (decl)
17816 && DECL_NAME (decl)
17817 && !DECL_HARD_REGISTER (decl)
17818 && DECL_MODE (decl) != VOIDmode)
17820 rtl = make_decl_rtl_for_debug (decl);
17821 if (!MEM_P (rtl)
17822 || GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != SYMBOL_REF
17823 || SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (rtl, 0)) != decl)
17824 rtl = NULL_RTX;
17827 return rtl;
17830 /* Check whether decl is a Fortran COMMON symbol. If not, NULL_TREE is
17831 returned. If so, the decl for the COMMON block is returned, and the
17832 value is the offset into the common block for the symbol. */
17834 static tree
17835 fortran_common (tree decl, HOST_WIDE_INT *value)
17837 tree val_expr, cvar;
17838 enum machine_mode mode;
17839 HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
17840 tree offset;
17841 int volatilep = 0, unsignedp = 0;
17843 /* If the decl isn't a VAR_DECL, or if it isn't static, or if
17844 it does not have a value (the offset into the common area), or if it
17845 is thread local (as opposed to global) then it isn't common, and shouldn't
17846 be handled as such. */
17847 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
17848 || !TREE_STATIC (decl)
17849 || !DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (decl)
17850 || !is_fortran ())
17851 return NULL_TREE;
17853 val_expr = DECL_VALUE_EXPR (decl);
17854 if (TREE_CODE (val_expr) != COMPONENT_REF)
17855 return NULL_TREE;
17857 cvar = get_inner_reference (val_expr, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
17858 &mode, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
17860 if (cvar == NULL_TREE
17861 || TREE_CODE (cvar) != VAR_DECL
17862 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (cvar)
17863 || !TREE_PUBLIC (cvar))
17864 return NULL_TREE;
17866 *value = 0;
17867 if (offset != NULL)
17869 if (!host_integerp (offset, 0))
17870 return NULL_TREE;
17871 *value = tree_low_cst (offset, 0);
17873 if (bitpos != 0)
17874 *value += bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
17876 return cvar;
17879 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
17880 data attribute for a variable or a parameter. We generate the
17881 DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
17882 or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
17883 register. This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
17884 actual argument in a call to an inline function. (It's possible that
17885 these things can crop up in other ways also.) Note that one type of
17886 constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
17887 pointer. This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
17888 function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.
17890 CACHE_P is true if it is worth caching the location list for DECL,
17891 so that future calls can reuse it rather than regenerate it from scratch.
17892 This is true for BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS in inlined subroutines,
17893 since we will need to refer to them each time the function is inlined. */
17895 static bool
17896 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl, bool cache_p,
17897 enum dwarf_attribute attr)
17899 rtx rtl;
17900 dw_loc_list_ref list;
17901 var_loc_list *loc_list;
17902 cached_dw_loc_list *cache;
17903 void **slot;
17905 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
17906 return false;
17908 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
17909 || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
17911 /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
17912 the location. */
17914 rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
17915 if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17916 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
17917 return true;
17919 /* See if we have single element location list that is equivalent to
17920 a constant value. That way we are better to use add_const_value_attribute
17921 rather than expanding constant value equivalent. */
17922 loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
17923 if (loc_list
17924 && loc_list->first
17925 && loc_list->first->next == NULL
17926 && NOTE_P (loc_list->first->loc)
17927 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (loc_list->first->loc)
17928 && NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc_list->first->loc))
17930 struct var_loc_node *node;
17932 node = loc_list->first;
17933 rtl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->loc);
17934 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == EXPR_LIST)
17935 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
17936 if ((CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
17937 && add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl))
17938 return true;
17940 /* If this decl is from BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS, we might need its
17941 list several times. See if we've already cached the contents. */
17942 list = NULL;
17943 if (loc_list == NULL || cached_dw_loc_list_table == NULL)
17944 cache_p = false;
17945 if (cache_p)
17947 cache = (cached_dw_loc_list *)
17948 htab_find_with_hash (cached_dw_loc_list_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
17949 if (cache)
17950 list = cache->loc_list;
17952 if (list == NULL)
17954 list = loc_list_from_tree (decl, decl_by_reference_p (decl) ? 0 : 2);
17955 /* It is usually worth caching this result if the decl is from
17956 BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VARS and if the list has at least two elements. */
17957 if (cache_p && list && list->dw_loc_next)
17959 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (cached_dw_loc_list_table, decl,
17960 DECL_UID (decl), INSERT);
17961 cache = ggc_alloc_cleared_cached_dw_loc_list ();
17962 cache->decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
17963 cache->loc_list = list;
17964 *slot = cache;
17967 if (list)
17969 add_AT_location_description (die, attr, list);
17970 return true;
17972 /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
17973 try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL. */
17974 return tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (die, decl);
17977 /* Add VARIABLE and DIE into deferred locations list. */
17979 static void
17980 defer_location (tree variable, dw_die_ref die)
17982 deferred_locations entry;
17983 entry.variable = variable;
17984 entry.die = die;
17985 VEC_safe_push (deferred_locations, gc, deferred_locations_list, &entry);
17988 /* Helper function for tree_add_const_value_attribute. Natively encode
17989 initializer INIT into an array. Return true if successful. */
17991 static bool
17992 native_encode_initializer (tree init, unsigned char *array, int size)
17994 tree type;
17996 if (init == NULL_TREE)
17997 return false;
17999 STRIP_NOPS (init);
18000 switch (TREE_CODE (init))
18002 case STRING_CST:
18003 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
18004 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
18006 tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
18007 enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
18009 if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_INT || GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) != 1)
18010 return false;
18011 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
18012 return false;
18013 if (size > TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init))
18015 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init),
18016 TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
18017 memset (array + TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init),
18018 '\0', size - TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init));
18020 else
18021 memcpy (array, TREE_STRING_POINTER (init), size);
18022 return true;
18024 return false;
18025 case CONSTRUCTOR:
18026 type = TREE_TYPE (init);
18027 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
18028 return false;
18029 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
18031 HOST_WIDE_INT min_index;
18032 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
18033 int curpos = 0, fieldsize;
18034 constructor_elt *ce;
18036 if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) == NULL_TREE
18037 || !host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0))
18038 return false;
18040 fieldsize = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type));
18041 if (fieldsize <= 0)
18042 return false;
18044 min_index = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)), 0);
18045 memset (array, '\0', size);
18046 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
18048 tree val = ce->value;
18049 tree index = ce->index;
18050 int pos = curpos;
18051 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
18052 pos = (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0) - min_index)
18053 * fieldsize;
18054 else if (index)
18055 pos = (tree_low_cst (index, 0) - min_index) * fieldsize;
18057 if (val)
18059 STRIP_NOPS (val);
18060 if (!native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
18061 return false;
18063 curpos = pos + fieldsize;
18064 if (index && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
18066 int count = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 1), 0)
18067 - tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (index, 0), 0);
18068 while (count-- > 0)
18070 if (val)
18071 memcpy (array + curpos, array + pos, fieldsize);
18072 curpos += fieldsize;
18075 gcc_assert (curpos <= size);
18077 return true;
18079 else if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
18080 || TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
18082 tree field = NULL_TREE;
18083 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT cnt;
18084 constructor_elt *ce;
18086 if (int_size_in_bytes (type) != size)
18087 return false;
18089 if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE)
18090 field = TYPE_FIELDS (type);
18092 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), cnt, ce)
18094 tree val = ce->value;
18095 int pos, fieldsize;
18097 if (ce->index != 0)
18098 field = ce->index;
18100 if (val)
18101 STRIP_NOPS (val);
18103 if (field == NULL_TREE || DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
18104 return false;
18106 if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (field)) == ARRAY_TYPE
18107 && TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))
18108 && ! TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (field))))
18109 return false;
18110 else if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field) == NULL_TREE
18111 || !host_integerp (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0))
18112 return false;
18113 fieldsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (field), 0);
18114 pos = int_byte_position (field);
18115 gcc_assert (pos + fieldsize <= size);
18116 if (val
18117 && !native_encode_initializer (val, array + pos, fieldsize))
18118 return false;
18120 return true;
18122 return false;
18123 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18124 case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
18125 return native_encode_initializer (TREE_OPERAND (init, 0), array, size);
18126 default:
18127 return native_encode_expr (init, array, size) == size;
18131 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE. The value of the
18132 attribute is the const value T. */
18134 static bool
18135 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree t)
18137 tree init;
18138 tree type = TREE_TYPE (t);
18139 rtx rtl;
18141 if (!t || !TREE_TYPE (t) || TREE_TYPE (t) == error_mark_node)
18142 return false;
18144 init = t;
18145 gcc_assert (!DECL_P (init));
18147 rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
18148 if (rtl)
18149 return add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
18150 /* If the host and target are sane, try harder. */
18151 else if (CHAR_BIT == 8 && BITS_PER_UNIT == 8
18152 && initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type))
18154 HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (init));
18155 if (size > 0 && (int) size == size)
18157 unsigned char *array = (unsigned char *)
18158 ggc_alloc_cleared_atomic (size);
18160 if (native_encode_initializer (init, array, size))
18162 add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, size, 1, array);
18163 return true;
18167 return false;
18170 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute to VAR_DIE. The value of the
18171 attribute is the const value of T, where T is an integral constant
18172 variable with static storage duration
18173 (so it can't be a PARM_DECL or a RESULT_DECL). */
18175 static bool
18176 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
18179 if (!decl
18180 || (TREE_CODE (decl) != VAR_DECL
18181 && TREE_CODE (decl) != CONST_DECL)
18182 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
18183 && !TREE_STATIC (decl)))
18184 return false;
18186 if (TREE_READONLY (decl)
18187 && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl)
18188 && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
18189 /* OK */;
18190 else
18191 return false;
18193 /* Don't add DW_AT_const_value if abstract origin already has one. */
18194 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_const_value))
18195 return false;
18197 return tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, DECL_INITIAL (decl));
18200 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
18201 location list. This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
18202 a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
18203 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa. OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
18204 expressions. */
18206 static dw_loc_list_ref
18207 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
18209 int ix;
18210 dw_fde_ref fde;
18211 dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
18212 dw_cfi_ref cfi;
18213 dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
18214 const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
18215 dw_cfa_location remember;
18217 fde = current_fde ();
18218 gcc_assert (fde != NULL);
18220 section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
18221 list_tail = &list;
18222 list = NULL;
18224 memset (&next_cfa, 0, sizeof (next_cfa));
18225 next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
18226 remember = next_cfa;
18228 start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
18230 /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
18231 advance opcodes. */
18232 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, cie_cfi_vec, ix, cfi)
18233 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
18235 last_cfa = next_cfa;
18236 last_label = start_label;
18238 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index == 0)
18240 /* If the first partition contained no CFI adjustments, the
18241 CIE opcodes apply to the whole first partition. */
18242 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
18243 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
18244 list_tail =&(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
18245 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
18248 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_cfi_ref, fde->dw_fde_cfi, ix, cfi)
18250 switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
18252 case DW_CFA_set_loc:
18253 case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
18254 case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
18255 case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
18256 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
18258 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
18259 start_label, last_label, section);
18261 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
18262 last_cfa = next_cfa;
18263 start_label = last_label;
18265 last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
18266 break;
18268 case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
18269 /* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this. */
18270 gcc_unreachable ();
18272 default:
18273 lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa, &remember);
18274 break;
18276 if (ix + 1 == fde->dw_fde_switch_cfi_index)
18278 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
18280 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
18281 start_label, last_label, section);
18283 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
18284 last_cfa = next_cfa;
18285 start_label = last_label;
18287 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
18288 start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section);
18289 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
18290 start_label = last_label = fde->dw_fde_second_begin;
18294 if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
18296 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
18297 start_label, last_label, section);
18298 list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
18299 start_label = last_label;
18302 *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
18303 start_label,
18304 fde->dw_fde_second_begin
18305 ? fde->dw_fde_second_end : fde->dw_fde_end,
18306 section);
18308 if (list && list->dw_loc_next)
18309 gen_llsym (list);
18311 return list;
18314 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
18315 frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
18316 frame_pointer_fb_offset. OFFSET is added to the displacement
18317 before the latter is negated. */
18319 static void
18320 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
18322 rtx reg, elim;
18324 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
18325 reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
18326 offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
18327 #else
18328 reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
18329 offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
18330 #endif
18332 elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
18333 if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
18335 offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
18336 elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
18339 gcc_assert ((SUPPORTS_STACK_ALIGNMENT
18340 && (elim == hard_frame_pointer_rtx
18341 || elim == stack_pointer_rtx))
18342 || elim == (frame_pointer_needed
18343 ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
18344 : stack_pointer_rtx));
18346 frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
18349 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
18350 the value of the attribute. */
18352 static void
18353 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
18355 if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
18357 if (demangle_name_func)
18358 name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
18360 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
18364 /* Retrieve the descriptive type of TYPE, if any, make sure it has a
18365 DIE and attach a DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type attribute to the DIE
18366 of TYPE accordingly.
18368 ??? This is a temporary measure until after we're able to generate
18369 regular DWARF for the complex Ada type system. */
18371 static void
18372 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree type,
18373 dw_die_ref context_die)
18375 tree dtype;
18376 dw_die_ref dtype_die;
18378 if (!lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type)
18379 return;
18381 dtype = lang_hooks.types.descriptive_type (type);
18382 if (!dtype)
18383 return;
18385 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
18386 if (!dtype_die)
18388 gen_type_die (dtype, context_die);
18389 dtype_die = lookup_type_die (dtype);
18390 gcc_assert (dtype_die);
18393 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_GNAT_descriptive_type, dtype_die);
18396 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE. */
18398 static void
18399 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
18401 const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
18402 char *wd1;
18404 if (wd == NULL)
18405 return;
18407 if (DWARF2_DIR_SHOULD_END_WITH_SEPARATOR)
18409 int wdlen;
18411 wdlen = strlen (wd);
18412 wd1 = (char *) ggc_alloc_atomic (wdlen + 2);
18413 strcpy (wd1, wd);
18414 wd1 [wdlen] = DIR_SEPARATOR;
18415 wd1 [wdlen + 1] = 0;
18416 wd = wd1;
18419 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, remap_debug_filename (wd));
18422 /* Return the default for DW_AT_lower_bound, or -1 if there is not any
18423 default. */
18425 static int
18426 lower_bound_default (void)
18428 switch (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language))
18430 case DW_LANG_C:
18431 case DW_LANG_C89:
18432 case DW_LANG_C99:
18433 case DW_LANG_C_plus_plus:
18434 case DW_LANG_ObjC:
18435 case DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus:
18436 case DW_LANG_Java:
18437 return 0;
18438 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
18439 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
18440 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
18441 return 1;
18442 case DW_LANG_UPC:
18443 case DW_LANG_D:
18444 case DW_LANG_Python:
18445 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 0 : -1;
18446 case DW_LANG_Ada95:
18447 case DW_LANG_Ada83:
18448 case DW_LANG_Cobol74:
18449 case DW_LANG_Cobol85:
18450 case DW_LANG_Pascal83:
18451 case DW_LANG_Modula2:
18452 case DW_LANG_PLI:
18453 return dwarf_version >= 4 ? 1 : -1;
18454 default:
18455 return -1;
18459 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
18460 a representation for that bound. */
18462 static void
18463 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
18465 switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
18467 case ERROR_MARK:
18468 return;
18470 /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes. */
18471 case INTEGER_CST:
18473 unsigned int prec = simple_type_size_in_bits (TREE_TYPE (bound));
18474 int dflt;
18476 /* Use the default if possible. */
18477 if (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
18478 && host_integerp (bound, 0)
18479 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
18480 && tree_low_cst (bound, 0) == dflt)
18483 /* Otherwise represent the bound as an unsigned value with the
18484 precision of its type. The precision and signedness of the
18485 type will be necessary to re-interpret it unambiguously. */
18486 else if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
18488 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT mask
18489 = ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1;
18490 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
18491 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound) & mask);
18493 else if (prec == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
18494 || TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound) == 0)
18495 add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr,
18496 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
18497 else
18498 add_AT_double (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (bound),
18499 TREE_INT_CST_LOW (bound));
18501 break;
18503 CASE_CONVERT:
18504 case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
18505 add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
18506 break;
18508 case SAVE_EXPR:
18509 break;
18511 case VAR_DECL:
18512 case PARM_DECL:
18513 case RESULT_DECL:
18515 dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
18517 /* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
18518 first? Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
18519 the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
18520 the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
18521 later parameter. */
18522 if (decl_die != NULL)
18524 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
18525 break;
18528 /* FALLTHRU */
18530 default:
18532 /* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
18533 evaluate the value of the array bound. */
18535 dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
18536 dw_loc_list_ref list;
18538 list = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 2);
18539 if (list == NULL || single_element_loc_list_p (list))
18541 /* If DW_AT_*bound is not a reference nor constant, it is
18542 a DWARF expression rather than location description.
18543 For that loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0) is needed.
18544 If that fails to give a single element list,
18545 fall back to outputting this as a reference anyway. */
18546 dw_loc_list_ref list2 = loc_list_from_tree (bound, 0);
18547 if (list2 && single_element_loc_list_p (list2))
18549 add_AT_loc (subrange_die, bound_attr, list2->expr);
18550 break;
18553 if (list == NULL)
18554 break;
18556 if (current_function_decl == 0)
18557 ctx = comp_unit_die ();
18558 else
18559 ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
18561 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
18562 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
18563 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
18564 add_AT_location_description (decl_die, DW_AT_location, list);
18565 add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
18566 break;
18571 /* Add subscript info to TYPE_DIE, describing an array TYPE, collapsing
18572 possibly nested array subscripts in a flat sequence if COLLAPSE_P is true.
18573 Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
18574 includes information about the element type of the given array type. */
18576 static void
18577 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type, bool collapse_p)
18579 unsigned dimension_number;
18580 tree lower, upper;
18581 dw_die_ref subrange_die;
18583 for (dimension_number = 0;
18584 TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE && (dimension_number == 0 || collapse_p);
18585 type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
18587 tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
18589 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type) && is_fortran () && dimension_number > 0)
18590 break;
18592 /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
18593 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds. Handle all three forms
18594 here. */
18595 subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
18596 if (domain)
18598 /* We have an array type with specified bounds. */
18599 lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
18600 upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
18602 /* Define the index type. */
18603 if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
18605 /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type. Ignore the
18606 TREE_TYPE field. We can't emit debug info for this
18607 because it is an unnamed integral type. */
18608 if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
18609 && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
18610 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
18611 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
18613 else
18614 add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
18615 type_die);
18618 /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
18619 but it does have a lower bound. This happens with Fortran
18620 dimension arr(N:*)
18621 Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
18622 to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
18623 bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope. */
18625 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
18626 if (upper)
18627 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
18630 /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length. The
18631 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
18632 bounds. */
18636 static void
18637 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
18639 unsigned size;
18641 switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
18643 case ERROR_MARK:
18644 size = 0;
18645 break;
18646 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
18647 case RECORD_TYPE:
18648 case UNION_TYPE:
18649 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
18650 size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
18651 break;
18652 case FIELD_DECL:
18653 /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
18654 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
18655 object of the *declared* type of the member itself. This is true
18656 even for bit-fields. */
18657 size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
18658 break;
18659 default:
18660 gcc_unreachable ();
18663 /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point. If it is, that
18664 indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable. We
18665 have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time,
18666 so just let the -1 pass on through. */
18667 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
18670 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
18671 which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
18672 "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
18673 bit-field itself.
18675 For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
18676 (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives. The
18677 type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
18678 declared type of the individual bit-field itself. The determination of the
18679 exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
18680 complicated. It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
18682 Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
18683 which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
18684 (See `byte_size_attribute' above). */
18686 static inline void
18687 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18689 HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
18690 tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
18691 HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
18692 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
18693 HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
18694 HOST_WIDE_INT bit_offset;
18696 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
18697 gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
18699 /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
18700 encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
18701 whatsoever. Likewise for variable or too large size. */
18702 if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
18703 || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
18704 return;
18706 bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
18708 /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
18709 highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
18710 the bit-field itself. Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
18711 is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
18712 below must take account of these differences. */
18713 highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
18714 highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
18716 if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
18718 highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
18719 highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
18722 bit_offset
18723 = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
18724 ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
18725 : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
18727 if (bit_offset < 0)
18728 add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
18729 else
18730 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) bit_offset);
18733 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
18734 which specifies the length in bits of the given field. */
18736 static inline void
18737 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18739 /* Must be a field and a bit field. */
18740 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
18741 && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
18743 if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
18744 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
18747 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
18748 attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function. */
18750 static inline void
18751 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
18753 if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
18754 && prototype_p (func_type))
18755 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
18758 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE. The DIE is found
18759 by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
18760 equate table. */
18762 static inline dw_die_ref
18763 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
18765 dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
18767 if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
18769 /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
18770 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
18771 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
18773 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
18774 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline. */
18775 tree fn = origin;
18777 if (TYPE_P (fn))
18778 fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
18780 fn = decl_function_context (fn);
18781 if (fn)
18782 dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
18785 if (DECL_P (origin))
18786 origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
18787 else if (TYPE_P (origin))
18788 origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
18790 /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
18791 trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
18792 languages). For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
18793 output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases. Rather
18794 than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
18795 have variables without a proper abstract origin. In the future, when all
18796 functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
18797 here. */
18799 if (origin_die)
18800 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
18801 return origin_die;
18804 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute. */
18806 static inline void
18807 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
18809 if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
18811 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
18813 if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
18814 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
18815 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
18816 tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
18817 0));
18819 /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally. */
18820 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
18821 && DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl))
18822 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
18823 lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
18827 /* Add a DW_AT_linkage_name or DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name attribute for the
18828 given decl. This used to be a vendor extension until after DWARF 4
18829 standardized it. */
18831 static void
18832 add_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18834 const char *name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl));
18836 /* Mimic what assemble_name_raw does with a leading '*'. */
18837 if (name[0] == '*')
18838 name = &name[1];
18840 if (dwarf_version >= 4)
18841 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_linkage_name, name);
18842 else
18843 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name, name);
18846 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl. */
18848 static void
18849 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18851 expanded_location s;
18853 if (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl) == UNKNOWN_LOCATION)
18854 return;
18855 s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
18856 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
18857 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
18860 /* Add DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute for the given decl. */
18862 static void
18863 add_linkage_name (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18865 if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
18866 && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
18867 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
18868 && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl))
18869 && die->die_tag != DW_TAG_member)
18871 /* Defer until we have an assembler name set. */
18872 if (!DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME_SET_P (decl))
18874 limbo_die_node *asm_name;
18876 asm_name = ggc_alloc_cleared_limbo_die_node ();
18877 asm_name->die = die;
18878 asm_name->created_for = decl;
18879 asm_name->next = deferred_asm_name;
18880 deferred_asm_name = asm_name;
18882 else if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
18883 add_linkage_attr (die, decl);
18887 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
18888 given decl, but only if it actually has a name. */
18890 static void
18891 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
18893 tree decl_name;
18895 decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
18896 if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
18898 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
18899 if (name)
18900 add_name_attribute (die, name);
18901 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
18902 add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
18904 add_linkage_name (die, decl);
18907 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18908 /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL. This may be different
18909 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
18910 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
18912 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
18913 XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
18914 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
18916 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
18919 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
18920 /* Output the debug main pointer die for VMS */
18922 void
18923 dwarf2out_vms_debug_main_pointer (void)
18925 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
18926 dw_die_ref die;
18928 /* Allocate the VMS debug main subprogram die. */
18929 die = ggc_alloc_cleared_die_node ();
18930 die->die_tag = DW_TAG_subprogram;
18931 add_name_attribute (die, VMS_DEBUG_MAIN_POINTER);
18932 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, PROLOGUE_END_LABEL,
18933 current_function_funcdef_no);
18934 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
18936 /* Make it the first child of comp_unit_die (). */
18937 die->die_parent = comp_unit_die ();
18938 if (comp_unit_die ()->die_child)
18940 die->die_sib = comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib;
18941 comp_unit_die ()->die_child->die_sib = die;
18943 else
18945 die->die_sib = die;
18946 comp_unit_die ()->die_child = die;
18949 #endif /* VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO */
18951 /* Push a new declaration scope. */
18953 static void
18954 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
18956 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
18959 /* Pop a declaration scope. */
18961 static inline void
18962 pop_decl_scope (void)
18964 VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
18967 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
18968 Non-named types get global scope. Named types nested in other
18969 types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
18970 otherwise. All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
18971 the current active scope. */
18973 static dw_die_ref
18974 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
18976 dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
18977 tree containing_scope;
18978 int i;
18980 /* Non-types always go in the current scope. */
18981 gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
18983 containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
18985 /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration). */
18986 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
18988 if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
18989 /* OK */;
18990 else
18991 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
18994 /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend. They mean that
18995 a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
18996 that isn't useful to DWARF. */
18997 if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
18998 containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
19000 if (SCOPE_FILE_SCOPE_P (containing_scope))
19001 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
19002 else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
19004 /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE. But
19005 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
19006 so we know where the new DIE should go. */
19007 for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
19008 if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
19009 break;
19011 if (i < 0)
19013 gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
19014 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
19015 /*We are not in the middle of emitting the type
19016 CONTAINING_SCOPE. Let's see if it's emitted already. */
19017 scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
19019 /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope. */
19020 if (scope_die == NULL)
19021 scope_die = comp_unit_die ();
19023 else
19024 scope_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (containing_scope);
19026 else
19027 scope_die = context_die;
19029 return scope_die;
19032 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function. */
19034 static inline int
19035 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
19037 for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
19038 if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
19039 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
19040 return 1;
19042 return 0;
19045 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class. */
19047 static inline int
19048 class_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
19050 return (context_die
19051 && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
19052 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type
19053 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_interface_type
19054 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type));
19057 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
19058 whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration. */
19060 static inline int
19061 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
19063 return (class_scope_p (context_die)
19064 || (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
19067 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute. This
19068 routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
19069 by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die. */
19071 static void
19072 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
19073 int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
19075 enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
19076 dw_die_ref type_die = NULL;
19078 /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral, floating-point
19079 or fixed-point type, use the inner type. This is because we have no
19080 support for unnamed types in base_type_die. This can happen if this is
19081 an Ada subrange type. Correct solution is emit a subrange type die. */
19082 if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE || code == FIXED_POINT_TYPE)
19083 && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
19084 type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
19086 if (code == ERROR_MARK
19087 /* Handle a special case. For functions whose return type is void, we
19088 generate *no* type attribute. (Note that no object may have type
19089 `void', so this only applies to function return types). */
19090 || code == VOID_TYPE)
19091 return;
19093 type_die = modified_type_die (type,
19094 decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
19095 decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
19096 context_die);
19098 if (type_die != NULL)
19099 add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
19102 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
19103 function call type. */
19104 static void
19105 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree decl)
19107 enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
19109 value = ((enum dwarf_calling_convention)
19110 targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
19112 if (is_fortran ()
19113 && !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)), "MAIN__"))
19115 /* DWARF 2 doesn't provide a way to identify a program's source-level
19116 entry point. DW_AT_calling_convention attributes are only meant
19117 to describe functions' calling conventions. However, lacking a
19118 better way to signal the Fortran main program, we used this for
19119 a long time, following existing custom. Now, DWARF 4 has
19120 DW_AT_main_subprogram, which we add below, but some tools still
19121 rely on the old way, which we thus keep. */
19122 value = DW_CC_program;
19124 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19125 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_main_subprogram, 1);
19128 /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
19129 is not DW_CC_normal. */
19130 if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
19131 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
19134 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
19135 a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
19136 was declared without a tag. */
19138 static const char *
19139 type_tag (const_tree type)
19141 const char *name = 0;
19143 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
19145 tree t = 0;
19147 /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name. */
19148 if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE
19149 && !TYPE_NAMELESS (type))
19150 t = TYPE_NAME (type);
19152 /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
19153 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
19154 involved. */
19155 else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
19156 && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
19158 /* We want to be extra verbose. Don't call dwarf_name if
19159 DECL_NAME isn't set. The default hook for decl_printable_name
19160 doesn't like that, and in this context it's correct to return
19161 0, instead of "<anonymous>" or the like. */
19162 if (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type))
19163 && !DECL_NAMELESS (TYPE_NAME (type)))
19164 name = lang_hooks.dwarf_name (TYPE_NAME (type), 2);
19167 /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one. */
19168 if (!name && t != 0)
19169 name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
19172 return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
19175 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
19176 for bit field types. */
19178 static inline tree
19179 member_declared_type (const_tree member)
19181 return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
19182 ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
19185 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
19186 from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file. */
19188 #if 0
19189 static const char *
19190 decl_start_label (tree decl)
19192 rtx x;
19193 const char *fnname;
19195 x = DECL_RTL (decl);
19196 gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
19198 x = XEXP (x, 0);
19199 gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
19201 fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
19202 return fnname;
19204 #endif
19206 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
19207 the compilation unit. Debugging information is collected by walking
19208 the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl(). */
19210 static void
19211 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19213 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19214 dw_die_ref array_die;
19216 /* GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of one
19217 dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array types.
19218 We sometimes squish that down to a single array_type DIE with multiple
19219 subscripts in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft Dwarf specification
19220 say that we are allowed to do this kind of compression in C, because
19221 there is no difference between an array of arrays and a multidimensional
19222 array. We don't do this for Ada to remain as close as possible to the
19223 actual representation, which is especially important against the language
19224 flexibilty wrt arrays of variable size. */
19226 bool collapse_nested_arrays = !is_ada ();
19227 tree element_type;
19229 /* Emit DW_TAG_string_type for Fortran character types (with kind 1 only, as
19230 DW_TAG_string_type doesn't have DW_AT_type attribute). */
19231 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type)
19232 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19233 && is_fortran ()
19234 && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == TYPE_MODE (char_type_node))
19236 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
19238 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_string_type, scope_die, type);
19239 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19240 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19241 size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
19242 if (size >= 0)
19243 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
19244 else if (TYPE_DOMAIN (type) != NULL_TREE
19245 && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type)) != NULL_TREE
19246 && DECL_P (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type))))
19248 tree szdecl = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (type));
19249 dw_loc_list_ref loc = loc_list_from_tree (szdecl, 2);
19251 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (szdecl));
19252 if (loc && size > 0)
19254 add_AT_location_description (array_die, DW_AT_string_length, loc);
19255 if (size != DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
19256 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size);
19259 return;
19262 /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types
19263 (e.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10]) unless the inner
19264 array type comes before the outer array type. We thus call gen_type_die
19265 before we new_die and must prevent nested array types collapsing for this
19266 target. */
19268 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
19269 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
19270 collapse_nested_arrays = false;
19271 #endif
19273 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
19274 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19275 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (array_die, type, context_die);
19276 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19278 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19279 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
19281 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
19282 if (is_fortran ()
19283 && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19284 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == ARRAY_TYPE
19285 && !TYPE_STRING_FLAG (TREE_TYPE (type)))
19286 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
19288 #if 0
19289 /* We default the array ordering. SDB will probably do
19290 the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present. It's not even
19291 an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway. If
19292 SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
19293 then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in. (But if
19294 and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
19295 for multidimensional arrays. */
19296 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
19297 #endif
19299 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
19300 /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
19301 AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs. */
19302 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
19303 && ! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
19304 add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19305 else
19306 #endif
19307 if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
19309 /* For VECTOR_TYPEs we use an array die with appropriate bounds. */
19310 dw_die_ref subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
19311 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, size_zero_node);
19312 add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
19313 size_int (TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type) - 1));
19315 else
19316 add_subscript_info (array_die, type, collapse_nested_arrays);
19318 /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type and
19319 emit the corresponding DIE if we haven't done it already. */
19320 element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
19321 if (collapse_nested_arrays)
19322 while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
19324 if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (element_type) && is_fortran ())
19325 break;
19326 element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
19329 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
19330 gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
19331 #endif
19333 add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
19335 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
19336 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
19339 static dw_loc_descr_ref
19340 descr_info_loc (tree val, tree base_decl)
19342 HOST_WIDE_INT size;
19343 dw_loc_descr_ref loc, loc2;
19344 enum dwarf_location_atom op;
19346 if (val == base_decl)
19347 return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_push_object_address, 0, 0);
19349 switch (TREE_CODE (val))
19351 CASE_CONVERT:
19352 return descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
19353 case VAR_DECL:
19354 return loc_descriptor_from_tree (val, 0);
19355 case INTEGER_CST:
19356 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
19357 return int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (val, 0));
19358 break;
19359 case INDIRECT_REF:
19360 size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (val));
19361 if (size < 0)
19362 break;
19363 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
19364 if (!loc)
19365 break;
19366 if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
19367 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
19368 else
19369 add_loc_descr (&loc, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref_size, size, 0));
19370 return loc;
19371 case POINTER_PLUS_EXPR:
19372 case PLUS_EXPR:
19373 if (host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
19374 && (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 1)
19375 < 16384)
19377 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
19378 if (!loc)
19379 break;
19380 loc_descr_plus_const (&loc, tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), 0));
19382 else
19384 op = DW_OP_plus;
19385 do_binop:
19386 loc = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 0), base_decl);
19387 if (!loc)
19388 break;
19389 loc2 = descr_info_loc (TREE_OPERAND (val, 1), base_decl);
19390 if (!loc2)
19391 break;
19392 add_loc_descr (&loc, loc2);
19393 add_loc_descr (&loc2, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
19395 return loc;
19396 case MINUS_EXPR:
19397 op = DW_OP_minus;
19398 goto do_binop;
19399 case MULT_EXPR:
19400 op = DW_OP_mul;
19401 goto do_binop;
19402 case EQ_EXPR:
19403 op = DW_OP_eq;
19404 goto do_binop;
19405 case NE_EXPR:
19406 op = DW_OP_ne;
19407 goto do_binop;
19408 default:
19409 break;
19411 return NULL;
19414 static void
19415 add_descr_info_field (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr,
19416 tree val, tree base_decl)
19418 dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
19420 if (host_integerp (val, 0))
19422 add_AT_unsigned (die, attr, tree_low_cst (val, 0));
19423 return;
19426 loc = descr_info_loc (val, base_decl);
19427 if (!loc)
19428 return;
19430 add_AT_loc (die, attr, loc);
19433 /* This routine generates DIE for array with hidden descriptor, details
19434 are filled into *info by a langhook. */
19436 static void
19437 gen_descr_array_type_die (tree type, struct array_descr_info *info,
19438 dw_die_ref context_die)
19440 dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
19441 dw_die_ref array_die;
19442 int dim;
19444 array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
19445 add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
19446 equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
19448 /* For Fortran multidimensional arrays use DW_ORD_col_major ordering. */
19449 if (is_fortran ()
19450 && info->ndimensions >= 2)
19451 add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_col_major);
19453 if (info->data_location)
19454 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_data_location, info->data_location,
19455 info->base_decl);
19456 if (info->associated)
19457 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_associated, info->associated,
19458 info->base_decl);
19459 if (info->allocated)
19460 add_descr_info_field (array_die, DW_AT_allocated, info->allocated,
19461 info->base_decl);
19463 for (dim = 0; dim < info->ndimensions; dim++)
19465 dw_die_ref subrange_die
19466 = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, array_die, NULL);
19468 if (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound)
19470 /* If it is the default value, omit it. */
19471 int dflt;
19473 if (host_integerp (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0)
19474 && (dflt = lower_bound_default ()) != -1
19475 && tree_low_cst (info->dimen[dim].lower_bound, 0) == dflt)
19477 else
19478 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
19479 info->dimen[dim].lower_bound,
19480 info->base_decl);
19482 if (info->dimen[dim].upper_bound)
19483 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
19484 info->dimen[dim].upper_bound,
19485 info->base_decl);
19486 if (info->dimen[dim].stride)
19487 add_descr_info_field (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_stride,
19488 info->dimen[dim].stride,
19489 info->base_decl);
19492 gen_type_die (info->element_type, context_die);
19493 add_type_attribute (array_die, info->element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
19495 if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
19496 add_pubtype (type, array_die);
19499 #if 0
19500 static void
19501 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
19503 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
19504 dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
19506 if (origin != NULL)
19507 add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
19508 else
19510 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
19511 add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
19512 0, 0, context_die);
19515 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
19516 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
19517 else
19518 add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
19520 #endif
19522 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
19523 emit full debugging info for them. */
19525 static void
19526 retry_incomplete_types (void)
19528 int i;
19530 for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
19531 if (should_emit_struct_debug (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i),
19532 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
19533 gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die ());
19536 /* Determine what tag to use for a record type. */
19538 static enum dwarf_tag
19539 record_type_tag (tree type)
19541 if (! lang_hooks.types.classify_record)
19542 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19544 switch (lang_hooks.types.classify_record (type))
19546 case RECORD_IS_STRUCT:
19547 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19549 case RECORD_IS_CLASS:
19550 return DW_TAG_class_type;
19552 case RECORD_IS_INTERFACE:
19553 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19554 return DW_TAG_interface_type;
19555 return DW_TAG_structure_type;
19557 default:
19558 gcc_unreachable ();
19562 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type. Note that these DIEs
19563 include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
19564 enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
19565 DIE. */
19567 static dw_die_ref
19568 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19570 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
19572 if (type_die == NULL)
19574 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
19575 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
19576 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
19577 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
19578 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
19579 if (dwarf_version >= 4 || !dwarf_strict)
19581 if (ENUM_IS_SCOPED (type))
19582 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_enum_class, 1);
19583 if (ENUM_IS_OPAQUE (type))
19584 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19587 else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
19588 return type_die;
19589 else
19590 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
19592 /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types. If the
19593 given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
19594 attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute. */
19595 if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
19597 tree link;
19599 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
19600 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
19601 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
19603 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19604 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
19607 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
19608 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
19609 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
19610 add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
19612 for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
19613 link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
19615 dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
19616 tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
19618 add_name_attribute (enum_die,
19619 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
19621 if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONST_DECL)
19622 value = DECL_INITIAL (value);
19624 if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
19625 /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
19626 not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned. GDB
19627 always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
19628 values as if they were signed. That means that
19629 enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
19630 will appear to have negative values in the debugger. */
19631 add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
19632 tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
19635 else
19636 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
19638 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
19639 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
19641 return type_die;
19644 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
19645 represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
19646 type.
19648 Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
19649 ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
19650 represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
19651 node. If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
19652 DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof). If
19653 it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
19654 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
19655 argument type of some subprogram type.
19656 If EMIT_NAME_P is true, name and source coordinate attributes
19657 are emitted. */
19659 static dw_die_ref
19660 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, tree origin, bool emit_name_p,
19661 dw_die_ref context_die)
19663 tree node_or_origin = node ? node : origin;
19664 tree ultimate_origin;
19665 dw_die_ref parm_die
19666 = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
19668 switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node_or_origin)))
19670 case tcc_declaration:
19671 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node_or_origin);
19672 if (node || ultimate_origin)
19673 origin = ultimate_origin;
19674 if (origin != NULL)
19675 add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
19676 else if (emit_name_p)
19677 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
19678 if (origin == NULL
19679 || (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin)
19680 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin),
19681 decl_function_context
19682 (node_or_origin))))
19684 tree type = TREE_TYPE (node_or_origin);
19685 if (decl_by_reference_p (node_or_origin))
19686 add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0,
19687 context_die);
19688 else
19689 add_type_attribute (parm_die, type,
19690 TREE_READONLY (node_or_origin),
19691 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node_or_origin),
19692 context_die);
19694 if (origin == NULL && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
19695 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19697 if (node && node != origin)
19698 equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
19699 if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node_or_origin))
19700 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin,
19701 node == NULL, DW_AT_location);
19703 break;
19705 case tcc_type:
19706 /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node. */
19707 add_type_attribute (parm_die, node_or_origin, 0, 0, context_die);
19708 break;
19710 default:
19711 gcc_unreachable ();
19714 return parm_die;
19717 /* Generate and return a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack. Also generate
19718 children DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs representing the arguments of the
19719 parameter pack.
19721 PARM_PACK must be a function parameter pack.
19722 PACK_ARG is the first argument of the parameter pack. Its TREE_CHAIN
19723 must point to the subsequent arguments of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
19724 SUBR_DIE is the DIE of the function PACK_ARG belongs to.
19725 If NEXT_ARG is non NULL, *NEXT_ARG is set to the function argument
19726 following the last one for which a DIE was generated. */
19728 static dw_die_ref
19729 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (tree parm_pack,
19730 tree pack_arg,
19731 dw_die_ref subr_die,
19732 tree *next_arg)
19734 tree arg;
19735 dw_die_ref parm_pack_die;
19737 gcc_assert (parm_pack
19738 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (parm_pack)
19739 && subr_die);
19741 parm_pack_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack, subr_die, parm_pack);
19742 add_src_coords_attributes (parm_pack_die, parm_pack);
19744 for (arg = pack_arg; arg; arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg))
19746 if (! lang_hooks.decls.function_parm_expanded_from_pack_p (arg,
19747 parm_pack))
19748 break;
19749 gen_formal_parameter_die (arg, NULL,
19750 false /* Don't emit name attribute. */,
19751 parm_pack_die);
19753 if (next_arg)
19754 *next_arg = arg;
19755 return parm_pack_die;
19758 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
19759 at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list. */
19761 static void
19762 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19764 new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
19767 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
19768 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
19769 parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
19770 those which appear as part of a function *definition*). */
19772 static void
19773 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
19775 tree link;
19776 tree formal_type = NULL;
19777 tree first_parm_type;
19778 tree arg;
19780 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19782 arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
19783 function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
19785 else
19786 arg = NULL_TREE;
19788 first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
19790 /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
19791 DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one. */
19792 for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
19794 dw_die_ref parm_die;
19796 formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
19797 if (formal_type == void_type_node)
19798 break;
19800 /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself. */
19801 parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, NULL,
19802 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
19803 context_die);
19804 if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
19805 && link == first_parm_type)
19807 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19808 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
19809 add_AT_die_ref (context_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
19811 else if (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg))
19812 add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
19814 link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
19815 if (arg)
19816 arg = DECL_CHAIN (arg);
19819 /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
19820 DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list. */
19821 if (formal_type != void_type_node)
19822 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
19824 /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
19825 and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary). */
19826 for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
19827 link && TREE_VALUE (link);
19828 link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
19829 gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
19832 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
19833 die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
19834 to the member declaration nested within TYPE. If we're trying to
19835 generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
19836 trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand. */
19838 static void
19839 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
19841 gen_type_die (type, context_die);
19843 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
19844 emitted the member decl for this function. Emit it now. */
19845 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
19846 && TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
19847 && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
19849 dw_die_ref type_die;
19850 gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
19852 push_decl_scope (type);
19853 type_die = lookup_type_die_strip_naming_typedef (type);
19854 if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
19855 gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
19856 else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
19858 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
19859 C++ anonymous unions and structs. */
19860 if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
19861 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
19862 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
19864 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
19865 gen_field_die (member, type_die);
19868 else
19869 gen_variable_die (member, NULL_TREE, type_die);
19871 pop_decl_scope ();
19875 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
19876 may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of. */
19878 static void
19879 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
19881 dw_die_ref old_die;
19882 tree save_fn;
19883 tree context;
19884 int was_abstract;
19885 htab_t old_decl_loc_table;
19886 htab_t old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
19887 int old_call_site_count, old_tail_call_site_count;
19888 struct call_arg_loc_node *old_call_arg_locations;
19890 /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone. */
19891 decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
19893 old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
19894 if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
19895 /* We've already generated the abstract instance. */
19896 return;
19898 /* We can be called while recursively when seeing block defining inlined subroutine
19899 DIE. Be sure to not clobber the outer location table nor use it or we would
19900 get locations in abstract instantces. */
19901 old_decl_loc_table = decl_loc_table;
19902 decl_loc_table = NULL;
19903 old_cached_dw_loc_list_table = cached_dw_loc_list_table;
19904 cached_dw_loc_list_table = NULL;
19905 old_call_arg_locations = call_arg_locations;
19906 call_arg_locations = NULL;
19907 old_call_site_count = call_site_count;
19908 call_site_count = -1;
19909 old_tail_call_site_count = tail_call_site_count;
19910 tail_call_site_count = -1;
19912 /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
19913 we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT. */
19914 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
19916 context = decl_class_context (decl);
19917 if (context)
19918 gen_type_die_for_member
19919 (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die ());
19922 /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function. */
19923 save_fn = current_function_decl;
19924 current_function_decl = decl;
19925 push_cfun (DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl));
19927 was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
19928 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
19929 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
19930 if (! was_abstract)
19931 set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
19933 current_function_decl = save_fn;
19934 decl_loc_table = old_decl_loc_table;
19935 cached_dw_loc_list_table = old_cached_dw_loc_list_table;
19936 call_arg_locations = old_call_arg_locations;
19937 call_site_count = old_call_site_count;
19938 tail_call_site_count = old_tail_call_site_count;
19939 pop_cfun ();
19942 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
19943 htab_traverse.
19945 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
19946 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. */
19948 static int
19949 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
19951 tree type;
19952 dw_die_ref die;
19954 type = (tree) *slot;
19955 die = lookup_type_die (type);
19956 if (die != NULL)
19957 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
19958 return 1;
19961 /* Helper function of premark_types_used_by_global_vars which gets called
19962 through htab_traverse.
19964 Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
19965 marked as unused by prune_unused_types. The DIE of the type is marked
19966 only if the global variable using the type will actually be emitted. */
19968 static int
19969 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper (void **slot,
19970 void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
19972 struct types_used_by_vars_entry *entry;
19973 dw_die_ref die;
19975 entry = (struct types_used_by_vars_entry *) *slot;
19976 gcc_assert (entry->type != NULL
19977 && entry->var_decl != NULL);
19978 die = lookup_type_die (entry->type);
19979 if (die)
19981 /* Ask cgraph if the global variable really is to be emitted.
19982 If yes, then we'll keep the DIE of ENTRY->TYPE. */
19983 struct varpool_node *node = varpool_get_node (entry->var_decl);
19984 if (node && node->needed)
19986 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
19987 /* Keep the parent DIEs as well. */
19988 while ((die = die->die_parent) && die->die_perennial_p == 0)
19989 die->die_perennial_p = 1;
19992 return 1;
19995 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial. */
19997 static void
19998 premark_used_types (void)
20000 if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
20001 htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
20004 /* Mark all members of types_used_by_vars_entry as perennial. */
20006 static void
20007 premark_types_used_by_global_vars (void)
20009 if (types_used_by_vars_hash)
20010 htab_traverse (types_used_by_vars_hash,
20011 premark_types_used_by_global_vars_helper, NULL);
20014 /* Generate a DW_TAG_GNU_call_site DIE in function DECL under SUBR_DIE
20015 for CA_LOC call arg loc node. */
20017 static dw_die_ref
20018 gen_call_site_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref subr_die,
20019 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc)
20021 dw_die_ref stmt_die = NULL, die;
20022 tree block = ca_loc->block;
20024 while (block
20025 && block != DECL_INITIAL (decl)
20026 && TREE_CODE (block) == BLOCK)
20028 if (VEC_length (dw_die_ref, block_map) > BLOCK_NUMBER (block))
20029 stmt_die = VEC_index (dw_die_ref, block_map, BLOCK_NUMBER (block));
20030 if (stmt_die)
20031 break;
20032 block = BLOCK_SUPERCONTEXT (block);
20034 if (stmt_die == NULL)
20035 stmt_die = subr_die;
20036 die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site, stmt_die, NULL_TREE);
20037 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, ca_loc->label);
20038 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
20039 add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_GNU_tail_call, 1);
20040 if (ca_loc->symbol_ref)
20042 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (ca_loc->symbol_ref));
20043 if (tdie)
20044 add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, tdie);
20045 else
20046 add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, ca_loc->symbol_ref);
20048 return die;
20051 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
20052 block-local). */
20054 static void
20055 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20057 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
20058 dw_die_ref subr_die;
20059 tree outer_scope;
20060 dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
20061 int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
20062 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
20064 premark_used_types ();
20066 /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
20067 started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
20068 its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
20069 from the member list for the class. If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
20070 we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class. */
20072 /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE. */
20073 if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
20075 origin = NULL;
20076 gcc_assert (!old_die);
20079 /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
20080 might need to retrofit the declaration into its class. */
20081 if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
20082 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
20083 && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
20084 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20085 old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
20087 if (origin != NULL)
20089 gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
20091 /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
20092 inline function. */
20093 if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
20094 add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
20096 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20097 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
20098 /* This is where the actual code for a cloned function is.
20099 Let's emit linkage name attribute for it. This helps
20100 debuggers to e.g, set breakpoints into
20101 constructors/destructors when the user asks "break
20102 K::K". */
20103 add_linkage_name (subr_die, decl);
20105 else if (old_die)
20107 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20108 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
20110 if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
20111 /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
20112 case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
20113 It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case. */
20114 && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20116 /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
20117 something we have already output. */
20118 return;
20121 /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
20122 maybe use the old DIE. We always want the DIE for this function
20123 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
20124 debugger can find it. We also need to do this for abstract
20125 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
20126 to have the same parent. For local class methods, this doesn't
20127 apply; we just use the old DIE. */
20128 if ((is_cu_die (old_die->die_parent) || context_die == NULL)
20129 && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
20130 || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
20131 && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
20132 == (unsigned) s.line))))
20134 subr_die = old_die;
20136 /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
20137 Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
20138 declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
20139 cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
20140 is one of the children that we do not want to remove. */
20141 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
20142 remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer);
20143 remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
20145 else
20147 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20148 add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
20149 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
20150 add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
20151 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
20152 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20155 else
20157 subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
20159 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20160 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20162 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
20163 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20165 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
20166 add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
20167 0, 0, context_die);
20170 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20171 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20172 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20174 add_accessibility_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20177 if (declaration)
20179 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20181 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20183 /* If this is an explicit function declaration then generate
20184 a DW_AT_explicit attribute. */
20185 if (lang_hooks.decls.function_decl_explicit_p (decl)
20186 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20187 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_explicit, 1);
20189 /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
20190 the class to which it belongs. We make sure of this by emitting
20191 the class first. The next time is the definition, which is
20192 handled above. The two may come from the same source text.
20194 Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
20195 later reused to represent definition. */
20196 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
20199 else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
20201 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
20203 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
20204 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
20205 else
20206 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
20208 else
20210 if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
20211 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
20212 else
20213 add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
20216 if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl)
20217 && lookup_attribute ("artificial", DECL_ATTRIBUTES (decl)))
20218 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20220 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
20222 else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20224 HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
20226 if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
20227 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
20229 if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
20231 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[current_funcdef_fde];
20232 if (fde->dw_fde_begin)
20234 /* We have already generated the labels. */
20235 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, fde->dw_fde_begin);
20236 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, fde->dw_fde_end);
20238 else
20240 /* Create start/end labels and add the range. */
20241 char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20242 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
20243 current_function_funcdef_no);
20244 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
20245 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
20246 current_function_funcdef_no);
20247 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
20250 #if VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20251 /* HP OpenVMS Industry Standard 64: DWARF Extensions
20252 Section 2.3 Prologue and Epilogue Attributes:
20253 When a breakpoint is set on entry to a function, it is generally
20254 desirable for execution to be suspended, not on the very first
20255 instruction of the function, but rather at a point after the
20256 function's frame has been set up, after any language defined local
20257 declaration processing has been completed, and before execution of
20258 the first statement of the function begins. Debuggers generally
20259 cannot properly determine where this point is. Similarly for a
20260 breakpoint set on exit from a function. The prologue and epilogue
20261 attributes allow a compiler to communicate the location(s) to use. */
20264 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue)
20265 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_prologue,
20266 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_end_prologue);
20268 if (fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue)
20269 add_AT_vms_delta (subr_die, DW_AT_HP_epilogue,
20270 fde->dw_fde_begin, fde->dw_fde_vms_begin_epilogue);
20272 #endif
20274 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20276 else
20277 { /* Generate pubnames entries for the split function code
20278 ranges. */
20279 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[current_funcdef_fde];
20281 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin)
20283 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20285 /* We should use ranges for non-contiguous code section
20286 addresses. Use the actual code range for the initial
20287 section, since the HOT/COLD labels might precede an
20288 alignment offset. */
20289 bool range_list_added = false;
20290 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_begin,
20291 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added);
20292 add_ranges_by_labels (subr_die, fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
20293 fde->dw_fde_second_end,
20294 &range_list_added);
20295 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20296 if (range_list_added)
20297 add_ranges (NULL);
20299 else
20301 /* There is no real support in DW2 for this .. so we make
20302 a work-around. First, emit the pub name for the segment
20303 containing the function label. Then make and emit a
20304 simplified subprogram DIE for the second segment with the
20305 name pre-fixed by __hot/cold_sect_of_. We use the same
20306 linkage name for the second die so that gdb will find both
20307 sections when given "b foo". */
20308 const char *name = NULL;
20309 tree decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
20310 dw_die_ref seg_die;
20312 /* Do the 'primary' section. */
20313 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc,
20314 fde->dw_fde_begin);
20315 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc,
20316 fde->dw_fde_end);
20317 /* Add it. */
20318 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20320 /* Build a minimal DIE for the secondary section. */
20321 seg_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram,
20322 subr_die->die_parent, decl);
20324 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20325 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20327 if (decl_name != NULL
20328 && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
20330 name = dwarf2_name (decl, 1);
20331 if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20332 add_src_coords_attributes (seg_die, decl);
20334 add_linkage_name (seg_die, decl);
20336 gcc_assert (name != NULL);
20337 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (seg_die, decl);
20338 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20339 add_AT_flag (seg_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20341 name = concat ("__second_sect_of_", name, NULL);
20342 add_AT_lbl_id (seg_die, DW_AT_low_pc,
20343 fde->dw_fde_second_begin);
20344 add_AT_lbl_id (seg_die, DW_AT_high_pc,
20345 fde->dw_fde_second_end);
20346 add_name_attribute (seg_die, name);
20347 add_pubname_string (name, seg_die);
20350 else
20352 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, fde->dw_fde_begin);
20353 add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, fde->dw_fde_end);
20354 add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
20358 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
20359 /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine. */
20360 add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
20361 #endif
20363 cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
20365 /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA. This is more
20366 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
20367 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
20368 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
20369 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
20370 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
20371 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
20372 function. */
20373 if (dwarf_version >= 3)
20375 dw_loc_descr_ref op = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_call_frame_cfa, 0, 0);
20376 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, op);
20378 else
20380 dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
20381 if (list->dw_loc_next)
20382 add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
20383 else
20384 add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
20387 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
20388 the CFA. The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
20389 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
20390 debugger about. We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
20391 by this displacement. */
20392 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
20394 if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
20395 add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
20396 loc_list_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl, 2));
20399 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
20400 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20401 gen_generic_params_dies (decl);
20403 /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
20404 (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
20405 for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
20406 `...' at the end of the formal parameter list. In order to find out if
20407 there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
20408 associated with the FUNCTION_DECL. This will be a node of type
20409 FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
20410 FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
20411 an ellipsis at the end. */
20413 /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
20414 need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
20415 its formal parameters. */
20416 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
20418 else if (declaration)
20419 gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
20420 else
20422 /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters. */
20423 tree parm = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
20424 tree generic_decl = lang_hooks.decls.get_generic_function_decl (decl);
20425 tree generic_decl_parm = generic_decl
20426 ? DECL_ARGUMENTS (generic_decl)
20427 : NULL;
20429 /* Now we want to walk the list of parameters of the function and
20430 emit their relevant DIEs.
20432 We consider the case of DECL being an instance of a generic function
20433 as well as it being a normal function.
20435 If DECL is an instance of a generic function we walk the
20436 parameters of the generic function declaration _and_ the parameters of
20437 DECL itself. This is useful because we want to emit specific DIEs for
20438 function parameter packs and those are declared as part of the
20439 generic function declaration. In that particular case,
20440 the parameter pack yields a DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE.
20441 That DIE has children DIEs representing the set of arguments
20442 of the pack. Note that the set of pack arguments can be empty.
20443 In that case, the DW_TAG_GNU_formal_parameter_pack DIE will not have any
20444 children DIE.
20446 Otherwise, we just consider the parameters of DECL. */
20447 while (generic_decl_parm || parm)
20449 if (generic_decl_parm
20450 && lang_hooks.function_parameter_pack_p (generic_decl_parm))
20451 gen_formal_parameter_pack_die (generic_decl_parm,
20452 parm, subr_die,
20453 &parm);
20454 else if (parm)
20456 dw_die_ref parm_die = gen_decl_die (parm, NULL, subr_die);
20458 if (parm == DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl)
20459 && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == METHOD_TYPE
20460 && parm_die
20461 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20462 add_AT_die_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_object_pointer, parm_die);
20464 parm = DECL_CHAIN (parm);
20467 if (generic_decl_parm)
20468 generic_decl_parm = DECL_CHAIN (generic_decl_parm);
20471 /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
20472 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
20473 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
20474 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
20475 definition). This just means that we have no info about the
20476 parameters at all. */
20477 if (prototype_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
20479 /* This is the prototyped case, check for.... */
20480 if (stdarg_p (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
20481 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
20483 else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
20484 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
20487 /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
20488 (if it has one - it may be just a declaration). */
20489 outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
20491 /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
20492 a function. This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
20493 for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
20494 parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
20495 end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
20496 the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
20497 DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
20499 The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
20500 the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
20501 for those in decls_for_scope. Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
20502 a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
20503 and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
20504 constructor function. */
20505 if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
20507 int call_site_note_count = 0;
20508 int tail_call_site_note_count = 0;
20510 /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value. */
20511 if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
20512 gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), NULL, subr_die);
20514 current_function_has_inlines = 0;
20515 decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
20517 if (call_arg_locations && !dwarf_strict)
20519 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc;
20520 for (ca_loc = call_arg_locations; ca_loc; ca_loc = ca_loc->next)
20522 dw_die_ref die = NULL;
20523 rtx tloc = NULL_RTX, tlocc = NULL_RTX;
20524 rtx arg, next_arg;
20526 for (arg = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note);
20527 arg; arg = next_arg)
20529 dw_loc_descr_ref reg, val;
20530 enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1));
20531 dw_die_ref cdie;
20533 next_arg = XEXP (arg, 1);
20534 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20535 && next_arg
20536 && MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0))
20537 && REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0))
20538 && REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0))
20539 == REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (next_arg, 0), 0), 0)))
20540 next_arg = XEXP (next_arg, 1);
20541 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20543 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0));
20544 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20545 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (arg, 0));
20547 if (mode == VOIDmode || mode == BLKmode)
20548 continue;
20549 if (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
20551 gcc_assert (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX);
20552 tloc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
20553 continue;
20555 else if (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)) == CLOBBER
20556 && XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0), 0) == pc_rtx)
20558 gcc_assert (ca_loc->symbol_ref == NULL_RTX);
20559 tlocc = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1);
20560 continue;
20562 if (REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
20563 reg = reg_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0),
20564 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20565 else if (MEM_P (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0)))
20567 rtx mem = XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 0);
20568 reg = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (mem, 0),
20569 get_address_mode (mem),
20570 GET_MODE (mem),
20571 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20573 else
20574 continue;
20575 if (reg == NULL)
20576 continue;
20577 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 0), 1), mode,
20578 VOIDmode,
20579 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20580 if (val == NULL)
20581 continue;
20582 if (die == NULL)
20583 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
20584 cdie = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_call_site_parameter, die,
20585 NULL_TREE);
20586 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_location, reg);
20587 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_value, val);
20588 if (next_arg != XEXP (arg, 1))
20590 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 1));
20591 if (mode == VOIDmode)
20592 mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1), 0), 0));
20593 val = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (arg, 1),
20594 0), 1),
20595 mode, VOIDmode,
20596 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20597 if (val != NULL)
20598 add_AT_loc (cdie, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_data_value, val);
20601 if (die == NULL
20602 && (ca_loc->symbol_ref || tloc))
20603 die = gen_call_site_die (decl, subr_die, ca_loc);
20604 if (die != NULL && (tloc != NULL_RTX || tlocc != NULL_RTX))
20606 dw_loc_descr_ref tval = NULL;
20608 if (tloc != NULL_RTX)
20609 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tloc,
20610 GET_MODE (tloc) == VOIDmode
20611 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tloc),
20612 VOIDmode,
20613 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20614 if (tval)
20615 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target, tval);
20616 else if (tlocc != NULL_RTX)
20618 tval = mem_loc_descriptor (tlocc,
20619 GET_MODE (tlocc) == VOIDmode
20620 ? Pmode : GET_MODE (tlocc),
20621 VOIDmode,
20622 VAR_INIT_STATUS_INITIALIZED);
20623 if (tval)
20624 add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_GNU_call_site_target_clobbered,
20625 tval);
20628 if (die != NULL)
20630 call_site_note_count++;
20631 if (ca_loc->tail_call_p)
20632 tail_call_site_note_count++;
20636 call_arg_locations = NULL;
20637 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
20638 if (tail_call_site_count >= 0
20639 && tail_call_site_count == tail_call_site_note_count
20640 && !dwarf_strict)
20642 if (call_site_count >= 0
20643 && call_site_count == call_site_note_count)
20644 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_call_sites, 1);
20645 else
20646 add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_GNU_all_tail_call_sites, 1);
20648 call_site_count = -1;
20649 tail_call_site_count = -1;
20651 /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested. */
20652 add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, decl);
20656 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct). */
20658 static hashval_t
20659 common_block_die_table_hash (const void *x)
20661 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
20662 return (hashval_t) d->decl_id ^ htab_hash_pointer (d->die_parent);
20665 /* Return nonzero if decl_id and die_parent of die_struct X is the same
20666 as decl_id and die_parent of die_struct Y. */
20668 static int
20669 common_block_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
20671 const_dw_die_ref d = (const_dw_die_ref) x;
20672 const_dw_die_ref e = (const_dw_die_ref) y;
20673 return d->decl_id == e->decl_id && d->die_parent == e->die_parent;
20676 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.
20677 Either DECL or ORIGIN must be non-null. */
20679 static void
20680 gen_variable_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
20682 HOST_WIDE_INT off;
20683 tree com_decl;
20684 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
20685 tree ultimate_origin;
20686 dw_die_ref var_die;
20687 dw_die_ref old_die = decl ? lookup_decl_die (decl) : NULL;
20688 dw_die_ref origin_die;
20689 bool declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl_or_origin)
20690 || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
20691 bool specialization_p = false;
20693 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
20694 if (decl || ultimate_origin)
20695 origin = ultimate_origin;
20696 com_decl = fortran_common (decl_or_origin, &off);
20698 /* Symbol in common gets emitted as a child of the common block, in the form
20699 of a data member. */
20700 if (com_decl)
20702 dw_die_ref com_die;
20703 dw_loc_list_ref loc;
20704 die_node com_die_arg;
20706 var_die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
20707 if (var_die)
20709 if (get_AT (var_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL)
20711 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, off ? 1 : 2);
20712 if (loc)
20714 if (off)
20716 /* Optimize the common case. */
20717 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
20718 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
20719 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
20720 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr)
20721 == SYMBOL_REF)
20722 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
20723 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
20724 else
20725 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
20727 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20728 remove_AT (var_die, DW_AT_declaration);
20731 return;
20734 if (common_block_die_table == NULL)
20735 common_block_die_table
20736 = htab_create_ggc (10, common_block_die_table_hash,
20737 common_block_die_table_eq, NULL);
20739 com_die_arg.decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
20740 com_die_arg.die_parent = context_die;
20741 com_die = (dw_die_ref) htab_find (common_block_die_table, &com_die_arg);
20742 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
20743 if (com_die == NULL)
20745 const char *cnam
20746 = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (com_decl));
20747 void **slot;
20749 com_die = new_die (DW_TAG_common_block, context_die, decl);
20750 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (com_die, com_decl);
20751 if (loc)
20753 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20754 /* Avoid sharing the same loc descriptor between
20755 DW_TAG_common_block and DW_TAG_variable. */
20756 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
20758 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20759 add_AT_flag (com_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20760 add_pubname_string (cnam, com_die); /* ??? needed? */
20761 com_die->decl_id = DECL_UID (com_decl);
20762 slot = htab_find_slot (common_block_die_table, com_die, INSERT);
20763 *slot = (void *) com_die;
20765 else if (get_AT (com_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL && loc)
20767 add_AT_location_description (com_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20768 loc = loc_list_from_tree (com_decl, 2);
20769 remove_AT (com_die, DW_AT_declaration);
20771 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, com_die, decl);
20772 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
20773 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
20774 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
20775 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20776 if (loc)
20778 if (off)
20780 /* Optimize the common case. */
20781 if (single_element_loc_list_p (loc)
20782 && loc->expr->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr
20783 && loc->expr->dw_loc_next == NULL
20784 && GET_CODE (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr) == SYMBOL_REF)
20785 loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr
20786 = plus_constant (loc->expr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, off);
20787 else
20788 loc_list_plus_const (loc, off);
20790 add_AT_location_description (var_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
20792 else if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
20793 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20794 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
20795 return;
20798 /* If the compiler emitted a definition for the DECL declaration
20799 and if we already emitted a DIE for it, don't emit a second
20800 DIE for it again. Allow re-declarations of DECLs that are
20801 inside functions, though. */
20802 if (old_die && declaration && !local_scope_p (context_die))
20803 return;
20805 /* For static data members, the declaration in the class is supposed
20806 to have DW_TAG_member tag; the specification should still be
20807 DW_TAG_variable referencing the DW_TAG_member DIE. */
20808 if (declaration && class_scope_p (context_die))
20809 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
20810 else
20811 var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
20813 origin_die = NULL;
20814 if (origin != NULL)
20815 origin_die = add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
20817 /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
20818 static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
20820 ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
20821 copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
20822 sharing them.
20824 ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
20826 ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
20827 variable, both of which are declarations. We want to avoid considering
20828 one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
20829 declaration. */
20830 else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
20831 && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
20833 /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static. */
20834 add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
20835 specialization_p = true;
20836 if (DECL_NAME (decl))
20838 expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
20839 struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
20841 if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
20842 add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
20844 if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
20845 add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
20847 if (old_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_member)
20848 add_linkage_name (var_die, decl);
20851 else
20852 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
20854 if ((origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
20855 || (origin != NULL
20856 && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
20857 && variably_modified_type_p (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin),
20858 decl_function_context
20859 (decl_or_origin))))
20861 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin);
20863 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
20864 add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
20865 else
20866 add_type_attribute (var_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl_or_origin),
20867 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
20870 if (origin == NULL && !specialization_p)
20872 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20873 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20875 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20876 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20878 add_accessibility_attribute (var_die, decl);
20881 if (declaration)
20882 add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
20884 if (decl && (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration || old_die == NULL))
20885 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
20887 if (! declaration
20888 && (! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl_or_origin)
20889 /* Local static vars are shared between all clones/inlines,
20890 so emit DW_AT_location on the abstract DIE if DECL_RTL is
20891 already set. */
20892 || (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL
20893 && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
20894 && DECL_RTL_SET_P (decl_or_origin)))
20895 /* When abstract origin already has DW_AT_location attribute, no need
20896 to add it again. */
20897 && (origin_die == NULL || get_AT (origin_die, DW_AT_location) == NULL))
20899 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl_or_origin)
20900 && !TREE_SYMBOL_REFERENCED (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl_or_origin)))
20901 defer_location (decl_or_origin, var_die);
20902 else
20903 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl_or_origin,
20904 decl == NULL, DW_AT_location);
20905 add_pubname (decl_or_origin, var_die);
20907 else
20908 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (var_die, decl_or_origin);
20911 /* Generate a DIE to represent a named constant. */
20913 static void
20914 gen_const_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20916 dw_die_ref const_die;
20917 tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
20919 const_die = new_die (DW_TAG_constant, context_die, decl);
20920 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (const_die, decl);
20921 add_type_attribute (const_die, type, 1, 0, context_die);
20922 if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
20923 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
20924 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
20925 add_AT_flag (const_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
20926 tree_add_const_value_attribute_for_decl (const_die, decl);
20929 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier. */
20931 static void
20932 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
20934 tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
20935 dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
20936 rtx insn;
20937 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20939 if (origin != NULL)
20940 add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
20941 else
20942 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
20944 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
20945 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
20946 else
20948 insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
20950 /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
20951 eliminated because of various optimizations. We still emit them
20952 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them. */
20953 if (insn
20954 && (LABEL_P (insn)
20955 || ((NOTE_P (insn)
20956 && NOTE_KIND (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
20958 /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
20959 (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
20960 represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
20961 the user. This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
20962 it if it ever does happen. */
20963 gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
20965 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
20966 add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
20971 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die. Add source coordinate
20972 attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
20973 function was called from. This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes. */
20975 static inline void
20976 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
20978 expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
20980 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
20982 add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
20983 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
20988 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
20989 Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT. */
20991 static inline void
20992 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
20994 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
20996 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt)
20997 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
20999 tree chain;
21001 if (inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt))
21003 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
21004 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21005 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_entry_pc, label);
21008 add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
21010 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
21013 add_ranges (chain);
21014 chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
21016 while (chain);
21017 add_ranges (NULL);
21019 else
21021 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
21022 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21023 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
21024 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
21025 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
21026 add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
21030 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block. */
21032 static void
21033 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
21035 dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
21037 if (call_arg_locations)
21039 if (VEC_length (dw_die_ref, block_map) <= BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt))
21040 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_die_ref, heap, block_map,
21041 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt) + 1);
21042 VEC_replace (dw_die_ref, block_map, BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt), stmt_die);
21045 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt) && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
21046 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
21048 decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
21051 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram. */
21053 static void
21054 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
21056 tree decl;
21058 /* The instance of function that is effectively being inlined shall not
21059 be abstract. */
21060 gcc_assert (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt));
21062 decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
21064 /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet. We
21065 must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
21066 emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
21067 a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing. */
21068 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
21070 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
21072 dw_die_ref subr_die
21073 = new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
21075 if (call_arg_locations)
21077 if (VEC_length (dw_die_ref, block_map) <= BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt))
21078 VEC_safe_grow_cleared (dw_die_ref, heap, block_map,
21079 BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt) + 1);
21080 VEC_replace (dw_die_ref, block_map, BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt), subr_die);
21082 add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
21083 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt))
21084 add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
21085 add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
21087 decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
21088 current_function_has_inlines = 1;
21092 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure. */
21094 static void
21095 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21097 dw_die_ref decl_die;
21099 if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
21100 return;
21102 decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
21103 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
21104 add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
21105 TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
21106 context_die);
21108 if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
21110 add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21111 add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21112 add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21115 if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
21116 add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21118 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
21119 add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
21121 add_accessibility_attribute (decl_die, decl);
21123 /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on. */
21124 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
21127 #if 0
21128 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
21129 Use modified_type_die instead.
21130 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
21131 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
21133 static void
21134 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21136 dw_die_ref ptr_die
21137 = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21139 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
21140 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
21141 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
21144 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
21145 Use modified_type_die instead.
21146 We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
21147 represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday. */
21149 static void
21150 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21152 dw_die_ref ref_die, scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21154 if (TYPE_REF_IS_RVALUE (type) && dwarf_version >= 4)
21155 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type, scope_die, type);
21156 else
21157 ref_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die, type);
21159 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
21160 add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
21161 add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
21163 #endif
21165 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type. */
21167 static void
21168 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21170 dw_die_ref ptr_die
21171 = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
21172 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21174 equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
21175 add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
21176 lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
21177 add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
21180 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit. */
21182 static dw_die_ref
21183 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
21185 dw_die_ref die;
21186 char producer[250];
21187 const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
21188 int language;
21190 die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
21192 if (filename)
21194 add_name_attribute (die, filename);
21195 /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>. */
21196 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename) && filename[0] != '<')
21197 add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
21200 sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
21202 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
21203 /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
21204 string. The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
21205 not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
21206 that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
21207 To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
21208 information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string. */
21209 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21210 strcat (producer, " -g");
21211 #endif
21213 add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
21215 /* If our producer is LTO try to figure out a common language to use
21216 from the global list of translation units. */
21217 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU GIMPLE") == 0)
21219 unsigned i;
21220 tree t;
21221 const char *common_lang = NULL;
21223 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (tree, all_translation_units, i, t)
21225 if (!TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t))
21226 continue;
21227 if (!common_lang)
21228 common_lang = TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t);
21229 else if (strcmp (common_lang, TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t)) == 0)
21231 else if (strncmp (common_lang, "GNU C", 5) == 0
21232 && strncmp (TRANSLATION_UNIT_LANGUAGE (t), "GNU C", 5) == 0)
21233 /* Mixing C and C++ is ok, use C++ in that case. */
21234 common_lang = "GNU C++";
21235 else
21237 /* Fall back to C. */
21238 common_lang = NULL;
21239 break;
21243 if (common_lang)
21244 language_string = common_lang;
21247 language = DW_LANG_C89;
21248 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
21249 language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
21250 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
21251 language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
21252 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
21253 language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
21254 else if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
21256 if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
21257 language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
21258 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Fortran") == 0)
21259 language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
21260 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
21261 language = DW_LANG_Java;
21262 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
21263 language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
21264 else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
21265 language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
21268 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
21270 switch (language)
21272 case DW_LANG_Fortran77:
21273 case DW_LANG_Fortran90:
21274 case DW_LANG_Fortran95:
21275 /* Fortran has case insensitive identifiers and the front-end
21276 lowercases everything. */
21277 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_identifier_case, DW_ID_down_case);
21278 break;
21279 default:
21280 /* The default DW_ID_case_sensitive doesn't need to be specified. */
21281 break;
21283 return die;
21286 /* Generate the DIE for a base class. */
21288 static void
21289 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
21291 dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
21293 add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
21294 add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
21296 if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
21297 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
21299 /* In DWARF3+ the default is DW_ACCESS_private only in DW_TAG_class_type
21300 children, otherwise the default is DW_ACCESS_public. In DWARF2
21301 the default has always been DW_ACCESS_private. */
21302 if (access == access_public_node)
21304 if (dwarf_version == 2
21305 || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_class_type)
21306 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
21308 else if (access == access_protected_node)
21309 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
21310 else if (dwarf_version > 2
21311 && context_die->die_tag != DW_TAG_class_type)
21312 add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
21315 /* Generate a DIE for a class member. */
21317 static void
21318 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21320 tree member;
21321 tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
21322 dw_die_ref child;
21324 /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
21325 members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
21326 members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
21327 DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
21328 function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
21329 types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
21330 for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
21331 members of this (containing) type themselves. The g++ front- end can
21332 force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
21333 type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
21334 the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type. */
21336 /* First output info about the base classes. */
21337 if (binfo)
21339 VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
21340 int i;
21341 tree base;
21343 for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
21344 gen_inheritance_die (base,
21345 (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
21346 : access_public_node), context_die);
21349 /* Now output info about the data members and type members. */
21350 for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
21352 /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
21353 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
21354 may have already been defined. Don't define them again, but
21355 do put them in the right order. */
21357 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
21358 if (child)
21359 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
21360 else
21361 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
21364 /* Now output info about the function members (if any). */
21365 for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = DECL_CHAIN (member))
21367 /* Don't include clones in the member list. */
21368 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
21369 continue;
21371 child = lookup_decl_die (member);
21372 if (child)
21373 splice_child_die (context_die, child);
21374 else
21375 gen_decl_die (member, NULL, context_die);
21379 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type. If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
21380 is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
21381 member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs. */
21383 static void
21384 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
21385 enum debug_info_usage usage)
21387 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21388 dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
21389 int nested = 0;
21390 int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
21391 && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
21392 || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
21393 int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
21394 complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
21396 if (type_die && ! complete)
21397 return;
21399 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
21400 && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
21401 || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
21402 nested = 1;
21404 scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
21406 if (! type_die || (nested && is_cu_die (scope_die)))
21407 /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class. */
21409 dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
21411 type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
21412 ? record_type_tag (type) : DW_TAG_union_type,
21413 scope_die, type);
21414 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
21415 if (old_die)
21416 add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
21417 else
21419 add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
21420 add_gnat_descriptive_type_attribute (type_die, type, context_die);
21423 else
21424 remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
21426 /* Generate child dies for template paramaters. */
21427 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
21428 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (type))
21429 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (type);
21431 /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
21432 then give a list of members. */
21433 if (complete && !ns_decl)
21435 /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
21436 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself. */
21437 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21438 add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
21439 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
21441 add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21442 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
21445 /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
21446 inline function, then it may not have a parent. Fix this now. */
21447 if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
21448 add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
21450 push_decl_scope (type);
21451 gen_member_die (type, type_die);
21452 pop_decl_scope ();
21454 /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in. */
21455 if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
21457 tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
21459 gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
21460 add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
21461 lookup_type_die (vtype));
21464 else
21466 add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
21468 /* We don't need to do this for function-local types. */
21469 if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
21470 && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
21471 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
21474 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
21475 add_pubtype (type, type_die);
21478 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_. */
21480 static void
21481 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21483 tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
21484 dw_die_ref subr_die
21485 = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
21486 scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
21488 equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
21489 add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
21490 add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
21491 gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
21493 if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
21494 add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
21497 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition. */
21499 static void
21500 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
21502 dw_die_ref type_die;
21503 tree origin;
21505 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
21506 return;
21508 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
21509 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
21510 origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
21511 if (origin != NULL)
21512 add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
21513 else
21515 tree type;
21517 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
21518 if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
21520 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
21522 gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
21523 equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
21525 else
21527 type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
21529 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
21531 /* Here, we are in the case of decl being a typedef naming
21532 an anonymous type, e.g:
21533 typedef struct {...} foo;
21534 In that case TREE_TYPE (decl) is not a typedef variant
21535 type and TYPE_NAME of the anonymous type is set to the
21536 TYPE_DECL of the typedef. This construct is emitted by
21537 the C++ FE.
21539 TYPE is the anonymous struct named by the typedef
21540 DECL. As we need the DW_AT_type attribute of the
21541 DW_TAG_typedef to point to the DIE of TYPE, let's
21542 generate that DIE right away. add_type_attribute
21543 called below will then pick (via lookup_type_die) that
21544 anonymous struct DIE. */
21545 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
21546 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
21548 /* This is a GNU Extension. We are adding a
21549 DW_AT_linkage_name attribute to the DIE of the
21550 anonymous struct TYPE. The value of that attribute
21551 is the name of the typedef decl naming the anonymous
21552 struct. This greatly eases the work of consumers of
21553 this debug info. */
21554 add_linkage_attr (lookup_type_die (type), decl);
21558 add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
21559 TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
21561 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (decl))
21562 /* We want that all subsequent calls to lookup_type_die with
21563 TYPE in argument yield the DW_TAG_typedef we have just
21564 created. */
21565 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
21567 add_accessibility_attribute (type_die, decl);
21570 if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
21571 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
21573 if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
21574 add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
21577 /* Generate a DIE for a struct, class, enum or union type. */
21579 static void
21580 gen_tagged_type_die (tree type,
21581 dw_die_ref context_die,
21582 enum debug_info_usage usage)
21584 int need_pop;
21586 if (type == NULL_TREE
21587 || !is_tagged_type (type))
21588 return;
21590 /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
21591 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too. This does not apply
21592 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
21593 the containing class as they are generated. FIXME: This hurts the
21594 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
21595 what set of template instantiations we'll get. */
21596 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
21597 && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
21598 && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
21600 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
21602 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
21603 return;
21605 /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub. */
21606 push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
21607 context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
21608 need_pop = 1;
21610 else if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
21611 && (TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == FUNCTION_DECL))
21613 /* If this type is local to a function that hasn't been written
21614 out yet, use a NULL context for now; it will be fixed up in
21615 decls_for_scope. */
21616 context_die = lookup_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
21617 /* A declaration DIE doesn't count; nested types need to go in the
21618 specification. */
21619 if (context_die && is_declaration_die (context_die))
21620 context_die = NULL;
21621 need_pop = 0;
21623 else
21625 context_die = declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
21626 need_pop = 0;
21629 if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
21631 /* This might have been written out by the call to
21632 declare_in_namespace. */
21633 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
21634 gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
21636 else
21637 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
21639 if (need_pop)
21640 pop_decl_scope ();
21642 /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
21643 it up if it is ever completed. gen_*_type_die will set it for us
21644 when appropriate. */
21647 /* Generate a type description DIE. */
21649 static void
21650 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
21651 enum debug_info_usage usage)
21653 struct array_descr_info info;
21655 if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
21656 return;
21658 if (TYPE_NAME (type) != NULL_TREE
21659 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
21660 && is_redundant_typedef (TYPE_NAME (type))
21661 && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
21662 /* The DECL of this type is a typedef we don't want to emit debug
21663 info for but we want debug info for its underlying typedef.
21664 This can happen for e.g, the injected-class-name of a C++
21665 type. */
21666 type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type));
21668 /* If TYPE is a typedef type variant, let's generate debug info
21669 for the parent typedef which TYPE is a type of. */
21670 if (typedef_variant_p (type))
21672 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
21673 return;
21675 /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type. */
21676 gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
21678 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
21679 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
21680 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
21681 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
21682 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
21684 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21686 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
21687 return;
21690 /* If type is an anonymous tagged type named by a typedef, let's
21691 generate debug info for the typedef. */
21692 if (is_naming_typedef_decl (TYPE_NAME (type)))
21694 /* Use the DIE of the containing namespace as the parent DIE of
21695 the type description DIE we want to generate. */
21696 if (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))
21697 && TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type))) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
21698 context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (TYPE_NAME (type)));
21700 gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), NULL, context_die);
21701 return;
21704 /* If this is an array type with hidden descriptor, handle it first. */
21705 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type)
21706 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info
21707 && lang_hooks.types.get_array_descr_info (type, &info)
21708 && (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
21710 gen_descr_array_type_die (type, &info, context_die);
21711 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21712 return;
21715 /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
21716 of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
21717 get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
21718 now. (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
21719 cloned type itself). */
21720 if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
21721 type = type_main_variant (type);
21723 if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
21724 return;
21726 switch (TREE_CODE (type))
21728 case ERROR_MARK:
21729 break;
21731 case POINTER_TYPE:
21732 case REFERENCE_TYPE:
21733 /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type. This
21734 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
21735 type is recursive. Recursive types are possible in Ada. */
21736 /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
21737 statement. */
21738 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21740 /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
21741 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type. */
21742 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
21743 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
21744 break;
21746 case OFFSET_TYPE:
21747 /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
21748 Output a description of the relevant class type. */
21749 gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
21750 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
21752 /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to. */
21753 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
21754 DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
21756 /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
21757 itself. */
21758 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
21759 break;
21761 case FUNCTION_TYPE:
21762 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
21763 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
21764 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
21765 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
21766 break;
21768 case METHOD_TYPE:
21769 /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already). */
21770 gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
21771 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
21772 gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
21773 break;
21775 case ARRAY_TYPE:
21776 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
21777 break;
21779 case VECTOR_TYPE:
21780 gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
21781 break;
21783 case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
21784 case RECORD_TYPE:
21785 case UNION_TYPE:
21786 case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
21787 gen_tagged_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
21788 return;
21790 case VOID_TYPE:
21791 case INTEGER_TYPE:
21792 case REAL_TYPE:
21793 case FIXED_POINT_TYPE:
21794 case COMPLEX_TYPE:
21795 case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
21796 /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types. */
21797 break;
21799 case NULLPTR_TYPE:
21800 case LANG_TYPE:
21801 /* Just use DW_TAG_unspecified_type. */
21803 dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
21804 if (type_die == NULL)
21806 tree name = TYPE_NAME (type);
21807 if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
21808 name = DECL_NAME (name);
21809 type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_type, comp_unit_die (), type);
21810 add_name_attribute (type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
21811 equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
21814 break;
21816 default:
21817 gcc_unreachable ();
21820 TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
21823 static void
21824 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
21826 gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
21829 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
21830 things which are local to the given block. */
21832 static void
21833 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
21835 int must_output_die = 0;
21836 bool inlined_func;
21838 /* Ignore blocks that are NULL. */
21839 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
21840 return;
21842 inlined_func = inlined_function_outer_scope_p (stmt);
21844 /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
21845 process the variables, since they will have been done by the
21846 origin block. Do process subblocks. */
21847 if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
21849 tree sub;
21851 for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
21852 gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
21854 return;
21857 /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
21858 block. */
21859 if (inlined_func)
21860 /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented. We
21861 generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them. (See below.) */
21862 must_output_die = 1;
21863 else
21865 /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
21866 local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for. */
21867 if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21868 /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
21869 as being a "significant" one. */
21870 must_output_die = ((BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
21871 || BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt))
21872 && (TREE_USED (stmt)
21873 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
21874 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
21875 else if ((TREE_USED (stmt)
21876 || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
21877 || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
21878 && !dwarf2out_ignore_block (stmt))
21879 must_output_die = 1;
21882 /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
21883 DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
21884 all. Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
21885 needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
21886 that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
21887 local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
21888 instances and local (nested) function definitions. */
21889 if (must_output_die)
21891 if (inlined_func)
21893 /* If STMT block is abstract, that means we have been called
21894 indirectly from dwarf2out_abstract_function.
21895 That function rightfully marks the descendent blocks (of
21896 the abstract function it is dealing with) as being abstract,
21897 precisely to prevent us from emitting any
21898 DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE as a descendent
21899 of an abstract function instance. So in that case, we should
21900 not call gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
21902 Later though, when cgraph asks dwarf2out to emit info
21903 for the concrete instance of the function decl into which
21904 the concrete instance of STMT got inlined, the later will lead
21905 to the generation of a DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIE. */
21906 if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
21907 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
21909 else
21910 gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
21912 else
21913 decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
21916 /* Process variable DECL (or variable with origin ORIGIN) within
21917 block STMT and add it to CONTEXT_DIE. */
21918 static void
21919 process_scope_var (tree stmt, tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
21921 dw_die_ref die;
21922 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
21924 if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == FUNCTION_DECL)
21925 die = lookup_decl_die (decl_or_origin);
21926 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == TYPE_DECL
21927 && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl_or_origin))
21928 die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin));
21929 else
21930 die = NULL;
21932 if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
21933 add_child_die (context_die, die);
21934 else if (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin) == IMPORTED_DECL)
21935 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl_or_origin, DECL_NAME (decl_or_origin),
21936 stmt, context_die);
21937 else
21938 gen_decl_die (decl, origin, context_die);
21941 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
21942 all of its sub-blocks. */
21944 static void
21945 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
21947 tree decl;
21948 unsigned int i;
21949 tree subblocks;
21951 /* Ignore NULL blocks. */
21952 if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
21953 return;
21955 /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
21956 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
21957 sub-blocks. Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
21958 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now. */
21959 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
21960 process_scope_var (stmt, decl, NULL_TREE, context_die);
21961 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (stmt); i++)
21962 process_scope_var (stmt, NULL, BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (stmt, i),
21963 context_die);
21965 /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks. */
21966 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
21967 return;
21969 /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
21970 therein) of this block. */
21971 for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
21972 subblocks != NULL;
21973 subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
21974 gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
21977 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting? */
21979 static inline int
21980 is_redundant_typedef (const_tree decl)
21982 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
21983 return 1;
21985 if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
21986 && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
21987 && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
21988 && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
21989 && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
21990 /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name. */
21991 return 1;
21993 return 0;
21996 /* Return TRUE if TYPE is a typedef that names a type for linkage
21997 purposes. This kind of typedefs is produced by the C++ FE for
21998 constructs like:
22000 typedef struct {...} foo;
22002 In that case, there is no typedef variant type produced for foo.
22003 Rather, the TREE_TYPE of the TYPE_DECL of foo is the anonymous
22004 struct type. */
22006 static bool
22007 is_naming_typedef_decl (const_tree decl)
22009 if (decl == NULL_TREE
22010 || TREE_CODE (decl) != TYPE_DECL
22011 || !is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))
22012 || DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl)
22013 || is_redundant_typedef (decl)
22014 /* It looks like Ada produces TYPE_DECLs that are very similar
22015 to C++ naming typedefs but that have different
22016 semantics. Let's be specific to c++ for now. */
22017 || !is_cxx ())
22018 return FALSE;
22020 return (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl) == NULL_TREE
22021 && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == decl
22022 && (TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl))
22023 != TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
22026 /* Returns the DIE for a context. */
22028 static inline dw_die_ref
22029 get_context_die (tree context)
22031 if (context)
22033 /* Find die that represents this context. */
22034 if (TYPE_P (context))
22036 context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (context);
22037 return strip_naming_typedef (context, force_type_die (context));
22039 else
22040 return force_decl_die (context);
22042 return comp_unit_die ();
22045 /* Returns the DIE for decl. A DIE will always be returned. */
22047 static dw_die_ref
22048 force_decl_die (tree decl)
22050 dw_die_ref decl_die;
22051 unsigned saved_external_flag;
22052 tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
22053 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22054 if (!decl_die)
22056 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
22058 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22059 if (decl_die)
22060 return decl_die;
22062 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
22064 case FUNCTION_DECL:
22065 /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
22066 that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
22067 declaration die. */
22068 save_fn = current_function_decl;
22069 current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
22070 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
22071 current_function_decl = save_fn;
22072 break;
22074 case VAR_DECL:
22075 /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
22076 gen_decl_die() call. */
22077 saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
22078 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
22079 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
22080 DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
22081 break;
22083 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
22084 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22085 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
22086 else
22087 /* DWARF2 has neither DW_TAG_module, nor DW_TAG_namespace. */
22088 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
22089 break;
22091 case TRANSLATION_UNIT_DECL:
22092 decl_die = comp_unit_die ();
22093 break;
22095 default:
22096 gcc_unreachable ();
22099 /* We should be able to find the DIE now. */
22100 if (!decl_die)
22101 decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22102 gcc_assert (decl_die);
22105 return decl_die;
22108 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type. A DIE is
22109 always returned. */
22111 static dw_die_ref
22112 force_type_die (tree type)
22114 dw_die_ref type_die;
22116 type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
22117 if (!type_die)
22119 dw_die_ref context_die = get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
22121 type_die = modified_type_die (type, TYPE_READONLY (type),
22122 TYPE_VOLATILE (type), context_die);
22123 gcc_assert (type_die);
22125 return type_die;
22128 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
22129 and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed. */
22131 static dw_die_ref
22132 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
22134 tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
22135 ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
22136 if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
22137 /* Force out the namespace. */
22138 context_die = force_decl_die (context);
22140 return context_die;
22143 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
22144 type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
22146 For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
22147 declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope. */
22149 static dw_die_ref
22150 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
22152 dw_die_ref ns_context;
22154 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22155 return context_die;
22157 /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
22158 namespace, as we will get confused. It would have already been emitted
22159 when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways. */
22160 if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
22161 return context_die;
22163 ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
22165 if (ns_context != context_die)
22167 if (is_fortran ())
22168 return ns_context;
22169 if (DECL_P (thing))
22170 gen_decl_die (thing, NULL, ns_context);
22171 else
22172 gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
22174 return context_die;
22177 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias. */
22179 static void
22180 gen_namespace_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
22182 dw_die_ref namespace_die;
22184 /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
22185 they are an alias of. */
22186 if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
22188 /* Output a real namespace or module. */
22189 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
22190 namespace_die = new_die (is_fortran ()
22191 ? DW_TAG_module : DW_TAG_namespace,
22192 context_die, decl);
22193 /* For Fortran modules defined in different CU don't add src coords. */
22194 if (namespace_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_module && DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
22196 const char *name = dwarf2_name (decl, 0);
22197 if (name)
22198 add_name_attribute (namespace_die, name);
22200 else
22201 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
22202 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
22203 add_AT_flag (namespace_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
22204 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
22206 else
22208 /* Output a namespace alias. */
22210 /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary. */
22211 dw_die_ref origin_die
22212 = force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
22214 if (DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl)
22215 || TREE_CODE (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
22216 context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die ());
22217 /* Now create the namespace alias DIE. */
22218 namespace_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
22219 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
22220 add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
22221 equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
22225 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.
22226 The return value is currently only meaningful for PARM_DECLs,
22227 for all other decls it returns NULL. */
22229 static dw_die_ref
22230 gen_decl_die (tree decl, tree origin, dw_die_ref context_die)
22232 tree decl_or_origin = decl ? decl : origin;
22233 tree class_origin = NULL, ultimate_origin;
22235 if (DECL_P (decl_or_origin) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl_or_origin))
22236 return NULL;
22238 switch (TREE_CODE (decl_or_origin))
22240 case ERROR_MARK:
22241 break;
22243 case CONST_DECL:
22244 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
22246 /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
22247 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself. */
22248 break;
22251 /* Emit its type. */
22252 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
22254 /* And its containing namespace. */
22255 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
22257 gen_const_die (decl, context_die);
22258 break;
22260 case FUNCTION_DECL:
22261 /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
22262 unless they are class members or explicit block externs. */
22263 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl_or_origin) == NULL_TREE
22264 && DECL_FILE_SCOPE_P (decl_or_origin)
22265 && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE
22266 || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl_or_origin)))
22267 break;
22269 #if 0
22270 /* FIXME */
22271 /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
22272 on local redeclarations of global functions. That seems broken. */
22273 if (current_function_decl != decl)
22274 /* This is only a declaration. */;
22275 #endif
22277 /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance. */
22278 if (origin || DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
22279 dwarf2out_abstract_function (origin
22280 ? DECL_ORIGIN (origin)
22281 : DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
22283 /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
22284 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it. */
22285 else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
22286 && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
22287 && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
22288 /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
22289 a declaration. We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
22290 that case, because that works only if we have a die. */
22291 && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
22293 dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
22294 set_decl_origin_self (decl);
22297 /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl. */
22298 else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22300 /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
22301 have its containing type. */
22302 if (!origin)
22303 origin = decl_class_context (decl);
22304 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
22305 gen_type_die (origin, context_die);
22307 /* And its return type. */
22308 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
22310 /* And its virtual context. */
22311 if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
22312 gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
22314 /* Make sure we have a member DIE for decl. */
22315 if (origin != NULL_TREE)
22316 gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
22318 /* And its containing namespace. */
22319 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
22322 /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself. */
22323 if (decl)
22324 gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
22325 break;
22327 case TYPE_DECL:
22328 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
22329 actual typedefs. */
22330 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22331 break;
22333 /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
22334 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
22335 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
22336 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
22337 used to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
22338 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here. But nothing
22339 should be actually referencing those DIEs, as variable DIEs with that
22340 type would be emitted already in the abstract origin, so it was always
22341 removed during unused type prunning. Don't add anything in this
22342 case. */
22343 if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE)
22344 break;
22346 if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
22347 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
22348 else
22349 /* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself. */
22350 gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
22351 break;
22353 case LABEL_DECL:
22354 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
22355 gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
22356 break;
22358 case VAR_DECL:
22359 case RESULT_DECL:
22360 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
22361 variable declarations or definitions. */
22362 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22363 break;
22365 /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
22366 object. */
22367 if (decl_by_reference_p (decl_or_origin))
22368 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
22369 else
22370 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
22372 /* And its containing type. */
22373 class_origin = decl_class_context (decl_or_origin);
22374 if (class_origin != NULL_TREE)
22375 gen_type_die_for_member (class_origin, decl_or_origin, context_die);
22377 /* And its containing namespace. */
22378 context_die = declare_in_namespace (decl_or_origin, context_die);
22380 /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself. This gets
22381 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
22382 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
22383 function. */
22384 ultimate_origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl_or_origin);
22385 if (ultimate_origin != NULL_TREE
22386 && TREE_CODE (ultimate_origin) == PARM_DECL)
22387 gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
22388 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
22389 context_die);
22390 else
22391 gen_variable_die (decl, origin, context_die);
22392 break;
22394 case FIELD_DECL:
22395 /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
22396 anonymous unions and structs. */
22397 if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
22398 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
22399 || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
22401 gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
22402 gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
22404 break;
22406 case PARM_DECL:
22407 if (DECL_BY_REFERENCE (decl_or_origin))
22408 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin)), context_die);
22409 else
22410 gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl_or_origin), context_die);
22411 return gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, origin,
22412 true /* Emit name attribute. */,
22413 context_die);
22415 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
22416 case IMPORTED_DECL:
22417 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22418 gen_namespace_die (decl, context_die);
22419 break;
22421 default:
22422 /* Probably some frontend-internal decl. Assume we don't care. */
22423 gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
22424 break;
22427 return NULL;
22430 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL. Called from toplev.c after
22431 compilation proper has finished. */
22433 static void
22434 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
22436 /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
22437 declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which
22438 had no corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations
22439 and definitions which have not yet been forced out. */
22440 if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
22441 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
22444 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL. Called from toplev.c
22445 and from language front ends (to record built-in types). */
22446 static void
22447 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
22449 if (!local)
22450 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
22453 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
22454 NAME is non-NULL name in the lexical block if the decl has been renamed.
22455 LEXICAL_BLOCK is the lexical block (which TREE_CODE is a BLOCK)
22456 that DECL belongs to.
22457 LEXICAL_BLOCK_DIE is the DIE of LEXICAL_BLOCK. */
22458 static void
22459 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (tree decl,
22460 tree name,
22461 tree lexical_block,
22462 dw_die_ref lexical_block_die)
22464 expanded_location xloc;
22465 dw_die_ref imported_die = NULL;
22466 dw_die_ref at_import_die;
22468 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == IMPORTED_DECL)
22470 xloc = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
22471 decl = IMPORTED_DECL_ASSOCIATED_DECL (decl);
22472 gcc_assert (decl);
22474 else
22475 xloc = expand_location (input_location);
22477 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
22479 at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
22480 /* For namespace N { typedef void T; } using N::T; base_type_die
22481 returns NULL, but DW_TAG_imported_declaration requires
22482 the DW_AT_import tag. Force creation of DW_TAG_typedef. */
22483 if (!at_import_die)
22485 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL);
22486 gen_typedef_die (decl, get_context_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl)));
22487 at_import_die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
22488 gcc_assert (at_import_die);
22491 else
22493 at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
22494 if (!at_import_die)
22496 /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
22497 emitted the member decl for this field. Emit it now. */
22498 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
22500 tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
22502 if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
22503 && TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
22504 && !should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
22505 DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
22506 return;
22507 gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl,
22508 get_context_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)));
22510 at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
22514 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
22516 if (dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict)
22517 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module,
22518 lexical_block_die,
22519 lexical_block);
22520 else
22521 return;
22523 else
22524 imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration,
22525 lexical_block_die,
22526 lexical_block);
22528 add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
22529 add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
22530 if (name)
22531 add_AT_string (imported_die, DW_AT_name,
22532 IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
22533 add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
22536 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl DECL.
22537 NAME is non-NULL name in context if the decl has been renamed.
22538 CHILD is true if decl is one of the renamed decls as part of
22539 importing whole module. */
22541 static void
22542 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree name, tree context,
22543 bool child)
22545 /* dw_die_ref at_import_die; */
22546 dw_die_ref scope_die;
22548 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22549 return;
22551 gcc_assert (decl);
22553 /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
22554 We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
22555 itself. */
22557 /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
22558 or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die. */
22559 if (context
22560 && TYPE_P (context)
22561 && !should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
22562 return;
22564 if (!(dwarf_version >= 3 || !dwarf_strict))
22565 return;
22567 scope_die = get_context_die (context);
22569 if (child)
22571 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child);
22572 gcc_assert (scope_die->die_child->die_tag == DW_TAG_imported_module);
22573 gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) != NAMESPACE_DECL);
22574 scope_die = scope_die->die_child;
22577 /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die. */
22578 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl_1 (decl, name, context, scope_die);
22582 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
22584 void
22585 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
22587 dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die ();
22589 switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
22591 case ERROR_MARK:
22592 return;
22594 case FUNCTION_DECL:
22595 /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
22596 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
22597 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
22598 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
22599 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
22600 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
22601 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions. If
22602 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
22603 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
22604 with the definition of the function.
22606 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
22607 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
22608 declarations. We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
22609 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
22610 function definitions. These can get inlined within the current
22611 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
22612 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
22613 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
22614 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
22615 that they *are* definitions).
22617 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
22618 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
22619 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
22620 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
22621 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas. */
22622 if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
22623 return;
22625 /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
22626 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. If
22627 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE. */
22628 if (decl_function_context (decl)
22629 /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope. */
22630 && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22631 context_die = NULL;
22632 break;
22634 case VAR_DECL:
22635 /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
22636 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
22637 within this entire compilation unit. We suppress these DIEs in
22638 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
22639 which are probably useless). Note that we must not suppress
22640 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
22641 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
22642 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point. */
22643 if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
22644 return;
22646 /* For local statics lookup proper context die. */
22647 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
22648 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
22650 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
22651 variable declarations or definitions. */
22652 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22653 return;
22654 break;
22656 case CONST_DECL:
22657 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22658 return;
22659 if (!is_fortran () && !is_ada ())
22660 return;
22661 if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
22662 context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
22663 break;
22665 case NAMESPACE_DECL:
22666 case IMPORTED_DECL:
22667 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22668 return;
22669 if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
22670 return;
22671 break;
22673 case TYPE_DECL:
22674 /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs. */
22675 if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
22676 return;
22678 /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
22679 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling. */
22680 if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
22681 return;
22683 /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types. */
22684 if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
22685 return;
22687 /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
22688 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope. */
22689 if (decl_function_context (decl))
22690 context_die = NULL;
22692 break;
22694 default:
22695 return;
22698 gen_decl_die (decl, NULL, context_die);
22701 /* Write the debugging output for DECL. */
22703 static void
22704 dwarf2out_function_decl (tree decl)
22706 dwarf2out_decl (decl);
22707 call_arg_locations = NULL;
22708 call_arg_loc_last = NULL;
22709 call_site_count = -1;
22710 tail_call_site_count = -1;
22711 VEC_free (dw_die_ref, heap, block_map);
22712 htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
22713 htab_empty (cached_dw_loc_list_table);
22716 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
22717 a lexical block. */
22719 static void
22720 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
22721 unsigned int blocknum)
22723 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
22724 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
22727 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
22728 lexical block. */
22730 static void
22731 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
22733 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
22734 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
22737 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
22738 information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
22740 Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
22741 as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
22742 we may end up calling them anyway. */
22744 static bool
22745 dwarf2out_ignore_block (const_tree block)
22747 tree decl;
22748 unsigned int i;
22750 for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = DECL_CHAIN (decl))
22751 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
22752 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
22753 return 0;
22754 for (i = 0; i < BLOCK_NUM_NONLOCALIZED_VARS (block); i++)
22756 decl = BLOCK_NONLOCALIZED_VAR (block, i);
22757 if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
22758 || (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
22759 return 0;
22762 return 1;
22765 /* Hash table routines for file_hash. */
22767 static int
22768 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
22770 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p1 =
22771 (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p1_p;
22772 const char *const p2 = (const char *) p2_p;
22773 return filename_cmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
22776 static hashval_t
22777 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
22779 const struct dwarf_file_data *const p = (const struct dwarf_file_data *) p_p;
22780 return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
22783 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
22784 dwarf2out.c) and return its "index". The index of each (known) filename is
22785 just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename. We
22786 need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
22787 section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
22788 and.debug_macinfo sections). If the filename given as an argument is not
22789 found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
22790 available unique index number. In order to speed up searches, we remember
22791 the index of the filename was looked up last. This handles the majority of
22792 all searches. */
22794 static struct dwarf_file_data *
22795 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
22797 void ** slot;
22798 struct dwarf_file_data * created;
22800 /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
22801 call matches this file name. If so, return the index. */
22802 if (file_table_last_lookup
22803 && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
22804 || filename_cmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
22805 return file_table_last_lookup;
22807 /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table. */
22808 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
22809 htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
22810 if (*slot)
22811 return (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
22813 created = ggc_alloc_dwarf_file_data ();
22814 created->filename = file_name;
22815 created->emitted_number = 0;
22816 *slot = created;
22817 return created;
22820 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
22821 internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
22822 a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet. The file table
22823 numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
22824 types, which may include filenames. */
22826 static int
22827 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
22829 if (! fd->emitted_number)
22831 if (last_emitted_file)
22832 fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
22833 else
22834 fd->emitted_number = 1;
22835 last_emitted_file = fd;
22837 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
22839 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
22840 output_quoted_string (asm_out_file,
22841 remap_debug_filename (fd->filename));
22842 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
22846 return fd->emitted_number;
22849 /* Schedule generation of a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIE.
22850 That generation should happen after function debug info has been
22851 generated. The value of the attribute is the constant value of ARG. */
22853 static void
22854 append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table (dw_die_ref die, tree arg)
22856 die_arg_entry entry;
22858 if (!die || !arg)
22859 return;
22861 if (!tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
22862 tmpl_value_parm_die_table
22863 = VEC_alloc (die_arg_entry, gc, 32);
22865 entry.die = die;
22866 entry.arg = arg;
22867 VEC_safe_push (die_arg_entry, gc,
22868 tmpl_value_parm_die_table,
22869 &entry);
22872 /* Return TRUE if T is an instance of generic type, FALSE
22873 otherwise. */
22875 static bool
22876 generic_type_p (tree t)
22878 if (t == NULL_TREE || !TYPE_P (t))
22879 return false;
22880 return lang_hooks.get_innermost_generic_parms (t) != NULL_TREE;
22883 /* Schedule the generation of the generic parameter dies for the
22884 instance of generic type T. The proper generation itself is later
22885 done by gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies. */
22887 static void
22888 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen (tree t)
22890 if (!generic_type_p (t))
22891 return;
22893 if (generic_type_instances == NULL)
22894 generic_type_instances = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
22896 VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, generic_type_instances, t);
22899 /* Add a DW_AT_const_value attribute to DIEs that were scheduled
22900 by append_entry_to_tmpl_value_parm_die_table. This function must
22901 be called after function DIEs have been generated. */
22903 static void
22904 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute (void)
22906 if (tmpl_value_parm_die_table)
22908 unsigned i;
22909 die_arg_entry *e;
22911 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (die_arg_entry, tmpl_value_parm_die_table, i, e)
22912 tree_add_const_value_attribute (e->die, e->arg);
22916 /* Generate generic parameters DIEs for instances of generic types
22917 that have been previously scheduled by
22918 schedule_generic_params_dies_gen. This function must be called
22919 after all the types of the CU have been laid out. */
22921 static void
22922 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies (void)
22924 unsigned i;
22925 tree t;
22927 if (generic_type_instances == NULL)
22928 return;
22930 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (tree, generic_type_instances, i, t)
22931 gen_generic_params_dies (t);
22935 /* Replace DW_AT_name for the decl with name. */
22937 static void
22938 dwarf2out_set_name (tree decl, tree name)
22940 dw_die_ref die;
22941 dw_attr_ref attr;
22942 const char *dname;
22944 die = TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (decl);
22945 if (!die)
22946 return;
22948 dname = dwarf2_name (name, 0);
22949 if (!dname)
22950 return;
22952 attr = get_AT (die, DW_AT_name);
22953 if (attr)
22955 struct indirect_string_node *node;
22957 node = find_AT_string (dname);
22958 /* replace the string. */
22959 attr->dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
22962 else
22963 add_name_attribute (die, dname);
22966 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location. We
22967 use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
22968 our lookup table. */
22970 static void
22971 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
22973 char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES + 2];
22974 struct var_loc_node *newloc;
22975 rtx next_real;
22976 static const char *last_label;
22977 static const char *last_postcall_label;
22978 static bool last_in_cold_section_p;
22979 tree decl;
22980 bool var_loc_p;
22982 if (!NOTE_P (loc_note))
22984 if (CALL_P (loc_note))
22986 call_site_count++;
22987 if (SIBLING_CALL_P (loc_note))
22988 tail_call_site_count++;
22990 return;
22993 var_loc_p = NOTE_KIND (loc_note) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION;
22994 if (var_loc_p && !DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
22995 return;
22997 next_real = next_real_insn (loc_note);
22999 /* If there are no instructions which would be affected by this note,
23000 don't do anything. */
23001 if (var_loc_p
23002 && next_real == NULL_RTX
23003 && !NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
23004 return;
23006 if (next_real == NULL_RTX)
23007 next_real = get_last_insn ();
23009 /* If there were any real insns between note we processed last time
23010 and this note (or if it is the first note), clear
23011 last_{,postcall_}label so that they are not reused this time. */
23012 if (last_var_location_insn == NULL_RTX
23013 || last_var_location_insn != next_real
23014 || last_in_cold_section_p != in_cold_section_p)
23016 last_label = NULL;
23017 last_postcall_label = NULL;
23020 if (var_loc_p)
23022 decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
23023 newloc = add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, loc_note,
23024 NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note)
23025 ? last_postcall_label : last_label);
23026 if (newloc == NULL)
23027 return;
23029 else
23031 decl = NULL_TREE;
23032 newloc = NULL;
23035 /* If there were no real insns between note we processed last time
23036 and this note, use the label we emitted last time. Otherwise
23037 create a new label and emit it. */
23038 if (last_label == NULL)
23040 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
23041 ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
23042 loclabel_num++;
23043 last_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
23046 if (!var_loc_p)
23048 struct call_arg_loc_node *ca_loc
23049 = ggc_alloc_cleared_call_arg_loc_node ();
23050 rtx prev = prev_real_insn (loc_note), x;
23051 ca_loc->call_arg_loc_note = loc_note;
23052 ca_loc->next = NULL;
23053 ca_loc->label = last_label;
23054 gcc_assert (prev
23055 && (CALL_P (prev)
23056 || (NONJUMP_INSN_P (prev)
23057 && GET_CODE (PATTERN (prev)) == SEQUENCE
23058 && CALL_P (XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0)))));
23059 if (!CALL_P (prev))
23060 prev = XVECEXP (PATTERN (prev), 0, 0);
23061 ca_loc->tail_call_p = SIBLING_CALL_P (prev);
23062 x = PATTERN (prev);
23063 if (GET_CODE (x) == PARALLEL)
23064 x = XVECEXP (x, 0, 0);
23065 if (GET_CODE (x) == SET)
23066 x = SET_SRC (x);
23067 if (GET_CODE (x) == CALL && MEM_P (XEXP (x, 0)))
23069 x = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0);
23070 if (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF
23071 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)
23072 && TREE_CODE (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (x)) == FUNCTION_DECL)
23073 ca_loc->symbol_ref = x;
23075 ca_loc->block = insn_scope (prev);
23076 if (call_arg_locations)
23077 call_arg_loc_last->next = ca_loc;
23078 else
23079 call_arg_locations = ca_loc;
23080 call_arg_loc_last = ca_loc;
23082 else if (!NOTE_DURING_CALL_P (loc_note))
23083 newloc->label = last_label;
23084 else
23086 if (!last_postcall_label)
23088 sprintf (loclabel, "%s-1", last_label);
23089 last_postcall_label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
23091 newloc->label = last_postcall_label;
23094 last_var_location_insn = next_real;
23095 last_in_cold_section_p = in_cold_section_p;
23098 /* Note in one location list that text section has changed. */
23100 static int
23101 var_location_switch_text_section_1 (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
23103 var_loc_list *list = (var_loc_list *) *slot;
23104 if (list->first)
23105 list->last_before_switch
23106 = list->last->next ? list->last->next : list->last;
23107 return 1;
23110 /* Note in all location lists that text section has changed. */
23112 static void
23113 var_location_switch_text_section (void)
23115 if (decl_loc_table == NULL)
23116 return;
23118 htab_traverse (decl_loc_table, var_location_switch_text_section_1, NULL);
23121 /* Create a new line number table. */
23123 static dw_line_info_table *
23124 new_line_info_table (void)
23126 dw_line_info_table *table;
23128 table = ggc_alloc_cleared_dw_line_info_table_struct ();
23129 table->file_num = 1;
23130 table->line_num = 1;
23131 table->is_stmt = DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START;
23133 return table;
23136 /* Lookup the "current" table into which we emit line info, so
23137 that we don't have to do it for every source line. */
23139 static void
23140 set_cur_line_info_table (section *sec)
23142 dw_line_info_table *table;
23144 if (sec == text_section)
23145 table = text_section_line_info;
23146 else if (sec == cold_text_section)
23148 table = cold_text_section_line_info;
23149 if (!table)
23151 cold_text_section_line_info = table = new_line_info_table ();
23152 table->end_label = cold_end_label;
23155 else
23157 const char *end_label;
23159 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
23161 if (in_cold_section_p)
23162 end_label = crtl->subsections.cold_section_end_label;
23163 else
23164 end_label = crtl->subsections.hot_section_end_label;
23166 else
23168 char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
23169 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
23170 current_function_funcdef_no);
23171 end_label = ggc_strdup (label);
23174 table = new_line_info_table ();
23175 table->end_label = end_label;
23177 VEC_safe_push (dw_line_info_table_p, gc, separate_line_info, table);
23180 cur_line_info_table = table;
23184 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
23185 function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
23186 declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
23187 that hook is called. Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here. */
23189 static void
23190 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
23192 section *sec = function_section (fun);
23194 if (sec != text_section)
23195 have_multiple_function_sections = true;
23197 if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition && !cold_text_section)
23199 gcc_assert (current_function_decl == fun);
23200 cold_text_section = unlikely_text_section ();
23201 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
23202 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
23203 switch_to_section (sec);
23206 dwarf2out_note_section_used ();
23207 call_site_count = 0;
23208 tail_call_site_count = 0;
23210 set_cur_line_info_table (sec);
23213 /* Add OPCODE+VAL as an entry at the end of the opcode array in TABLE. */
23215 static void
23216 push_dw_line_info_entry (dw_line_info_table *table,
23217 enum dw_line_info_opcode opcode, unsigned int val)
23219 dw_line_info_entry e;
23220 e.opcode = opcode;
23221 e.val = val;
23222 VEC_safe_push (dw_line_info_entry, gc, table->entries, &e);
23225 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
23226 and record information relating to this source line, in
23227 'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section. */
23228 /* ??? The discriminator parameter ought to be unsigned. */
23230 static void
23231 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename,
23232 int discriminator, bool is_stmt)
23234 unsigned int file_num;
23235 dw_line_info_table *table;
23237 if (debug_info_level < DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL || line == 0)
23238 return;
23240 /* The discriminator column was added in dwarf4. Simplify the below
23241 by simply removing it if we're not supposed to output it. */
23242 if (dwarf_version < 4 && dwarf_strict)
23243 discriminator = 0;
23245 table = cur_line_info_table;
23246 file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
23248 /* ??? TODO: Elide duplicate line number entries. Traditionally,
23249 the debugger has used the second (possibly duplicate) line number
23250 at the beginning of the function to mark the end of the prologue.
23251 We could eliminate any other duplicates within the function. For
23252 Dwarf3, we ought to include the DW_LNS_set_prologue_end mark in
23253 that second line number entry. */
23254 /* Recall that this end-of-prologue indication is *not* the same thing
23255 as the end_prologue debug hook. The NOTE_INSN_PROLOGUE_END note,
23256 to which the hook corresponds, follows the last insn that was
23257 emitted by gen_prologue. What we need is to preceed the first insn
23258 that had been emitted after NOTE_INSN_FUNCTION_BEG, i.e. the first
23259 insn that corresponds to something the user wrote. These may be
23260 very different locations once scheduling is enabled. */
23262 if (0 && file_num == table->file_num
23263 && line == table->line_num
23264 && discriminator == table->discrim_num
23265 && is_stmt == table->is_stmt)
23266 return;
23268 switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
23270 /* If requested, emit something human-readable. */
23271 if (flag_debug_asm)
23272 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START, filename, line);
23274 if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
23276 /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as. */
23277 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0", file_num, line);
23278 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
23279 fprintf (asm_out_file, " is_stmt %d", is_stmt ? 1 : 0);
23280 if (SUPPORTS_DISCRIMINATOR && discriminator != 0)
23281 fprintf (asm_out_file, " discriminator %d", discriminator);
23282 fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
23284 else
23286 unsigned int label_num = ++line_info_label_num;
23288 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL, label_num);
23290 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_address, label_num);
23291 if (file_num != table->file_num)
23292 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_file, file_num);
23293 if (discriminator != table->discrim_num)
23294 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_discriminator, discriminator);
23295 if (is_stmt != table->is_stmt)
23296 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_negate_stmt, 0);
23297 push_dw_line_info_entry (table, LI_set_line, line);
23300 table->file_num = file_num;
23301 table->line_num = line;
23302 table->discrim_num = discriminator;
23303 table->is_stmt = is_stmt;
23304 table->in_use = true;
23307 /* Record the beginning of a new source file. */
23309 static void
23310 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
23312 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && ! use_debug_types)
23314 /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes. */
23315 dw_die_ref bincl_die;
23317 bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
23318 add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, remap_debug_filename (filename));
23321 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
23323 macinfo_entry e;
23324 e.code = DW_MACINFO_start_file;
23325 e.lineno = lineno;
23326 e.info = xstrdup (filename);
23327 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
23331 /* Record the end of a source file. */
23333 static void
23334 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
23336 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && ! use_debug_types)
23337 /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes. */
23338 new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die (), NULL);
23340 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
23342 macinfo_entry e;
23343 e.code = DW_MACINFO_end_file;
23344 e.lineno = lineno;
23345 e.info = NULL;
23346 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
23350 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
23351 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
23352 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
23354 static void
23355 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
23356 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
23358 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
23360 macinfo_entry e;
23361 e.code = DW_MACINFO_define;
23362 e.lineno = lineno;
23363 e.info = xstrdup (buffer);;
23364 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
23368 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c. The `buffer' parameter contains
23369 the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
23370 initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part. */
23372 static void
23373 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
23374 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
23376 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
23378 macinfo_entry e;
23379 e.code = DW_MACINFO_undef;
23380 e.lineno = lineno;
23381 e.info = xstrdup (buffer);;
23382 VEC_safe_push (macinfo_entry, gc, macinfo_table, &e);
23386 static void
23387 output_macinfo (void)
23389 unsigned i;
23390 unsigned long length = VEC_length (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table);
23391 macinfo_entry *ref;
23393 if (! length)
23394 return;
23396 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table, i, ref); i++)
23398 switch (ref->code)
23400 case DW_MACINFO_start_file:
23402 int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (ref->info));
23403 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
23404 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128
23405 (ref->lineno, "Included from line number %lu",
23406 (unsigned long)ref->lineno);
23407 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", ref->info);
23409 break;
23410 case DW_MACINFO_end_file:
23411 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
23412 break;
23413 case DW_MACINFO_define:
23414 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
23415 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
23416 (unsigned long)ref->lineno);
23417 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
23418 break;
23419 case DW_MACINFO_undef:
23420 dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
23421 dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (ref->lineno, "At line number %lu",
23422 (unsigned long)ref->lineno);
23423 dw2_asm_output_nstring (ref->info, -1, "The macro");
23424 break;
23425 default:
23426 fprintf (asm_out_file, "%s unrecognized macinfo code %lu\n",
23427 ASM_COMMENT_START, (unsigned long)ref->code);
23428 break;
23433 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation. */
23435 static void
23436 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
23438 /* Allocate the file_table. */
23439 file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
23440 file_table_eq, NULL);
23442 /* Allocate the decl_die_table. */
23443 decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
23444 decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
23446 /* Allocate the decl_loc_table. */
23447 decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
23448 decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
23450 /* Allocate the cached_dw_loc_list_table. */
23451 cached_dw_loc_list_table
23452 = htab_create_ggc (10, cached_dw_loc_list_table_hash,
23453 cached_dw_loc_list_table_eq, NULL);
23455 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table. */
23456 decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
23458 /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table. */
23459 abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared_vec_dw_die_ref
23460 (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT);
23461 abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
23462 /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused. */
23463 abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
23465 /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors. */
23466 pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
23467 pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
23469 incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
23471 used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
23473 debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
23474 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23475 debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
23476 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23477 debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
23478 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23479 debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
23480 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23481 debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
23482 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23483 debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
23484 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23485 debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
23486 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23487 debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
23488 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23489 debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
23490 DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
23491 debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
23492 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23493 debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
23494 SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
23496 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
23497 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
23498 DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
23499 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
23500 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
23501 COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
23502 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
23504 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
23505 DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
23506 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
23507 DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
23508 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
23509 DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
23510 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
23511 DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
23513 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
23514 macinfo_table = VEC_alloc (macinfo_entry, gc, 64);
23516 switch_to_section (text_section);
23517 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
23519 /* Make sure the line number table for .text always exists. */
23520 text_section_line_info = new_line_info_table ();
23521 text_section_line_info->end_label = text_end_label;
23524 /* Called before cgraph_optimize starts outputtting functions, variables
23525 and toplevel asms into assembly. */
23527 static void
23528 dwarf2out_assembly_start (void)
23530 if (HAVE_GAS_CFI_SECTIONS_DIRECTIVE
23531 && dwarf2out_do_cfi_asm ()
23532 && (!(flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions)
23533 || targetm.except_unwind_info (&global_options) != UI_DWARF2))
23534 fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.cfi_sections\t.debug_frame\n");
23537 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
23538 htab_traverse. Emit one queued .debug_str string. */
23540 static int
23541 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
23543 struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
23545 if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
23547 switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
23548 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
23549 assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
23552 return 1;
23555 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
23556 /* Verify that all marks are clear. */
23558 static void
23559 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
23561 dw_die_ref c;
23563 gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
23564 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
23566 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
23568 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
23569 Be cool if the mark isn't set. */
23571 static void
23572 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
23574 dw_die_ref c;
23576 if (die->die_mark)
23577 die->die_mark = 0;
23578 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
23581 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
23582 it references as attributes and mark them as used. */
23584 static void
23585 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
23587 dw_attr_ref a;
23588 unsigned ix;
23590 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
23592 if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
23594 /* A reference to another DIE.
23595 Make sure that it will get emitted.
23596 If it was broken out into a comdat group, don't follow it. */
23597 if (! use_debug_types
23598 || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
23599 || a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die->die_id.die_type_node == NULL)
23600 prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
23602 /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
23603 accounts properly for it. */
23604 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
23605 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
23609 /* Mark the generic parameters and arguments children DIEs of DIE. */
23611 static void
23612 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (dw_die_ref die)
23614 dw_die_ref c;
23616 if (die == NULL || die->die_child == NULL)
23617 return;
23618 c = die->die_child;
23621 switch (c->die_tag)
23623 case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
23624 case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
23625 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_template_param:
23626 case DW_TAG_GNU_template_parameter_pack:
23627 prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1);
23628 break;
23629 default:
23630 break;
23632 c = c->die_sib;
23633 } while (c && c != die->die_child);
23636 /* Mark DIE as being used. If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
23637 to DIE's children. */
23639 static void
23640 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
23642 dw_die_ref c;
23644 if (die->die_mark == 0)
23646 /* We haven't done this node yet. Mark it as used. */
23647 die->die_mark = 1;
23648 /* If this is the DIE of a generic type instantiation,
23649 mark the children DIEs that describe its generic parms and
23650 args. */
23651 prune_unused_types_mark_generic_parms_dies (die);
23653 /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
23654 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.) */
23655 if (die->die_parent)
23656 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
23658 /* Mark any referenced nodes. */
23659 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
23661 /* If this node is a specification,
23662 also mark the definition, if it exists. */
23663 if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
23664 prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
23667 if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
23669 /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
23670 Remember that we've walked the kids. */
23671 die->die_mark = 2;
23673 /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
23674 kids get marked, even if they're types. If we're
23675 breaking out types into comdat sections, do this
23676 for all type definitions. */
23677 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type
23678 || (use_debug_types
23679 && is_type_die (die) && ! is_declaration_die (die)))
23680 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
23681 else
23682 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
23686 /* For local classes, look if any static member functions were emitted
23687 and if so, mark them. */
23689 static void
23690 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (dw_die_ref die)
23692 dw_die_ref c;
23694 if (die->die_mark == 2)
23695 return;
23697 switch (die->die_tag)
23699 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
23700 case DW_TAG_union_type:
23701 case DW_TAG_class_type:
23702 break;
23704 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
23705 if (!get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration)
23706 || die->die_definition != NULL)
23707 prune_unused_types_mark (die, 1);
23708 return;
23710 default:
23711 return;
23714 /* Mark children. */
23715 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (c));
23718 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use. */
23720 static void
23721 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
23723 dw_die_ref c;
23725 /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked and
23726 children have been marked as well. */
23727 if (die->die_mark == 2)
23728 return;
23730 switch (die->die_tag)
23732 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
23733 case DW_TAG_union_type:
23734 case DW_TAG_class_type:
23735 if (die->die_perennial_p)
23736 break;
23738 for (c = die->die_parent; c; c = c->die_parent)
23739 if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
23740 break;
23742 /* Finding used static member functions inside of classes
23743 is needed just for local classes, because for other classes
23744 static member function DIEs with DW_AT_specification
23745 are emitted outside of the DW_TAG_*_type. If we ever change
23746 it, we'd need to call this even for non-local classes. */
23747 if (c)
23748 prune_unused_types_walk_local_classes (die);
23750 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
23751 return;
23753 case DW_TAG_const_type:
23754 case DW_TAG_packed_type:
23755 case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
23756 case DW_TAG_reference_type:
23757 case DW_TAG_rvalue_reference_type:
23758 case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
23759 case DW_TAG_typedef:
23760 case DW_TAG_array_type:
23761 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
23762 case DW_TAG_friend:
23763 case DW_TAG_variant_part:
23764 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
23765 case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
23766 case DW_TAG_string_type:
23767 case DW_TAG_set_type:
23768 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
23769 case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
23770 case DW_TAG_file_type:
23771 if (die->die_perennial_p)
23772 break;
23774 /* It's a type node --- don't mark it. */
23775 return;
23777 default:
23778 /* Mark everything else. */
23779 break;
23782 if (die->die_mark == 0)
23784 die->die_mark = 1;
23786 /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here. */
23787 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
23790 die->die_mark = 2;
23792 /* Mark children. */
23793 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
23796 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
23797 attributes. */
23799 static void
23800 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
23802 dw_attr_ref a;
23803 unsigned ix;
23805 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
23806 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
23808 struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
23809 s->refcount++;
23810 /* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
23811 twice in the hash table. */
23812 if (s->refcount
23813 == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
23815 void ** slot;
23816 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
23817 htab_hash_string (s->str),
23818 INSERT);
23819 gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
23820 *slot = s;
23825 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked. */
23827 static void
23828 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
23830 dw_die_ref c;
23832 gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
23833 prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
23835 if (! die->die_child)
23836 return;
23838 c = die->die_child;
23839 do {
23840 dw_die_ref prev = c;
23841 for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
23842 if (c == die->die_child)
23844 /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list. */
23845 if (prev == c)
23846 /* No marked children at all. */
23847 die->die_child = NULL;
23848 else
23850 prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
23851 die->die_child = prev;
23853 return;
23856 if (c != prev->die_sib)
23857 prev->die_sib = c;
23858 prune_unused_types_prune (c);
23859 } while (c != die->die_child);
23862 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use. */
23864 static void
23865 prune_unused_types (void)
23867 unsigned int i;
23868 limbo_die_node *node;
23869 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
23870 pubname_ref pub;
23871 dw_die_ref base_type;
23873 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
23874 /* All the marks should already be clear. */
23875 verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die ());
23876 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23877 verify_marks_clear (node->die);
23878 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23879 verify_marks_clear (ctnode->root_die);
23880 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
23882 /* Mark types that are used in global variables. */
23883 premark_types_used_by_global_vars ();
23885 /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used. */
23886 prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die ());
23887 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23888 prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
23889 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23891 prune_unused_types_walk (ctnode->root_die);
23892 prune_unused_types_mark (ctnode->type_die, 1);
23895 /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
23896 pubname_table. */
23897 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub)
23898 prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
23899 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_die_ref, base_types, i, base_type); i++)
23900 prune_unused_types_mark (base_type, 1);
23902 if (debug_str_hash)
23903 htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
23904 prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die ());
23905 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23906 prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
23907 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23908 prune_unused_types_prune (ctnode->root_die);
23910 /* Leave the marks clear. */
23911 prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die ());
23912 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
23913 prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
23914 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode; ctnode = ctnode->next)
23915 prune_unmark_dies (ctnode->root_die);
23918 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
23919 the file table. */
23920 static int
23921 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
23923 bool *p = (bool *) param;
23924 struct dwarf_file_data *d = (struct dwarf_file_data *) *slot;
23925 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (d->filename))
23927 *p = true;
23928 return 0;
23930 return 1;
23933 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of comdat type units. */
23935 static hashval_t
23936 htab_ct_hash (const void *of)
23938 hashval_t h;
23939 const comdat_type_node *const type_node = (const comdat_type_node *) of;
23941 memcpy (&h, type_node->signature, sizeof (h));
23942 return h;
23945 static int
23946 htab_ct_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
23948 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_1 = (const comdat_type_node *) of1;
23949 const comdat_type_node *const type_node_2 = (const comdat_type_node *) of2;
23951 return (! memcmp (type_node_1->signature, type_node_2->signature,
23952 DWARF_TYPE_SIGNATURE_SIZE));
23955 /* Move a DW_AT_{,MIPS_}linkage_name attribute just added to dw_die_ref
23956 to the location it would have been added, should we know its
23957 DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME when we added other attributes. This will
23958 probably improve compactness of debug info, removing equivalent
23959 abbrevs, and hide any differences caused by deferring the
23960 computation of the assembler name, triggered by e.g. PCH. */
23962 static inline void
23963 move_linkage_attr (dw_die_ref die)
23965 unsigned ix = VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
23966 dw_attr_node linkage = *VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
23968 gcc_assert (linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_linkage_name
23969 || linkage.dw_attr == DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name);
23971 while (--ix > 0)
23973 dw_attr_node *prev = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix - 1);
23975 if (prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_decl_line || prev->dw_attr == DW_AT_name)
23976 break;
23979 if (ix != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr) - 1)
23981 VEC_pop (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr);
23982 VEC_quick_insert (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, &linkage);
23986 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, mark DW_TAG_base_type nodes
23987 referenced from typed stack ops and count how often they are used. */
23989 static void
23990 mark_base_types (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
23992 dw_die_ref base_type = NULL;
23994 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
23996 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
23998 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
23999 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
24000 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
24001 break;
24002 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
24003 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
24004 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
24005 base_type = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
24006 break;
24007 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
24008 mark_base_types (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc);
24009 continue;
24010 default:
24011 continue;
24013 gcc_assert (base_type->die_parent == comp_unit_die ());
24014 if (base_type->die_mark)
24015 base_type->die_mark++;
24016 else
24018 VEC_safe_push (dw_die_ref, heap, base_types, base_type);
24019 base_type->die_mark = 1;
24024 /* Comparison function for sorting marked base types. */
24026 static int
24027 base_type_cmp (const void *x, const void *y)
24029 dw_die_ref dx = *(const dw_die_ref *) x;
24030 dw_die_ref dy = *(const dw_die_ref *) y;
24031 unsigned int byte_size1, byte_size2;
24032 unsigned int encoding1, encoding2;
24033 if (dx->die_mark > dy->die_mark)
24034 return -1;
24035 if (dx->die_mark < dy->die_mark)
24036 return 1;
24037 byte_size1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_byte_size);
24038 byte_size2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_byte_size);
24039 if (byte_size1 < byte_size2)
24040 return 1;
24041 if (byte_size1 > byte_size2)
24042 return -1;
24043 encoding1 = get_AT_unsigned (dx, DW_AT_encoding);
24044 encoding2 = get_AT_unsigned (dy, DW_AT_encoding);
24045 if (encoding1 < encoding2)
24046 return 1;
24047 if (encoding1 > encoding2)
24048 return -1;
24049 return 0;
24052 /* Move base types marked by mark_base_types as early as possible
24053 in the CU, sorted by decreasing usage count both to make the
24054 uleb128 references as small as possible and to make sure they
24055 will have die_offset already computed by calc_die_sizes when
24056 sizes of typed stack loc ops is computed. */
24058 static void
24059 move_marked_base_types (void)
24061 unsigned int i;
24062 dw_die_ref base_type, die, c;
24064 if (VEC_empty (dw_die_ref, base_types))
24065 return;
24067 /* Sort by decreasing usage count, they will be added again in that
24068 order later on. */
24069 VEC_qsort (dw_die_ref, base_types, base_type_cmp);
24070 die = comp_unit_die ();
24071 c = die->die_child;
24074 dw_die_ref prev = c;
24075 c = c->die_sib;
24076 while (c->die_mark)
24078 remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
24079 /* As base types got marked, there must be at least
24080 one node other than DW_TAG_base_type. */
24081 gcc_assert (c != c->die_sib);
24082 c = c->die_sib;
24085 while (c != die->die_child);
24086 gcc_assert (die->die_child);
24087 c = die->die_child;
24088 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_die_ref, base_types, i, base_type); i++)
24090 base_type->die_mark = 0;
24091 base_type->die_sib = c->die_sib;
24092 c->die_sib = base_type;
24093 c = base_type;
24097 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, attempt to resolve
24098 one CONST_STRING, return non-zero if not successful. Similarly verify that
24099 SYMBOL_REFs refer to variables emitted in the current CU. */
24101 static int
24102 resolve_one_addr (rtx *addr, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
24104 rtx rtl = *addr;
24106 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
24108 size_t len = strlen (XSTR (rtl, 0)) + 1;
24109 tree t = build_string (len, XSTR (rtl, 0));
24110 tree tlen = size_int (len - 1);
24111 TREE_TYPE (t)
24112 = build_array_type (char_type_node, build_index_type (tlen));
24113 rtl = lookup_constant_def (t);
24114 if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
24115 return 1;
24116 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
24117 VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
24118 *addr = rtl;
24119 return 0;
24122 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF
24123 && SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))
24125 if (TREE_CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
24127 if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (DECL_INITIAL (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl))))
24128 return 1;
24130 else if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (SYMBOL_REF_DECL (rtl)))
24131 return 1;
24134 if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST
24135 && for_each_rtx (&XEXP (rtl, 0), resolve_one_addr, NULL))
24136 return 1;
24138 return 0;
24141 /* Helper function for resolve_addr, handle one location
24142 expression, return false if at least one CONST_STRING or SYMBOL_REF in
24143 the location list couldn't be resolved. */
24145 static bool
24146 resolve_addr_in_expr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
24148 dw_loc_descr_ref keep = NULL;
24149 for (; loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
24150 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
24152 case DW_OP_addr:
24153 if (resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
24154 return false;
24155 break;
24156 case DW_OP_const4u:
24157 case DW_OP_const8u:
24158 if (loc->dtprel
24159 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, NULL))
24160 return false;
24161 break;
24162 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
24163 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class == dw_val_class_addr
24164 && resolve_one_addr (&loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_addr, NULL))
24165 return false;
24166 break;
24167 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
24168 if (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class == dw_val_class_decl_ref)
24170 dw_die_ref ref
24171 = lookup_decl_die (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_decl_ref);
24172 if (ref == NULL)
24173 return false;
24174 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
24175 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = ref;
24176 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
24178 break;
24179 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
24180 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
24181 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
24182 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
24183 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
24184 while (loc->dw_loc_next
24185 && loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_convert)
24187 dw_die_ref base1, base2;
24188 unsigned enc1, enc2, size1, size2;
24189 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
24190 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
24191 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die;
24192 else
24193 base1 = loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
24194 base2 = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die;
24195 gcc_assert (base1->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type
24196 && base2->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type);
24197 enc1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_encoding);
24198 enc2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_encoding);
24199 size1 = get_AT_unsigned (base1, DW_AT_byte_size);
24200 size2 = get_AT_unsigned (base2, DW_AT_byte_size);
24201 if (size1 == size2
24202 && (((enc1 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc1 == DW_ATE_signed)
24203 && (enc2 == DW_ATE_unsigned || enc2 == DW_ATE_signed)
24204 && loc != keep)
24205 || enc1 == enc2))
24207 /* Optimize away next DW_OP_GNU_convert after
24208 adjusting LOC's base type die reference. */
24209 if (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_regval_type
24210 || loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_GNU_deref_type)
24211 loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
24212 else
24213 loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_die_ref.die = base2;
24214 loc->dw_loc_next = loc->dw_loc_next->dw_loc_next;
24215 continue;
24217 /* Don't change integer DW_OP_GNU_convert after e.g. floating
24218 point typed stack entry. */
24219 else if (enc1 != DW_ATE_unsigned && enc1 != DW_ATE_signed)
24220 keep = loc;
24221 break;
24223 break;
24224 default:
24225 break;
24227 return true;
24230 /* Resolve DW_OP_addr and DW_AT_const_value CONST_STRING arguments to
24231 an address in .rodata section if the string literal is emitted there,
24232 or remove the containing location list or replace DW_AT_const_value
24233 with DW_AT_location and empty location expression, if it isn't found
24234 in .rodata. Similarly for SYMBOL_REFs, keep only those that refer
24235 to something that has been emitted in the current CU. */
24237 static void
24238 resolve_addr (dw_die_ref die)
24240 dw_die_ref c;
24241 dw_attr_ref a;
24242 dw_loc_list_ref *curr, *start, loc;
24243 unsigned ix;
24245 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
24246 switch (AT_class (a))
24248 case dw_val_class_loc_list:
24249 start = curr = AT_loc_list_ptr (a);
24250 loc = *curr;
24251 gcc_assert (loc);
24252 /* The same list can be referenced more than once. See if we have
24253 already recorded the result from a previous pass. */
24254 if (loc->replaced)
24255 *curr = loc->dw_loc_next;
24256 else if (!loc->resolved_addr)
24258 /* As things stand, we do not expect or allow one die to
24259 reference a suffix of another die's location list chain.
24260 References must be identical or completely separate.
24261 There is therefore no need to cache the result of this
24262 pass on any list other than the first; doing so
24263 would lead to unnecessary writes. */
24264 while (*curr)
24266 gcc_assert (!(*curr)->replaced && !(*curr)->resolved_addr);
24267 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr ((*curr)->expr))
24269 dw_loc_list_ref next = (*curr)->dw_loc_next;
24270 if (next && (*curr)->ll_symbol)
24272 gcc_assert (!next->ll_symbol);
24273 next->ll_symbol = (*curr)->ll_symbol;
24275 *curr = next;
24277 else
24279 mark_base_types ((*curr)->expr);
24280 curr = &(*curr)->dw_loc_next;
24283 if (loc == *start)
24284 loc->resolved_addr = 1;
24285 else
24287 loc->replaced = 1;
24288 loc->dw_loc_next = *start;
24291 if (!*start)
24293 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
24294 ix--;
24296 break;
24297 case dw_val_class_loc:
24298 if (!resolve_addr_in_expr (AT_loc (a)))
24300 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
24301 ix--;
24303 else
24304 mark_base_types (AT_loc (a));
24305 break;
24306 case dw_val_class_addr:
24307 if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_const_value
24308 && resolve_one_addr (&a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr, NULL))
24310 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
24311 ix--;
24313 if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_call_site
24314 && a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
24316 tree tdecl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr);
24317 dw_die_ref tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
24318 if (tdie == NULL
24319 && DECL_EXTERNAL (tdecl)
24320 && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (tdecl) == NULL_TREE)
24322 force_decl_die (tdecl);
24323 tdie = lookup_decl_die (tdecl);
24325 if (tdie)
24327 a->dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
24328 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = tdie;
24329 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
24331 else
24333 remove_AT (die, a->dw_attr);
24334 ix--;
24337 break;
24338 default:
24339 break;
24342 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, resolve_addr (c));
24345 /* Helper routines for optimize_location_lists.
24346 This pass tries to share identical local lists in .debug_loc
24347 section. */
24349 /* Iteratively hash operands of LOC opcode. */
24351 static inline hashval_t
24352 hash_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, hashval_t hash)
24354 dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
24355 dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
24357 switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
24359 case DW_OP_const4u:
24360 case DW_OP_const8u:
24361 if (loc->dtprel)
24362 goto hash_addr;
24363 /* FALLTHRU */
24364 case DW_OP_const1u:
24365 case DW_OP_const1s:
24366 case DW_OP_const2u:
24367 case DW_OP_const2s:
24368 case DW_OP_const4s:
24369 case DW_OP_const8s:
24370 case DW_OP_constu:
24371 case DW_OP_consts:
24372 case DW_OP_pick:
24373 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
24374 case DW_OP_breg0:
24375 case DW_OP_breg1:
24376 case DW_OP_breg2:
24377 case DW_OP_breg3:
24378 case DW_OP_breg4:
24379 case DW_OP_breg5:
24380 case DW_OP_breg6:
24381 case DW_OP_breg7:
24382 case DW_OP_breg8:
24383 case DW_OP_breg9:
24384 case DW_OP_breg10:
24385 case DW_OP_breg11:
24386 case DW_OP_breg12:
24387 case DW_OP_breg13:
24388 case DW_OP_breg14:
24389 case DW_OP_breg15:
24390 case DW_OP_breg16:
24391 case DW_OP_breg17:
24392 case DW_OP_breg18:
24393 case DW_OP_breg19:
24394 case DW_OP_breg20:
24395 case DW_OP_breg21:
24396 case DW_OP_breg22:
24397 case DW_OP_breg23:
24398 case DW_OP_breg24:
24399 case DW_OP_breg25:
24400 case DW_OP_breg26:
24401 case DW_OP_breg27:
24402 case DW_OP_breg28:
24403 case DW_OP_breg29:
24404 case DW_OP_breg30:
24405 case DW_OP_breg31:
24406 case DW_OP_regx:
24407 case DW_OP_fbreg:
24408 case DW_OP_piece:
24409 case DW_OP_deref_size:
24410 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
24411 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_int, hash);
24412 break;
24413 case DW_OP_skip:
24414 case DW_OP_bra:
24416 int offset;
24418 gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
24419 offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
24420 hash = iterative_hash_object (offset, hash);
24422 break;
24423 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
24424 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_unsigned, hash);
24425 switch (val2->val_class)
24427 case dw_val_class_const:
24428 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
24429 break;
24430 case dw_val_class_vec:
24432 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
24433 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
24435 hash = iterative_hash_object (elt_size, hash);
24436 hash = iterative_hash_object (len, hash);
24437 hash = iterative_hash (val2->v.val_vec.array,
24438 len * elt_size, hash);
24440 break;
24441 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24442 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.low, hash);
24443 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.high, hash);
24444 break;
24445 case dw_val_class_addr:
24446 hash = iterative_hash_rtx (val2->v.val_addr, hash);
24447 break;
24448 default:
24449 gcc_unreachable ();
24451 break;
24452 case DW_OP_bregx:
24453 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
24454 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_int, hash);
24455 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
24456 break;
24457 case DW_OP_addr:
24458 hash_addr:
24459 if (loc->dtprel)
24461 unsigned char dtprel = 0xd1;
24462 hash = iterative_hash_object (dtprel, hash);
24464 hash = iterative_hash_rtx (val1->v.val_addr, hash);
24465 break;
24466 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
24467 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
24468 break;
24469 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
24470 hash = hash_loc_operands (val1->v.val_loc, hash);
24471 break;
24472 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
24473 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
24475 unsigned int byte_size
24476 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
24477 unsigned int encoding
24478 = get_AT_unsigned (val2->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
24479 hash = iterative_hash_object (val1->v.val_int, hash);
24480 hash = iterative_hash_object (byte_size, hash);
24481 hash = iterative_hash_object (encoding, hash);
24483 break;
24484 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
24485 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
24486 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
24488 unsigned int byte_size
24489 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_byte_size);
24490 unsigned int encoding
24491 = get_AT_unsigned (val1->v.val_die_ref.die, DW_AT_encoding);
24492 hash = iterative_hash_object (byte_size, hash);
24493 hash = iterative_hash_object (encoding, hash);
24494 if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_GNU_const_type)
24495 break;
24496 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->val_class, hash);
24497 switch (val2->val_class)
24499 case dw_val_class_const:
24500 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_int, hash);
24501 break;
24502 case dw_val_class_vec:
24504 unsigned int elt_size = val2->v.val_vec.elt_size;
24505 unsigned int len = val2->v.val_vec.length;
24507 hash = iterative_hash_object (elt_size, hash);
24508 hash = iterative_hash_object (len, hash);
24509 hash = iterative_hash (val2->v.val_vec.array,
24510 len * elt_size, hash);
24512 break;
24513 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24514 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.low, hash);
24515 hash = iterative_hash_object (val2->v.val_double.high, hash);
24516 break;
24517 default:
24518 gcc_unreachable ();
24521 break;
24523 default:
24524 /* Other codes have no operands. */
24525 break;
24527 return hash;
24530 /* Iteratively hash the whole DWARF location expression LOC. */
24532 static inline hashval_t
24533 hash_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, hashval_t hash)
24535 dw_loc_descr_ref l;
24536 bool sizes_computed = false;
24537 /* Compute sizes, so that DW_OP_skip/DW_OP_bra can be checksummed. */
24538 size_of_locs (loc);
24540 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
24542 enum dwarf_location_atom opc = l->dw_loc_opc;
24543 hash = iterative_hash_object (opc, hash);
24544 if ((opc == DW_OP_skip || opc == DW_OP_bra) && !sizes_computed)
24546 size_of_locs (loc);
24547 sizes_computed = true;
24549 hash = hash_loc_operands (l, hash);
24551 return hash;
24554 /* Compute hash of the whole location list LIST_HEAD. */
24556 static inline void
24557 hash_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
24559 dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
24560 hashval_t hash = 0;
24562 for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
24564 hash = iterative_hash (curr->begin, strlen (curr->begin) + 1, hash);
24565 hash = iterative_hash (curr->end, strlen (curr->end) + 1, hash);
24566 if (curr->section)
24567 hash = iterative_hash (curr->section, strlen (curr->section) + 1,
24568 hash);
24569 hash = hash_locs (curr->expr, hash);
24571 list_head->hash = hash;
24574 /* Return true if X and Y opcodes have the same operands. */
24576 static inline bool
24577 compare_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
24579 dw_val_ref valx1 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd1;
24580 dw_val_ref valx2 = &x->dw_loc_oprnd2;
24581 dw_val_ref valy1 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd1;
24582 dw_val_ref valy2 = &y->dw_loc_oprnd2;
24584 switch (x->dw_loc_opc)
24586 case DW_OP_const4u:
24587 case DW_OP_const8u:
24588 if (x->dtprel)
24589 goto hash_addr;
24590 /* FALLTHRU */
24591 case DW_OP_const1u:
24592 case DW_OP_const1s:
24593 case DW_OP_const2u:
24594 case DW_OP_const2s:
24595 case DW_OP_const4s:
24596 case DW_OP_const8s:
24597 case DW_OP_constu:
24598 case DW_OP_consts:
24599 case DW_OP_pick:
24600 case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
24601 case DW_OP_breg0:
24602 case DW_OP_breg1:
24603 case DW_OP_breg2:
24604 case DW_OP_breg3:
24605 case DW_OP_breg4:
24606 case DW_OP_breg5:
24607 case DW_OP_breg6:
24608 case DW_OP_breg7:
24609 case DW_OP_breg8:
24610 case DW_OP_breg9:
24611 case DW_OP_breg10:
24612 case DW_OP_breg11:
24613 case DW_OP_breg12:
24614 case DW_OP_breg13:
24615 case DW_OP_breg14:
24616 case DW_OP_breg15:
24617 case DW_OP_breg16:
24618 case DW_OP_breg17:
24619 case DW_OP_breg18:
24620 case DW_OP_breg19:
24621 case DW_OP_breg20:
24622 case DW_OP_breg21:
24623 case DW_OP_breg22:
24624 case DW_OP_breg23:
24625 case DW_OP_breg24:
24626 case DW_OP_breg25:
24627 case DW_OP_breg26:
24628 case DW_OP_breg27:
24629 case DW_OP_breg28:
24630 case DW_OP_breg29:
24631 case DW_OP_breg30:
24632 case DW_OP_breg31:
24633 case DW_OP_regx:
24634 case DW_OP_fbreg:
24635 case DW_OP_piece:
24636 case DW_OP_deref_size:
24637 case DW_OP_xderef_size:
24638 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int;
24639 case DW_OP_skip:
24640 case DW_OP_bra:
24641 gcc_assert (valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
24642 && valy1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc
24643 && x->dw_loc_addr == y->dw_loc_addr);
24644 return valx1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr == valy1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr;
24645 case DW_OP_implicit_value:
24646 if (valx1->v.val_unsigned != valy1->v.val_unsigned
24647 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
24648 return false;
24649 switch (valx2->val_class)
24651 case dw_val_class_const:
24652 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24653 case dw_val_class_vec:
24654 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24655 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
24656 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
24657 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24658 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
24659 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24660 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
24661 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
24662 case dw_val_class_addr:
24663 return rtx_equal_p (valx2->v.val_addr, valy2->v.val_addr);
24664 default:
24665 gcc_unreachable ();
24667 case DW_OP_bregx:
24668 case DW_OP_bit_piece:
24669 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
24670 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24671 case DW_OP_addr:
24672 hash_addr:
24673 return rtx_equal_p (valx1->v.val_addr, valy1->v.val_addr);
24674 case DW_OP_GNU_implicit_pointer:
24675 return valx1->val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref
24676 && valx1->val_class == valy1->val_class
24677 && valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
24678 && valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24679 case DW_OP_GNU_entry_value:
24680 return compare_loc_operands (valx1->v.val_loc, valy1->v.val_loc);
24681 case DW_OP_GNU_const_type:
24682 if (valx1->v.val_die_ref.die != valy1->v.val_die_ref.die
24683 || valx2->val_class != valy2->val_class)
24684 return false;
24685 switch (valx2->val_class)
24687 case dw_val_class_const:
24688 return valx2->v.val_int == valy2->v.val_int;
24689 case dw_val_class_vec:
24690 return valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size == valy2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24691 && valx2->v.val_vec.length == valy2->v.val_vec.length
24692 && memcmp (valx2->v.val_vec.array, valy2->v.val_vec.array,
24693 valx2->v.val_vec.elt_size
24694 * valx2->v.val_vec.length) == 0;
24695 case dw_val_class_const_double:
24696 return valx2->v.val_double.low == valy2->v.val_double.low
24697 && valx2->v.val_double.high == valy2->v.val_double.high;
24698 default:
24699 gcc_unreachable ();
24701 case DW_OP_GNU_regval_type:
24702 case DW_OP_GNU_deref_type:
24703 return valx1->v.val_int == valy1->v.val_int
24704 && valx2->v.val_die_ref.die == valy2->v.val_die_ref.die;
24705 case DW_OP_GNU_convert:
24706 case DW_OP_GNU_reinterpret:
24707 return valx1->v.val_die_ref.die == valy1->v.val_die_ref.die;
24708 default:
24709 /* Other codes have no operands. */
24710 return true;
24714 /* Return true if DWARF location expressions X and Y are the same. */
24716 static inline bool
24717 compare_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref x, dw_loc_descr_ref y)
24719 for (; x != NULL && y != NULL; x = x->dw_loc_next, y = y->dw_loc_next)
24720 if (x->dw_loc_opc != y->dw_loc_opc
24721 || x->dtprel != y->dtprel
24722 || !compare_loc_operands (x, y))
24723 break;
24724 return x == NULL && y == NULL;
24727 /* Return precomputed hash of location list X. */
24729 static hashval_t
24730 loc_list_hash (const void *x)
24732 return ((const struct dw_loc_list_struct *) x)->hash;
24735 /* Return 1 if location lists X and Y are the same. */
24737 static int
24738 loc_list_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
24740 const struct dw_loc_list_struct *a = (const struct dw_loc_list_struct *) x;
24741 const struct dw_loc_list_struct *b = (const struct dw_loc_list_struct *) y;
24742 if (a == b)
24743 return 1;
24744 if (a->hash != b->hash)
24745 return 0;
24746 for (; a != NULL && b != NULL; a = a->dw_loc_next, b = b->dw_loc_next)
24747 if (strcmp (a->begin, b->begin) != 0
24748 || strcmp (a->end, b->end) != 0
24749 || (a->section == NULL) != (b->section == NULL)
24750 || (a->section && strcmp (a->section, b->section) != 0)
24751 || !compare_locs (a->expr, b->expr))
24752 break;
24753 return a == NULL && b == NULL;
24756 /* Recursively optimize location lists referenced from DIE
24757 children and share them whenever possible. */
24759 static void
24760 optimize_location_lists_1 (dw_die_ref die, htab_t htab)
24762 dw_die_ref c;
24763 dw_attr_ref a;
24764 unsigned ix;
24765 void **slot;
24767 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a)
24768 if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
24770 dw_loc_list_ref list = AT_loc_list (a);
24771 /* TODO: perform some optimizations here, before hashing
24772 it and storing into the hash table. */
24773 hash_loc_list (list);
24774 slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (htab, list, list->hash,
24775 INSERT);
24776 if (*slot == NULL)
24777 *slot = (void *) list;
24778 else
24779 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = (dw_loc_list_ref) *slot;
24782 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, optimize_location_lists_1 (c, htab));
24785 /* Optimize location lists referenced from DIE
24786 children and share them whenever possible. */
24788 static void
24789 optimize_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
24791 htab_t htab = htab_create (500, loc_list_hash, loc_list_eq, NULL);
24792 optimize_location_lists_1 (die, htab);
24793 htab_delete (htab);
24796 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
24797 and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info. */
24799 static void
24800 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
24802 limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
24803 comdat_type_node *ctnode;
24804 htab_t comdat_type_table;
24805 unsigned int i;
24807 gen_scheduled_generic_parms_dies ();
24808 gen_remaining_tmpl_value_param_die_attribute ();
24810 /* Add the name for the main input file now. We delayed this from
24811 dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH. */
24812 add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die (), remap_debug_filename (filename));
24813 if (!IS_ABSOLUTE_PATH (filename))
24814 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
24815 else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
24817 bool p = false;
24818 htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
24819 if (p)
24820 add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die ());
24823 for (i = 0; i < VEC_length (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list); i++)
24825 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (
24826 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->die,
24827 VEC_index (deferred_locations, deferred_locations_list, i)->variable,
24828 false,
24829 DW_AT_location);
24832 /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links. The only
24833 dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
24834 inline functions, and the comp_unit_die. We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
24835 For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
24836 instance. */
24837 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
24839 dw_die_ref die = node->die;
24840 next_node = node->next;
24842 if (die->die_parent == NULL)
24844 dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
24846 if (origin)
24847 add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
24848 else if (is_cu_die (die))
24850 else if (seen_error ())
24851 /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input. */
24852 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
24853 else
24855 /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
24856 nested function can be optimized away, which results
24857 in the nested function die being orphaned. Likewise
24858 with the return type of that nested function. Force
24859 this to be a child of the containing function.
24861 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
24862 inlined and optimized out. In that case we are lost and
24863 assign the empty child. This should not be big issue as
24864 the function is likely unreachable too. */
24865 tree context = NULL_TREE;
24867 gcc_assert (node->created_for);
24869 if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
24870 context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
24871 else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
24872 context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
24874 gcc_assert (context
24875 && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
24876 || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
24878 origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
24879 if (origin)
24880 add_child_die (origin, die);
24881 else
24882 add_child_die (comp_unit_die (), die);
24887 limbo_die_list = NULL;
24889 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
24891 dw_die_ref die = comp_unit_die (), c;
24892 FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, gcc_assert (! c->die_mark));
24894 #endif
24895 resolve_addr (comp_unit_die ());
24896 move_marked_base_types ();
24898 for (node = deferred_asm_name; node; node = node->next)
24900 tree decl = node->created_for;
24901 if (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl))
24903 add_linkage_attr (node->die, decl);
24904 move_linkage_attr (node->die);
24908 deferred_asm_name = NULL;
24910 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
24911 emit full debugging info for them. */
24912 retry_incomplete_types ();
24914 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
24915 prune_unused_types ();
24917 /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
24918 They will go into limbo_die_list. */
24919 if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups && ! use_debug_types)
24920 break_out_includes (comp_unit_die ());
24922 /* Generate separate COMDAT sections for type DIEs. */
24923 if (use_debug_types)
24925 break_out_comdat_types (comp_unit_die ());
24927 /* Each new type_unit DIE was added to the limbo die list when created.
24928 Since these have all been added to comdat_type_list, clear the
24929 limbo die list. */
24930 limbo_die_list = NULL;
24932 /* For each new comdat type unit, copy declarations for incomplete
24933 types to make the new unit self-contained (i.e., no direct
24934 references to the main compile unit). */
24935 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
24936 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (ctnode->root_die);
24937 copy_decls_for_unworthy_types (comp_unit_die ());
24939 /* In the process of copying declarations from one unit to another,
24940 we may have left some declarations behind that are no longer
24941 referenced. Prune them. */
24942 prune_unused_types ();
24945 /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
24946 that have children. */
24947 add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die ());
24948 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
24949 add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
24950 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
24951 add_sibling_attributes (ctnode->root_die);
24953 /* Output a terminator label for the .text section. */
24954 switch_to_section (text_section);
24955 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
24956 if (cold_text_section)
24958 switch_to_section (cold_text_section);
24959 targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
24962 /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
24963 in .text. */
24964 if (!have_multiple_function_sections
24965 || (dwarf_version < 3 && dwarf_strict))
24967 /* Don't add if the CU has no associated code. */
24968 if (text_section_used)
24970 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
24971 add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
24974 else
24976 unsigned fde_idx = 0;
24977 bool range_list_added = false;
24979 if (text_section_used)
24980 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), text_section_label,
24981 text_end_label, &range_list_added);
24982 if (cold_text_section_used)
24983 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), cold_text_section_label,
24984 cold_end_label, &range_list_added);
24986 for (fde_idx = 0; fde_idx < fde_table_in_use; fde_idx++)
24988 dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_idx];
24990 if (!fde->in_std_section)
24991 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), fde->dw_fde_begin,
24992 fde->dw_fde_end, &range_list_added);
24993 if (fde->dw_fde_second_begin && !fde->second_in_std_section)
24994 add_ranges_by_labels (comp_unit_die (), fde->dw_fde_second_begin,
24995 fde->dw_fde_second_end, &range_list_added);
24998 if (range_list_added)
25000 /* We need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
25001 "base address". Use zero so that these addresses become
25002 absolute. Historically, we've emitted the unexpected
25003 DW_AT_entry_pc instead of DW_AT_low_pc for this purpose.
25004 Emit both to give time for other tools to adapt. */
25005 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_low_pc, const0_rtx);
25006 if (! dwarf_strict && dwarf_version < 4)
25007 add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
25009 add_ranges (NULL);
25013 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
25014 add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_stmt_list,
25015 debug_line_section_label);
25017 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
25018 add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die (), DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
25020 if (have_location_lists)
25021 optimize_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
25023 /* Output all of the compilation units. We put the main one last so that
25024 the offsets are available to output_pubnames. */
25025 for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
25026 output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
25028 comdat_type_table = htab_create (100, htab_ct_hash, htab_ct_eq, NULL);
25029 for (ctnode = comdat_type_list; ctnode != NULL; ctnode = ctnode->next)
25031 void **slot = htab_find_slot (comdat_type_table, ctnode, INSERT);
25033 /* Don't output duplicate types. */
25034 if (*slot != HTAB_EMPTY_ENTRY)
25035 continue;
25037 /* Add a pointer to the line table for the main compilation unit
25038 so that the debugger can make sense of DW_AT_decl_file
25039 attributes. */
25040 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
25041 add_AT_lineptr (ctnode->root_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
25042 debug_line_section_label);
25044 output_comdat_type_unit (ctnode);
25045 *slot = ctnode;
25047 htab_delete (comdat_type_table);
25049 /* Output the main compilation unit if non-empty or if .debug_macinfo
25050 will be emitted. */
25051 output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die (), debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE);
25053 /* Output the abbreviation table. */
25054 switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
25055 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
25056 output_abbrev_section ();
25058 /* Output location list section if necessary. */
25059 if (have_location_lists)
25061 /* Output the location lists info. */
25062 switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
25063 ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
25064 DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
25065 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
25066 output_location_lists (comp_unit_die ());
25069 /* Output public names table if necessary. */
25070 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
25072 gcc_assert (info_section_emitted);
25073 switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
25074 output_pubnames (pubname_table);
25077 /* Output public types table if necessary. */
25078 /* ??? Only defined by DWARF3, but emitted by Darwin for DWARF2.
25079 It shouldn't hurt to emit it always, since pure DWARF2 consumers
25080 simply won't look for the section. */
25081 if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
25083 bool empty = false;
25085 if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
25087 /* The pubtypes table might be emptied by pruning unused items. */
25088 unsigned i;
25089 pubname_ref p;
25090 empty = true;
25091 FOR_EACH_VEC_ELT (pubname_entry, pubtype_table, i, p)
25092 if (p->die->die_offset != 0)
25094 empty = false;
25095 break;
25098 if (!empty)
25100 gcc_assert (info_section_emitted);
25101 switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
25102 output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
25106 /* Output the address range information if a CU (.debug_info section)
25107 was emitted. We output an empty table even if we had no functions
25108 to put in it. This because the consumer has no way to tell the
25109 difference between an empty table that we omitted and failure to
25110 generate a table that would have contained data. */
25111 if (info_section_emitted)
25113 unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
25115 switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
25116 output_aranges (aranges_length);
25119 /* Output ranges section if necessary. */
25120 if (ranges_table_in_use)
25122 switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
25123 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
25124 output_ranges ();
25127 /* Output the source line correspondence table. We must do this
25128 even if there is no line information. Otherwise, on an empty
25129 translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
25130 .debug_info section. IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
25131 examining the file. This is done late so that any filenames
25132 used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'. */
25133 switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
25134 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
25135 if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
25136 output_line_info ();
25138 /* Have to end the macro section. */
25139 if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
25141 switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
25142 ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
25143 if (!VEC_empty (macinfo_entry, macinfo_table))
25144 output_macinfo ();
25145 dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
25148 /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
25149 table too. */
25150 if (debug_str_hash)
25151 htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
25154 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"